S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller S1D13506 TECHNICAL MANUAL Document Number: X25B-Q-001-06 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-Q-001-06 TECHNICAL MANUAL Issue Date: 01/04/18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 COMPREHENSIVE SUPPORT TOOL S EPSON provides the designer and manufacturer a complete set of resources and tools for the development of LCD Graphics Systems. Documentation • Technical manuals • Evaluation/Demonstration board manual Evaluation/Demonstration Board • • • • • • • Assembled and fully tested Graphics Evaluation/Demonstration board Schematic of Evaluation/Demonstration board Parts List Installation Guide CPU Independent Software Utilities Evaluation Software Windows CE Display Driver Application Engineering Support EPSON offers the following services through their Sales and Marketing Network: • Sales Technical Support • Customer Training • Design Assistance Application Engineering Support Engineering and Sales Support is provided by: Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 TECHNICAL MANUAL Issue Date: 01/04/18 North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 S1D13506 X25B-Q-001-06 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-Q-001-06 TECHNICAL MANUAL Issue Date: 01/04/18 ENERGY S AV I N G GRAPHICS EPSON S1D13506 S1D13506 COLOR LCD/CRT/TV CONTROLLER March 2001 The S1D13506 is a color LCD/CRT/TV graphics controller interfacing to a wide range of CPUs and display devices. The S1D13506 architecture is designed to meet the low cost, low power requirements of the embedded markets, such as Mobile Communications, Hand-Held PC’s, and Office Automation. The S1D13506 supports multiple CPUs, all LCD panel types, CRT, TV, and additionally provides a number of differentiating features. Products requiring digital camera input can take advantage of the directly supported WINNOV VideumCam™ digital interface. EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display allows the user to configure two different images on two different displays, while the SwivelView™, Hardware Cursor, Ink Layer, and BitBLT engine offer substantial performance benefits. These features, combined with the S1D13506’s Operating System independence, make it an ideal display solution for a wide variety of applications. ■ FEATURES • 16-bit EDO-DRAM or FPM-DRAM interface. • Memory size options: • • • • SwivelView™: 90°, 180°, 270° hardware rotation of displayed image. • EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display: 512K bytes using one 256K×16 device. 2M bytes using one 1M×16 device. Multiple CPU interface support. Resolutions up to: 640x480 at a color depth of 16 bpp. 800x600 at a color depth of 16 bpp. Display Support for: 4/8/16-bit passive panels. 9/12 TFT/D-TFD panels. 18-bit TFT/D-TFD to a depth of 64K colors. CRT. NTSC and PAL TV Output. • • • • • • displays different images on different displays. Virtual Display Support: displays images larger than the panel size through the use of panning. Hardware Cursor or full screen Ink Layer. 2D BitBLT Engine. WINNOV Videum® Cam digital camera interface. Software initiated Power Save Mode. Operating System Independent. ■ SYSTEM BLOCK DIAGRAM TV EDO-DRAM FPM-DRAM Analog Out CPU OR CRT Control Clock S1D13506 AND Digital Out MediaPlug Interface X25B-C-001-05 Flat Panel 1 GRAPHICS S1D13506 ■ DESCRIPTION Memory Interface • 16-bit EDO-DRAM or FPM-DRAM interface. Digital Video Camera Interface • Built-in WINNOV Videum® Cam digital camera interface. • Addressable as a single linear address space. CPU Interface • Supports the following interfaces: EPSON E0C33 NEC MIPS VR41xx Hitachi SH-4/SH-3 PC Card (PCMCIA) ISA bus Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Motorola M68xxx StrongARM (PC Card) Motorola MPC821 Toshiba MIPS TX39xx MPU with programmable READY • CPU Write buffer. Display Support • LCD Panels: 4/8/16-bit passive LCD interface. 9/12-bit TFT/D-TFD. 18-bit TFT/D-TFD to a depth of 64K colors. Display Modes • 4/8/16 bit-per-pixel (bpp) support on LCD, CRT andTV. • CRT: • TV: Embedded RAMDAC for direct analog CRT. Composite/S-Video TV output. NTSC/PAL support. Flicker filter. Luminance filter. Chrominance filter. • Maximum resolution of 800x600 at 16 bpp . Power Down Modes • Software initiated power save mode. • LCD Power Sequencing. • Up to 64 shades of gray on monochrome LCD panels using FRM and Dithering. • Up to 64K colors on passive LCD, active matrix TFT/D-TFD, CRT and TV in 16 bpp modes. • SwivelView™: 90°, 180°, 270° hardware rotation of displayed image. • EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD): displays different images on different displays. • Virtual Display Support: displays images larger than the panel size through the use of panning and scrolling. • Hardware Cursor or full screen Ink Layer. Acceleration • 2D Engine including the following BitBLTs: Write BLT Move BLT Solid Fill Pattern Fill Transparent Write BLT Transparent Move BLT Read BLT Color Expansion Move BLT with Color Expansion Operating Voltage • 2.7 volts to 5.5 volts. Package • 128-pin QFP15. . CONTACT YOUR SALES REPRESENTATIVE FOR THESE COMPREHENSIVE DESIGN TOOLS • S1D13506 Technical Manual • QNX Photon Display Driver • S5U13506 Evaluation • VXWorks UGL and WindML Boards Display Drivers • CPU Independent Software • Windows CE Display Driver Utilities Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Taiwan Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 Copyright ©1998, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All rights reserved. VDC Information in this document is subject to change without notice. You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Microsoft, Windows, and the Windows Embedded Partner Logo are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Videum is a registered trademark of WINNOV. 2 X25B-C-001-05 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Hardware Functional Specification Document Number: X25B-A-001-10 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 1.1 Scope . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 1.2 Overview Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 2 Features . . . . . . . . 2.1 Memory Interface . 2.2 CPU Interface . . 2.3 Display Support . . 2.4 Display Modes . . 2.5 Display Features . 2.6 Clock Source . . . 2.7 Acceleration . . . 2.8 MediaPlug Interface 2.9 Miscellaneous . . 3 Typical System Implementation Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 4 Internal Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 4.1 Block Diagram Showing Pipelines . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 5 Pins . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.1 Pinout Diagram . . . . . . . . 5.2 Pin Description . . . . . . . . 5.2.1 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . 5.2.2 Memory Interface . . . . . . 5.2.3 LCD Interface . . . . . . . . 5.2.4 CRT Interface . . . . . . . . 5.2.5 Miscellaneous . . . . . . . . 5.3 Summary of Configuration Options 5.4 Multiple Function Pin Mapping . 5.5 CRT/TV Interface . . . . . . . 6 D.C. Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45 7 A.C. Characteristics . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1 CPU Interface Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.1 Generic Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.2 Hitachi SH-4 Interface Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.3 Hitachi SH-3 Interface Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.4 MIPS/ISA Interface Timing (e.g. NEC VR41xx) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.5 Motorola MC68K Bus 1 Interface Timing (e.g. MC68000) . . . . . . . . 7.1.6 Motorola MC68K Bus 2 Interface Timing (e.g. MC68030) . . . . . . . . Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 18 18 19 19 19 20 20 20 20 28 28 29 29 35 37 38 38 39 40 44 48 48 48 50 52 54 56 58 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 7.6 7.7 8 7.1.7 Motorola PowerPC Interface Timing (e.g. MPC8xx, MC68040, Coldfire) 7.1.8 PC Card Timing (e.g. StrongARM) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.9 Philips Interface Timing (e.g. PR31500/PR31700) . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.1.10 Toshiba Interface Timing (e.g. TX39xx) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clock Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2.1 Input Clocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2.2 Internal Clocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Memory Interface Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3.1 EDO-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3.2 EDO-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3.3 EDO-DRAM Self-Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3.4 FPM-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3.5 FPM-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.3.6 FPM-DRAM Self-Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Power Sequencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.1 LCD Power Sequencing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.4.2 Power Save Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Display Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.1 Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.2 Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.3 Single Color 4-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.4 Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.5 Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.6 Single Color 16-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.7 Single Color 16-Bit Panel Timing with External Circuit . . . . . . . . . 7.5.8 Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.9 Dual Color 8-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.10 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.11 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel Timing with External Circuit . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.12 TFT/D-TFD Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.5.13 CRT Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . TV Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7.6.1 TV Output Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MediaPlug Interface Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 Initializing the S1D13506 . . . . . 8.1.1 Register/Memory Select Bit . . . 8.2 Register Mapping . . . . . . . . 8.3 Register Descriptions . . . . . . . 8.3.1 Basic Registers . . . . . . . . . S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 . . 62 . . 64 . . 66 . .68 . . 68 . . 69 . . 70 . . 70 . . 72 . . 73 . . 74 . . 76 . . 77 . . 78 . . 78 . . 79 . .81 . . 81 . . 84 . . 87 . . 90 . . 93 . . 96 . . 99 . .102 . .105 . .108 . .111 . .114 . .117 . 119 . .119 . 123 . . . . . . 124 124 .124 124 125 .125 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.2 8.3.3 8.3.4 8.3.5 8.3.6 8.3.7 8.3.8 8.3.9 8.3.10 8.3.11 8.3.12 8.3.13 8.3.14 8.3.15 8.3.16 8.3.17 8.3.18 9 Page 5 General IO Pins Registers . . . . . . . MD Configuration Readback Registers Clock Configuration Registers . . . . Memory Configuration Registers . . . Panel Configuration Registers . . . . . LCD Display Mode Registers . . . . . CRT/TV Configuration Registers . . . CRT/TV Display Mode Registers . . . LCD Ink/Cursor Registers . . . . . . . CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Registers . . . . BitBlt Configuration Registers . . . . Look-Up Table Registers . . . . . . . Power Save Configuration Registers . Miscellaneous Registers . . . . . . . . Common Display Mode Register . . . MediaPlug Register Descriptions . . . BitBlt Data Registers Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .126 .128 .128 .132 .135 .140 .145 .150 .153 .157 .161 .169 .170 .171 .172 .173 .177 2D BitBlt Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 9.1 Functional Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 9.2 BitBlt Operations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 178 10 Display Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1 Image Buffer . . . . . . . . . 10.2 Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Buffers 10.3 Dual Panel Buffer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 . 182 . 182 . 182 11 Display Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 11.1 Display Mode Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 11.2 Image Manipulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 12 Look-Up Table Architecture . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 12.1 Monochrome Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 12.2 Color Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 13 TV Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.1 NTSC/PAL Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.2 Clock Source . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3 Filters . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.3.1 Chrominance Filter (REG[05Bh] bit 5) . . . . 13.3.2 Luminance Filter (REG[05Bh] bit 4) . . . . . 13.3.3 Anti-flicker Filter (REG[1FCh] bits [2:1]) . . 13.4 TV Output Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13.5 TV Image Display and Positioning . . . . . . . Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 188 . . . 188 . . . 188 . . . 189 . . . .189 . . . .189 . . . . 189 . . . 190 . . . 193 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 13.6 TV Cursor Operation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 195 14 Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Architecture 14.1 Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Buffers . . 14.2 Ink/Cursor Data Format . . . . . . . 14.3 Ink/Cursor Image Manipulation . . . . 14.3.1 Ink Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2 Cursor Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 SwivelView™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.1 Concept . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.2 90° SwivelView™ . . . . . . . . 15.2.1 Register Programming . . . . . . 15.2.2 Physical Memory Requirement . 15.2.3 Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.3 180° SwivelView™ . . . . . . . . 15.3.1 Register Programming . . . . . . 15.3.2 Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . 15.4 270° SwivelView™ . . . . . . . . 15.4.1 Register Programming . . . . . . 15.4.2 Physical Memory Requirement . 15.4.3 Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 196 196 197 198 .198 .198 . 200 . 200 . 200 . .201 . .202 . .204 . 205 . .205 . .206 . 206 . .206 . .207 . .208 16 EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 16.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 209 16.2 Bandwidth Limitation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 210 17 MediaPlug Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 17.1 Revision Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 17.2 How to enable the MediaPlug Slave . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 211 18 Clocking . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.1 Frame Rate Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.1.1 LCD Frame Rate Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.1.2 CRT Frame Rate Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.1.3 TV Frame Rate Calculation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2 Example Frame Rates . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.1 Frame Rates for 640x480 with EISD Disabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.2 Frame Rates for 800x600 with EISD Disabled . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18.2.3 Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (640x480) with EISD Enabled . . . . . 18.2.4 Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (800x600) with EISD Enabled . . . . . 18.2.5 Frame Rates for LCD and NTSC TV with EISD Enabled . . . . . . . . 18.2.6 Frame Rates for LCD and PAL TV with EISD Enabled . . . . . . . . . 19 Power Save Mode S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 212 . 212 . .212 . .213 . .214 . 215 . .215 . .216 . .217 . .218 . .219 . .220 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 19.1 19.2 19.3 19.4 Display Modes . . . . . . Power Save Mode . . . . . Power Save Status Bits . . . Power Save Mode Summary . Page 7 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20 Clocks . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20.1 Clock Selection . . . . . . . . 20.2 Clock Descriptions . . . . . . 20.2.1 MCLK . . . . . . . . . . . . 20.2.2 LCD PCLK . . . . . . . . . 20.2.3 CRT/TV PCLK . . . . . . . 20.2.4 MediaPlug Clock . . . . . . 20.3 Clocks vs. Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 221 . 221 . 221 . 222 . . 223 . . 223 . . 224 . . .224 . . .224 . . .224 . . .224 . . 225 21 Mechanical Data . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 226 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 List of Tables Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-2: Memory Interface Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-3: LCD Interface Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-4: CRT Interface Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-5: Miscellaneous Interface Pin Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-6: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-7: CPU Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-8: Memory Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-9: LCD Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-10: MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-11: MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 6-1: Absolute Maximum Ratings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 6-2: Recommended Operating Conditions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 6-3: Electrical Characteristics for VDD = 5.0V typical. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 6-4: Electrical Characteristics for VDD = 3.3V typical. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 6-5: Electrical Characteristics for VDD = 3.0V typical. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-1: Generic Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-2: Hitachi SH-4 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-3: Hitachi SH-3 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-4: MIPS/ISA Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-5: Motorola MC68000 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-6: Motorola MC68030 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-7: Motorola PowerPC Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-8: PC Card Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-9: Philips Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-10: Toshiba Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-11: Clock Input Requirements for CLKI/CLKI2/BUSCLK divided down internally. . . . . Table 7-12: Clock Input Requirements for CLKI or BUSCLK if used directly for MCLK1 . . . . . Table 7-13: Internal Clock Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-14: EDO-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-15: EDO-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-16: EDO - DRAM Self-Refresh Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-17: FPM-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-18: FPM-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-19: FPM-DRAM Self-Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-20: LCD Panel Power-off/Power-on Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-21: Power Save Mode Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 29 35 37 38 38 39 40 41 42 43 43 45 45 45 46 47 49 51 53 55 57 59 61 63 65 67 68 68 69 71 72 73 75 76 77 78 80 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 10 Table 7-22: Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing. . . . . . . . . . Table 7-23: Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing. . . . . . . . . . Table 7-24: Single Color 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-25: Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 1) . . . . . . . . Table 7-26: Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 2) . . . . . . . . Table 7-27: Single Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-28: Single Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing. Table 7-29: Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-30: Dual Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-31: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-32: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing . Table 7-33: TFT/D-TFD A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-34: CRT A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-35: Horizontal Timing for NTSC/PAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-36: Vertical Timing for NTSC/PAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 7-37: MediaPlug A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-1: Register Mapping with CS# = 0 and M/R# = 0 . . . . . . . . . Table 8-2: MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-3: MCLK Source Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-4: LCD PCLK Divide Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-5: LCD PCLK Source Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-6: CRT/TV PCLK Divide Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-7: CRT/TV PCLK Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-8: MediaPlug Clock Divide Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-9: Video Clock Source Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-10: Minimum Memory Timing Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-11: Memory Type Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-12: Refresh Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-13: DRAM Refresh Rate Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-14: DRAM Timing Control Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-15: Panel Data Width Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-16: Horizontal Display Width (Pixels) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-17: LCD FPLINE Polarity Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-18: LCD FPFRAME Polarity Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-19: Setting SwivelView Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-20: LCD Bit-per-pixel Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-21: LCD Pixel Panning Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-22: DAC Output Level Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-23: CRT/TV Bit-per-pixel Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-24: CRT/TV Pixel Panning Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83 . 86 . 89 . 92 . 95 . 98 .101 .104 .107 .110 .113 .116 .118 .121 .122 .123 .124 .126 .128 .129 .129 .130 .130 .130 .131 .131 .132 .132 .133 .134 .135 .136 .138 .140 .141 .141 .144 .149 .150 .152 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 8-25: Table 8-26: Table 8-27: Table 8-28: Table 8-29: Table 8-30: Table 8-31: Table 8-32: Table 8-33: Table 8-34: Table 8-35: Table 8-36: Table 8-37: Table 8-38: Table 8-39: Table 8-40: Table 8-41: Table 10-1: Table 13-1: Table 13-2: Table 13-3: Table 13-4: Table 13-5: Table 13-6: Table 14-1: Table 14-2: Table 15-1: Table 17-1: Table 18-1: Table 18-2: Table 18-3: Table 18-4: Table 18-5: Table 18-6: Table 19-1: Table 20-1: LCD Ink/Cursor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding . . . . . . . . . . BitBlt Active Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BitBlt FIFO Data Available . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BitBlt ROP Code/Color Expansion Function Selection . . . . . BitBlt Operation Selection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . BitBlt Source Start Address Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LUT Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Setting SwivelView Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Display Mode Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MediaPlug LCMD Read/Write Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . Timeout Option Delay . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Cable Detect and Remote Powered Status. . . . . . . . . . . . MediaPlug CMD Read/Write Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . MediaPlug Commands. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S1D13506 Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Required Clock Frequencies for NTSC/PAL . . . . . . . . . . NTSC/PAL SVideo-Y (Luminance) Output Levels. . . . . . . NTSC/PAL SVideo-C (Chrominance) Output Levels. . . . . . NTSC/PAL Composite Output Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum and Maximum Values for NTSC/PAL . . . . . . . . Register Values for Example NTSC/PAL Images. . . . . . . . Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Ink/Cursor Color Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Minimum DRAM Size Required for SwivelView™ . . . . . . MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Frame Rates for 640x480 with EISD Disabled . . . . . . . . . Frame Rates for 800x600 with EISD Disabled . . . . . . . . . Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (640x480) with EISD Enabled Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (800x600) with EISD Enabled Frame Rates for LCD and NTSC TV with EISD Enabled . . . Frame Rates for LCD and PAL TV with EISD Enabled . . . . Power Save Mode Summary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clocks vs. Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Page 11 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .153 .154 .157 . 158 .161 .162 . 163 .164 .165 .169 .172 .172 .173 .173 .174 .175 .176 .181 . 188 . 190 . 191 .192 .194 .195 .196 .197 .204 .211 . 215 . 216 . 217 . 218 . 219 . 220 .222 .225 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 List of Figures Figure 3-1: Figure 3-2: Figure 3-3: Figure 3-4: Figure 3-5: Figure 3-6: Figure 3-7: Figure 3-8: Figure 3-9: Figure 3-10: Figure 4-1: Figure 5-1: Figure 5-2: Figure 7-1: Figure 7-2: Figure 7-3: Figure 7-4: Figure 7-5: Figure 7-6: Figure 7-7: Figure 7-8: Figure 7-9: Figure 7-10: Figure 7-11: Figure 7-12: Figure 7-13: Figure 7-14: Figure 7-15: Figure 7-16: Figure 7-17: Figure 7-18: Figure 7-19: Figure 7-20: Figure 7-21: Figure 7-22: Figure 7-23: Figure 7-24: Typical System Diagram (Generic Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 Typical System Diagram (Hitachi SH-4 Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Typical System Diagram (Hitachi SH-3 Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 Typical System Diagram (MC68K Bus 1, Motorola 16-Bit 68000) . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Typical System Diagram (MC68K Bus 2, Motorola 32-Bit 68030) . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Typical System Diagram (Motorola PowerPC Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Typical System Diagram (NECVR41xx MIPS Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 Typical System Diagram (PC Card Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Typical System Diagram (Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Bus). . . . . . . . . . . . . 25 Typical System Diagram (Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Bus) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 S1D13506 Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 Pinout Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 External Circuitry for CRT/TV Interface. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44 Generic Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48 Hitachi SH-4 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50 Hitachi SH-3 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52 MIPS/ISA Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54 Motorola MC68000 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 Motorola MC68030 Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 58 Motorola PowerPC Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60 PC Card Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62 Philips Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64 Toshiba Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66 CLKI Clock Input Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68 EDO-DRAM Page Mode Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 EDO-DRAM Read-Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70 EDO-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72 EDO - DRAM Self-Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73 FPM-DRAM Page Mode Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 FPM-DRAM Read-Write Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74 FPM-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76 FPM - DRAM Self-Refresh Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77 LCD Panel Power-off/Power-on Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78 Power Save Mode Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79 Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81 Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82 Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 14 Figure 7-25: Figure 7-26: Figure 7-27: Figure 7-28: Figure 7-29: Figure 7-30: Figure 7-31: Figure 7-32: Figure 7-33: Figure 7-34: Figure 7-35: Figure 7-36: Figure 7-37: Figure 7-38: Figure 7-39: Figure 7-40: Figure 7-41: Figure 7-42: Figure 7-43: Figure 7-44: Figure 7-45: Figure 7-46: Figure 7-47: Figure 7-48: Figure 7-49: Figure 7-50: Figure 7-51: Figure 7-52: Figure 7-53: Figure 7-54: Figure 10-1: Figure 11-1: Figure 11-2: Figure 12-1: Figure 12-2: Figure 12-3: Figure 13-1: Figure 13-2: Figure 13-3: Figure 13-4: S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85 Single Color 4-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87 Single Color 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 88 Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90 Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91 Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93 Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 2) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94 Single Color 16-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96 Single Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97 16-Bit Single Color Panel Timing with External Circuit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 External Circuit for Color Single 16-Bit Panel When the Media Plug is Enabled . . . . 100 Single Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103 Dual Color 8-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105 Dual Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109 16-Bit Dual Color Panel Timing with External Circuit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 111 External Circuit for Color Dual 16-Bit Panel When the Media Plug is Enabled . . . . . 112 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 112 TFT/D-TFD Panel Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114 TFT/D-TFD A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115 CRT Timing. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 117 CRT A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118 NTSC Video Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119 PAL Video Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120 Horizontal Timing for NTSC/PAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 121 Vertical Timing for NTSC/PAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 122 MediaPlug A.C. Timing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 123 Display Buffer Addressing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 181 4/8/15/16 Bit-per-pixel Format Memory Organization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 183 Image Manipulation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 184 4 Bit-Per-Pixel Monochrome Mode Data Output Path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 185 4 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Mode Data Output Path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 186 8 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Mode Data Output Path . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 187 NTSC/PAL SVideo-Y (Luminance) Output Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 190 NTSC/PAL SVideo-C (Chrominance) Output Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 191 NTSC/PAL Composite Output Levels . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 192 NTSC/PAL Image Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 194 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 13-5: Figure 14-1: Figure 14-2: Figure 14-3: Figure 15-1: Figure 20-1: Figure 21-1: Page 15 Typical Total Display and Visible Display Dimensions for NTSC and PAL . . . . . . Ink/Cursor Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Unclipped Cursor Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clipped Cursor Positioning . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Relationship Between Screen Image and 90° Rotated Image in the Display Buffer . . . Clock Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Mechanical Drawing QFP15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 195 197 198 199 200 223 226 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 1 Introduction 1.1 Scope This is the Hardware Functional Specification for the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller. Included in this document are timing diagrams, AC and DC characteristics, register descriptions, and power management descriptions. This document is intended for two audiences: Video Subsystem Designers and Software Developers. This specification will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. 1.2 Overview Description The S1D13506 is a color LCD/CRT/TV graphics controller interfacing to a wide range of CPUs and display devices. The S1D13506 architecture is designed to meet the low cost, low power requirements of the embedded markets, such as Mobile Communications, Hand-Held PC’s, and Office Automation. The S1D13506 supports multiple CPUs, all LCD panel types, CRT, TV, and additionally provides a number of differentiating features. Products requiring digital camera input can take advantage of the directly supported WINNOV VideumCam™ digital interface. The EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD) capability allows the user to configure two different images on two different displays, while the SviwelView™, Hardware Cursor, Ink Layer, and BitBLT engine offer substantial performance benefits. These features, combined with the S1D13506’s Operating System independence, make it an ideal display solution for a wide variety of applications. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Features 2.1 Memory Interface • 16-bit DRAM interface: • EDO-DRAM up to 40MHz data rate (80M Bytes/s). • FPM-DRAM up to 25MHz data rate (50M Bytes/s). • Memory size options: • 512K bytes using one 256K×16 device. • 2M bytes using one 1M×16 device. • A configuration register can be programmed to enhance performance by tailoring the memory control output timing to the DRAM device. • The complete 2M byte display buffer address space is directly and contiguously available through the 21-bit address bus. 2.2 CPU Interface • Supports the following interfaces: • Epson E0C33 (16-bit interface to 32-bit microprocessor). • Hitachi SH-4 bus interface. • Hitachi SH-3 bus interface. • MIPS/ISA. • Motorola MC68000 (16-bit interface to 16/32-bit microprocessor/microcontroller). • Motorola MC68030 (16-bit interface to 16/32-bit microprocessor/microcontroller). • Motorola PowerPC MPC82x (16-bit interface to 32-bit microprocessor). • MPU bus interface with programmable READY. • NEC MIPS VR41xx. • PC Card (PCMCIA). • Philips MIPS PR31500/31700. • Toshiba MIPS TX39xx. • StrongARM (PC Card). • One-stage write buffer for minimum wait-state CPU writes. • Registers are memory-mapped – the M/R# pin selects between display buffer and register address space. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 2.3 Display Support • 4/8-bit monochrome or 4/8/16-bit color LCD interface for single-panel, single-drive displays. • 8-bit monochrome or 8/16-bit color LCD interface for dual-panel, dual-drive displays. • Direct support for 9/12-bit TFT/D-TFD, 18-bit TFT/D-TFD is supported up to 64K colors. • Direct support for CRT up to 64K colors using Embedded RAMDAC. • Direct support for NTSC/PAL TV output using Embedded RAMDAC. 2.4 Display Modes • 4/8/15/16 bit-per-pixel (bpp) color depths. • Up to 64 shades of gray on monochrome passive LCD panels using Frame Rate Modulation (FRM) and Dithering. • Up to 32K/64K colors in 15/16 bpp modes on color passive LCD panels using dithering. • Up to 64K colors on TFT/D-TFD, CRT and TV. • 4/8 bit-per-pixel color depths are mapped using three 256x4 Look-Up Tables (LUT) allowing 16/256 out of a possible 4096 colors. • Separate LUTs for LCD and CRT/TV. • 15/16 bit-per-pixel color depths are mapped directly, bypassing the LUT. • Example Resolutions: 320 x 240 at a color depth of 16 bpp. 640 x 240 at a color depth of 16 bpp. 640 x 480 at a color depth of 16 bpp. 800 x 600 at a color depth of 16 bpp. 2.5 Display Features • SwivelView™: 90°, 180°, 270° hardware rotation of display image. • EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD): displays independent images on different displays (CRT or TV and passive or TFT/D-TFD panel). • Virtual Display Support: displays images larger than the panel size through the use of panning and scrolling. • Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer: separate 64x64x2 hardware cursor or 2-bit ink layer for both LCD and CRT/TV. • Double Buffering/Multi-pages: for smooth animation and instantaneous screen update. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2.6 Clock Source • Memory clock can be derived from CLKI or BUSCLK pin. It can be internally divided by 2. • Pixel clock can be derived from CLKI, CLKI2, or BUSCLK pin. It can be internally divided by 2, 3 or 4. • Bus clock can be BUSCLK or (BUSCLK)/2, i.e. a 2x clock may be used. 2.7 Acceleration • 2D Engine including the following 2 ROP BitBlts: Write BLT. Move BLT. Solid Fill. Pattern Fill. Transparent Write BLT. Transparent Move BLT. Read BLT. Color Expansion. Move BLT with Color Expansion. 2.8 MediaPlug Interface • Built-in WINNOV MediaPlug interface. • Videum®Cam support at resolution of 320x240x256 color at 30fps. 2.9 Miscellaneous • The memory data bus, MD[15:0], is used to configure the chip at power-on. • Three General Purpose Input/Output pins, GPIO[3:1], are available if upper Memory Address pins are not required for asymmetric DRAM support. • Power save mode is initiated by software. • Operating voltage from 2.7 volts to 5.5 volts. • 128-pin QFP15 surface mount package. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 21 3 Typical System Implementation Diagrams For the pin mapping of each system implementation, see Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on pag e40. Oscillator Oscillator CLKI2 CLKI . Generic BUS BS# FPDAT[7:4] A0 A[27:21] CSn# Decoder M/R# CS# FPSHIFT FPFRAME FPFRAME A[20:1] AB[20:1] FPLINE D[15:0] DB[15:0] DRDY WE0# WE0# WE1# WE1# RD0# RD# RD1# RD/WR# RED,GREEN,BLUE HRTC RAS# LCAS# UCAS# LCAS# UCAS# WE# RAS# MD[15:0] VRTC WE# D[15:0] BUSCLK RESET# MA[11:0] BCLK DRDY (MOD) GPIOx WAIT# RESET# LCD Display FPLINE S1D13506 A[11:0] WAIT# 4-bit Single L[3:0] FPSHIFT Power VDD IREF CRT/TV Display IREF 1Mx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-1: Typical System Diagram (Generic Bus) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 22 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Oscillator CLKI SH-4 BUS Oscillator CLKI2 . VDD M/R# CSn# CS# A[20:1] AB[20:1] D[15:0] DB[15:0] FPDAT[7:4] FPSHIFT FPFRAME FPFRAME FPLINE WE1# WE1# BS# BS# RD/WR# DRDY FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 4-bit Single LCD Display GPIOx RD/WR# RD# D[3:0] FPSHIFT Power A0 A[21] RD# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# LCAS# UCAS# WE# RAS# BUSCLK RESET# CRT/TV Display VRTC WE# CKIO RESET# MD[15:0] HRTC D[15:0] RED,GREEN,BLUE WAIT# MA[8:0] WE0# RDY# A[8:0] WE0# IREF IREF 256Kx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-2: Typical System Diagram (Hitachi SH-4 Bus) Oscillator CLKI SH-3 BUS Oscillator CLKI2 . VDD M/R# CSn# CS# A[20:1] AB[20:1] D[15:0] DB[15:0] FPDAT[7:0] FPSHIFT Single FPFRAME FPFRAME LCD Display FPLINE WE1# BS# RD/WR# RD# WE1# BS# 8-bit D[7:0] FPSHIFT DRDY FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 Power A0 A[21] GPIOx RD/WR# RD# WE# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# BUSCLK RESET# VRTC WE# CKIO RESET# MD[15:0] HRTC D[15:0] RED,GREEN,BLUE WAIT# MA[8:0] WE0# A[8:0] WE0# WAIT# IREF CRT/TV Display IREF 256Kx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-3: Typical System Diagram (Hitachi SH-3 Bus) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 23 . Oscillator Oscillator MC68000 BUS Decoder M/R# Decoder CS# FPDAT[7:4] UD[3:0] FPDAT[3:0] LD[3:0] FPSHIFT FPSHIFT 8-bit Dual FPFRAME FPFRAME LCD Display A[20:1] AB[20:1] FPLINE D[15:0] DB[15:0] DRDY LDS# AB0 UDS# WE1# AS# FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 Power A[23:21] FC0, FC1 CLKI RD# WE0# CLKI2 VDD GPIOx BS# R/W# RED,GREEN,BLUE RD/WR# DTACK# UCAS# UCAS# RAS# LCAS# LCAS# WE# RAS# MD[15:0] VRTC WE# MA[11:0] A[11:0] BUSCLK RESET# D[15:0] CLK RESET# CRT/TV Display HRTC WAIT# IREF IREF 256Kx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-4: Typical System Diagram (MC68K Bus 1, Motorola 16-Bit 68000) . Oscillator Oscillator M/R# Decoder CS# FPDAT[8:0] A[20:0] AB[20:0] D[31:16] DB[15:0] FPSHIFT 9-bit FPFRAME FPFRAME TFT Display FPLINE DS# WE1# AS# BS# R/W# RD/WR# DRDY S1D13506 WE0# RED,GREEN,BLUE WAIT# HRTC LCAS# UCAS# LCAS# UCAS# RAS# RAS# WE# VRTC WE# A[8:0] D[15:0] BUSCLK RESET# MD[15:0] SIZ0 DSACK1# MA[8:0] RD# CLK FPLINE DRDY (MOD) GPIOx SIZ1 RESET# D[8:0] FPSHIFT Power Decoder CLKI A[31:21] FC0, FC1 CLKI2 MC68030 BUS IREF CRT/TV Display IREF 256Kx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-5: Typical System Diagram (MC68K Bus 2, Motorola 32-Bit 68030) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 24 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Oscillator Oscillator M/R# Decoder CS# FPSHIFT FPSHIFT 16-bit Single FPFRAME FPFRAME LCD Display FPDAT[15:0] A[11:31] AB[20:0] D[0:15] DB[15:0] D[15:0] FPLINE BI# TS# BS# RD/WR# RD/WR# S1D13506 WE0# RED,GREEN,BLUE TA# WAIT# HRTC CRT/TV Display UCAS# UCAS# RAS# LCAS# LCAS# RAS# WE# VRTC WE# D[15:0] A[8:0] BUSCLK RESET# MD[15:0] TSIZ1 MA[8:0] RD# RESET# DRDY (MOD) GPIOx TSIZ0 CLKOUT FPLINE DRDY WE1# Power Decoder CLKI A[0:10] CLKI2 PowerPC BUS IREF IREF 256Kx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-6: Typical System Diagram (Motorola PowerPC Bus) Oscillator Oscillator CLKI2 CLKI . MIPS BUS M/R# Decoder FPDAT[7:0] CSn# CS# A[20:0] AB[20:0] D[15:0] DB[15:0] FPSHIFT FPSHIFT Single FPFRAME FPFRAME LCD Display FPLINE FPLINE DRDY MEMW# WE0# SBHE# WE1# MEMR# DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 GPIOx RD# VDD RED,GREEN,BLUE RD/WR# BS# WE# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# MD[15:0] VRTC WE# D[15:0] BUSCLK RESET# MA[11:0] BCLK RESET CRT/TV Display HRTC WAIT# A[11:0] RDY 8-bit D[7:0] Power A[25:21] IREF IREF 1Mx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-7: Typical System Diagram (NECVR41xx MIPS Bus) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 25 Oscillator CLKI PC Card BUS Oscillator CLKI2 . VDD Decoder A[25:21] Decoder M/R# CS# FPDAT[15:8] UD[7:0] FPDAT[7:0] LD[7:0] FPSHIFT FPSHIFT FPFRAME FPFRAME A[20:1] AB[20:1] FPLINE D[15:0] DB[15:0] DRDY WE# WE0# CE2# WE1# OE# 16-bit Dual LCD Display FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 Power A0 GPIOx RD# CE1# RED,GREEN,BLUE RD/WR# WAIT# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# LCAS# UCAS# WE# RAS# MD[15:0] D[15:0] VRTC WE# MA[11:0] BUSCLK A[11:0] RESET# Oscillator CRT/TV Display HRTC WAIT# RESET IREF IREF 1Mx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-8: Typical System Diagram (PC Card Bus) A[12:0] D[23:16] DB[15:8] DB[7:0] AB20 D[31:24] ALE /CARDREG /CARDIORD AB18 AB17 /CARDxCSH WE1# /CARDxCSL RD/WR# UD[3:0] LD[3:0] FPSHIFT FPSHIFT 8-bit Dual FPFRAME FPFRAME LCD Display FPLINE AB19 /CARDIOWR FPDAT[7:4] FPDAT[3:0] DRDY FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 Power M/R# CS# BS# AB[16:13] AB[12:0] Oscillator CLKI PR31500 /PR31700 BUS Oscillator CLKI2 . GPIOx RAS# LCAS# UCAS# RAS# LCAS# UCAS# RESET# VRTC WE# BUSCLK RESET# MD[15:0] DCLKOUT HRTC WE# WAIT# D[15:0] /CARDxWAIT RED,GREEN,BLUE MA[11:0] RD# WE0# A[11:0] /RD /WE IREF CRT/TV Display IREF 1Mx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-9: Typical System Diagram (Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Bus) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 26 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CARDIORD* AB18 CARDIOWR* AB17 CARDxCSH* WE1# CARDxCSL* RD/WR# FPFRAME FPFRAME TFT Display DRDY FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 RAS# LCAS# UCAS# UCAS# VRTC LCAS# BUSCLK RESET# CRT/TV Display HRTC WE# WAIT# RAS# WE0# CARDxWAIT* MD[15:0] RD# RED,GREEN,BLUE WE# RD* PON* 12-bit GPIOx WE* DCLKOUT FPSHIFT FPLINE AB19 D[11:0] FPSHIFT Power DB[7:0] AB20 D[15:0] D[31:24] ALE CARDREG* MA[11:0] D[23:16] FPDAT[11:0] A[11:0] A[12:0] M/R# CS# BS# AB[16:13] AB[12:0] DB[15:8] Oscillator CLKI TX3912 BUS Oscillator CLKI2 . IREF IREF 1Mx16 FPM/EDO-DRAM Figure 3-10: Typical System Diagram (Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Bus) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 27 4 Internal Description 4.1 Block Diagram Showing Pipelines DRAM Camera MediaPlug I/F Memory Controller Host CPU LCD Pipeline I/F LCD LUT LCD I/F LCD 2D Register CRT/TV Pipeline CRT/TV LUT DAC CRT /TV TV Encoder Power Save Figure 4-1: S1D13506 Block Diagram Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 28 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5 Pins 5.1 Pinout Diagram 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76 75 74 73 72 71 70 69 68 67 66 65 128 MA2 127 MA4 126 MA3 125 VSS 124 CLKI 123 TESTEN 122 CLKI2 121 VDD 120 FPFRAME 119 FPLINE 118 NC 117 DRDY 116 FPSHIFT 115 VSS 114 FPDAT0 113 FPDAT1 112 FPDAT2 111 FPDAT4 110 FPDAT3 109 FPDAT5 108 FPDAT6 107 FPDAT7 106 VSS 105 FPDAT8 104 FPDAT9 103 FPDAT10 102 FPDAT11 101 FPDAT12 100 FPDAT13 99 FPDAT14 98 FPDAT15 VSS 97 MA5 VDD DACVSS MA1 DACVDD MA6 RED MA0 IREF MA7 MA10 DACVDD MA8 GREEN MA11 DACVDD BLUE MA9 DACVSS VDD HRTC RAS# VRTC WE# VDD UCAS# VSS LCAS# AB20 VSS AB19 MD7 S1D13506 AB18 MD8 AB17 MD6 AB16 MD9 AB15 MD5 AB14 MD10 AB13 MD4 AB12 MD11 AB11 MD3 AB10 MD12 AB9 MD2 AB8 MD13 AB7 MD1 AB6 MD14 AB5 MD0 AB4 MD15 AB3 VDD 63 62 61 60 59 58 57 56 55 54 53 52 51 50 49 48 47 46 45 44 43 42 41 40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 DB0 VSS DB1 DB2 DB3 DB4 DB5 DB6 DB8 DB7 DB9 DB10 DB12 DB11 DB13 DB14 DB15 VSS WAIT# VDD BUSCLK 8 RESET# 7 RD/WR# WE1# 6 WE0# 5 BS# 4 RD# 3 M/R# AB0 2 CS# AB2 AB1 1 64 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 Figure 5-1: Pinout Diagram 128-pin QFP15 surface mount package S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 29 5.2 Pin Description Key: I O IO A P C CD CS COx = = = = = = = = = TSx = TSu = TSxD = CNx CNxU CNxD = = = Input Output Bi-Directional (Input/Output) Analog Power pin CMOS level input CMOS level input with pull down resistor (typical values of 50Ω/90ΚΩ at 5V/3.3V respectively) CMOS level Schmitt input CMOS output driver, x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V) Tri-state CMOS output driver, x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V), x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V) TSx with pull up resistor (typical values of 100KΩ/180ΚΩ at 5V/3.3V respectively) TSx with pull down resistor, x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V) (typical values of 100KΩ/180ΚΩ at 5V/3.3V) CMOS low-noise output driver, x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V) CNx with pull up resistor, x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V) CNx with pull down resistor, x denotes driver type (1=4/-4mA, 2=8/-8mA, 3=12/-12mA @ 5V) 5.2.1 Host Bus Interface Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions Pin Name AB0 Type I Pin # 3 Cell CS RESET# State Hi-Z Description • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin must be connected to VSS or VDD. • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin inputs the lower data strobe (LDS#). • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin inputs system address bit 0 (A0). • For Generic Bus, this pin must be connected to VSS or VDD. • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin inputs system address bit 0 (SA0). • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs system address bit 0 (A0). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs system address bit 0 (A0). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs system address bit 31 (A31). • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin must be connected to VSS or VDD. SeeTable 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. AB[12:1] I 119-128, 1, 2 C Hi-Z • For PowerPC Bus, these pins input the system address bits 19 through 30 (A[19:30]). • For all other busses, these pins input the system address bits 12 through 1 (A[12:1]). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 30 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions (Continued) Pin Name AB[16:13] Type I Pin # 115-118 Cell C RESET# State Hi-Z Description • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, these pins are connected to VDD. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, these pins are connected to VDD. • For PowerPC Bus, these pins input the system address bits 15 through 18 (A[15:18]). • For all other busses, these pins input the system address bits 16 through 13 (A[16:13]). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. AB17 I 114 C Hi-Z • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the IO write command (/CARDIOWR). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the IO write command (CARDIOWR*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the system address bit 14 (A14). • For all other busses, this pin inputs the system address bit 17 (A17). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. AB18 I 113 C Hi-Z • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the IO read command (/CARDIORD). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the IO read command (CARDIORD*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the system address bit 13 (A13). • For all other busses, this pin inputs the system address bit 18 (A18). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. AB19 I 112 C Hi-Z • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the card control register access (/CARDREG). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the card control register access (CARDREG*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the system address bit 12 (A12). • For all other busses, this pin inputs the system address bit 19 (A19). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. AB20 I 111 C Hi-Z • For the MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin inputs system address bit 20. Note that for the ISA Bus, the unlatched LA20 must first be latched before input to AB20. • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the address latch enable (ALE). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the address latch enable (ALE). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the system address bit 11 (A11). • For all other busses, this pin inputs the system address bit 20 (A20). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 31 Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions (Continued) Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State Description These pins are the system data bus. For 8-bit bus modes, unused data pins should be tied to VDD. DB[15:0] IO 16-31 C/TS2 Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, these pins are connected to D[15:0]. • For MC68K Bus 1, these pins are connected to D[15:0]. • For MC68K Bus 2, these pins are connected to D[31:16] for 32-bit devices (e.g. MC68030) or D[15:0] for 16-bit devices (e.g. MC68340). • For Generic Bus, these pins are connected to D[15:0]. • For MIPS/ISA Bus, these pins are connected to SD[15:0]. • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, pins DB[15:8] are connected to D[23:16] and pins DB[7:0] are connected to D[31:24]. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, pins DB[15:8] are connected to D[23:16] and pins DB[7:0] are connected to D[31:24]. • For PowerPC Bus, these pins are connected to D[0:15]. • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, these pins are connected to D[15:0]. See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: WE1# IO 9 CS/TS 2 Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin inputs the write enable signal for the upper data byte (WE1#). • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin inputs the upper data strobe (UDS#). • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin inputs the data strobe (DS#). • For Generic Bus, this pin inputs the write enable signal for the upper data byte (WE1#). • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin inputs the system byte high enable signal (SBHE#). • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the odd byte access enable signal (/CARDxCSH). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the odd byte access enable signal (CARDxCSH*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin outputs the burst inhibit signal (BI#). • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin inputs the card enable 2 signal (CE2#). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. M/R# I 5 C Hi-Z • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin is connected to V DD. • For all other busses, this input pin is used to select between the display buffer and register address spaces of the S1D13506. M/R# is set high to access the display buffer and low to access the registers. See Register Mapping. See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40. CS# I 4 C Hi-Z • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin is connected to V DD. • For all other busses, this is the Chip Select input. See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 32 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions (Continued) Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State Description This pin inputs the system bus clock. It is possible to apply a 2x clock and divide it by 2 internally - see MD12 in Summary of Configuration Options. BUSCLK I 13 C Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin is connected to CKIO. • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin is connected to CLK. • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin is connected to CLK. • For Generic Bus, this pin is connected to BCLK. • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin is connected to CLK. • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin is connected to DCLKOUT. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin is connected to DCLKOUT. • For PowerPC Bus, this pin is connected to CLKOUT. • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin is connected to an external input clock source. See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: BS# I 6 CS Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin inputs the bus start signal (BS#). • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin inputs the address strobe (AS#). • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin inputs the address strobe (AS#). • For Generic Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin is connected to V DD. • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the Transfer Start signal (TS#). • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: RD/WR# I 10 CS Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin inputs the read write signal (RD/WR#). The S1D13506 needs this signal for early decode of the bus cycle. • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin inputs the read write signal (R/W#). • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin inputs the read write signal (R/W#). • For Generic Bus, this pin inputs the read command for the upper data byte (RD1#). • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin is connected to VDD. • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the even byte access enable signal (/CARDxCSL). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the even byte access enable signal (CARDxCSL*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the read write signal (RD/WR#). • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin inputs the card enable 1 signal (CE1#). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 33 Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions (Continued) Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State Description This is a multi-purpose pin: RD# I 7 CS Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin inputs the read signal (RD#). • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin is connected to V DD. • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin inputs the bus size bit 1 (SIZ1). • For Generic Bus, this pin inputs the read command for the lower data byte (RD0#). • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin inputs the memory read signal (MEMR#). • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the memory read command (/RD). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the memory read command (RD*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the transfer size 0 signal (TSIZ0). • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin inputs the output enable signal (OE#). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: WE0# I 8 CS Hi-Z • For SH-3/SH-4 Bus, this pin inputs the write enable signal for the lower data byte (WE0#). • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin must be connected to VDD • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin inputs the bus size bit 0 (SIZ0). • For Generic Bus, this pin inputs the write enable signal for the lower data byte (WE0#). • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin inputs the memory write signal (MEMW#). • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin inputs the memory write command (/WE). • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin inputs the memory write command (WE*). • For PowerPC Bus, this pin inputs the Transfer Size 1 signal (TSIZ1). • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin inputs the write enable signal (WE#). See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 34 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 5-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Descriptions (Continued) Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State Description The active polarity of the WAIT# output is configurable; the state of MD5 on the rising edge of RESET# defines the active polarity of WAIT# - see “Summary of Configuration Options”. WAIT# O 15 TS2 Hi-Za or 1b or 0c • For SH-3 Bus, this pin outputs the wait request signal (WAIT#); MD5 must be pulled low during reset by the internal pull-down resistor. • For SH-4 Bus, this pin outputs the ready signal (RDY#); MD5 must be pulled high during reset by an external pull-up resistor. • For MC68K Bus 1, this pin outputs the data transfer acknowledge signal (DTACK#); MD5 must be pulled high during reset by an external pull-up resistor. • For MC68K Bus 2, this pin outputs the data transfer and size acknowledge bit 1 (DSACK1#); MD5 must be pulled high during reset by an external pull-up resistor. • For Generic Bus, this pin outputs the wait signal (WAIT#); MD5 must be pulled low during reset by the internal pull-down resistor. • For MIPS/ISA Bus, this pin outputs the IO channel ready signal (IOCHRDY); MD5 must be pulled low during reset by the internal pull-down resistor. • For Philips PR31500/31700 Bus, this pin outputs the wait state signal (/CARDxWAIT). MD5 must be pulled low during reset by the internal pull-down resistor. • For Toshiba TX3912 Bus, this pin outputs the wait state signal (CARDxWAIT*). MD5 must be pulled low during reset by the internal pull-down resistor. • For PowerPC Bus, this pin outputs the transfer acknowledge signal (TA#); MD5 must be pulled high during reset by an external pull-up resistor. • For PC Card (PCMCIA) Bus, this pin outputs the wait signal (WAIT#); MD5 must be pulled low during reset by the internal pulldown resistor. See Table 5-7:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 40 for summary. See the respective AC Timing diagram for detailed functionality. RESET# I 11 CS 0 Active low input that clears all internal registers and forces all outputs to their inactive states. Note that active high RESET signals must be inverted before input to this pin. a When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that WAIT# can be tristated. the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that WAIT# is always driven and active low. c When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that WAIT# is always driven and active high. bWhen S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 35 5.2.2 Memory Interface Table 5-2: Memory Interface Pin Descriptions Pin Name LCAS# Type O Pin # 51 Cell CO1 RESET# State 1 Description • For dual-CAS# DRAM, this is the column address strobe for the lower byte (LCAS#). • For single-CAS DRAM, this is the column address strobe (CAS#). See Table 5-8:, “Memory Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 41 for summary. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: UCAS# O 52 CO1 1 • For dual-CAS# DRAM, this is the column address strobe for the upper byte (UCAS#). • For single-CAS# DRAM, this is the write enable signal for the upper byte (UWE#). See Table 5-8:, “Memory Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 41 for summary. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. WE# O 53 CO1 1 RAS# O 54 CO1 1 • For dual-CAS# DRAM, this is the write enable signal (WE#). • For single-CAS# DRAM, this is the write enable signal for the lower byte (LWE#). See Table 5-8:, “Memory Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 41 for summary. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. Row address strobe - see Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. Bi-directional memory data bus. MD[15:0] IO 34, 36, 38, 40, 42, 44, 46, 48, 49, C/TS1D 47, 45, 43, 41, 39, 37, 35 Hi-Z (pull 0) During reset, these pins are inputs and their states at the rising edge of RESET# are used to configure the chip - see Summary of Configuration Options on page 39. Internal pull-down resistors (typical values of 100KΩ/180ΚΩ at 5V/3.3V respectively) pull the reset states to 0. External pull-up resistors can be used to pull the reset states to 1. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 36 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 5-2: Memory Interface Pin Descriptions (Continued) Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State MA[8:0] O 58, 60, 62, 64, 66, 67, 65, 63, 61 CO1 0 Description Multiplexed memory address - see Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: MA9 IO 56 C/TS1 0a or Hi-Zb • For 2M byte DRAM, this is memory address bit 9 (MA9). • For asymmetrical 512K byte DRAM, this is memory address bit 9 (MA9). • For symmetrical 512K byte DRAM, this pin can be used as general purpose IO pin 3 (GPIO3). Note that unless configured otherwise, this pin defaults to an input and must be driven to a valid logic level. See Table 5-8:, “Memory Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 41 for summary. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: MA10 IO 59 C/TS1 0c or Hi-Zd • For asymmetrical 2M byte DRAM this is memory address bit 10 (MA10). • For symmetrical 2M byte DRAM and all 512K byte DRAM this pin can be used as general purpose IO pin 1 (GPIO1). Note that unless configured otherwise, this pin defaults to an input and must be driven to a valid logic level. See Table 5-8:, “Memory Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 41 for summary. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. This is a multi-purpose pin: MA11 IO 57 C/TS1 0e or Hi-Zf or 1g • For asymmetrical 2M byte DRAM this is memory address bit 11 (MA11). • For symmetrical 2M byte DRAM and all 512K byte DRAM this pin can be used as general purpose IO pin 2 (GPIO2). Note that unless configured otherwise, this pin defaults to an input and must be driven to a valid logic level. See Table 5-8:, “Memory Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 41 for summary. See Memory Interface Timing on page 70 for detailed functionality. This pin can also be configured as the MediaPlug power pin VMPEPWR - see Table 5-10:, “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping,” on page 43 for details. a When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA9 is used as MA9. the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA9 is used as GPIO3. c When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA10 is used as MA10. d When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA10 is used as GPIO1. eWhen the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA11 is used as MA11. f When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA11 is used as GPIO2. g When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that MA11 is used as VMPEPWR. bWhen S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 37 5.2.3 LCD Interface Table 5-3: LCD Interface Pin Descriptions Pin Name FPDAT[8:0] FPDAT9 FPDAT[13:10] Type O O IO RESET# State Description CN3 0 Panel data bus. Not all pins are used for some panels - see Table 5-9:, “LCD Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 42 for details. Unused pins are driven low. FPDAT[15:8] can be configured for MediaPlug interface see Table 5-11:, “MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 43 for details. CN3D 0a or Hi-Zb Panel data bus. Not all pins are used for some panels - see Table 5-9:, “LCD Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 42 for details. Unused pins are driven low. FPDAT[15:8] can be configured for MediaPlug interface see Table 5-11:, “MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 43 for details. C/TS3U 0c or Hi-Zd Panel data bus. Not all pins are used for some panels - see Table 5-9:, “LCD Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 42 for details. Unused pins are driven low. FPDAT[15:8] can be configured for MediaPlug interface see Table 5-11:, “MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 43 for details. Pin # Cell 88, 86-79 89 93-90 FPDAT[15:14] O 95,94 CN3 0 Panel data bus. Not all pins are used for some panels - see Table 5-9:, “LCD Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 42 for details. Unused pins are driven low. FPDAT[15:8] can be configured for MediaPlug interface see Table 5-11:, “MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 43 for details. FPFRAME O 73 CN3 0 Frame pulse FPLINE O 74 CN3 0 Line pulse FPSHIFT O 77 CO3 0 Shift clock This is a multi-purpose pin: DRDY O 76 CO3 0e or 1f • For TFT/D-TFD panels this is the display enable output (DRDY). • For passive LCD with Format 1 interface this is the 2nd Shift Clock (FPSHIFT2). • For all other LCD panels this is the LCD backplane bias signal (MOD). See Table 5-9:, “LCD Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 42 and REG[030h] for details. This pin can also be configured as the MediaPlug power pin VMPEPWR - see Table 5-10:, “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping,” on page 43 for details. aWhen the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that FPDAT9 is used as FPDAT9. When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that FPDAT9 is used as VMPRCTL. cWhen the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that FPDAT[13:10] is used as FPDAT[13:10]. d When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that FPDAT[13:10] is used as VMPD[3:0]. e When the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that DRDY is used as DRDY (MOD). fWhen the MD configuration at RESET# is set such that DRDY is used as VMPEPWR. b Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 38 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5.2.4 CRT Interface Table 5-4: CRT Interface Pin Descriptions Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State HRTC O 107 CN3 0 Horizontal retrace signal for CRT VRTC O 108 CN3 0 Vertical retrace signal for CRT Description RED O 100 A no output Analog output for CRT color Red / S-Video Luminance current GREEN O 103 A no output Analog output for CRT color Green / Composite Video Out current BLUE O 105 A no output Analog output for CRT color Blue / S-Video Chrominance current IREF I 101 A -- Current reference for DAC. This pin must be connected to V SS if the DAC is not needed. 5.2.5 Miscellaneous Table 5-5: Miscellaneous Interface Pin Descriptions Pin Name Type Pin # Cell RESET# State Description CLKI I 69 C -- Selectable input clock. Can be used for the internal pixel clock (PCLK), memory clock (MCLK), and MediaPlug Clock. CLKI2 I 71 C -- Selectable input clock. Can be used for the internal pixel clock (PCLK) and MediaPlug Clock. TESTEN I 70 CD -- Test Enable. This pin should be connected to VSS for normal operation. VDD P 12, 33, 55, 72, 97, 109 P -- VDD DACVDD P 99, 102, 104 P -- DAC VDD VSS P 14, 32, 50, 68, 78, 87, 96, 110 P -- VSS DACVSS P 98, 106 P -- DAC VSS NC - 75 -- Not connected S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 39 5.3 Summary of Configuration Options Table 5-6: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options Pin Name value of this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure:(1/0) 1 MD0 0 Not used, value of this pin at rising edge of RESET# can be read at REG[00Ch] bit 0 Select Host Bus Interface as follows: MD11,MD[3:1] MD11 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 MD3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 MD2 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 1 MD1 0 1 0 1 0 1 0 1 1 Host Bus SH-4/SH-3 Bus interface MC68K Bus 1 MC68K Bus 2 Generic Reserved MIPS/ISA PowerPC PC Card (PCMCIA) Philips PR31500/PR31700 / Toshiba TX3912 MD4 Little Endian Big Endian MD5 WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD[7:6] Memory Address/GPIO configuration: (See Table 5-10:, “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping,” on page 43) 00 = symmetrical 256K×16 DRAM. MA[8:0] = DRAM address. MA[11:9] can be used as GPIO2,1,3 pins. 01 = symmetrical 1M×16 DRAM. MA[9:0] = DRAM address. MA[11:10] can be used as GPIO2,1 pins. 10 = asymmetrical 256K×16 DRAM. MA[9:0] = DRAM address. MA[11:10] can be used as GPIO2,1 pins. 11 = asymmetrical 1M×16 DRAM. MA[11:0] = DRAM address. MD8 Not used, value of this pin at rising edge of RESET# can be read at REG[00Dh] bit 0 MD9 Not used, value of this pin at rising edge of RESET# can be read at REG[00Dh] bit 1 MD10 Not Used, value of this pin at rising edge of RESET# can be read at REG[00Dh] bit 2 MD12 BUSCLK input divided by 2 BUSCLK input not divided MD13 Configure FPDAT[15:8] for MediaPlug I/F. External latches required to support 16-bit passive panels. Support 16-bit passive panels directly MD14 DRDY or MA11 is configured as MediaPlug power down pin (VMPEPWR). (See Table 5-10:, “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping,” on page 43) DRDY is configured as a normal LCD I/F output pin. MA11 is configured as either a memory address or GPIO2. (See Table 5-10:, “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping,” on page 43) MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is tristated when the chip is not accessed by the host Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 40 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5.4 Multiple Function Pin Mapping Table 5-7: CPU Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names Generic Hitachi SH-4/SH-3 MIPS/ISA Motorola MC68K Bus 1 Motorola MC68K Bus 2 Motorola PowerPC PC Card Philips PR31500 /PR31700 Toshiba TX3912 AB20 A20 A20 LatchA20 A20 A20 A11 A20 ALE ALE AB19 A19 A19 SA19 A19 A19 A12 A19 /CARDREG CARDREG* AB18 A18 A18 SA18 A18 A18 A13 A18 /CARDIORD CARDIORD* AB17 A17 A17 SA17 A17 A17 A14 A17 /CARDIOWR CARDIOWR* AB[16:13] A[16:13] A[16:13] SA[16:13] A[16:13] A[16:13] A[15:18] A[16:13] AB[12:1] A[12:1] A[12:1] SA[12:1] A[12:1] A[12:1] A[19:30] A[12:1] A[12:1] A[12:1] AB0 Connected to VDD1 Connected to VDD1 SA0 LDS# A0 A31 Connected to VDD1 A0 A0 DB[15:8] D[15:0] D[15:8] SD[15:0] D[15:8] D[31:24] D[0:7] D[15:0] D[23:16] D[23:16] DB[7:0] D[7:0] D[7:0] SD[7:0] D[7:0] D[23:16] D[8:15] D[7:0] D[31:24] D[31:24] WE1# WE1# WE1# SBHE# UDS# DS# BI CE2# /CARDxCSH CARDxCSH* Connected to VDD Connected to VDD M/R# External Decode Connected to VDD Connected to VDD CS# External Decode Connected to VDD Connected to VDD BUSCLK BS# BCLK Connected to VDD CKIO BS# CLK Connected to VDD Connected to External Oscillator2 CLK CLK CLKOUT AS# AS# TS R/W# R/W# RD/WR CE1# /CARDxCSL CARDxCSL* SIZ1 TSIZ0 OE# /RD RD* SIZ0 TSIZ1 WE# /WE WE* Connected to VDD RD/WR# RD1# RD/WR# RD# RD0# RD# MEMR# WE0# WE0# WE0# MEMW# WAIT# WAIT# RDY# /WAIT# IOCHRDY DTACK# DSACK1# TA WAIT# RESET# RESET# RESET# inverted RESET RESET# RESET# RESET# inverted RESET VDD Connected to VDD Connected to VDD DCLKOUT DCLKOUT Connected to VDD Connected to VDD /CARDxWAIT CARDxWAIT* RESET# PON* Note All GPIO pins default to input on reset and unless programmed otherwise, must be connected to either VSS or IO VDD if not used. Note 1 AB0 is not used internally for these busses and must be connected to either VSS or VDD. 2 For further information on interfacing the S1D13506 to the PC Card bus, see Interfacing to the PC Card Bus, document number X25B-G-005-xx. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 41 Table 5-8: Memory Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names FPM/EDO-DRAM Sym 256Kx16 2-CAS# 2-WE# Asym 256Kx16 2-CAS# Sym 1Mx16 2-WE# MD[15:0] 2-CAS# 2-WE# Asym 1Mx16 2-CAS# 2-WE# D[15:0] MA[8:0] A[8:0] 1 GPIO32 MA9 A9 MA101 GPIO12 MA111 GPIO22 UCAS# UCAS# UWE# UCAS# LCAS# WE# LCAS# CAS# WE# LWE# RAS# A9 A10 A11 UWE# UCAS# UWE# UCAS# LCAS# CAS# WE# LWE# UWE# LCAS# CAS# LCAS# CAS# WE# LWE# WE# LWE# RAS# Note 1. For MA9, MA10, and MA11 functionality see Table 5-10:, “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping,” on page 43. 2. All GPIO pins default to input on reset and unless programmed otherwise, should be connected to either VSS or IO VDD if not used. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 42 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 5-9: LCD Interface Pin Mapping Monochrome Passive Panel S1D13506 Pin Names Single 4-bit 8-bit Color Passive Panel Dual Single 8-bit 4-bit Single Single Format 1 Format 2 8-bit 8-bit Color TFT/D-TFD Panel Single 16-Bit FPFRAME FPFRAME FPLINE FPLINE FPSHIFT Dual 8-bit 16-bit 9-bit 12-bit 18-bit FPSHIFT DRDY MOD MOD FPSHIFT2 DRDY FPDAT0 driven 0 D0 LD0 driven 0 D0 D0 D0 LD0 LD0 R2 R3 R5 FPDAT1 driven 0 D1 LD1 driven 0 D1 D1 D1 LD1 LD1 R1 R2 R4 FPDAT2 driven 0 D2 LD2 driven 0 D2 D2 D2 LD2 LD2 R0 R1 R3 FPDAT3 driven 0 D3 LD3 driven 0 D3 D3 D3 LD3 LD3 G2 G3 G5 FPDAT4 D0 D4 UD0 D0 D4 D4 D4 UD0 UD0 G1 G2 G4 FPDAT5 D1 D5 UD1 D1 D5 D5 D5 UD1 UD1 G0 G1 G3 FPDAT6 D2 D6 UD2 D2 D6 D6 D6 UD2 UD2 B2 B3 B5 FPDAT7 D3 D7 UD3 D3 D7 D7 D7 UD3 UD3 B1 B2 B4 FPDAT8 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D8 driven 0 LD4 B0 B1 B3 FPDAT9 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D9 driven 0 LD5 driven 0 R0 R2 FPDAT10 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D10 driven 0 LD6 driven 0 driven 0 R1 FPDAT11 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D11 driven 0 LD7 driven 0 G2 FPDAT12 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D12 driven 0 UD4 driven 0 driven 0 G1 FPDAT13 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D13 driven 0 UD5 driven 0 driven 0 G0 FPDAT14 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D14 driven 0 UD6 driven 0 B2 FPDAT15 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 driven 0 D15 driven 0 UD7 driven 0 driven 0 G0 B0 B1 Note DRDY and FPDAT[15:8] may be used by the MediaPlug interface when the MediaPlug is enabled. For MediaPlug Interface pin mapping, see Table 5-11:. Note For FPDATxx to LCD interface hardware connections, refer to Section 7.5, “Display Interface” on page 81. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 43 Table 5-10: MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping MD14, MD7, MD6 MA11 MA10 MA9 DRDY 000 GPIO2 GPIO1 GPIO3 DRDY 001 GPIO2 GPIO1 MA9 DRDY 010 GPIO2 GPIO1 MA9 DRDY 011 MA11 MA10 MA9 DRDY 100 VMPEPWR GPIO1 GPIO3 DRDY 101 VMPEPWR GPIO1 MA9 DRDY 110 VMPEPWR GPIO1 MA9 DRDY 111 MA11 MA10 MA9 VMPEPWR Table 5-11: MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names FPDAT8 FPDAT9 FPDAT10 FPDAT11 FPDAT12 FPDAT13 FPDAT14 FPDAT15 DRDY or MA111 IO Type O I IO IO IO IO O O O MediaPlug I/F (MD13=1 at RESET) VMPLCTL VMPRCTL VMPD0 VMPD1 VMPD2 VMPD3 VMPCLK VMPCLKN VMPEPWR Note 1 Either DRDY or MA11 may be used for VMPEPWR (see Table 5-10: “MA11, MA10, MA9, and DRDY Pin Mapping”). If DRDY is required by the LCD interface and MA11 is required by the DRAM interface then VMPEPWR is not available. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 44 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5.5 CRT/TV Interface The following figure shows external circuitry for the CRT/TV interface. CRT/TV (REG[05Bh] bit 3 = 0) DAC VDD = 3.3V IREF CRT Only (REG[05Bh] bit 3 =1) OR 1.5kΩ 1% 9.2 mA or 4.6 mA 9.2 mA 1kΩ 1% DAC VSS R G B } DAC VSS 1µF 4.6 mA V+ 2N2222 DAC VSS DAC VSS DAC VDD = 2.7V to 5.5V R 69.8Ω 1% 150Ω 1% 1.5kΩ 1% OR 4.6 mA 2N2222 150Ω 1% DAC VDD = 3.3V CRT Only (REG[05Bh] bit 3 =1) 140Ω 1% DAC VSS LM334 V- 1kΩ 1% DAC VSS 290Ω 1% 29Ω 1% 1N457 DAC VSS DAC VSS To CRT/TV 150Ω 1% DAC VSS Figure 5-2: External Circuitry for CRT/TV Interface Note Example implementation only, individual characteristics of components may affect actual IREF current. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 45 6 D.C. Characteristics Table 6-1: Absolute Maximum Ratings Symbol VDD DAC VDD VIN VOUT TSTG TSOL Parameter Supply Voltage Supply Voltage Input Voltage Output Voltage Storage Temperature Solder Temperature/Time Rating VSS - 0.3 to 6.0 VSS - 0.3 to 6.0 VSS - 0.3 to VDD + 0.5 VSS - 0.3 to VDD + 0.5 -65 to 150 260 for 10 sec. max at lead Units V V V V °C °C Table 6-2: Recommended Operating Conditions Symbol VDD VIN TOPR Parameter Supply Voltage Input Voltage Operating Temperature Condition VSS = 0 V Min 2.7 VSS -40 Typ 3.0/3.3/5.0 25 Max 5.5 VDD 85 Units V V °C Max 400 1 1 Units uA µA µA Table 6-3: Electrical Characteristics for VDD = 5.0V typical Symbol IDDS IIZ IOZ Parameter Quiescent Current Input Leakage Current Output Leakage Current VOH High Level Output Voltage VOL Low Level Output Voltage VIH VIL High Level Input Voltage Low Level Input Voltage VT+ High Level Input Voltage VT- Low Level Input Voltage VH1 Hysteresis Voltage RPD CI CO CIO Pull Down Resistance Input Pin Capacitance Output Pin Capacitance Bi-Directional Pin Capacitance Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Condition Quiescent Conditions Min Typ -1 -1 VDD = min -4mA (Type1), IOL = -8mA (Type2) -12mA (Type3) VDD = min IOL = 4mA (Type1), 8mA (Type2) 12mA (Type3) CMOS level, VDD = max CMOS level, VDD = min CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 5.0V CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 5.0V CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 5.0V VI = VDD VDD - 0.4 V 0.4 V 1.0 V V 4.0 V 3.5 0.8 V 0.3 V 50 100 200 12 12 12 kΩ pF pF pF S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 46 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 6-4: Electrical Characteristics for VDD = 3.3V typical Symbol IDDS IIZ IOZ Parameter Quiescent Current Input Leakage Current Output Leakage Current VOH High Level Output Voltage VOL Low Level Output Voltage VIH VIL High Level Input Voltage Low Level Input Voltage VT+ High Level Input Voltage VT- Low Level Input Voltage VH1 Hysteresis Voltage RPD CI CO CIO Pull Down Resistance Input Pin Capacitance Output Pin Capacitance Bi-Directional Pin Capacitance S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Condition Quiescent Conditions Min Typ -1 -1 VDD = min IOL = -2mA (Type1), -4mA (Type2) -6mA (Type3) VDD = min IOL = 2mA (Type1), 4mA (Type2) 6mA (Type3) CMOS level, VDD = max CMOS level, VDD = min CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 3.3V CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 3.3V CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 3.3V VI = VDD Max 290 1 1 VDD - 0.3 Units uA µA µA V 0.3 V 0.8 V V 2.4 V 2.2 0.6 V 0.1 V 90 180 360 12 12 12 kΩ pF pF pF Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 47 Table 6-5: Electrical Characteristics for VDD = 3.0V typical Symbol IDDS IIZ IOZ Parameter Quiescent Current Input Leakage Current Output Leakage Current VOH High Level Output Voltage VOL Low Level Output Voltage VIH VIL High Level Input Voltage Low Level Input Voltage VT+ High Level Input Voltage VT- Low Level Input Voltage VH1 Hysteresis Voltage RPD CI CO CIO Pull Down Resistance Input Pin Capacitance Output Pin Capacitance Bi-Directional Pin Capacitance Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Condition Quiescent Conditions Min Typ -1 -1 VDD = min IOL = -1.8mA (Type1), -3.5mA (Type2) -5mA (Type3) VDD = min IOL = 1.8mA (Type1), 3.5mA (Type2) 5mA (Type3) CMOS level, VDD = max CMOS level, VDD = min CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 3.0V CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 3.0V CMOS Schmitt, VDD = 3.0V VI = VDD Max 260 1 1 VDD - 0.3 Units uA µA µA V 0.3 V 0.8 V V 2.3 V 2.0 0.5 V 0.1 V 100 200 400 12 12 12 kΩ pF pF pF S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 48 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7 A.C. Characteristics Conditions: VDD = 3.0V ± 10% and VDD = 5.0V ± 10% TA = -40° C to 85° C Trise and Tfall for all inputs must be < 5 ns (10% ~ 90%) CL = 50pF (CPU Interface), unless noted CL = 100pF (LCD Panel Interface) CL = 10pF (Display Memory Interface) CL = 10pF (CRT Interface) 7.1 CPU Interface Timing 7.1.1 Generic Timing TCLK t2 t3 CLK t5 t4 A[20:1] M/R# t6 CS# RD0#,RD1# WE0#,WE1# t7 t8 WAIT# t10 t9 D[15:0](write) t11 t12 t13 D[15:0](read) Figure 7-1: Generic Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 49 Table 7-1: Generic Timing Symbol fCLK TCLK t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 Parameter Clock frequency Clock period Clock pulse width high Clock pulse width low A[20:1], M/R# setup to first CLK where CS# = 0 and either RD0#, RD1#= 0 or WE0#, WE1#= 0 A[20:1], M/R# hold from rising edge of either RD0#, RD1# or WE0#, WE1# CS# hold from rising edge of either RD0#, RD1# or WE0#, WE1# Falling edge of either RD0#, RD1# or WE0#, WE1# to WAIT# driven low Rising edge of either RD0#, RD1# or WE0#, WE1# to WAIT# tri-state D[15:0] setup to third CLK where CS# = 0 and WE0#, WE1# = 0 (write cycle) D[15:0] hold (write cycle) Falling edge RD0#, RD1# to D[15:0] driven (read cycle) D[15:0] setup to rising edge WAIT# (read cycle) Rising edge of RD0#, RD1# to D[15:0] tri-state (read cycle) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 3.0V Min Max 50 1/fCLK 6 6 5.0V Min Max 50 1/fCLK 6 6 Units MHz ns ns ns 4 3 ns 0 0 ns 0 4 3 0 3 2 ns ns ns 21 14 13 7 0 0 ns 0 3 0 7 0 3 0 4 ns ns ns ns 31 15 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 50 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.2 Hitachi SH-4 Interface Timing TCKIO t2 t3 CKIO t5 t4 A[20:1], M/R# RD/WR# t6 t7 BS# t17 t12 t8 CSn# t10 t9 WEn# RD# t18 t12 t11 RDY# t14 t13 D[15:0](write) t15 t16 D[15:0](read) Figure 7-2: Hitachi SH-4 Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). Note The SH-4 Wait State Control Register for the area in which the S1D13506 resides must be set to a non-zero value. The SH-4 read-to-write idle cycle transition must be set to a non-zero value (with reference to BUSCLK). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 51 Table 7-2: Hitachi SH-4 Timing Symbol fCKIO TCKIO t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 t17 t18 1. 2. Parameter Clock frequency Clock period Clock pulse width low Clock pulse width high A[20:1], M/R#, RD/WR# setup to CKIO A[20:1], M/R#, RD/WR# hold from CSn# BS# setup BS# hold CSn# setup Falling edge RD# to D[15:0] driven CKIO to RDY# high Falling edge CSn# to RDY# driven CKIO to RDY# delay D[15:0] setup to 2nd CKIO after BS# (write cycle) D[15:0] hold (write cycle) D[15:0] valid to RDY# falling edge (read cycle) Rising edge RD# to D[15:0] tri-state (read cycle) CSn# high setup to CKIO Falling edge CKIO to RDY# tri-state 3.0V1 Min Max 0 66 1/fCKIO 6 6 4 0 4 3 3 3 4 21 3 11 4 20 0 0 0 6 30 3 3 14 5.0V2 Min Max 0 66 1/fCKIO 16 6 3 0 3 2 2 3 3 13 2 7 3 13 0 0 0 3 16 2 2 10 Units MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns Two software WAIT states are required. One software WAIT state is required. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 52 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.3 Hitachi SH-3 Interface Timing TCKIO t2 t3 CKIO t4 t5 A[20:1], M/R# RD/WR# t6 t7 BS# t17 t12 t8 CSn# t10 t9 WEn# RD# t12 t11 WAIT# t14 t13 D[15:0](write) t15 t16 D[15:0](read) Figure 7-3: Hitachi SH-3 Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). Note The SH-3 Wait State Control Register for the area in which the S1D13506 resides must be set to a non-zero value. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 53 Table 7-3: Hitachi SH-3 Timing Symbol fCKIO TCKIO t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 t17 1. 2. Parameter Clock frequency Clock period Clock pulse width low Clock pulse width high A[20:1], M/R#, RD/WR# setup to CKIO A[20:1], M/R#, RD/WR# hold from CSn# BS# setup BS# hold CSn# setup Falling edge RD# to D[15:0] driven Rising edge CSn# to WAIT# tri-state Falling edge CSn# to WAIT# driven CKIO to WAIT# delay D[15:0] setup to 2nd CKIO after BS# (write cycle) D[15:0] hold (write cycle) D[15:0] valid to WAIT# rising edge (read cycle) Rising edge RD# to D[15:0] tri-state (read cycle) CSn# high setup to CKIO 3.0V1 Min Max 66 1/fCKIO 6 6 4 0 4 3 3 3 2 10 3 16 4 20 0 0 0 6 30 3 5.0V2 Min Max 66 1/fCKIO 6 6 3 0 3 2 3 2 1 6 2 10 3 13 0 0 0 3 15 2 Units MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns Two software WAIT states are required when fCKIO is greater than 33MHz. One software WAIT state is required when fCKIO is greater than 33MHz. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 54 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.4 MIPS/ISA Interface Timing (e.g. NEC VR41xx) TBUSCLK t2 t3 BUSCLK t5 t4 LatchA20 SA[19:0] M/R#, SBHE# t6 CS# MEMR# MEMW# t7 t8 IOCHRDY t10 t9 SD[15:0](write) t11 t12 t13 SD[15:0](read) Figure 7-4: MIPS/ISA Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 55 Table 7-4: MIPS/ISA Timing 3.0V Symbol fBUSCLK TBUSCLK t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 Parameter Min Clock frequency Clock period 1/fBUSCLK Clock pulse width high 6 Clock pulse width low 6 LatchA20, SA[19:0], M/R#, SBHE# setup to first BUSCLK where CS# = 0 and either MEMR# = 0 or 4 MEMW# = 0 LatchA20, SA[19:0], M/R#, SBHE# hold from rising edge 0 of either MEMR# or MEMW# CS# hold from rising edge of either MEMR# or MEMW# 0 Falling edge of either MEMR# or MEMW# to IOCHRDY# 2 driven low Rising edge of either MEMR# or MEMW# to IOCHRDY# 2 tri-state SD[15:0] setup to third BUSCLK where CS# = 0 0 MEMW# = 0 (write cycle) SD[15:0] hold (write cycle) 0 Falling edge MEMR# to SD[15:0] driven (read cycle) 4 SD[15:0] setup to rising edge IOCHRDY# (read cycle) 0 Rising edge of MEMR# toSD[15:0] tri-state (read cycle) 7 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 5.0V Max 50 Min Max 50 1/fBUSCLK 6 6 Units MHz ns ns ns 3 ns 0 ns 0 ns 17 2 10 ns 12 1 7 ns 31 0 ns 0 3 0 4 ns ns ns ns 15 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 56 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.5 Motorola MC68K Bus 1 Interface Timing (e.g. MC68000) TCLK t2 t3 CLK t4 t5 A[20:1] M/R# t6 CS# t17 AS# t11 UDS# LDS# t8 t7 R/W# t9 t10 DTACK# t12 t13 D[15:0](write) t14 t15 t16 D[15:0](read) Figure 7-5: Motorola MC68000 Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 57 Table 7-5: Motorola MC68000 Timing 3.0V Symbol fCLK TCLK t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 t17 Parameter Clock frequency Clock period Clock pulse width high Clock pulse width low A[20:1], M/R# setup to first CLK where CS# = 0 AS# = 0, and either UDS#=0 or LDS# = 0 A[20:1], M/R# hold from AS# CS# hold from AS# R/W# setup to before to either UDS#=0 or LDS# = 0 R/W# hold from AS# AS# = 0 and CS# = 0 to DTACK# driven high AS# high to DTACK# high First BCLK where AS# = 1 to DTACK# high impedance D[15:0] valid to third CLK where CS# = 0 AS# = 0, and either UDS#=0 or LDS# = 0 (write cycle) D[15:0] hold from falling edge of DTACK# (write cycle) Falling edge of UDS#=0 or LDS# = 0 to D[15:0] driven (read cycle) D[15:0] valid to DTACK# falling edge (read cycle) UDS# and LDS# high to D[15:0] invalid/high impedance (read cycle) AS# high setup to CLK Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Min 5.0V Max 50 1/fCLK 6 6 1/fCLK 6 6 Units MHz ns ns ns 5 3 ns 0 0 10 0 1 4 3 0 0 10 0 1 3 2 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 18 15 Min Max 50 11 10 0 0 ns 0 0 ns 3 3 ns 0 0 ns 6 4 31 4 3 15 ns ns S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 58 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.6 Motorola MC68K Bus 2 Interface Timing (e.g. MC68030) TCLK t2 t3 CLK t5 t4 A[20:0] SIZ[1:0] M/R# t6 CS# t17 AS# t11 DS# t7 t8 R/W# t9 t10 DSACK1# t12 t13 D[31:16](write) t14 t15 t16 D[31:16](read) Figure 7-6: Motorola MC68030 Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 59 Table 7-6: Motorola MC68030 Timing 3.0V Symbol fCLK TCLK t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 t17 Parameter Clock frequency Clock period Clock pulse width high Clock pulse width low A[20:0], SIZ[1:0], M/R# setup to first CLK where CS# = 0, AS# = 0, and DS# = 0 A[20:0], SIZ[1:0], M/R# hold from AS# CS# hold from AS# R/W# setup to DS# R/W# hold from AS# AS# = 0 and CS# = 0 to DSACK1# driven high AS# high to DSACK1# high First BCLK where AS# = 1 to DSACK1# high impedance D[31:16] valid to third CLK where CS# = 0, AS# = 0, and DS# = 0 (write cycle) D[31:16] hold from falling edge of DSACK1# (write cycle) Falling edge of DS# = 0 to D[31:16] driven (read cycle) D[31:16] valid to DSACK1# falling edge (read cycle) DS# high to D[31:16] invalid/high impedance (read cycle) AS# high setup to CLK Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Min 5.0V Max 50 1/fCLK 6 6 1/fCLK 6 6 Units MHz ns ns ns 5 3 ns 0 0 10 0 1 4 3 0 0 10 0 1 3 2 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 18 15 Min Max 50 12 14 0 0 ns 0 3 0 6 4 0 3 0 4 3 ns ns ns ns ns 31 15 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 60 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.7 Motorola PowerPC Interface Timing (e.g. MPC8xx, MC68040, Coldfire) TCLKOUT t2 t3 CLKOUT t4 t5 A[11:31], RD/WR# TSIZ[0:1], M/R# t7 t6 CS# t8 t9 TS# t11 t10 t12 t13 t15 t16 TA# t14 BI# t17 t18 D[0:15](write) t19 t20 t21 D[0:15](read) Figure 7-7: Motorola PowerPC Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 61 Table 7-7: Motorola PowerPC Timing 3.0V Symbol fCLKOUT TCLKOUT t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 t17 t18 t19 t20 t21 Parameter Min Clock frequency Clock period 1/fCLKOUT Clock pulse width low 6 Clock pulse width high 6 AB[11:31], RD/WR#, TSIZ[0:1], M/R# setup 0 AB[11:31], RD/WR#, TSIZ[0:1], M/R# hold 0 CS# setup 1 CS# hold 0 TS# setup 1 TS# hold 0 CLKOUT to TA# driven 2 CLKOUT to TA# low 3 CLKOUT to TA# high 3 negative edge CLKOUT to TA# tri-state 3 CLKOUT to BI# driven 3 CLKOUT to BI# high 3 negative edge CLKOUT to BI# tri-state 3 DB[15:0] setup to 2nd CLKOUT after TS# = 0 (write cycle) 0 DB[15:0] hold (write cycle) 0 CLKOUT to DB driven (read cycle) 3 DB[15:0] valid to TA# falling edge (read cycle) 0 CLKOUT to DB[15:0] tri-state (read cycle) 3 5.0V Max 45 15 16 14 13 13 14 14 Min 1/fCLKOUT 6 6 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 2 2 2 2 2 2 0 0 2 0 2 Max 50 9 10 9 8 8 8 9 Units MHz ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns Note Output pin loading on DB[15:0], TA#, BI# is 10pF. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 62 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.8 PC Card Timing (e.g. StrongARM) TCLK t2 t3 CLK (provided externally) t5 t4 A[20:1] M/R# CE1#, CE2# t6 CS# OE# WE# t7 t8 WAIT# t10 t9 D[15:0](write) t11 t12 t13 D[15:0](read) Figure 7-8: PC Card Timing Note The above timing diagram is not applicable if MD12 = 1 (BUSCLK divided by 2). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 63 Table 7-8: PC Card Timing Symbol fCLK TCLK t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 Parameter Clock frequency Clock period Clock pulse width high Clock pulse width low A[20:1], M/R# setup to first CLK where CE1# = 0 or CE2# = 0 and either OE# = 0 or WE# = 0 A[20:1], M/R# hold from rising edge of either OE# or WE# CS# hold from rising edge of either OE# or WE# Falling edge of either OE# or WE# to WAIT# driven low Rising edge of either OE# or WE# to WAIT# tri-state D[15:0] setup to third CLK where CE1# = 0, CE2# = 0 and WE# = 0 (write cycle) D[15:0] hold (write cycle) Falling edge OE# to D[15:0] driven (read cycle) D[15:0] setup to rising edge WAIT# (read cycle) Rising edge of OE# to D[15:0] tri-state (read cycle) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 3.0V Min Max 50 1/fCLK 6 6 5.0V Min Max 50 1/fCLK 6 6 Units MHz ns ns ns 4 3 ns 0 0 2 3 0 0 2 2 ns ns ns ns 21 14 9 9 0 0 ns 0 10 0 7 0 8 0 5 ns ns ns ns 34 17 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 64 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.9 Philips Interface Timing (e.g. PR31500/PR31700) TDCLKOUT t3 t2 DCLKOUT t4 t5 ADDR[12:0] t6 t7 ALE t8 /CARDREG /CARDxCSH /CARDxCSL /CARDIORD /CARDIOWR /WE /RD t9 t10 /CARDxWAIT t11 t12 D[31:16](write) t13 t14 t15 D[31:16](read) Figure 7-9: Philips Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 65 Table 7-9: Philips Timing 3.0V Symbol fDCLKOUT Clock frequency TDCLKOUT Clock period Parameter Min 5.0V Max 75 Min Max 75 1/fDCLKOUT 1/fDCLKOUT Units MHz ns t2 Clock pulse width low 6 6 ns t3 Clock pulse width high 6 6 ns t4 ADDR[12:0] setup to first CLK of cycle 10 10 ns t5 ADDR[12:0] hold from command invalid 0 0 ns t6 ADDR[12:0] setup to falling edge ALE 10 10 ns t7 ADDR[12:0] hold from falling edge ALE 5 5 ns t8 /CARDREG hold from command invalid 0 0 ns t9 Falling edge of chip select to /CARDxWAIT driven 2 14 1 9 ns t10 Command invalid to /CARDxWAIT tri-state 2 13 2 12 ns t11 D[31:16] valid to first CLK of cycle (write cycle) 10 10 t12 D[31:16] hold from rising edge of /CARDxWAIT 0 0 t13 Chip select to D[31:16] driven (read cycle) 4 3 ns t14 D[31:16] setup to rising edge /CARDxWAIT (read cycle) 0 0 ns t15 Command invalid to D[31:16] tri-state (read cycle) 7 30 4 ns 16 ns Note If BUSCLK exceeds 37.5MHz, it must be divided by 2 using MD12 (see Table 5-6:, “Summary of Power-On/Reset Options,” on page 39). Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 66 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.1.10 Toshiba Interface Timing (e.g. TX39xx) TDCLKOUT t3 t2 DCLKOUT t4 t5 ADDR[12:0] t6 t7 ALE t8 CARDREG* CARDxCSH* CARDxCSL* CARDIORD* CARDIOWR* WE* RD* t9 t10 CARDxWAIT* t11 t12 D[31:16](write) t13 t14 t15 D[31:16](read) Figure 7-10: Toshiba Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 67 Table 7-10: Toshiba Timing 3.0V Symbol fDCLKOUT Clock frequency TDCLKOUT Clock period Parameter Min 5.0V Max 75 Min Max 75 1/fDCLKOUT 1/fDCLKOUT Units MHz ns t2 Clock pulse width low 6 6 ns t3 Clock pulse width high 6 6 ns t4 ADDR[12:0] setup to first CLK of cycle 10 10 ns t5 ADDR[12:0] hold from command invalid 0 0 ns t6 ADDR[12:0] setup to falling edge ALE 10 10 ns t7 ADDR[12:0] hold from falling edge ALE 5 5 ns t8 CARDREG* hold from command invalid 0 0 ns t9 Falling edge of chip select to CARDxWAIT* driven 2 14 1 9 ns t10 Command invalid to CARDxWAIT* tri-state 2 13 2 12 ns t11 D[31:16] valid to first CLK of cycle (write cycle) 10 10 t12 D[31:16] hold from rising edge of CARDxWAIT* 0 0 t13 Chip select to D[31:16] driven (read cycle) 4 3 ns t14 D[31:16] setup to rising edge CARDxWAIT* (read cycle) 0 0 ns t15 Command invalid to D[31:16] tri-state (read cycle) 7 30 4 ns 16 ns Note If BUSCLK exceeds 37.5MHz, it must be divided by 2 using MD12 (see Table 5-6:, “Summary of Power-On/Reset Options,” on page 39). Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 68 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.2 Clock Timing 7.2.1 Input Clocks t t PWH PWL 90% V IH VIL 10% t tr T f OSC Figure 7-11: CLKI Clock Input Requirements Table 7-11: Clock Input Requirements for CLKI/CLKI2/BUSCLK divided down internally Symbol fOSC TOSC tPWH tPWL tf tr Parameter Input Clock Frequency Input Clock Period Input Clock Pulse Width High Input Clock Pulse Width Low Input Clock Fall Time (10% - 90%) Input Clock Rise Time (10% - 90%) Min Max 80 1/fOSC 5.6 5.6 5 5 Units MHz ns ns ns ns ns Table 7-12: Clock Input Requirements for CLKI or BUSCLK if used directly for MCLK1 Symbol Parameter Min Max Units 40 MHz fOSC Input Clock Frequency TOSC Input Clock Period 1/fOSC ns Input Clock Pulse Width High 11.31 ns Input Clock Pulse Width Low 11.31 ns tPWH tPWL tf Input Clock Fall Time (10% - 90%) 5 ns tr Input Clock Rise Time (10% - 90%) 5 ns Note 1. MCLK must have a duty cycle of 50% ± 5%. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 69 7.2.2 Internal Clocks Table 7-13: Internal Clock Requirements 1. Symbol Parameter Min Max Units fMCLK Memory Clock Frequency 0 40 MHz fLCD PCLK LCD Pixel Clock Frequency 0 40 MHz fCRT/TV PCLK CRT/TV Pixel Clock Frequency 0 Note 1 MHz fMediaPlug Clock MediaPlug Clock Frequency 0 10 MHz The maximum CRT pixel clock is 40MHz. The TV pixel clock for NTSC output is fixed at 14.318MHz. The TV pixel clock for PAL output is fixed at 17.734MHz. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 70 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.3 Memory Interface Timing 7.3.1 EDO-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing t1 Memory Clock t2 RAS# t3 t5 t4 t6 t1 t7 CAS# t8 MA t9 t10 t11 t10 t11 C1 R C2 C3 t12 t13 WE# (read) t15 t14 MD (read) d1 t17 t16 d2 d3 t19 t18 WE#(write) t20 t21 MD(write) d1 d2 t22 d3 Figure 7-12: EDO-DRAM Page Mode Timing Memory Clock t1 RAS# t3 t5 t4 t6 t1 t7 CAS# t8 MA t9 t10 t11 C1 R C2 C3 t12 C2 C1 t23 C3 t19 t24 WE# t15 t14 MD(Read) d1 t25 d2 t26 d3 t20 t21 MD(Write) d1 t22 d2 d3 Figure 7-13: EDO-DRAM Read-Write Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 71 Table 7-14: EDO-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 t17 t18 t19 t20 t21 t22 t23 t24 t25 t26 Parameter Memory clock period Random read or write cycle time (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00) Random read or write cycle time (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01) Random read or write cycle time (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) CAS# precharge time CAS# pulse width RAS# hold time Row address setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00 Row address setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) Row address setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) Row address hold time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) Row address hold time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) Column address setup time Column address hold time Read Command setup (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 00) Read Command setup (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 10) Read Command setup (all other REG[02Ah] values) Read Command hold (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 00) Read Command hold (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 10) Read Command hold (all other REG[02Ah] values) Read data setup referenced from CAS# Read data hold referenced from CAS# Last read data setup referenced from RAS# Bus turn-off from RAS# Write command setup time Write command hold time Write Data setup time Write Data hold time MD tri-state CAS# to WE# active during read-write cycle Write command setup during read-write cycle Last read data setup referenced from WE# during read-write cycle Bus tri-state from WE# during read-write cycle Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Min 25 5 t1 4 t1 3 t1 2 t1 1.45 t1 t1 Max Units ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 2 t1 - 3 2 t1 ns t1 - 3 t1 ns 1.45 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 0.45 t1 - 1 t1 2.45 t1 - 3 2 t1 - 3 1.45 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 - 1 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 - 1 1.55 t1 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 4.45 t1 - 1 ns 2.45 t1 - 1 3.45 t1 - 1 3.45 t1 - 1 1.45 t1 - 1 2.45 t1 - 1 4 2 3 2 0.45 t1 - 1 0.45 t1 - 1 0.45 t1 - 4 0.45 t1 0.45 t1 t1 1.45 t1 - 1 ns 0.55 t1 + 19 18 0 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns t1 - 6 ns S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 72 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.3.2 EDO-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing t1 Memory Clock t2 t3 RAS# t4 t5 t6 CAS# Figure 7-14: EDO-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing Table 7-15: EDO-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 Parameter Memory clock period RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) CAS# setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) CAS# setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Min Max Units 25 ns 2 t1 1.45 t1 t1 3 t1 - 7 3.45 t1 - 1 4 t1 - 7 2 t1 - 7 2.45 t1 - 1 3 t1 - 7 t1 - 7 1.45 t1 - 1 2 t1 - 7 2 t1 t1 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 0.45 t1 ns t1 - 4 ns 2.45 t1 - 4 3 t1 3.45 t1 - 4 1.45 t1 - 4 2 t1 2.45 t1 - 4 0.45 t1 - 4 t1 1.45 t1 - 4 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 73 7.3.3 EDO-DRAM Self-Refresh Timing MCLK can be stopped (See Note) t1 Memory Clock t2 RAS# t3 t5 t4 CAS# Figure 7-15: EDO - DRAM Self-Refresh Timing Note MCLK can be stopped. For timing see Section 7.4.2, “Power Save Mode” on page 79. Table 7-16: EDO - DRAM Self-Refresh Timing Symbol Parameter Min t1 Memory clock period RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# to CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# to CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) 25 ns 2 t1 1.45 t1 t1 1.45 t1 0.45 t1 2 t1 t1 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns CAS# setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) 0.45 t1 ns t1 - 4 ns t2 t3 t4 t5 CAS# setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Max Units S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 74 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.3.4 FPM-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing t1 Memory Clock t2 RAS# t5 t4 t3 t6 t1 t7 CAS# t8 MA t9 t11 t10 t11 t10 R C1 C2 C3 t12 t13 WE#(read) t14 MD(read) d1 d2 t15 d3 t16 t17 WE#(write) t18 t19 MD(write) d1 t20 d2 d3 Figure 7-16: FPM-DRAM Page Mode Timing Memory Clock t1 RAS# t5 t4 t3 t6 t1 t7 CAS# t9 t8 MA R t10 t11 C2 C1 C3 C1 t12 t21 C2 C3 t16 t17 t18 t19 t20 WE# t14 MD(read) MD(write) d1 t15 d2 d3 d1 d2 d3 Figure 7-17: FPM-DRAM Read-Write Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 75 Table 7-17: FPM-DRAM Read, Write, Read-Write Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 Parameter Memory clock Random read or write cycle time (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00) Random read or write cycle time (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01) Random read or write cycle time (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 01) RAS# to CAS# delay time (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 01) CAS# precharge time CAS# pulse width RAS# hold time Row address setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00 Row address setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) Row address setup time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 10) Row address hold time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00 or 10) Row address hold time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01) Column address set-up time Column address hold time Read Command setup (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 00) Read Command setup (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) Read Command setup (all other REG[02Ah] values) Read Command hold (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 0 and bits 1-0 = 00) Read Command hold (REG[02Ah] bit 4 = 1 and bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) Read Command hold (all other REG[02Ah] values) Min 40 5 t1 4 t1 3 t1 2 t1 1.45 t1 t1 Max Units ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 2.45 t1 - 3 2.55 t1 ns 1.45 t1 - 3 1.55 t1 ns 2 t1 - 3 2 t1 ns t1 - 3 t1 ns 0.45 t1 0.45 t1 - 1 0.45 t1 2 t1 - 2 1.45 t1 - 2 t1 - 2 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 - 3 0.45 t1 - 1 ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns ns 4.45 t1 - 1 ns 2.45 t1 - 1 ns 3.45 t1 - 1 ns 4 t1 - 1 ns 2 t1 - 1 ns 3 t1 - 1 ns 3 3 ns ns t14 Read data setup referenced from CAS# t15 Read Data turn-off from CAS# t16 Write command setup time 0.45 t1 - 1 ns t17 Write command hold time 0.45 t1 - 1 ns t18 Write Data setup time 0.45 t1 - 4 ns t19 Write Data hold time t20 t21 MD tri-state CAS# to WE# active during read-write cycle 0.45 t1 0.45 t1 0.45 t1 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 0.55 t1 + 19 ns ns ns S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 76 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.3.5 FPM-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing t1 Memory Clock t2 t3 RAS# t4 t5 t6 CAS# Figure 7-18: FPM-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing Table 7-18: FPM-DRAM CAS Before RAS Refresh Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 Parameter Min Memory clock RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# pulse width (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) 40 ns 2.45 t1 1.45 t1 ns ns 2.45 t1 - 7 ns 3.45 t1 - 7 ns 1.45 t1 - 7 ns 2.45 t1 - 7 ns 0.45 t1 - 7 ns 1.45 t1 - 7 ns 2 t1 t1 ns ns 0.45 t1 ns 2.45 t1 - 4 ns 3.45 t1 - 4 ns 1.45 t1 - 4 ns 2.45 t1 - 4 ns 0.45 t1 - 4 ns 1.45 t1 - 4 ns CAS# setup time CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 00, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 01, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) CAS# hold to RAS# (REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 = 10, REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Max Units Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 77 7.3.6 FPM-DRAM Self-Refresh Timing MCLK can be stopped (See Note) t1 Memory Clock t2 RAS# t3 t4 CAS# Figure 7-19: FPM - DRAM Self-Refresh Timing Note MCLK can be stopped. For timing see Section 7.4.2, “Power Save Mode” on page 79. Table 7-19: FPM-DRAM Self-Refresh Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 Parameter Min Max Units Memory clock RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) RAS# to CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 00) RAS# to CAS# precharge time (REG[02Ah] bits 1-0 = 01 or 10) 40 ns 2.45 t1 1.45 t1 2 t1 t1 ns ns ns ns CAS# setup time 0.45 t1 ns Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 78 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.4 Power Sequencing 7.4.1 LCD Power Sequencing #RESET LCD Enable Bit (REG[1FCh] bit 0) t1 t2 FPFRAME t3 t4 FPLINE, FPSHIFT FPDATA, DRDY LCD Power Save Status Bit (REG[1F1h] bit 1) t4 Figure 7-20: LCD Panel Power-off/Power-on Timing Table 7-20: LCD Panel Power-off/Power-on Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 1. Parameter LCD Enable Bit high to FPFRAME active FPFRAME inactive to LCD Power Save Status bit high LCD Enable Bit high to FPLINE, FPSHIFT, FPDATA, DRDY active LCD Enable Bit low to FPLINE, FPSHIFT, FPDATA, DRDY active and LCD Power Save Status bit high t4 Min Max TFPFRAME 5TFPFRAME 3TFPLINE Units ns ns ns note 1 ns = 130TFPFRAME for dual panels = 65TFPFRAME for single panels Note Where TFPFRAME is the period of FPFRAME and TFPLINE is the period of FPLINE. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 79 7.4.2 Power Save Mode Power Save Mode Enable Bit (REG[1F0h] bit 0) t1 t2 FPFRAME t3 FPLINE, FPSHIFT FPDATA, DRDY t4 t6 t5 LCD Power Save Status Bit (REG[1F1h] bit 1) t8 t7 Memory Controller Power Save Status Bit (REG[1F1h] bit 0) allowed Memory Access not allowed t9 allowed Figure 7-21: Power Save Mode Timing Note Memory accesses cannot be performed after a Power Save Mode has been initiated. Note The Memory Controller Power Save Status Bit will go high only if the Refresh Select Bits (REG[021h] bits 7-6) are set to Self-Refresh or No Refresh. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 80 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-21: Power Save Mode Timing Symbol t1 Power Save Mode Enable Bit high to FPFRAME inactive t2 Power Save Mode Enable Bit low to FPFRAME active Power Save Mode Enable Bit high to FPLINE, FPSHIFT, FPDATA, DRDY inactive Power Save Mode Enable Bit low to FPLINE, FPSHIFT, FPDATA, DRDY active Power Save Mode Enable Bit high to LCD Power Save Status Bit high Power Save Mode Enable Bit low to LCD Power Save Status Bit low Power Save Mode Enable Bit high to Memory Controller Power Save Status Bit high (self-refresh or no refresh selected) Power Save Mode Enable Bit low to Memory Controller Power Save Status Bit low (self-refresh or no refresh selected) Memory Controller Power Save Status Bit low to the earliest time where memory access is allowed (self-refresh or no refresh selected) t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 1. Parameter Min Max Units TFPFRAME + ns TFPLINE 3TFPLINE ns 129TFPFRAME + ns TFPLINE 128TFPFRAME TFPFRAME ns 129TFPRAME TPCLK ns ns note 1 ns 12TMCLK ns 8TMCLK ns t14max = (1 DRAM refresh clock period) + 12 MCLK periods Note Where TFPFRAME is the period of FPFRAME, TFPLINE is the period of FPLINE, TPCLK is the period of the pixel clock, and TMCLK is the period of the memory clock. Note The DRAM refresh clock period is programmed using REG[021h]. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 81 7.5 Display Interface 7.5.1 Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) LINE1 FPDAT[7:4] LINE2 LINE3 LINE4 LINE239 LINE240 LINE1 LINE2 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1-1 1-5 1-317 FPDAT6 1-2 1-6 1-318 FPDAT5 1-3 1-7 1-319 FPDAT4 1-4 1-8 1-320 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 320x240 panel Figure 7-22: Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 82 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center t1 Sync Timing t2 FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t11 t12 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:4] t14 1 2 Figure 7-23: Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 83 Table 7-22: Single Monochrome 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:4] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:4] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 5 7 16 18 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 20 18 4 note 6 note 6 18 16 2 2 2 2 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 229 231 240 242 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 27] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 25] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 16] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 14] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 84 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.5.2 Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) LINE1 FPDAT[7:0] LINE2 LINE3 LINE4 LINE479 LINE480 LINE1 LINE2 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1-1 1-9 1-633 FPDAT6 1-2 1-10 1-634 FPDAT5 1-3 1-11 1-635 FPDAT4 1-4 1-12 1-636 FPDAT3 1-5 1-13 1-637 FPDAT2 1-6 1-14 1-638 FPDAT1 1-7 1-15 1-639 FPDAT0 1-8 1-16 1-640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-24: Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 85 t1 t2 Sync Timing FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t11 t12 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:0] t14 1 2 Figure 7-25: Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 86 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-23: Single Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 7 9 18 20 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 22 20 8 note 6 note 6 18 16 4 4 4 4 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 231 233 242 244 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 25] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 23] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 14] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 12] for 15/16 bpp color depth S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 87 7.5.3 Single Color 4-Bit Panel Timing VNDP VDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) LINE1 FPDAT[7:4] LINE2 LINE3 LINE4 LINE479 LINE480 LINE1 LINE2 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 FPDAT6 FPDAT5 FPDAT4 1-R1 1-G2 1-B3 1-B319 1-G1 1-B2 1-R4 1-R320 1-B1 1-R3 1-G4 1-G320 1-R2 1-G3 1-B4 1-B320 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-26: Single Color 4-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 88 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center t1 t2 Sync Timing FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t11 t12 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:4] t14 1 2 Figure 7-27: Single Color 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 89 Table 7-24: Single Color 4-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:4] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:4] hold from FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 4.5 6.5 15.5 17.5 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 19.5 17.5 1 note 6 note 6 19 17 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 228.5 230.5 239.5 241.5 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 27.5] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 25.5] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 16.5] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 14.5] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 90 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.5.4 Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 1) VNDP VDP FPFRAME FPLINE FPDAT[7:0] LINE1 LINE2 LINE3 LINE4 LINE479 LINE480 LINE1 LINE2 FPLINE HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPSHIFT2 FPDAT7 1-R1 1-G1 1-G6 1-B6 1-B11 1-R12 1-R636 FPDAT6 1-B1 1-R2 1-R7 1-G7 1-G12 1-B12 1-B636 FPDAT5 FPDAT4 1-G2 1-B2 1-B7 1-R8 1-R13 1-G13 1-G637 1-R3 1-G3 1-G8 1-B8 1-B13 1-R14 1-R638 FPDAT3 1-B3 1-R4 1-R9 1-G9 1-G14 1-B14 1-B638 FPDAT2 1-G4 1-B4 1-B9 1-R10 1-R15 1-G15 1-G639 FPDAT1 1-R5 1-G5 1-G10 1-B10 1-B15 1-R16 1-R640 FPDAT0 1-B5 1-R6 1-R11 1-G11 1-G16 1-B16 1-B640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-28: Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 1) VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 91 t1 t2 Sync Timing FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE Data Timing FPLINE t5 t6 t7 t9 t8 t11 t12 t13 FPSHIFT t10 FPSHIFT2 t14 FPDAT[7:0] t15 1 2 Figure 7-29: Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 1) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 92 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-25: Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 1) Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5a t5b t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11a t11b t12 t13 t14 t15 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. t1 t4 t5 5. t6 6. t9 7. t10 Max. Min. Units Typical Setting Setting FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge 28 note 2 1268 Ts (note 1) FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge 12 Ts FPLINE pulse width 11 Ts FPLINE period 40 note 3 1280 Ts FPSHIFT2 falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp 5 note 4 229 Ts FPSHIFT2 falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp 7 note 4 231 Ts FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp 3 note 5 227 Ts FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp 5 note 5 229 Ts FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT2 rising, FPSHIFT falling edge, 4/8 bpp 20 Ts FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT2 rising, FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp 18 Ts FPSHIFT2, FPSHIFT period 4 Ts FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp 14 note 6 238 Ts FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp 16 note 6 240 Ts FPSHIFT2 falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp 16 note 7 240 Ts FPSHIFT2 falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp 18 note 7 242 Ts FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp 18 Ts FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp 16 Ts FPSHIFT2, FPSHIFT pulse width high 2 Ts FPSHIFT2, FPSHIFT pulse width low 2 Ts FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT2 rising, FPSHIFT falling edge 1 Ts FPDAT[7:0] hold from FPSHIFT2 rising, FPSHIFT falling edge 1 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Parameter = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 27] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 25] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 29] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 27] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 18] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 16] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 16] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 14] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 93 7.5.5 Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 2) VDP VNDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) LINE1 FPDAT[7:0] LINE2 LINE3 LINE4 LINE479 LINE480 LINE1 LINE2 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1-R1 1-B3 1-G6 1-G638 FPDAT6 1-G1 1-R4 1-B6 1-B638 FPDAT5 1-B1 1-G4 1-R7 1-R639 FPDAT4 1-R2 1-B4 1-G7 1-G639 FPDAT3 1-G2 1-R5 1-B7 1-B639 FPDAT2 1-B2 1-G5 1-R8 1-R640 FPDAT1 1-R3 1-B5 1-G8 1-G640 FPDAT0 1-G3 1-R6 1-B8 1-B640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-30: Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 2) VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 94 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center t1 Sync Timing t2 FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t11 t12 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:0] t14 1 2 Figure 7-31: Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 2) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 95 Table 7-26: Single Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing (Format 2) Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 4 6 15 17 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 20 18 2 note 6 note 6 18 16 1 1 1 1 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 228 230 239 241 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 28] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 26] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 17] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 15] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 96 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.5.6 Single Color 16-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) FPDAT[15:0] LINE1 LINE2 LINE3 LINE4 LINE479 LINE480 LINE1 LINE2 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPDAT15 1-R1 1-G6 1-B11 1-G635 FPDAT14 1-B1 1-R7 1-G12 1-G636 FPDAT13 1-G2 1-B7 1-R13 1-R637 FPDAT12 1-R3 1-G8 1-B13 1-B637 FPDAT11 1-B3 1-R9 1-G14 1-G638 FPDAT10 1-G4 1-B9 1-R15 1-R639 FPDAT9 1-R5 1-G10 1-B15 1-B639 FPDAT8 1-B5 1-R11 1-G16 1-G640 FPDAT7 1-G1 1-B6 1-R12 1-R636 FPDAT6 1-R2 1-G7 1-B12 1-B636 FPDAT5 1-B2 1-R8 1-G13 1-G637 FPDAT4 1-G3 1-B8 1-R14 1-R638 FPDAT3 1-R4 1-G9 1-B14 1-B638 FPDAT2 1-B4 1-R10 1-G15 1-G639 FPDAT1 1-G5 1-B10 1-R16 1-R640 FPDAT0 1-R6 1-G11 1-B16 1-B640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-32: Single Color 16-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 97 t1 Sync Timing t2 FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t12 t11 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[15:0] t14 1 2 Figure 7-33: Single Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 98 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-27: Single Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[15:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[15:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Min. Setting 28 40 3 5 7 16 18 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 21 19 5 note 6 note 6 18 16 2 2 2 2 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 229 231 240 242 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 27] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 25] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 16] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 14] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 99 7.5.7 Single Color 16-Bit Panel Timing with External Circuit VNDP VDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) S1D13506 OUTPUTS FPDAT[15:0] LINE 1 LINE 3 LINE 4 LINE 479 LINE 480 LINE 1 LINE 2 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HDP HNDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1 -R 1 1-G1 1 -B 6 3 5 1-R636 FPDAT6 1-B1 1-R2 1 -G 6 3 6 1-B636 FPDAT5 1-G2 1 -B 2 1-R 637 FPDAT4 1 -R 3 1-G3 1-B637 1 -R6 3 8 1 -G 6 3 7 FPDAT3 FPDAT2 1-B3 1-R4 1 -G 6 3 8 1 -B 6 3 8 1-G4 1-B4 1 - R 6 3 9 1 -G 6 3 9 FPDAT1 1 -R 5 1-G5 1 -B 6 3 9 FPDAT0 1-B5 1 -R 6 1-G640 1 - B 6 4 0 1-R1 1-G635 D15 16-bit PANEL INPUTS LINE 2 1 -R6 4 0 D14 1 -B 1 1-G636 D13 1-G 2 1-R637 D12 1 -R 3 1 -B 6 3 7 D11 1-B3 1 -G 63 8 D10 1-G 4 1-R 639 D9 1-R5 1 -B 6 3 9 D8 1-B5 1-G640 D7 1-G1 1 -R 6 3 6 D6 1 -R 2 1 -B 6 3 6 D5 1 -B 2 1-G637 D4 1 -G 3 1-R638 D3 1 -R 4 1-B638 D2 1-B4 1-G639 D1 1-G5 1-R640 D0 1-R6 1-B640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-34: 16-Bit Single Color Panel Timing with External Circuit VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 100 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center D[7:0] FPDAT[7:0] D[15:8] Q D TO 16-BIT PANEL FROM S1D13506 FPSHIFT CK Figure 7-35: External Circuit for Color Single 16-Bit Panel When the Media Plug is Enabled t1 Sync Timing t2 FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t12 t11 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:0] t14 1 t15 t16 2 3 4 Figure 7-36: Single Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 101 Table 7-28: Single Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT rising edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT rising edge FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 5 7 16 18 Nominal note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 22 20 4 note 6 note 6 20 18 2 2 1 1 1 1 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 229 231 240 242 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 27] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 25] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 16] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 14] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 102 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.5.8 Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing VNDP VDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) FPDAT[7:0] LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 LINE 3/243 LINE 4/244 LINE 239/479 LINE 240/480 LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HNDP HDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1-1 1-5 1-637 FPDAT6 1-2 1-6 1-638 FPDAT5 1-3 1-7 1-639 FPDAT4 1-4 1-8 1-640 FPDAT3 241-1 241-5 241-637 FPDAT2 241-2 241-6 241-638 FPDAT1 241-3 241-7 241-639 FPDAT0 241-4 241-8 241-640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-37: Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:1]) = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 103 t1 Sync Timing t2 FPFRAME t3 t4 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t12 t11 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:0] t14 1 2 Figure 7-38: Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 104 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-29: Dual Monochrome 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t12 t11 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width low FPSHIFT pulse width high FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Min. Setting 28 40 3 13 15 24 26 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 12 10 4 note 6 note 6 10 8 2 2 2 2 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 237 239 248 250 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 19] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 17] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 8] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 6] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 105 7.5.9 Dual Color 8-Bit Panel Timing VNDP VDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) FPDAT[7:0] LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 LINE 3/243 LINE 4/244 LINE 239/479 LINE 240/480 LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HNDP HDP FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1-R 1 1-G2 1-B3 1-R5 1-G6 1-B7 1-B 639 FPDAT6 1-G1 1-B2 1-R4 1-G5 1-B6 1-R8 1-R640 FPDAT5 1-B1 1-R 3 1-G4 1-B5 1-R7 1-G8 1-G640 1-R2 1-G 3 1-B4 1-R6 1-G7 1-B8 1-B640 FPDAT4 FPDAT3 241-R 1 241-G2 241-B 3 241-R5 241-G6 241-B7 2 41B639 FPDAT2 241-G1 24 1-B2 241-R 4 241-G 5 241-B6 241-R8 241R640 FPDAT1 241-B1 241-R3 241-G4 241-B5 241-R7 241-G8 241G640 FPDAT0 241-R 2 241-G3 241-B4 241-R 6 241-G7 241-B8 241B640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-39: Dual Color 8-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 = ((REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1) /2 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 106 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center t1 t2 Sync Timing FPFRAME t3 t4 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t11 t12 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:0] t14 1 2 Figure 7-40: Dual Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 107 Table 7-30: Dual Color 8-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 12 14 23 25 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 10.5 8.5 1 note 6 note 6 11 9 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 236 238 247 249 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 20] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 18] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 9] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 7] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 108 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.5.10 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) FPDAT[15:0] LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 LINE 3/243 LINE 4/244 LINE 239/479 LINE 240/480 LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 FPLINE DRDY (MOD) HNDP HDP FPSHIFT FPDAT[15,7] 1-R1, 241-R1 1-B3, 2 41-B 3 1-G 63 8, 2 41-G 63 8 FPDAT[14,6] 1-G1, 24 1-G 1 1-R4, 2 41 -R 4 1-B 63 8, 241-B 638 FPDAT[13,5] 1-B1, 2 41-B 1 1-G 4, 2 41-G 4 1-R639 , 241 -R639 FPDAT[12,4] 1-R2, 2 41-R 2 1-B4, 2 41-B 4 1-G 63 9, 2 41-G 63 9 FPDAT[11,3] 1-G2, 24 1-G 2 1-R5, 2 41 -R 5 1-B 63 9, 2 41-B63 9 FPDAT[10,2] 1-B2, 2 41-B 2 1-G 5, 2 41-G 5 1-R640 , 241 -R640 FPDAT[9,1] 1-R3, 2 41-R 3 1-B 5, 2 41-B 5 1-G 640, 2 41-G 64 0 FPDAT[8,0] 1-G3, 24 1-G 3 1-R6, 2 41 -R 6 1-B 64 0, 2 41-B64 0 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-41: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = ((REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1) /2 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 109 t1 t2 Sync Timing FPFRAME t3 t4 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t11 t12 FPSHIFT t13 t14 1 2 FPDAT[15:0] Figure 7-42: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 110 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-31: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[15:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[15:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Min. Setting 28 40 3 12 14 23 25 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 12 10 2 note 6 note 6 10 8 1 1 1 1 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 236 238 247 249 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 20] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 18] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 9] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 7] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 111 7.5.11 Dual Color 16-Bit Panel Timing with External Circuit VDP VNDP FPFRAME FPLINE DRDY (MOD) LINE 1/241 FPDAT[15:0] LINE 2/242 LINE 3/243 LINE 4/244 LINE 239/479 LINE 240/480 LINE 1/241 LINE 2/242 S1D13506 Outputs FPLINE DRDY (MOD) FPSHIFT FPDAT7 1 -R 1 1-G 2 1 -B 3 FPDAT6 1-G1 1-B2 1-R4 1-B 638 1-R 640 FPDAT5 1 -B 1 1 -R 3 1 -G 4 1 -R6 3 9 FPDAT4 1 -R 2 1-G3 1 -B 4 1 -G 6 3 9 1 -B 6 4 0 1 -G 6 3 8 1 -B 6 3 9 1-G640 241-R1 241-G2 241-B3 241G638 241B639 241-G1 241-B2 241-R4 241B638 241R640 FPDAT1 2 41 -B 1 2 4 1 -R 3 2 41 -B 4 241R639 241G 640 FPDAT0 2 4 1 -R 2 2 4 1-G 3 2 41 -B 4 241G 639 241B640 FPDAT3 FPDAT2 16-BIT PANEL INPUTS HNDP HDP UD7 1 -R 1 UD6 1-G1 1-B638 UD5 1-B1 1-R639 UD4 1-R2 1-G639 UD3 1-G2 1 -B 6 3 9 UD2 1 -B 2 1-R 640 UD1 1-R3 1 -G 6 4 0 UD0 1-G 3 1 -B 6 4 0 LD7 241-R1 2 4 1 -G 6 3 8 LD6 241-G1 2 4 1 -B 6 3 8 1-G638 LD5 241-B1 2 4 1 -R 6 3 9 LD4 241-R2 2 4 1 -G 6 3 9 LD3 2 4 1-G 2 241B639 LD2 2 41 -B 2 241R 640 LD1 241-R3 241G 640 LD0 2 4 1-G 3 241B640 * Diagram drawn with 2 FPLINE vertical blank period Example timing for a 640x480 panel Figure 7-43: 16-Bit Dual Color Panel Timing with External Circuit VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 = ((REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1) /2 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 112 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center UD[3:0] LD[3:0] FROM S1D13506 FPDAT[7:4] FPDAT[3:0] FPSHIFT UD[7:4] LD[7:4] Q D TO 16-BIT PANEL CK Figure 7-44: External Circuit for Color Dual 16-Bit Panel When the Media Plug is Enabled t1 Sync Timing t2 FPFRAME t4 t3 FPLINE t5 DRDY (MOD) Data Timing FPLINE t6 t7 t9 t8 t10 t12 t11 FPSHIFT t13 FPDAT[7:0] t14 1 t15 t16 2 3 4 Figure 7-45: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 113 Table 7-32: Dual Color 16-Bit Panel (with External Circuit) A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6a t6b t7a t7b t8 t9a t9b t10a t10b t11 t12 t13 t14 t15 t16 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. t1 t4 t5 t6 6. t9 Parameter FPFRAME setup to FPLINE falling edge FPFRAME hold from FPLINE falling edge FPLINE pulse width FPLINE period DRDY (MOD) delay from FPLINE falling edge FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPSHIFT falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE falling edge to FPSHIFT rising edge, 15/16 bpp FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT rising edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT rising edge FPDAT[7:0] setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPDAT[7:0] hold to FPSHIFT falling edge Min. Setting 28 40 3 12.5 14.5 23.5 25.5 Typical note 2 12 11 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 5 12.5 10.5 2 note 6 note 6 11.5 9.5 1 1 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 Max. Setting 1268 1280 259 236.5 238.5 247.5 249.5 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = t4 - 12 = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 + 3] = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 19.5] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 17.5] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 8.5] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - 6.5] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 114 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7.5.12 TFT/D-TFD Panel Timing VNDP VDP FPFRAME FPLINE R[5:1], G[5:0], B[5:1] LINE480 LINE1 LINE480 DRDY FPLINE HDP HNDP1 HNDP2 FPSHIFT DRDY R[5:1] G [5:0] B[5:1] 1-1 1-2 1-640 1-1 1-2 1-640 1-1 1-2 1-640 Note: DRDY is used to indicate the first pixel Example Timing for 640x480 panel Figure 7-46: TFT/D-TFD Panel Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = HNDP1 + HNDP2 = ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 115 t8 t9 FPFRAME t12 FPLINE t6 FPLINE t15 t7 t17 DRDY t14 t1 t2 t3 t11 t13 t16 FPSHIFT t4 R[5:1] G[5:0] B[5:1] t5 1 2 639 640 t10 Note: DRDY is used to indicate the first pixel Figure 7-47: TFT/D-TFD A.C. Timing Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 116 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 7-33: TFT/D-TFD A.C. Timing Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 t12 t13 t14 t15a t15b t16 t17a t17b 1. Ts 2. 3. 4. 5. 6. 7. 8. 9. t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t12 t14 t15 Parameter FPSHIFT period FPSHIFT pulse width high FPSHIFT pulse width low data setup to FPSHIFT falling edge data hold from FPSHIFT falling edge FPLINE cycle time FPLINE pulse width low FPFRAME cycle time FPFRAME pulse width low horizontal display period FPLINE setup to FPSHIFT falling edge FPFRAME falling edge to FPLINE falling edge phase difference DRDY to FPSHIFT falling edge setup time DRDY pulse width DRDY falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 4 bpp or 8 bpp DRDY falling edge to FPLINE falling edge, 15/16 bpp DRDY hold from FPSHIFT falling edge FPLINE Falling edge to DRDY active, 4 bpp or 8 bpp FPLINE Falling edge to DRDY active, 15/16 bpp 10. t17 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Min. Setting 40 8 2 1 8 1 8 4 6 -6 -8 Typical 1 0.5 0.5 0.5 0.5 note 2 note 3 note 4 note 5 note 6 0.5 note 7 0.5 note 8 note 9 note 9 0.5 note 10 note 10 Max. Setting 1280 128 1088 8 1024 249 1024 252 254 250 248 Units Ts (note 1) Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts lines lines Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts Ts = LCD pixel clock period. LCD pixel clock frequency is LCD pixel clock source divided by 1, 2, 3 or 4 (see REG[014h]). = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 + ((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[036h] bits [3:0]) + 1) × 8] = [((REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1) + ((REG[03Ah] bits [5:0]) + 1)] = [((REG[03Ch] bits [2:0]) + 1)] = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8] = [(REG[035h] bits [4:0]) × 8 + 1] = [((REG[032h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8] = [(REG[035h] bits [4:0]) × 8 + 4] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [(REG[035h] bits [4:0]) × 8 + 6] for 15/16 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - (REG[035h] bits [4:0]) × 8 - 4] for 4 bpp or 8 bpp color depth = [((REG[034h] bits [4:0]) + 1) × 8 - (REG[035h] bits [4:0]) × 8 - 6] for 15/16 bpp color depth Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 117 7.5.13 CRT Timing VNDP VDP VRTC HRTC RED,GREEN,BLUE LINE480 LINE1 LINE480 HRTC HDP HNDP1 1-1 RED,GREEN,BLUE 1-2 HNDP2 1-640 Example Timing for 640x480 CRT Figure 7-48: CRT Timing VDP VNDP HDP HNDP = Vertical Display Period = Vertical Non-Display Period = Horizontal Display Period = Horizontal Non-Display Period = (REG[057h] bits [1:0], REG[056h] bits [7:0]) + 1 = (REG[058h] bits [5:0]) + 1 = ((REG[050h] bits [6:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts = HNDP1 + HNDP2= ((REG[052h] bits [5:0]) + 1) × 8 Ts Note The signals RED, GREEN and BLUE are analog signals from the embedded DAC and represent the color components which make up each pixel. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 118 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center t1 t2 VRTC t3 HRTC Figure 7-49: CRT A.C. Timing Table 7-34: CRT A.C. Timing Symbol t1 1. 2. 3. Parameter VRTC cycle time Min. Setting Typical Max. Setting Units 2 note 1 1152 lines t2 VRTC pulse width low 1 note 2 8 lines t3 VRTC falling edge to FPLINE falling edge phase difference 8 note 3 512 Ts t1 t2 t3 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 = [((REG[057h] bits 1:0, REG[056h] bits 7:0) + 1) + ((REG[058h] bits 6:0) + 1)] lines = [((REG[05Ah] bits 2:0) + 1)] lines = [((REG[053h] bits 5:0) + 1) × 8] Ts Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 119 7.6 TV Timing 7.6.1 TV Output Timing The overall NTSC and PAL video timing is shown in Figure 7-50: and Figure 7-51: respectively. Register Programming: Vertical Non-Display Period = 20 VRTC Start Position = 0 vertical blanking interval = 20 lines 261 262 1 2 3 4 Field 1 5 6 7 vertical sync pulse interval pre-equalizing pulse interval 8 9 10 19 20 21 post-equalizing pulse interval start of field 1 VNDP TV VRTC Start Position (field 1) 261 262 263 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 19 20 21 Field 2 start of field 2 VNDP TV VRTC Start Position (field 2) Start of Vertical Sync Figure 7-50: NTSC Video Timing Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 120 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Register Programming: Vertical Non-Display Period = 26 VRTC Start Position = 0 Field 1 vertical blanking interval = 25 lines 620 621 622 623 624 625 1 2 3 vertical sync pulse interval pre-equalizing pulse interval 4 5 6 7 21 22 23 24 post-equalizing pulse interval start of field 1 VNDP TV VRTC Start Position (field 1) 308 309 310 311 312 313 314 315 316 317 318 319 320 334 335 336 Field 2 start of field 2 VNDP TV VRTC Start Position (field 2) 620 621 622 623 624 625 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 21 22 23 24 Field 3 start of field 3 VNDP TV VRTC Start Position (field 3) 308 309 310 311 312 313 314 315 316 317 318 319 320 334 335 336 Field 4 start of field 4 VNDP TV VRTC Start Position (field 4) Start of Vertical Sync Figure 7-51: PAL Video Timing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 121 IRE 100 Active Line 20 0 Blanking Level 40 IRE -20 -40 t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 Blanking Level 0 t10 Equalizing Pulse Vertical Sync Pulse t11 -40 Start of Horizontal Sync Figure 7-52: Horizontal Timing for NTSC/PAL Table 7-35: Horizontal Timing for NTSC/PAL Symbol T4SC t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 t7 t8 t9 t10 t11 1. t1 2. t5NTSC 3. t5PAL 4. 6. 7. t6NTSC t6PAL t7 Parameter (4x Subcarrier clock) period Front Porch Horizontal Sync Breezeway Color Burst Color Back Porch Horizontal Blanking Active Video Line Period Half Line Period Equalizing Pulse Vertical Serration NTSC 69.841 note 1 67 9 39 note 2 note 4 note 6 910 455 33 67 PAL 56.387 note 1 83 16 44 note 3 note 5 note 6 1135 568 / 567 41 83 Units ns T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC T4SC = ((REG[053] bits[5:0]) + 1) x 8 - 7 (4 bpp, 8 bpp modes) = ((REG[053] bits[5:0]) + 1) x 8 - 5 (15/16 bpp modes) = (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 6) - (((REG[053] bits[5:0]) + 1) x 8) - 108 (4 bpp, 8 bpp modes) = (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 6) - (((REG[053] bits[5:0]) + 1) x 8) - 110 (15/16 bpp modes) = (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 7) - (((REG[053] bits[5:0]) + 1) x 8) - 136 (4 bpp, 8 bpp modes) = (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 7) - (((REG[053] bits[5:0]) + 1) x 8) - 138 (15/16 bpp modes) = ((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 6 = ((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 7 = ((REG[050] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 8 Important: REG[050] and REG[052] must be programmed to satisfy the Line Period (t8). For NTSC, (((REG[050] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 8) + (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 6) = 910. For PAL, (((REG[050] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 8) + (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 7) = 1135. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 122 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 909 (NTSC) 1134 (PAL) 0 Vertical Non-Display Period t4 t2 Vertical Sync Odd Field 1,3 Vertical Display Period t1 Odd Lines (1, 3, 5, ...) t5 Vertical Non-Display Period t4 Vertical Sync t3 Even Field 2,4 Vertical Display Period t1 Even Lines (2, 4, 6, ...) Horizontal Sync Figure 7-53: Vertical Timing for NTSC/PAL Table 7-36: Vertical Timing for NTSC/PAL Symbol TLINE t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 1. 2. 3. 4. t1 t2 t3 t4NTSC 5. t4PAL Parameter Line Period Vertical Field Period Vertical Blanking (Fields 1, 3) Vertical Blanking (Fields 2, 4) Vertical Sync Position Frame Period NTSC 63.55556 note 1 note 2 note 3 note 4 525 PAL 63.99964 note 1 note 2 note 3 note 5 625 Units us TLINE TLINE TLINE TLINE TLINE = ({(REG[057] bits[1:0]), (REG[056] bits[7:0])} + 1) / 2 = ((REG[058] bits[6:0]) + 1) for fields 1 & 3 = ((REG[058] bits[6:0]) + 2) for fields 2 & 4 = ((REG[059] bits[6:0]) + 4) for field 1 = ((REG[059] bits[6:0]) + 4.5) for field 2 = ((REG[059] bits[6:0]) + 5) for field 1 and field 3 = ((REG[059] bits[6:0]) + 4.5) for field 2 and field 4 Important REG[056], REG[057], and REG[058] must be programmed to satisfy the Frame Period (t5). For NTSC, ({(REG[057] bits[1:0]), (REG[056] bits[7:0])} + 1) + ((REG[058] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 2 + 1) = 525 For PAL, ({(REG[057] bits[1:0]), (REG[056] bits[7:0])} + 1) + ((REG[058] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 2 + 1) = 625. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 123 7.7 MediaPlug Interface Timing T1 VMPCLK t2 t2 t2 t2 VMPCLKN t3 VMPDIN[3:0] t4 VMPCTRL t5 VMPLCTRL t7 t6 VMPDout Figure 7-54: MediaPlug A.C. Timing Note The above timing diagram assumes no load. Table 7-37: MediaPlug A.C. Timing Symbol Parameter Min Max T1 MediaPlug clock period t2 VMPCLKN delay from VMPCLK 0 t3 Input data setup 6 t4 VMPCTRL setup 6 t5 Local control signal delay from VMPCLK falling edge 2 ns t6 Output data delay from VMPCLK falling edge 1 ns t7 Output data tristate delay from VMPCLK falling edge 14 ns Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 100 Units ns 3 ns ns S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 124 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8 Registers This section discusses how and where to access the S1D13506 registers. It also provides detailed information about the layout and usage of each register. 8.1 Initializing the S1D13506 Before programming the S1D13506 registers, the Register/Memory Select bit (REG[000h] bit 7) must be set. 8.1.1 Register/Memory Select Bit At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (readonly) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers and memory accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 8.2 Register Mapping The S1D13506 registers are memory-mapped. When the system decodes the input pins as CS# = 0 and M/R# = 0, the registers may be accessed. The register space is decoded by A20-A0. When A20 = 1 the BitBlt data register ports are decoded allowing the system to access the display buffer through the 2D BitBlt engine using address lines A19-A0. When A20 = 0 and A12 = 0 the registers are decoded using A8-A0 as an index. When A20 = 0 and A12 = 1 the MediaPlug register ports are decoded using A11-A0. The MediaPlug register ports are defined only when configuration input MD13 = 1 on reset. When MD13 = 0 on reset, A12 is always treated as 0 and the MediaPlug register space is not available - see Table 5-6:, “Summary of Power-On/Reset Options,” on page 39. Table 8-1: “Register Mapping with CS# = 0 and M/R# = 0” shows the decoding for each register type. Table 8-1: Register Mapping with CS# = 0 and M/R# = 0 Register Types (Range) Address A20-A0 Decoding BitBlt data registers (1M byte) 100000h to 1FFFFFh MediaPlug registers (4K bytes) 1000h to 1FFFh Main Registers (512 bytes) 0 to 1FFh Note The registers may be aliased within the allocated register space. If aliasing is undesirable, the register space must be fully decoded. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 125 8.3 Register Descriptions 8.3.1 Basic Registers Revision Code Register REG[000h] RO Product Code Product Code Product Code Product Code Product Code Product Code Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Revision Code Bit 1 Revision Code Bit 0 bits 7-2 Product Code Bits [5:0] This is a read-only register that indicates the product code of the chip. The product code for S1D13506 is 000100b. bits 1-0 Revision Code Bits [1:0] This is a read-only register that indicates the revision code of the chip. The revision code is 01b. Miscellaneous Register REG[001h] Register/ Memory Select n/a RW n/a n/a n/a Reserved Reserved Reserved bit 7 Register Memory Select At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers and memory accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. bit 2 Reserved. This bit must be set to 0. bit 1 Reserved. This bit must be set to 0. bit 0 Reserved. This bit must be set to 0. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 126 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.2 General IO Pins Registers General IO Pins Configuration Register REG[004h] Reserved Reserved bit 3 Reserved RW Reserved GPIO3 Pin IO Config. GPIO2 Pin IO Config. GPIO1 Pin IO Config. Reserved GPIO3 Pin IO Configuration When this bit = 1, GPIO3 is configured as an output pin. When this bit = 0 (default), GPIO3 is configured as an input pin. Note Note that MD[7:6] must be properly configured at the rising edge of RESET# to enable GPIO3, otherwise GPIO3 will be used as MA[9] for the DRAM and this bit will have no hardware effect. (See Table 8-2: “MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality”). bit 2 GPIO2 Pin IO Configuration When this bit = 1, GPIO2 is configured as an output pin. When this bit = 0 (default), GPIO2 is configured as an input pin. Note Note that MD[14] and MD[7:6] must be properly configured at the rising edge of RESET# to enable GPIO2, otherwise GPIO2 will be used as MA[11] for the DRAM or as the MediaPlug VMPEPWR output and this bit will have no hardware effect. (See Table 8-2: “MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality”). bit 1 GPIO1 Pin IO Configuration When this bit = 1, GPIO1 is configured as an output pin. When this bit = 0 (default), GPIO1 is configured as an input pin. Note Note that MD[7:6] must be properly configured at the rising edge of RESET# to enable GPIO1, otherwise GPIO1 will be used as MA[10] for the DRAM and this bit will have no hardware effect. (See Table 8-2: “MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality”). Table 8-2: MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Pin MD[14] on Reset MD[7:6] on Reset MA[9]/GPIO3 MA[10]/GPIO1 MA[11]/GPIO2 0 00 GPIO3 GPIO1 GPIO2 0 01 MA9 GPIO1 GPIO2 0 10 MA9 GPIO1 GPIO2 0 11 MA9 MA10 MA11 1 00 GPIO3 GPIO1 VMPEPWR 1 01 MA9 GPIO1 VMPEPWR 1 10 MA9 GPIO1 VMPEPWR 1 11 MA9 MA10 MA11 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 127 General IO Pins Control Register REG[008h] Reserved bit 3 Reserved Reserved RW Reserved GPIO3 Pin IO Status GPIO2 Pin IO Status GPIO1 Pin IO Status Reserved GPIO3 Pin IO Status When GPIO3 is configured as an output, writing a 1 to this bit drives GPIO3 high and writing a 0 to this bit drives GPIO3 low. When GPIO3 is configured as an input, a read from this bit returns the status of GPIO3. Note Note that MD[7:6] must be properly configured at the rising edge of RESET# to enable GPIO3, otherwise GPIO3 will be used as MA9 for the DRAM and this bit will have no hardware effect. (See Table 8-2: “MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality”). bit 2 GPIO2 Pin IO Status When GPIO2 is configured as an output, writing a 1 to this bit drives GPIO2 high and writing a 0 to this bit drives GPIO2 low. When GPIO2 is configured as an input, a read from this bit returns the status of GPIO2. Note Note that MD[14] and MD[7:6] must be properly configured at the rising edge of RESET# to enable GPIO2, otherwise GPIO2 will be used as MA11 for the DRAM or as the MediaPlug VMPEPWR output and this bit will have no hardware effect. (See Table 8-2: “MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality”). bit 1 GPIO1 Pin IO Status When GPIO1 is configured as an output, writing a 1 to this bit drives GPIO1 high and writing a 0 to this bit drives GPIO1 low. When GPIO1 is configured as an input, a read from this bit returns the status of GPIO1. Note Note that MD[7:6] must be properly configured at the rising edge of RESET# to enable GPIO1, otherwise GPIO1 will be used as MA10 for the DRAM and this bit will have no hardware effect. (See Table 8-2: “MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality”). Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 128 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.3 MD Configuration Readback Registers MD Configuration Status Register 0 REG[00Ch] RO MD[7] MD[6] MD[5] MD[4] MD[3] MD[2] MD[1] MD[0] Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status MD Configuration Status Register 1 REG[00Dh] RO MD[15] MD[14] MD[13] MD[12] MD[11] MD[10] MD[9] MD[8] Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status Config. Status REG[00Ch] bits 7-0 REG[00Dh] bits 7-0 MD[15:0] Configuration Status Bits [15:0] These read-only bits return the status of MD[15:0] at the rising edge of RESET#. 8.3.4 Clock Configuration Registers Memory Clock Configuration Register REG[010h] n/a bit 4 n/a RW MCLK Divide Select n/a n/a n/a n/a MCLK Source Select MCLK Divide Select When this bit = 1, the internal memory clock frequency is half of the MCLK source frequency. When this bit = 0, the memory clock frequency is equal to the MCLK source frequency. The MCLK frequency should always be set to the maximum frequency allowed by the DRAM. This provides maximum performance and minimizes overall system power consumption. bit 0 MCLK Source Select When this bit = 1, the source for the internal MCLK is derived from BUSCLK. When this bit = 0, the source for MCLK is derived from CLKI. Table 8-3: MCLK Source Select MCLK Source Select MCLK Source 0 CLKI 1 BUSCLK Note The MCLK Divide Select bit must be set to 1 before changing the MCLK Source Select bit. Note For further information on MCLK, refer to Section 20.2, “Clock Descriptions” on page 225. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 129 LCD Pixel Clock Configuration Register REG[014h] n/a LCD PCLK Divide Select Bit 1 n/a bits 5-4 RW LCD PCLK Divide Select Bit 0 n/a n/a LCD PCLK LCD PCLK Source Select Source Select Bit 1 Bit 0 LCD PCLK Divide Select Bits [1:0] These bits determine the divide used to generate the LCD pixel clock from the LCD pixel clock source. Table 8-4: LCD PCLK Divide Selection LCD PCLK Divide Select Bits LCD PCLK Source to LCD PCLK Frequency Ratio 00 1:1 01 2:1 10 3:1 11 4:1 bits 1-0 LCD PCLK Source Select Bits [1:0] These bits determine the source of the LCD pixel clock for the LCD display. Table 8-5: LCD PCLK Source Selection LCD PCLK Source Select Bits LCD PCLK Source 00 CLKI 01 BUSCLK 10 CLKI2 11 MCLK (see note) Note MCLK may be a previously divided down version of CLKI, CLKI2 or BUSCLK. CRT/TV Pixel Clock Configuration Register REG[018h] CRT/TV PCLK 2X Enable bit 7 CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select Bit 1 n/a CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select Bit 0 RW n/a n/a CRT/TV PCLK Source Select Bit 1 CRT/TV PCLK Source Select Bit 0 CRT/TV PCLK 2X Enable This bit multiplies the CRT/TV pixel clock by 2. This bit must be set to 1 when TV with flicker filter is enabled. See REG[1FCh] bits 2-0. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 130 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bits 5-4 CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select Bits[1:0] These bits determine the divide used to generate the CRT/TV pixel clock from the CRT/TV pixel clock source. Table 8-6: CRT/TV PCLK Divide Selection CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select Bits CRT/TV PCLK Source to CRT/TV PCLK Frequency Ratio 00 1:1 01 2:1 10 3:1 11 4:1 bits 1-0 CRT/TV PCLK Source Select Bits [1:0] These bits determine the source of the CRT/TV pixel clock for the CRT/TV display. Table 8-7: CRT/TV PCLK Source Selection CRT/TV PCLK Source Select Bits CRT/TV PCLK Source 00 CLKI 01 BUSCLK 10 CLKI2 11 MCLK (see note) Note MCLK may be a previously divided down version of CLKI, CLKI2 or BUSCLK. MediaPlug Clock Configuration Register REG[01Ch] n/a bits 5-4 n/a MediaPlug Clock Divide Select Bit 1 RW MediaPlug Clock Divide Select Bit 0 n/a n/a MediaPlug Clock Source Select Bit 1 MediaPlug Clock Source Select Bit 0 MediaPlug Clock Divide Select Bits[1:0] These bits determine the divide used to generate the MediaPlug Clock from the CRT/TV pixel clock source. Table 8-8: MediaPlug Clock Divide Selection S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 MediaPlug Clock Divide Select Bits MediaPlug Clock Source to CRT/TV Pixel Clock Frequency Ratio 00 1:1 01 2:1 10 3:1 11 4:1 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bits 1-0 Page 131 MediaPlug Clock Source Select Bits [1:0] These bits determine the source of the MediaPlug Clock for the MediaPlug Interface. See Section 7.7, “MediaPlug Interface Timing” on page 123 for AC Timing. Table 8-9: Video Clock Source Selection MediaPlug Clock Source Select Bits MediaPlug Clock Source 00 CLKI 01 BUSCLK 10 CLKI2 11 MCLK (see note) Note MCLK may be a previously divided down version of CLKI, CLKI2 or BUSCLK. CPU To Memory Wait State Select Register REG[01Eh] n/a bits 1-0 n/a n/a RW n/a n/a n/a CPU to Memory Wait State Select Bit 1 CPU to Memory Wait State Select Bit 0 CPU to Memory Wait State Select Bits [1:0] These bits are used to optimize the handshaking between the host interface and the memory controller. The bits should be set according to the relationship between BCLK and MCLK (memory clock). Note BCLK can be either BUSCLK or BUSCLK ÷ 2 depending on the setting of MD12 (see Table 5-6:, “Summary of Power-On/Reset Options,” on pag e39). Failure to meet the following conditions may lead to system failure which is recoverable only by RESET. Table 8-10: Minimum Memory Timing Selection Wait State Bits [1:0] Condition 00 no restrictions 01 2 x period (MCLK) - 4ns > period(BCLK) 10 period(MCLK) - 4ns > period(BCLK) 11 Reserved Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 132 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.5 Memory Configuration Registers Memory Configuration Register REG[020h] n/a bits 1-0 n/a RW n/a n/a n/a n/a Memory Type Memory Type Bit 1 Bit 0 Memory Type Bits [1:0] These bits specify the memory type. Table 8-11: Memory Type Selection Memory Type Bits [1:0] Memory Type 00 EDO-DRAM with 2-CAS# 01 FPM-DRAM with 2-CAS# 10 EDO-DRAM with 2-WE# 11 FPM-DRAM with 2-WE# DRAM Refresh Rate Register REG[021h] Refresh Select Bit 1 bits 7-6 Refresh Select Bit 0 RW n/a n/a DRAM Refresh Rate Bit 2 n/a DRAM Refresh Rate Bit 1 DRAM Refresh Rate Bit 0 Refresh Select Bits [1:0] These bits specify the type of DRAM refresh used while in power save mode. Table 8-12: Refresh Selection Refresh Select Bits [1:0] DRAM Refresh Type 00 CBR Refresh 01 Self-Refresh 1X No Refresh Note These bits should not be changed while power save mode is enabled. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bits 2-0 Page 133 DRAM Refresh Rate Select Bits [2:0] These bits specify the divide used to generate the DRAM refresh clock rate, which is equal to 2(ValueOfTheseBits + 6), from the MCLK source (either BUSCLK or CLKI as determined by REG[010h] bit 0). Table 8-13: DRAM Refresh Rate Selection DRAM Refresh Rate Bits [2:0] MCLK Source Divide Amount Refresh Rate for 40MHz MCLK Source DRAM Refresh Time/256 cycles 000 64 625 kHz 0.4 ms 001 128 312 kHz 0.8 ms 010 256 156 kHz 1.6 ms 011 512 78 kHz 3.3 ms 100 1024 39 kHz 6.6 ms 101 2048 20 kHz 13.1 ms 110 4096 10 kHz 26.2 ms 111 8192 5 kHz 52.4 ms Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 134 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center DRAM Timing Control Register 0 REG[02Ah] RW DRAM Timing DRAM Timing DRAM Timing DRAM Timing DRAM Timing DRAM Timing DRAM Timing DRAM Timing Control Control Control Control Control Control Control Control Register Register Register Register Register Register Register Register Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 DRAM Timing Control Register 1 REG[02Bh] n/a n/a REG[02Ah] bits 4-0 REG[02Bh] bits 1-0 RW n/a n/a n/a n/a DRAM Timing DRAM Timing Control Control Register Register Bit 9 Bit 8 DRAM Timing Control Bits [9:0] The DRAM Timing Control registers must be set based on the type of DRAM, speed of DRAM, and MCLK frequency used. The following table provides the optimal values for each register. Table 8-14: DRAM Timing Control Selection DRAM Type EDO FPM S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 DRAM Speed (ns) 50 50 60 50 60 70 50 60 70 80 50 60 70 80 50 60 50 60 70 80 MCLK Frequency (MHz) 40 33 30 25 20 25 20 DRAM Timing Control Register 0 DRAM Timing Control Register 1 01h 01h 01h 12h 01h 00h 12h 12h 01h 00h 12h 12h 12h 01h 12h 01h 12h 12h 11h 01h 01h 01h 01h 02h 01h 00h 02h 02h 01h 01h 02h 02h 02h 01h 02h 01h 02h 02h 02h 01h Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 135 8.3.6 Panel Configuration Registers Panel Type Register REG[030h] EL Panel Mode Enable RW Panel Data Width Bit 1 n/a Panel Data Width Bit 0 Panel Data Format Select Color/Mono. Panel Select Dual/Single Panel Select TFT/ Passive LCD Panel Select bit 7 EL Panel Mode Enable When this bit = 1, the EL Panel support circuit is enabled. When this bit = 0, there is no hardware effect. This bit enables the S1D13506 built-in circuit for EL panels which require the Frame Rate Modulation (FRM) to remain static for one frame after every 262143 frames (approximately 1 hour at 60Hz refresh). When this bit is enabled, the need for external circuitry to perform the above function is eliminated. bits 5-4 Panel Data Width Bits [1:0] These bits select passive LCD/TFT/D-TFD panel data width size. Table 8-15: Panel Data Width Selection Panel Data Width Bits [1:0] Passive LCD Panel Data Width Size TFT/D-TFD Panel Data Width Size 00 4-bit 9-bit 01 8-bit 12-bit 10 16-bit 18-bit (64K color) 11 Reserved Reserved bit 3 Panel Data Format Select When this bit = 1, 8-bit single color passive LCD panel data format 2 is selected. For AC timing see Section 7.5.5, “Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 2)” on page 93. When this bit = 0, 8-bit single color passive LCD panel data format 1 is selected. For AC timing see Section 7.5.4, “Single Color 8-Bit Panel Timing (Format 1)” on page 90. bit 2 Color/Mono Panel Select When this bit = 1, color LCD panel is selected. When this bit = 0, monochrome LCD panel is selected. bit 1 Dual/Single Panel Select When this bit = 1, dual LCD panel is selected. When this bit = 0, single LCD panel is selected. bit 0 TFT/Passive LCD Panel Select When this bit = 1, TFT/D-TFD panel is selected. When this bit = 0, passive LCD panel is selected. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 136 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center MOD Rate Register REG[031h] n/a bits 5-0 RW MOD Rate Bit MOD Rate Bit MOD Rate Bit MOD Rate Bit MOD Rate Bit MOD Rate Bit 5 4 3 2 1 0 n/a MOD Rate Bits [5:0] For a non-zero value these bits specify the number of FPLINE between toggles of the MOD output signal (DRDY). When these bits are all 0’s the MOD output signal toggles every FPFRAME. These bits are for passive LCD panels only. LCD Horizontal Display Width Register REG[032h] n/a bits 6-0 RW LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 LCD Horizontal Display Width Bits [6:0] These bits specify the LCD panel horizontal display width, in 8 pixel resolution. Horizontal display width in number of pixels = ((ContentsOfThisRegister)+ 1) × 8 The Horizontal Display Width has certain limitations on the values that may be used for each type of LCD panel. Use of values that do not meet the limitations listed in the following table will result in undefined behavior. Table 8-16: Horizontal Display Width (Pixels) Panel Type Passive Single Passive Dual TFT Horizontal Display Width (Pixels) must be divisible by 16 must be divisible by 32 must be divisible by 8 Note This register must be programmed such that REG[032h] ≥ 3 (32 pixels). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 137 LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Register REG[034h] n/a n/a bits 4-0 n/a LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 4 RW LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 3 LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 2 LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 1 LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 0 LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period Bits [4:0] These bits specify the LCD panel horizontal non-display period width in 8 pixel resolution. Horiz. non-display period width in number of pixels = ((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) × 8 Note This register must be programmed such that REG[032h] ≥ 3 (32 pixels). Note For TFT/D-TFD only: REG[034h] + 1 ≥ (REG[035h] + 1) + (REG[036h] bits 3-0 + 1) TFT FPLINE Start Position Register REG[035h] n/a bits 4-0 n/a n/a RW TFT FPLINE Start Position Bit 4 TFT FPLINE Start Position Bit 3 TFT FPLINE Start Position Bit 2 TFT FPLINE Start Position Bit 1 TFT FPLINE Start Position Bit 0 TFT FPLINE Start Position Bits [4:0] For TFT/D-TFD panel only, these bits specify the delay, in 8 pixel resolution, from the start of the horizontal non-display period to the leading edge of the FPLINE pulse. For 4/8 bpp color depth: FPLINE start position in number of pixels = [(ContentsOfThisRegister) x 8 + 4] For 15/16 bpp color depth: FPLINE start position in number of pixels = [(ContentsOfThisRegister) x 8 + 6] Note For TFT/D-TFD only: REG[034h] + 1 ≥ (REG[035h] + 1) + (REG[036h] bits 3-0 + 1) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 138 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center TFT FPLINE Pulse Width Register REG[036h] LCD FPLINE Polarity Select n/a bit 7 n/a RW TFT FPLINE Pulse Width Bit 3 n/a TFT FPLINE Pulse Width Bit 2 TFT FPLINE Pulse Width Bit 1 TFT FPLINE Pulse Width Bit 0 LCD FPLINE Polarity Select This bit selects the polarity of FPLINE for all LCD panels. When this bit = 1, the FPLINE pulse is active high for TFT/D-TFD and active low for passive LCD. When this bit = 0, the FPLINE pulse is active low for TFT/D-TFD and active high for passive LCD. Table 8-17: LCD FPLINE Polarity Selection LCD FPLINE Polarity Select Passive LCD FPLINE Polarity TFT FPLINE Polarity 0 active high active low 1 active low active high bits 3-0 TFT FPLINE Pulse Width Bits [3:0] For TFT/D-TFD panel only, these bits specify the pulse width of the FPLINE output signal in 8 pixel resolution. FPLINE pulse width in number of pixels = ((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) × 8 The maximum FPLINE pulse width is 128 pixels. Note For TFT/D-TFD only: REG[034h] + 1 ≥ (REG[035h] + 1) + (REG[036h] bits 3-0 + 1) LCD Vertical Display Height Register 0 REG[038h] LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 7 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 6 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 5 RW LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 4 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 3 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 2 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 1 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 0 n/a LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 9 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 8 LCD Vertical Display Height Register 1 REG[039h] n/a n/a n/a RW n/a n/a REG[038h] bits 7-0 LCD Vertical Display Height Bits [9:0] REG[039h] bits 1-0 These bits specify the LCD panel vertical display height, in 1 line resolution. Vertical display height in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 139 LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Register REG[03Ah] LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Status (RO) LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 5 n/a LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 4 RW LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 3 LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 2 LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 1 LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 0 bit 7 LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Status This is a read-only status bit. When a read from this bit = 1, a LCD panel vertical non-display period is occurring. When a read from this bit = 0, the LCD panel output is in a vertical display period. bits 5-0 LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bits [5:0] These bits specify the LCD panel vertical non-display period height in 1 line resolution. Vertical non-display period height in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 Note For TFT/D-TFD only: (REG[03Ah] bits 5-0 + 1) ≥ (REG[03Bh] + 1) + (REG[03Ch] bits 2-0 + 1) TFT FPFRAME Start Position Register REG[03Bh] n/a bits 5-0 TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 5 n/a RW TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 4 TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 3 TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 2 TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 1 TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 0 TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bits [5:0] For TFT/D-TFD panel only, these bits specify the delay in lines from the start of the vertical non-display period to the leading edge of the FPFRAME pulse. FPFRAME start position in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 Note For TFT/D-TFD only: (REG[03Ah] bits 5-0 + 1) ≥ (REG[03Bh] + 1) + (REG[03Ch] bits 2-0 + 1) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 140 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center TFT FPFRAME Pulse Width Register REG[03Ch] LCD FPFRAME Polarity Select n/a bit 7 RW n/a n/a n/a TFT FPFRAME Pulse Width Bit 2 TFT FPFRAME Pulse Width Bit 1 TFT FPFRAME Pulse Width Bit 0 LCD FPFRAME Polarity Select This bit selects the polarity of FPFRAME for all LCD panels. When this bit = 1, the FPFRAME pulse is active high for TFT/D-TFD and active low for passive LCD. When this bit = 0, the FPFRAME pulse is active low for TFT/D-TFD and active high for passive LCD. Table 8-18: LCD FPFRAME Polarity Selection LCD FPFRAME Polarity Select Passive LCD FPFRAME Polarity TFT FPFRAME Polarity 0 active high active low 1 active low active high bits 2-0 TFT FPFRAME Pulse Width Bits [2:0] For TFT/D-TFD panel only, these bits specify the pulse width of the FPFRAME output signal in number of lines. FPFRAME pulse width in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 Note For TFT/D-TFD only: (REG[03Ah] bits 5-0 + 1) ≥ (REG[03Bh] + 1) + (REG[03Ch] bits 2-0 + 1) 8.3.7 LCD Display Mode Registers LCD Display Mode Register REG[040h] LCD Display Blank bit 7 n/a RW n/a SwivelView™ Enable Bit 1 n/a LCD Bit-perpixel Select Bit 2 LCD Bit-perpixel Select Bit 1 LCD Bit-perpixel Select Bit 0 LCD Display Blank When this bit = 1, the LCD display pipeline is disabled and all LCD data outputs are forced to zero (i.e., the screen is blanked). When this bit = 0, the LCD display pipeline is enabled. Note If a dual panel is used, the Dual Panel Buffer (REG[041h] bit 0) must be disabled (set to 1) before blanking the LCD display. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bit 4 Page 141 SwivelView™ Enable Bit 1 When this bit = 1, the LCD display image is rotated 180° clockwise. Please refer to Section 15, “SwivelView™” on page 201 for application and limitations. When this bit = 0, there is no hardware effect. This bit in conjunction with SwivelView™ Enable Bit 0 achieves the following hardware rotations. Table 8-19: Setting SwivelView Modes SwivelView™ Modes SwivelView Enable Bits bits 2-0 Normal SwivelView 90° SwivelView 180° SwivelView 270° SwivelView Enable Bit 0 (REG[1FCh] bit 6) 0 1 0 1 SwivelView Enable Bit 1 (REG[040h] bit 4) 0 0 1 1 LCD Bit-per-pixel Select Bits [2:0] These bits select the color depth (bit-per-pixel) for the displayed data. Note 15/16 bpp color depths bypass the LUT. Passive panels are supported up to 32K/64K colors (4096 colors if dithering disabled, see REG[041h] bit 1). TFT/D-TFD panels are supported up to 32K/64K colors. Table 8-20: LCD Bit-per-pixel Selection Bit-per-pixel Select Bits [1:0] Color Depth (bpp) 000 Reserved 001 Reserved 010 4 bpp 011 8 bpp 100 15 bpp 101 16 bpp 110-111 Reserved Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 142 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center LCD Miscellaneous Register REG[041h] n/a bit 1 n/a RW n/a n/a n/a n/a Dithering Disable Dual Panel Buffer Disable Dithering Disable When this bit = 1, dithering on the passive LCD panel for 15/16 bpp mode is disabled allowing a maximum of 4096 colors (212) or 16 gray shades. When this bit = 0, dithering on the passive LCD panel for 15/16 bpp mode is enabled allowing a maximum of 64K colors (216) or 64 gray shades. Note This bit has no effect in 4/8 bpp modes where dithering is not supported. All passive STN color panels are controlled using 3 bits for each pixel (RGB) for a total of 8 possible colors. LCD controllers use a combination of Frame Rate Modulation (FRM) and dithering to achieve more than 8 colors per pixel. FRM can achieve 16 shades of color for each RGB component resulting in a total of 4096 possible colors (16x16x16). Dithering uses a 4 pixel square formation and applies a set of 4 hard-coded patterns for each of the 16 shades of color. This expands the original 16 shades of color from the FRM logic to 64 shades per RGB component which results in 256K colors per pixel (64x64x64). For the S1D13506, 16 bpp is arranged as 5-6-5 RGB. In this mode, when dithering is enabled, the LUT is bypassed and the original 16-bit data is used as a pointer into the 64 shades per color in the following manner. (5-6-5 RGB) 32 possible Red, 64 possible Green, 32 possible Blue This combination of FRM and dithering results in 256K colors/pixel, however, the 16 bpp limitation of the S1D13506 limits this to 64K colors/pixel. bit 0 Dual Panel Buffer Disable This bit is used to disable the Dual Panel Buffer. When this bit = 1, the Dual Panel Buffer is disabled. When this bit = 0, the Dual Panel Buffer is enabled. When a single panel is selected, the Dual Panel Buffer is automatically disabled and this bit has no effect. The Dual Panel Buffer is needed to fully support dual panels. Disabling the Dual Panel Buffer will improve performance, reduce power consumption, and allow higher resolution/ color display modes than would otherwise be possible; however, disabling the Dual Panel Buffer will reduce image contrast and overall display quality. This mode is not normally used except in special circumstances such as simultaneous display on a CRT/TV and dual panel LCD. For details on Frame Rate Calculation, see Section 17. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 143 LCD Display Start Address Register 0 REG[042h] LCD Display Start Address Bit 7 LCD Display Start Address Bit 6 LCD Display Start Address Bit 5 RW LCD Display Start Address Bit 4 LCD Display Start Address Bit 3 LCD Display Start Address Bit 2 LCD Display Start Address Bit 1 LCD Display Start Address Register 1 REG[043h] LCD Display Start Address Bit 15 LCD Display Start Address Bit 14 LCD Display Start Address Bit 13 RW LCD Display Start Address Bit 12 LCD Display Start Address Bit 11 LCD Display Start Address Bit 10 LCD Display Start Address Bit 9 LCD Display Start Address Register 2 REG[044h] n/a n/a n/a LCD Display Start Address Bit 0 LCD Display Start Address Bit 8 RW n/a LCD Display Start Address Bit 19 LCD Display Start Address Bit 18 LCD Display Start Address Bit 17 LCD Display Start Address Bit 16 REG[042h] bits 7-0 LCD Display Start Address Bits [19:0] REG[043h] bits 7-0 This register forms the 20-bit address for the starting word of the LCD image in the display buffer. REG[044h] bits 3-0 Note that this is a word address. An entry of 00000h into these registers represents the first word of display memory, an entry of 00001h represents the second word of the display memory, and so on. LCD Memory Address Offset Register 0 REG[046h] LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 7 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 6 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 5 RW LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 4 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 3 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 2 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 1 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 0 n/a LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 10 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 9 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 8 LCD Memory Address Offset Register 1 REG[047h] n/a REG[046h] bits 7-0 REG[047h] bits 2-0 n/a n/a RW n/a LCD Memory Address Offset Bits [10:0] These bits are the LCD display’s 11-bit address offset from the starting word of line “n” to the starting word of line “n + 1”. A virtual image can be formed by setting this register to a value greater than the width of the display. The displayed image is a window into the larger virtual image. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 144 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center LCD Pixel Panning Register REG[048h] n/a n/a RW n/a n/a Reserved Reserved LCD Pixel Panning Bit 1 LCD Pixel Panning Bit 0 bits 3-2 Reserved. Must be set to 0. bits 1-0 LCD Pixel Panning Bits [1:0] This register is used to control the horizontal pixel panning of the LCD display. The display can be panned to the left by programming its respective Pixel Panning Bits to a nonzero value. This value represents the number of pixels panned. The maximum pan value is dependent on the display mode as shown in the table below. Table 8-21: LCD Pixel Panning Selection Color Depth (bpp) Screen 2 Pixel Panning Bits Used 4 bpp Bits [1:0] 8 bpp Bit 0 15/16 bpp --- Smooth horizontal panning can be achieved by a combination of this register and the LCD Display Start Address register. LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Control Register REG[04Ah] n/a bits 5-0 LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 5 n/a LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 4 RW LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 3 LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 2 LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 1 LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 0 LCD Display FIFO High Threshold Bits [5:0] These bits are used to optimize the display memory request arbitration. When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. However, programming may be required if screen corruption is present (see Section 18.2, “Example Frame Rates” on page 216). Note This register does not need to be used in single display modes and may only be required in some display modes where two displays are active (see Section 16.2, “Bandwidth Limitation” on page 211). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 145 LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Control Register REG[04Bh] n/a LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 5 n/a bits 5-0 LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 4 RW LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 3 LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 2 LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 1 LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 0 LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bits [5:0] When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. If it becomes necessary to adjust REG[04Ah] from its default value, then the following formula must be maintained: REG[04Bh] > REG[04Ah] and REG[04Bh] ≤ 3Ch 8.3.8 CRT/TV Configuration Registers CRT/TV Horizontal Display Width Register REG[050h] n/a RW CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Horizontal Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Display Width Bit 0 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 bits 6-0 CRT/TV Horizontal Display Width Bits [6:0] These bits specify the CRT/TV horizontal display width, in 8 pixel resolution. Horizontal display width in number of pixels = ((ContentsOfThisRegister)+ 1) × 8 CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Register REG[052h] n/a bits 5-0 CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 5 n/a CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 4 RW CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 3 CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 2 CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 1 CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 0 CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bits [5:0] These bits specify the CRT/TV horizontal non-display period width in 8 pixel resolution. Horizontal non-display period width in number of pixels = ((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) × 8 for CRT mode (ContentsOfThisRegister) × 8 + 6 for TV mode with NTSC output (ContentsOfThisRegister) × 8 + 7 for TV mode with PAL output Note For CRT mode, the recommended minimum value which should be programmed into this register is 3 (32 pixels). Note REG[052h] + 1 ≥ (REG[053h] + 1) + (REG[054h] bits 3-0 + 1) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 146 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Register REG[053h] n/a CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 5 n/a bits 5-0 RW CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 4 CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 3 CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 2 CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 1 CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 0 CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bits [5:0] For CRT/TV, these bits specify the delay, in 8 pixel resolution, from the start of the horizontal non-display period to the leading edge of the HRTC pulse. The following equations can be used to determine the HRTC start position in number of pixels for each display type: HRTC start position in number of pixels=: [(ContentsOfThisRegister) x 8 + 3] for CRT with 4/8 bpp color depth [(ContentsOfThisRegister) x 8 + 5] for CRT in 15/16 bpp color depth [((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) x 8 - 7] for TV-NTSC in 4/8 bpp color depth [((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) x 8 - 5] for TV-NTSC in 15/16 bpp color depth [((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) x 8 - 7] for TV-PAL in 4/8 bpp color depth [((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) x 8 - 5] for TV-PAL in 15/16 bpp color depth Note REG[052h] + 1 ≥ (REG[053h] + 1) + (REG[054h] bits 3-0 + 1) CRT HRTC Pulse Width Register REG[054h] CRT HRTC Polarity Select bit 7 n/a n/a RW n/a CRT HRTC Pulse Width Bit 3 CRT HRTC Pulse Width Bit 2 CRT HRTC Pulse Width Bit 1 CRT HRTC Pulse Width Bit 0 CRT HRTC Polarity Select This bit selects the polarity of HRTC for CRTs. When this bit = 1, the HRTC pulse is active high. When this bit = 0, the HRTC pulse is active low. Note For NTSC/PAL modes, this bit must be set to 0b. bits 3-0 CRT HRTC Pulse Width Bits [3:0] These bits specify the pulse width of the CRT HRTC output signal in 8 pixel resolution. HRTC pulse width in number of pixels = ((ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1) × 8 Note For NTSC/PAL modes, these bits must be set to 0000b. Note REG[052h] + 1 ≥ (REG[053h] + 1) + (REG[054h] bits 3-0 + 1) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 147 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Register 0 REG[056h] CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 7 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 6 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 5 RW CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 4 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 3 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 2 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 1 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 0 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Register 1 REG[057h] n/a n/a n/a RW n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 9 REG[056h] bits 7-0 CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bits [9:0] REG[057h] bits 1-0 These bits specify the CRT/TV vertical display height, in 1 line resolution. CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 8 Vertical display height in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 CRT/TV Vertical Non-Display Period Register REG[058h] CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Status (RO) CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 6 CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 5 CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 4 RW CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 3 CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 2 CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 1 CRT/TV Vertical NonDisplay Period Bit 0 bit 7 CRT/TV Vertical Non-Display Period Status This is a read-only status bit. When a read from this bit = 1, a CRT/TV vertical non-display period is occurring. When a read from this bit = 0, the CRT/TV output is in a vertical display period. bits 6-0 CRT/TV Vertical Non-Display Period Bits [6:0] These bits specify the CRT/TV vertical non-display period height in 1 line resolution. Vertical non-display period height in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 Note (REG[058h] bits 5-0 + 1) ≥ (REG[059h] + 1) + (REG[05Ah] bits 2-0 + 1) Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 148 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Register REG[059h] n/a CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 6 bits 6-0 CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 5 RW CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 4 CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 3 CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 2 CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 1 CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 0 CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bits [6:0] For CRT/TV, these bits specify the delay in lines from the start of the vertical non-display period to the leading edge of the VRTC pulse. VRTC start position in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 Note (REG[058h] bits 5-0 + 1) ≥ (REG[059h] + 1) + (REG[05Ah] bits 2-0 + 1) CRT/TV VRTC Pulse Width Register REG[05Ah] CRT VRTC Polarity Select bit 7 n/a n/a RW n/a n/a CRT VRTC Pulse Width Bit 2 CRT VRTC Pulse Width Bit 1 CRT VRTC Pulse Width Bit 0 CRT VRTC Polarity Select This bit selects the polarity of VRTC for CRT. When this bit = 1, the VRTC pulse is active high. When this bit = 0, the VRTC pulse is active low. Note For PAL/NTSC, this bit must be set to 0b. bits 2-0 CRT VRTC Pulse Width Bits [2:0] These bits specify the pulse width of the CRT VRTC output signal in number of lines. VRTC pulse width in number of lines = (ContentsOfThisRegister) + 1 Note For NTSC/PAL modes, these bits should be set to 000b. Note (REG[058h] bits 5-0 + 1) ≥ (REG[059h] + 1) + (REG[05Ah] bits 2-0 + 1) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 149 CRT/TV Output Control Register REG[05Bh] n/a RW TV Chrominance Filter Enable n/a TV Luminance Filter Enable DAC Output Level Select n/a TV S-Video/ TV Composite PAL/NTSC Output Select Output Select bit 5 TV Chrominance Filter Enable When this bit = 1, the TV chrominance filter is enabled. When this bit = 0, there is no hardware effect. The chrominance filter adjusts the color of the TV by limiting the bandwidth of the chrominance signal (reducing cross-luminance distortion). This reduces the “ragged edges” seen at boundaries between sharp color transitions. This filter is most useful for composite video output. bit 4 TV Luminance Filter Enable When this bit = 1, the TV luminance filter is enabled. When this bit = 0, there is no hardware effect. The luminance filter adjusts the brightness of the TV by limiting the bandwidth of the luminance signal (reducing cross-chrominance distortion). This reduces the “rainbowlike” colors at boundaries between sharp luminance transitions. This filter is most useful for composite video output. bit 3 DAC Output Level Select This bit should be set based on the conditions in the following table. When this bit is set to 1 it allows IREF to be reduced. For an example implementation of the required external CRT/TV circuitry, see Figure 5-2: “External Circuitry for CRT/TV Interface,” on page 44. Table 8-22: DAC Output Level Selection LCD Supported x x CRT Not Supported Supported Supported x TV Not Supported Not Supported Supported REG[05Bh] bit 3 x 1 0 IREF (mA) x 4.6 9.2 = don’t care bit 1 TV S-Video/Composite Output Select When this bit = 1, S-Video TV signal output is selected. When this bit = 0, Composite TV signal output is selected. bit 0 TV PAL/NTSC Output Select When this bit = 1, PAL format TV signal output is selected. When this bit = 0, NTSC format TV signal output is selected. This bit must be set to 0 when CRT mode is enabled. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 150 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.9 CRT/TV Display Mode Registers CRT/TV Display Mode Register REG[060h] CRT/TV Display Blank n/a RW n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Bitper-pixel Select Bit 2 CRT/TV Bitper-pixel Select Bit 1 CRT/TV Bitper-pixel Select Bit 0 bit 7 CRT/TV Display Blank When this bit = 1 the CRT/TV display pipeline is disabled and all CRT/TV data outputs are forced to zero (i.e., the screen is blanked). When this bit = 0 the CRT/TV display pipeline is enabled. bits 2-0 CRT/TV Bit-per-pixel Select Bits [2:0] These bits select the bit-per-pixel for the displayed data. Note 15/16 bpp color depths bypass the LUT. Table 8-23: CRT/TV Bit-per-pixel Selection S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Bit-per-pixel Select Bits [2:0] Color Depth (bpp) 000 Reserved 001 Reserved 010 4 bpp 011 8 bpp 100 15 bpp 101 16 bpp 110-111 Reserved Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 151 CRT/TV Display Start Address Register 0 REG[062h] CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 7 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 6 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 5 RW CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 4 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 3 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 2 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 1 CRT/TV Display Start Address Register 1 REG[063h] CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 15 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 14 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 13 RW CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 12 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 11 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 10 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 9 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 8 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 19 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 18 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 17 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 16 CRT/TV Display Start Address Register 2 REG[064h] n/a n/a REG[062h] bits 7-0 REG[063h] bits 7-0 RW n/a n/a CRT/TV Start Address Bits [19:0] This register forms the 20-bit address for the starting word of the CRT/TV image in the display buffer. Note that this is a word address. An entry of 00000h into these registers represents the first word of display memory, an entry of 00001h represents the second word of the display memory, and so on. REG[064h] bits 3-0 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Register 0 REG[066h] CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 7 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 6 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 5 RW CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 4 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 3 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 2 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 1 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Register 1 REG[067h] n/a REG[066h] bits 7-0 REG[067h] bits 2-0 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 0 n/a n/a CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 0 RW n/a n/a CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 10 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 9 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 8 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bits [10:0] These bits are the CRT/TV display’s 11-bit address offset from the starting word of line “n” to the starting word of line “n + 1”. A virtual image can be formed by setting this register to a value greater than the width of the display. The displayed image is a window into the larger virtual image. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 152 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CRT/TV Pixel Panning Register REG[068h] n/a n/a RW n/a n/a Reserved Reserved CRT/TV Pixel Panning Bit 1 CRT/TV Pixel Panning Bit 0 bits 3-2 Reserved. Must be set to 0. bits 1-0 CRT/TV Pixel Panning Bits [1:0] This register is used to control the horizontal pixel panning of the CRT/TV display. The display can be panned to the left by programming its respective Pixel Panning Bits to a non-zero value. This value represents the number of pixels panned. The maximum pan value is dependent on the display mode as shown in the table below. Table 8-24: CRT/TV Pixel Panning Selection Color Depth (bpp) Screen 2 Pixel Panning Bits Used 4 bpp Bits [1:0] 8 bpp Bit 0 15/16 bpp --- Smooth horizontal panning can be achieved by a combination of this register and the CRT/TV Display Start Address register. CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Control Register REG[06Ah] n/a bits 5-0 CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 5 n/a CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 4 CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 3 RW CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 2 CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 1 CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bit 0 CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Bits [5:0] These bits are used to optimize the display memory request arbitration. When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. However, programming may be required if screen corruption is present (see Section 18.2, “Example Frame Rates” on page 216). Note This register does not need to be used in single display modes and may only be required in some display modes where two displays are active (see Section 16.2, “Bandwidth Limitation” on page 211). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 153 CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Control Register REG[06Bh] n/a CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 5 n/a bits 5-0 CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 4 RW CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 3 CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 2 CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 1 CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 0 CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bits [5:0] When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. If it becomes necessary to adjust REG[04Ah] from its default value, then the following formula must be maintained: REG[04Bh] > REG[04Ah] and REG[04Bh] ≤ 3Ch 8.3.10 LCD Ink/Cursor Registers LCD Ink/Cursor Control Register REG[070h] n/a bits 1-0 n/a RW n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Control Bits [1:0] These bits enable the LCD Ink/Cursor circuitry. Table 8-25: LCD Ink/Cursor Selection LCD Ink/Cursor Bits [1:0] Mode 00 Inactive 01 Cursor 10 Ink 11 Reserved Note While in Ink mode, the Cursor X & Y Position registers must be set to 00h. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 154 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Register REG[071h] RW LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 bits 7-0 LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Encoded bits defining the start address for the LCD Ink/Cursor. For Cursor modes, a start address of 0 should be valid for most applications. For Ink or special Cursor modes, the start address should be set at an address location that does not conflict with the display memory of Dual Panel Buffer, which always takes the top M memory locations in bytes, where M = (Panel Height x Panel Width / 16) x c, c = 1 for monochrome, 4 for color panel. Table 8-26: LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Start Address 0 Memory Size - 1024 n = 255...1 Memory Size - n x 8192 Note The effect of this register takes place at the next LCD vertical non-display period. Note See Section 10, “Display Buffer” on page 182 for display buffer organization. LCD Cursor X Position Register 0 REG[072h] RW LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 LCD Cursor X Position Register 1 REG[073h] LCD Cursor X Sign n/a n/a RW n/a n/a n/a LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X Position Position Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[073h] bit 7 LCD Cursor X Sign When this bit = 1, it defines the LCD Cursor X Position register to be a negative number. The negative number shall not exceed 63 decimal. When this bit = 0, it defines the LCD Cursor X Position register to be a positive number. REG[072h] bits 7-0 REG[073h] bits 1-0 LCD Cursor X Position Bits [9:0] A 10-bit register that defines the horizontal position of the LCD Cursor’s top left hand corner in pixel units. This register is only valid when Cursor has been selected in the LCD Ink/Cursor select registers. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 155 LCD Cursor Y Position Register 0 REG[074h] RW LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 LCD Cursor Y Position Register 1 REG[075h] LCD Cursor Y Sign n/a n/a RW n/a n/a n/a LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y Position Position Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[075h] bit 7 LCD Cursor Y Sign When this bit = 1, it defines the LCD Cursor Y Position register to be a negative number. The negative number shall not exceed 63 decimal. When this bit = 0, it defines the LCD Cursor Y Position register to be a positive number. REG[074h] bits 7-0 REG[075h] bits 1-0 LCD Cursor Y Position Bits [9:0] A 10-bit register that defines the vertical position of the LCD Cursor’s top left hand corner in pixel units. This register is only valid when Cursor has been selected in the LCD Ink/Cursor select registers. Note The effect of REG[072h] through REG[074h] takes place only after REG[075h] is written and at the next LCD vertical non-display period.The effect of REG[075h] takes place at the next LCD vertical non-display period. LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Register REG[076h] n/a n/a bits 4-0 n/a RW LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 2 bits 5-0 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bits[4:0] These bits define the blue LCD Ink/Cursor color 0. LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Register REG[077h] n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 1 RW LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Bits[5:0] These bits define the green LCD ink/Cursor color 0. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 156 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Register REG[078h] n/a n/a bits 4-0 n/a RW LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bits[4:0] These bits define the red LCD Ink/Cursor color 0. LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Register REG[07Ah] n/a n/a bits 4-0 n/a RW LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 1 n/a bits 5-0 RW LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Bits[5:0] These bits define the green LCD Ink/Cursor color 1. LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Register REG[07Ch] n/a bits 4-0 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bits[4:0] These bits define the blue LCD Ink/Cursor color 1. LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Register REG[07Bh] n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 0 n/a n/a RW LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bits[4:0] These bits define the red LCD Ink/Cursor color 1. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 157 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Register REG[07Eh] n/a n/a bits 5-0 n/a n/a RW LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bits [3:0] These bits are used to optimize the display memory request arbitration for the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer. When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. 8.3.11 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Registers CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Control Register REG[080h] n/a bits 1-0 n/a n/a RW n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Control Bits [1:0] These bits enable the CRT/TV Ink/Cursor circuitry. Table 8-27: CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Selection CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Bits [1:0] Mode 00 Inactive 01 Cursor 10 Ink 11 Reserved Note During Ink mode, the Cursor X & Y Position registers must be programmed to zero. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 158 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Register REG[081h] RW CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 bits 7-0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Encoded bits defining the start address for the CRT/TV Ink/Cursor. For Cursor modes, a start address of 0 should be valid for most applications. For Ink or special Cursor modes, the start address should be set at an address location that does not conflict with the display memory of Dual Panel Buffer, which always takes the top M memory locations in bytes, where M = (Panel Height x Panel Width / 16) x c, c = 1 for monochrome, 4 for color panel. Table 8-28: CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Start Address 0 Memory Size - 1024 n = 255...1 Memory Size - n x 8192 Note The effect of this register takes place at the next CRT/TV vertical non-display period. Note See Section 10, “Display Buffer” on page 182 for display buffer organization. CRT/TV Cursor X Position Register 0 REG[082h] CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 7 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 6 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 5 RW CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 4 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 3 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 2 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 1 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Register 1 REG[083h] CRT/TV Cursor X Sign REG[083h] bit 7 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 0 RW n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 9 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 8 CRT/TV Cursor X Sign When this bit = 1, it defines the CRT/TV Cursor X Position register to be a negative number. The negative number shall not exceed 63 decimal. When this bit = 0, it defines the CRT/TV Cursor X Position register to be a positive number. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[082h] bits 7-0 REG[083h] bits 1-0 Page 159 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bits [9:0] A 10-bit register that defines the horizontal position of the CRT/TV Cursor’s top left hand corner in pixel units. This register is only valid when Cursor has been selected in the CRT/TV Ink/Cursor select registers. CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Register 0 REG[084h] CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 7 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 6 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 5 RW CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 4 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 3 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 2 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 1 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Register 1 REG[085h] CRT/TV Cursor Y Sign n/a CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 0 RW n/a n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 9 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 8 REG[084h] bit 7 CRT/TV Cursor YSign When this bit = 1, it defines the CRT/TV Cursor Y Position register as a negative number. The negative number shall not exceed 63 decimal. When this bit = 0, it defines the CRT/TV Cursor Y Position register as a positive number. REG[084h] bits 7-0 REG[085h] bits 1-0 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bits [9:0] A 10-bit register that defines the vertical position of the CRT/TV Cursor’s top left hand corner in pixel units. This register is only valid when Cursor has been selected in the CRT/TV Ink/Cursor select registers. Note The effect of REG[082h] through REG[084h] takes place only after REG[085h]is written to and at the next CRT/TV vertical non-display period.The effect of REG[085h] takes place at the next CRT/TV vertical non-display period. CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Register REG[086h] n/a bits 4-0 n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 4 RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bits[4:0] These bits define the blue CRT/TV Ink/Cursor color 0. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 160 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Register REG[087h] n/a n/a bits 5-0 RW CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Bits[5:0] These bits define the green CRT/TV Ink/Cursor color 0. CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Register REG[088h] n/a n/a bits 4-0 RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 4 n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bits[4:0] These bits define the red CRT/TV Ink/Cursor color 0. CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Register REG[08Ah] n/a n/a bits 4-0 n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 4 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bits[4:0] These bits define the blue CRT/TV Ink/Cursor color 1. CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Register REG[08Bh] n/a n/a bits 5-0 RW CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Bits[5:0] These bits define the green CRT/TV Ink/Cursor color 1. CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Register REG[08Ch] n/a bits 4-0 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 n/a n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 4 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bits[4:0] These bits define the red CRT/TV Ink/Cursor color 1. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 161 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Register REG[08Eh] n/a bits 5-0 n/a n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 3 n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bits [5:0] These bits are used to optimize the display memory request arbitration for the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer. When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. 8.3.12 BitBlt Configuration Registers BitBlt Control Register 0 REG[100h] BitBlt Active Status bits 7 RW BitBlt FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBlt FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBlt FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBlt Destination Linear Select BitBlt Source Linear Select BitBlt Active Status This register bit has two data paths, one for write, the other for read. Write Data Path When software writes a one to this bit, it will initiate the 2D operation. Read Data Path The read back of this register indicates the status of the 2D engine. When a read from this bit = 1, the 2D engine is busy. When a read from this bit = 0, the 2D engine is idle and is ready for the next operation. . Table 8-29: BitBlt Active Status BitBlt Active Status State Write Read 0 0 Idle 0 1 Reserved 1 0 Initiating operation 1 1 Operation in progress Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 162 bit 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center BitBlt FIFO Not-Empty Status This is a read-only status bit. When this bit = 1, the BitBlt FiFO has at least one data. When this bit = 0, the BitBlt FIFO is empty. To reduce system memory read latency, software can monitor this bit prior to a BitBlt read burst operation. The following table shows the number of data available in BitBlt FIFO under different status conditions. Table 8-30: BitBlt FIFO Data Available BitBlt FIFO Half BitBlt FIFO Full Full Status Status (REG[100h] (REG[100h] Bit 5) Bit 4) BitBlt FIFO Not Empty Status (REG[100h] Bit 6) Number of Data available in BitBlt FIFO 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1 to 6 0 1 1 7 to 14 1 1 1 15 to 16 bit 5 BitBlt FIFO Half Full Status This is a read-only status bit. Software can use this bit to optimize BitBlt write burst operations. When this bit = 1, the BitBlt FIFO is half full or greater than half full. When this bit = 0, the BitBlt FIFO is less than half full. bit 4 BitBlt FIFO Full Status This is a read-only status bit. Software can use this bit to optimize BitBlt write burst operations. When this bit = 1, the BitBlt FIFO is full. When this bit = 0, the BitBlt FIFO is not full. bit 1 BitBlt Destination Linear Select When this bit = 1, the Destination Blit is stored as a contiguous linear block of memory. When this bit = 0, the Destination Blit is stored as a rectangular region of memory. The BitBlt Memory Address Offset (REG[10Ch], REG[10Dh]) determines the address offset from the start of one line to the next line. bit 0 BitBlt Source Linear Select When this bit = 1, the Source Blit is stored as a contiguous linear block of memory. When this bit = 0, the Source Blit is stored as a rectangular region of memory. The BitBlt Memory Address Offset (REG[10Ch], REG[10Dh]) determines the address offset from the start of one line to the next line. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 163 BitBlt Control Register 1 REG[101h] n/a RW n/a n/a Reserved n/a n/a n/a bit 4 Reserved. Must be set to 0. bit 0 BitBlt Color Format Select This bit selects the color format that the 2D operation is applied to. When this bit = 0, 8 bpp (256 color) format is selected. When this bit = 1, 16 bpp (64K color) format is selected. BitBlt ROP Code/Color Expansion Register REG[102h] n/a n/a bits 3-0 n/a BitBlt Color Format Select RW BitBlt ROP Code Bit 3 n/a BitBlt ROP Code Bit 2 BitBlt ROP Code Bit 1 BitBlt ROP Code Bit 0 BitBlt Raster Operation Code/Color Expansion Bits [3:0] ROP Code for Write Blit and Move Blit. Bits 2-0 also specify the start bit position for Color Expansion. Table 8-31: BitBlt ROP Code/Color Expansion Function Selection BitBlt ROP Code Bits [3:0] Boolean Function for Write Blit and Move Blit Boolean Function for Pattern Fill Start Bit Position for Color Expansion 0000 0 (Blackness) 0 (Blackness) bit 0 0001 ~S . ~D or ~(S + D) ~P . ~D or ~(P + D) bit 1 0010 ~S . D ~P . D bit 2 0011 ~S ~P bit 3 0100 S . ~D P . ~D bit 4 0101 ~D ~D bit 5 0110 S^D P^D bit 6 0111 ~S + ~D or ~(S . D) ~P + ~D or ~(P . D) bit 7 1000 S.D P.D bit 0 1001 ~(S ^ D) ~(P ^ D) bit 1 1010 D D bit 2 1011 ~S + D ~P + D bit 3 1100 S P bit 4 1101 S + ~D P + ~D bit 5 1110 S+D P+D bit 6 1111 1 (Whiteness) 1 (Whiteness) bit 7 Note S = Source, D = Destination, P = Pattern. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 164 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center BitBlt Operation Register REG[103h] n/a bits 3-0 n/a RW n/a n/a BitBlt Operation Bit 3 BitBlt Operation Bit 2 BitBlt Operation Bit 1 BitBlt Operation Bit 0 BitBlt Operation Bits [3:0] Specifies the 2D Operation to be carried out based on the following table: Table 8-32: BitBlt Operation Selection BitBlt Operation Bits [3:0] Blit Operation 0000 Write Blit with ROP. 0001 Read Blit. 0010 Move Blit in positive direction with ROP. 0011 Move Blit in negative direction with ROP. 0100 Transparent Write Blit. 0101 Transparent Move Blit in positive direction. 0110 Pattern Fill with ROP. 0111 Pattern Fill with transparency. 1000 Color Expansion. 1001 Color Expansion with transparency. 1010 Move Blit with Color Expansion. 1011 Move Blit with Color Expansion and transparency. 1100 Solid Fill. Other combinations Reserved Note The BitBlt operations Pattern Fill with ROP and Pattern Fill with transparency require a BitBlt width ≥ 2. The BitBlt width is set in REG[110h], REG[111h]. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 165 BitBlt Source Start Address Register 0 REG[104h] RW BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 BitBlt Source Start Address Register 1 REG[105h] RW BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source BitBlt Source Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 BitBlt Source Start Address Register 2 REG[106h] n/a n/a REG[104h] bits 7-0 REG[105h] bits 7-0 REG[106h] bits 4-0 n/a RW BitBlt Source BitBlt Source Start Address Start Address Bit 20 Bit 19 BitBlt Source Start Bit 18 BitBlt Source Start Address Bit 17 BitBlt Source Start Address Bit 16 BitBlt Source Start Address Bits [20:0] A 21-bit register that specifies the source start address for the BitBlt operation. If data is sourced from the CPU, then bit 0 is used for byte alignment within a 16-bit word and the other address bits are ignored. In pattern fill operation, the BitBlt Source Start Address is defined by the following equation: Value programmed to the Source Start Address Register = Pattern Base Address + Pattern Line Offset + Pixel Offset. The following table shows how Source Start Address Register is defined for 8 and 16 bpp color depths. Table 8-33: BitBlt Source Start Address Selection Color Format Pattern Base Address[20:0] Pattern Line Offset[2:0] Pixel Offset[3:0] 8 bpp BitBlt Source Start Address[20:6], 6’b0 BitBlt Source Start Address[5:3] 1’b0, BitBlt Source Start Address[2:0] 16 bpp BitBlt Source Start Address[20:7], 7’b0 BitBlt Source Start Address[6:4] BitBlt Source Start Address[3:0] Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 166 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center BitBlt Destination Start Address Register 0 REG[108h] RW BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 BitBlt Destination Start Address Register 1 REG[109h] RW BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 BitBlt Destination Start Address Register 2 REG[10Ah] n/a n/a REG[108h] bits 7-0 REG[109h] bits 7-0 REG[10Ah] bits 4-0 n/a RW BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt BitBlt Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 BitBlt Destination Start Address Bits [20:0] A 21-bit register that specifies the destination start address for the BitBlt operation. BitBlt Memory Address Offset Register 0 REG[10Ch] RW BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory Address Address Address Address Address Address Address Address Offset Bit 7 Offset Bit 6 Offset Bit 5 Offset Bit 4 Offset Bit 3 Offset Bit 2 Offset Bit 1 Offset Bit 0 BitBlt Memory Address Offset Register 1 REG[10Dh] n/a n/a REG[10Ch] bits 7-0 REG[10Dh] bits 2-0 n/a RW n/a n/a BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory BitBlt Memory Address Address Address Offset Bit 10 Offset Bit 9 Offset Bit 8 BitBlt Memory Address Offset Bits [10:0] These bits are the display’s 11-bit address offset from the starting word of line “n” to the starting word of line “n + 1”. They are used only for address calculation when the Blit is configured as a rectangular region of memory. They are not used for the displays. BitBlt Width Register 0 REG[110h] BitBlt Width Bit 7 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 BitBlt Width Bit 6 RW BitBlt Width Bit 5 BitBlt Width Bit 4 BitBlt Width Bit 3 BitBlt Width Bit 2 BitBlt Width Bit 1 BitBlt Width Bit 0 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 167 BitBlt Width Register 1 REG[111h] n/a RW n/a REG[110h] bits 7-0 REG[111h] bits 1-0 n/a n/a n/a n/a BitBlt Width Bit 9 BitBlt Width Bit 8 BitBlt Width Bits [9:0] A 10-bit register that specifies the BitBlt width in pixels -1. Note The BitBlt operations Pattern Fill with ROP and Pattern Fill with transparency require a BitBlt width ≥ 2. BitBlt Height Register 0 REG[112h] BitBlt Height Bit 7 BitBlt Height Bit 6 RW BitBlt Height Bit 5 BitBlt Height Bit 4 BitBlt Height Bit 3 BitBlt Height Bit 2 BitBlt Height Bit 1 BitBlt Height Register 1 REG[113h] n/a REG[112h] bits 7-0 REG[113h] bits 1-0 n/a BitBlt Height Bit 0 RW n/a n/a n/a n/a BitBlt Height Bit 9 BitBlt Height Bit 8 BitBlt Height Bits [9:0] A 10-bit register that specifies the BitBlt height in lines -1. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 168 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center BitBlt Background Color Register 0 REG[114h] BitBlt Background Color Bit 7 BitBlt Background Color Bit 6 BitBlt Background Color Bit 5 RW BitBlt Background Color Bit 4 BitBlt Background Color Bit 3 BitBlt Background Color Bit 2 BitBlt Background Color Bit 1 BitBlt Background Color Register 1 REG[115h] BitBlt Background Color Bit 15 BitBlt Background Color Bit 14 REG[114h] bits 7-0 REG[115h] bits 15-8 BitBlt Background Color Bit 13 RW BitBlt Background Color Bit 12 BitBlt Background Color Bit 11 BitBlt Background Color Bit 10 BitBlt Background Color Bit 9 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 6 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 5 RW BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 4 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 3 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 2 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 1 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 0 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 12 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 11 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 10 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 9 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 8 BitBlt Foreground Color Register 1 REG[119h] BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 15 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 14 REG[118h] bits 7-0 REG[119h] bits 7-0 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 BitBlt Background Color Bit 8 BitBlt Background Color Bits [15:0] A 16-bit register that specifies the BitBlt background color for Color Expansion or key color for Transparent Blit. For 16 bpp mode (REG[101h] bit 0 = 1), all 16 bits are used. For 8 bpp mode (REG[101h] bit 0 = 0), only bits 7-0 are used. BitBlt Foreground Color Register 0 REG[118h] BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 7 BitBlt Background Color Bit 0 BitBlt Foreground Color Bit 13 RW BitBlt Foreground Color Bits [15:0] A 16-bit register that specifies the BitBlt foreground color for Color Expansion or Solid Fill. For 16 bpp mode (REG[101h] bit 0 = 1), all 16 bits are used. For 8 bpp mode (REG[101h] bit 0 = 0), only bits 7-0 are used. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 169 8.3.13 Look-Up Table Registers Note Accessing the LCD Look-Up Table (LUT) requires an active LCD PCLK and accessing the CRT/TV LUT requires an active CRT/TV PCLK. Additionally, access to the LUT registers is not permitted during power save mode. For further information on the clocks, see Section 20, “Clocks” on page 224. Look-Up Table Mode Register REG[1E0h] n/a bits 1-0 n/a RW n/a n/a n/a LUT Mode Bit 1 n/a LUT Mode Bit 0 Look-Up Table Mode Bits [1:0] These bits determine which of the Look-Up Tables (LCD and CRT/TV) are accessible by REG[1E2h] and REG[1E4h]. Table 8-34: LUT Mode Selection LUT Mode Bits [1:0] Read Write 00 LCD LUT LCD and CRT/TV LUT’s 01 LCD LUT LCD LUT 10 CRT/TV LUT CRT/TV LUT 11 Reserved Reserved Look-Up Table Address Register REG[1E2h] LUT Address Bit 7 bits 7-0 LUT Address Bit 6 LUT Address Bit 5 RW LUT Address Bit 4 LUT Address Bit 3 LUT Address Bit 2 LUT Address Bit 1 LUT Address Bit 0 LUT Address Bits [7:0] These 8 bits control a pointer into the Look-Up Tables (LUT). The S1D13506 has three 256-position, 4-bit wide LUTs, one for each of red, green, and blue – refer to Section 12, “Look-Up Table Architecture” on page 186 for details. This register selects which LUT entry is read/write accessible through the LUT Data Register (REG[1E4h]). Writing the LUT Address Register automatically sets the pointer to the Red LUT. Accesses to the LUT Data Register automatically increment the pointer. For example, writing a value 03h into the LUT Address Register sets the pointer to R[3]. A subsequent access to the LUT Data Register accesses R[3] and moves the pointer onto G[3]. Subsequent accesses to the LUT Data Register move the pointer onto B[3], R[4], G[4], B[4], R[5], etc. Note The RGB data is inserted into the LUT after the Blue data is written, i.e. all three colors must be written before the LUT is updated. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 170 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Look-Up Table Data Register REG[1E4h] LUT Data Bit 3 LUT Data Bit 2 bits 7-4 RW LUT Data Bit 1 LUT Data Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a n/a LUT Data Bits [3:0] This register is used to read/write the RGB Look-Up Tables. This register accesses the entry at the pointer controlled by the Look-Up Table Address Register (REG[1E2h]). Accesses to the Look-Up Table Data Register automatically increment the pointer. Note The RGB data is inserted into the LUT after the Blue data is written, i.e. all three colors must be written before the LUT is updated. 8.3.14 Power Save Configuration Registers Power Save Configuration Register REG[1F0h] n/a n/a n/a RW Reserved n/a n/a n/a bit 4 Reserved. This bit must be set to 0. bit 0 Power Save Mode Enable When this bit = 1, the software initiated power save mode is enabled. When this bit = 0, the software initiated power save mode is disabled. Power Save Mode Enable Power Save Status Register REG[1F1h] n/a bit 1 n/a RO n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Power Save Status Memory Controller Power Save Status LCD Power Save Status This bit indicates the power save state of the LCD panel. When this bit = 1, the panel is powered down. When this bit = 0, the panel is powered up, or in transition of powering up or down. Note When this bit reads a 1, the system may safely shut down the LCD pixel clock source. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bit 0 Page 171 Memory Controller Power Save Status This bit indicates the power save state of the memory controller. When this bit = 1, the memory controller is powered down and is either in self refresh or no refresh mode. When this bit = 0, the memory controller is powered up and is either in CBR refresh or normal mode. Note When this bit reads a 1, the system may safely shut down the memory clock source. 8.3.15 Miscellaneous Registers CPU-to-Memory Access Watchdog Timer Register REG[1F4h] n/a bits 5-0 Mem. Access Watchdog Timer bit 5 n/a Mem. Access Watchdog Timer bit 4 RW Mem. Access Watchdog Timer bit 3 Mem. Access Watchdog Timer bit 2 Mem. Access Watchdog Timer bit 1 Mem. Access Watchdog Timer bit 0 CPU-to-Memory Access Watchdog Timer A non-zero value in this register enables the watchdog timer for CPU-to-memory access. When enabled, any CPU-to-memory access cycle will be completed successfully within a time determined by the following equation: Maximum CPU-to-memory access cycle time = (8n + 7) × Tbclk + 13 × Tmclk where: n = A non-zero value in this register Tbclk = Bus clock period, or Bus clock period x 2 (if MD12 = 1, see Table 5-6: on page 39) Tmclk = Memory clock period This function is required by some busses which time-out if the cycle duration exceeds a certain time period. This function is not intended to arbitrarily shorten the CPU-to-memory access cycle time in order gain higher CPU bandwidth. Doing so may significantly reduce the available display refresh bandwidth which may cause display corruption. This register does not affect CPU-to-register access or blit access. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 172 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.16 Common Display Mode Register Display Mode Register REG[1FCh] RW SwivelView™ Enable Bit 0 n/a bit 6 n/a n/a Display Mode Select Bit 2 n/a Display Mode Select Bit 1 Display Mode Select Bit 0 SwivelView™ Enable Bit 0 When this bit = 1, the LCD display image is rotated 90° clockwise. Please refer to Section 15, “SwivelView™” on page 201 for application and limitations. When this bit = 0, there is no hardware effect. This bit in conjunction with SwivelView™ Enable Bit 1 achieves the following hardware rotations. Table 8-35: Setting SwivelView Modes SwivelView™ Modes SwivelView Enable Bits Normal SwivelView 90° SwivelView 180° SwivelView 270° SwivelView Enable Bit 0 (REG[1FCh] bit 6) 0 1 0 1 SwivelView Enable Bit 1 (REG[040h] bit 4) 0 0 1 1 bits 2-0 Display Mode Select Bits [2:0] These bits select the display model according to the following table. The LCD display mode is enabled/disabled using bit 0. Programming this bit from a 0 to a 1 starts the power-on sequence. Programming this bit from a 1 to a 0 starts the power-off sequence. Table 8-36: Display Mode Selection Display Mode Select Bits [2:0] Display Mode Enabled 000 no display 001 LCD only 010 CRT only 011 EISD (CRT and LCD) 100 TV with flicker filter off 101 EISD (TV with flicker filter off and LCD) 110 TV with flicker filter on 111 EISD (TV with flicker filter on and LCD) Note REG[018h] bit 7 must be set to 1 when the flicker filter is enabled. Note The Flicker Filter reduces the “flickering” effect seen on interlaced displays by averaging adjacent lines on the TV display. This “flickering” is caused by sharp vertical image transitions that occur over one line (1 vertical pixel). For example, one pixel high lines, edges of window boxes, etc. Flickering occurs because these high resolution lines are effectively displayed at half the refresh frequency due to interlacing. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 173 8.3.17 MediaPlug Register Descriptions The S1D13506 has built-in support for Winnov’s MediaPlug connection designed for video cameras. The following registers are used to control the connection and accept data from the camera. The MediaPlug registers decode A11-A0 and require A20 = 0 and A12 = 1. The MediaPlug registers are 16-bit wide. Byte access to the MediaPlug registers is not allowed. For further information, see Section 17, “MediaPlug Interface” on page 212. Note The MediaPlug control registers must not be accessed while Power Save Mode is enabled (REG[1F0h] bit 0 = 1). MediaPlug LCMD Register REG[1000h] RW LCMD Bit 7 LCMD Bit 6 LCMD Bit 5 LCMD Bit 4 LCMD Bit 3 LCMD Bit 2 LCMD Bit 1 LCMD Bit 0 LCMD Bit 15 LCMD Bit 14 LCMD Bit 13 LCMD Bit 12 LCMD Bit 11 LCMD Bit 10 LCMD Bit 9 LCMD Bit 8 REG[1000h] bits 15-0 MediaPlug LCMD Bits [15:0] A 16-bit register for setting and detecting various modes of operation of the MediaPlug Local Slave. This register is handled differently for reads and writes. The following table shows the MediaPlug description of the LCMD Register. See bit descriptions for details. Table 8-37: MediaPlug LCMD Read/Write Descriptions Data D15 D14 Write TO[2:0] Read TO[2:0] bits 15-14 D13 D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 IC MC P W 0b IC MC P W Xxxxxxxxxx 00b Rev[3:0] Rstat[2:0] Timeout Option (MediaPlug Parameter TO) These bits select the timeout delay in MediaPlug clock cycles: Table 8-38: Timeout Option Delay Timeout Option Bits[15:14] Timeout (MediaPlug clock cycles) 00 1023 (default) 01 64 10 128 11 64 bits 13-12 A read from these bits will always return 00b. A write to these bits has no hardware effect. bits 11-8 MediaPlug IC Revision (MediaPlug Parameter Rev) The revision for this MediaPlug IC is “0011b”. A write to these bits has no hardware effect. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 174 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bit 7 Cable Detected Status (MediaPlug Parameter Rstat) The cable detected status as determined by the MPD(1) pin. When this bit = 0, a MediaPlug cable is connected. When this bit = 1, a MediaPlug cable is not detected. A write to this bit has no hardware effect. bit 6 A read from this bit will always return 0b. A write to this bit has no hardware effect. bit 5 Remote Powered Status (MediaPlug Parameter Rstat) The remote powered status as determined by the RCTRL pin. When this bit = 0, the remote is not powered. When this bit = 1, the remote is powered and connected. A write to this bit has no hardware effect. Table 8-39: Cable Detect and Remote Powered Status Cable Detected Remote Powered Status [bit 7] Status [bit 5] Status 0 0 cable connected but remote not powered 0 1 cable connected and remote powered 1 x cable not connected bit 4 A read from this bit will always return 0b. A write to this bit has no hardware effect. bit 3 MediaPlug Interface Clock Enable (MediaPlug Parameter IC) When this bit = 0, the MediaPlug interface clock is enabled (default). When this bit = 1, the MediaPlug interface clock is disabled. bit 2 MediaPlug Clock (MediaPlug Parameter MC) When this bit = 0, the MediaPlug cable clock is disabled (default). When this bit = 1, the MediaPlug cable clock is enabled. bit 1 Power Enable to Remote (MediaPlug Parameter P) When this bit = 0, power to remote is off (default). When this bit =1, power to remote is on. bit 0 Watchdog Disable (MediaPlug Parameter W) When this bit = 0, the MediaPlug watchdog is enabled (default). When this bit = 1, the MediaPlug watchdog is disabled. MediaPlug Reserved LCMD Register REG[1002h] RW LCMD Bit 23 LCMD Bit 22 LCMD Bit 21 LCMD Bit 20 LCMD Bit 19 LCMD Bit 18 LCMD Bit 17 LCMD Bit 16 LCMD Bit 31 LCMD Bit 30 LCMD Bit 29 LCMD Bit 28 LCMD Bit 27 LCMD Bit 26 LCMD Bit 25 LCMD Bit 24 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 175 REG[1002h] bits 15-0 MediaPlug Reserved LCMD Bits [15:0] This register is not implemented and is reserved for future expansion of the LCMD register. A write to this register has no hardware effect. A read from this register always return 0000h. MediaPlug CMD Register REG[1004h] RW CMD Bit 7 CMD Bit 6 CMD Bit 5 CMD Bit 4 CMD Bit 3 CMD Bit 2 CMD Bit 1 CMD Bit 0 CMD Bit 15 CMD Bit 14 CMD Bit 13 CMD Bit 12 CMD Bit 11 CMD Bit 10 CMD Bit 9 CMD Bit 8 REG[1002h] bits 15-0 MediaPlug CMD Bits [15:0] A 16-bit register for setting the MediaPlug commands. This register is handled differently for reads and writes. The following table shows the MediaPlug description of the CMD Register. See bit descriptions for details. Table 8-40: MediaPlug CMD Read/Write Descriptions Data D15 D14 D T D13 Write Read D12 D11 D10 D9 D8 I[12:0] D7 D6 D5 D4 D3 D2 D1 D0 C[2:0] I[10:0] C[2:0] bit 15 Dirty Bit (MediaPlug Parameter D) This bit is set by the hardware when the command register is written. It is cleared by hardware by the following conditions: 1. Remote-Reset (After this command has been acknowledged by remote. 2. End_Stream (After this command has been acknowledged by remote. 3. Write to DATA register if the CCC field is Write_Reg. 4. Read to DATA register if the CCC field is Read_Reg. It is also set when the Remote Machine loses power or the cable is disconnected. bit 14 Timeout Bit (MediaPlug Parameter T) It is set when Watchdog is enabled and MediaPlug read or write cycle takes longer than 64, 128, 1024 cycles of MediaPlug clock depending on LCMD register settings. It is also set when the remote is not powered. It is cleared at the beginning of every command write by the host. bits 13-3 Index Field (MediaPlug Parameter I) This field is the address presented by the remote to the remote function. MediaPlug transmits the entire 16-bits of the first word of the command Register as written, but I12 (D15) and I11 (D14) are hidden from readback by the dirty bit and Watchdog error bit. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 176 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center bit 2-0 Command Field (MediaPlug Parameter C) Selects the command as follows: Table 8-41: MediaPlug Commands Command Field [bits 2:0] Command 000 Remote-Reset: Hardware reset of remote. 001 Stream-End: Indicates end of data streaming operation. 010 Write-Register: Write remote register INDEX[5:0] with DATA. 011 Read-Register: Read remote register INDEX[5:0] to DATA. 100 Write_Stream: Begin streaming data to the remote. 101 NOP: The command is sent across the MediaPlug. There is no other effect. 110 NOP: The command is sent across the MediaPlug. There is no other effect. 111 Read-Stream: Begin streaming data from the remote. MediaPlug Reserved CMD Register REG[1006h] RW CMD Bit 23 CMD Bit 22 CMD Bit 21 CMD Bit 20 CMD Bit 19 CMD Bit 18 CMD Bit 17 CMD Bit 16 CMD Bit 31 CMD Bit 30 CMD Bit 29 CMD Bit 28 CMD Bit 27 CMD Bit 26 CMD Bit 25 CMD Bit 24 REG[1006h] bits 15-0 MediaPlug Reserved CMD Bits [15:0] This register is not implemented and is reserved for future expansion of the CMD register. A write to this register has no hardware effect. A read from this register always return 0000h. MediaPlug Data Register REG[1008h] to REG[1FFEh], even address RW Data Bit 7 Data Bit 6 Data Bit 5 Data Bit 4 Data Bit 3 Data Bit 2 Data Bit 1 Data Bit 0 Data Bit 15 Data Bit 14 Data Bit 13 Data Bit 12 Data Bit 11 Data Bit 10 Data Bit 9 Data Bit 8 Data Register bits 15-0 MediaPlug Data Bits [15:0] A 16-bit register used for read/write and streaming read/write of MediaPlug data. This register is loosely decoded from 1008h to 1FFEh so that the port may be accessed using DWORD block transfer instructions. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 177 8.3.18 BitBlt Data Registers Descriptions The BitBlt data registers decode A19-A0 and require A20 = 1. The BitBlt data registers are 16-bit wide. Byte access to the BitBlt data registers is not allowed. BitBlt Data Register 0 A20-A0 = 100000h-1FFFFEh, even address RW Data Bit 7 Data Bit 6 Data Bit 5 Data Bit 4 Data Bit 3 Data Bit 2 Data Bit 1 Data Bit 0 Data Bit 15 Data Bit 14 Data Bit 13 Data Bit 12 Data Bit 11 Data Bit 10 Data Bit 9 Data Bit 8 Data Register bits 15-0 BitBlt Data Bits [15:0] A 16-bit register that specifies the BitBlt data. This register is loosely decoded from 100000h to 1FFFFEh. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 178 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 9 2D BitBlt Engine The S1D13506 has a built-in 2D BitBlt engine which increases the performance of Bit Block Transfers (BitBlt). This section will discuss the BitBlt engine design and functionality. 9.1 Functional Description The 2D BitBlt engine is designed using a 16-bit architecture. It implements a 16-bit data bus and supports both 8 and 16 bit-per-pixel color depths. The design does not support VGA planar mode. The BitBlt engine supports rectangular and linear addressing modes for source and destination in a positive direction for all BitBlt operations except the move blit which also supports in negative direction. The BitBlt operations support byte alignment of all types. The BitBlt engine has a dedicated BitBlt IO access space allowing it to support multi-tasking applications. This allows the BitBlt engine to support simultaneous BitBlt and CPU read/write operations. 9.2 BitBlt Operations Note For details on the operation of the BitBlt registers, see Section 8.3.12, “BitBlt Configuration Registers” on page 161. Write Blit The Write Blit provides 16, two operand, ROP functions. Move Blit The Move Blit provides 16, two operand, ROP functions and is supported in both a positive and negative direction. Read Blit The Read Blit supports bit block transfers from the display buffer to the host. No ROP function is applied. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 179 Solid Fill The Solid Fill Blit fills a specified blit area with a solid color as defined in the Foreground Color Register. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of the Foreground Color is used for solid fill. Pattern Fill The Pattern Fill Blit fills a specified blit area with an 8 pixel by 8 line pattern in full color defined in off-screen display buffer. The pattern data has to be stored in a contiguous address (i.e. for 8 and 16 bpp, the pattern data will occupy 64 and 128 bytes respectively starting from the base address). Any pixel within the 8x8 pattern can be used to start the fill area. The least significant bits of the source address start register are used to specify the starting pixel. The 2D engine can detects the end of each line and continues from the beginning of the next line. When the last line of pattern is encountered, the first line of the pattern will be drawn on the following line. Supports two full 16-bit operand ROP functions. Note The BitBlt operation Pattern Fill with ROP requires a BitBlt width ≥ 2. The BitBlt width is set in REG[110h], REG[111h]. Transparent Pattern Fill The Transparent Pattern Fill fills a specified blit area with an 8 pixel by 8 line pattern in full color defined in off-screen display buffer. The pattern data has to be stored in a contiguous address (i.e. for 8 and 16 bpp, the pattern data will occupy 64 and 128 bytes respectively starting from the base address). When the pattern color is equal to the key color, which is defined in Background Color Register, the destination area is not updated. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of the key color is used for comparison. For this blit no raster operation is applied. Note The BitBlt operation Pattern Fill with transparency requires a BitBlt width ≥ 2. The BitBlt width is set in REG[110h], REG[111h]. Transparent Write Blit The Transparent Write Blit supports bit block transfers from the host to display buffer. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 180 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center When the source color is equal to key color, which is defined in Background Color Register, the destination area is not updated. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of the key color is used for comparison. For this blit no raster operation is applied. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 181 Transparent Move Blit The Transparent Move Blit supports bit block transfers from display buffer to display buffer in positive direction only. When the source color is equal to key color, which is defined in Background Color Register, the destination area is not updated. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of key color is used for comparison. For this blit no raster operation is applied. Color Expansion The Color Expansion Blit expands the host’s monochrome data to 8 or 16 bpp color format. A 1 expands to the color defined in the Foreground Color Register. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of the Foreground Color Register is used. A 0 expands to the color defined in the Background Color Register. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of the Background Color Register is used. If background transparency is enabled, then the destination color will remain untouched. The host will be continuously feeding a 16-bit data package. When the end of the line is reached, any unused bits will be discarded. The data for the next line will be taken from the next data package. The low byte write data will be used first for the operation. Each bit is serially expanded to the destination data starting from MSB (Bit 7) to LSB (Bit 0). This blit supports any bit alignment, but supports in a positive direction only. Move Blit with Color Expansion The Move Blit with Color Expansion expands off-screen source’s monochrome data to 8 or 16 bpp color format. A 1 expands to the color defined in the Foreground Color Register. A 0 expands to the color defined in the Background Color Register. If background transparency is enabled, then the destination color will remain untouched. In 8 bpp mode, only the low byte of the Foreground Color Register and Background Color Register are used for color expansion. The low byte write data will be used first for the operation. Each bit is serially expanded to the destination data starting from MSB (Bit 7) to LSB (Bit 0). This blit supports byte alignment only and supports in a positive direction only. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 182 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 10 Display Buffer The system addresses the display buffer through the CS#, M/R#, and AB[20:0] input pins. When CS# = 0 and M/R# = 1, the display buffer is addressed by bits AB[20:0]. See the table below: Table 10-1: S1D13506 Addressing CS# M/R# Access Register access - see Section 8.2, “Register Mapping” on page 124. • REG[000h] is addressed when AB[12:0] = 0 • REG[001h] is addressed when AB[12:0] = 1 • REG[n] is addressed when AB[12:0] = n 0 0 0 1 Memory access: the 2M byte display buffer is addressed by AB[20:0] 1 X S1D13506 not selected The display buffer address space is always 2M bytes. However, the physical display buffer may be either 512K bytes or 2M bytes – see Section 5.3, “Summary of Configuration Options” on page 39. A 512K byte display buffer is replicated in the 2M byte address space – see Figure 10-1: “Display Buffer Addressing,” on page 182. The display buffer can contain an image buffer, one or more Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor buffers, and a Dual Panel Buffer. 512K Byte Buffer AB[20:0] 2M Byte Buffer 000000h Image Buffer Ink/Cursor Buffer Dual Panel Buffer Image Buffer 07FFFFh 080000h Image Buffer Ink/Cursor Buffer Dual Panel Buffer Image Buffer Ink/Cursor Buffer Dual Panel Buffer Image Buffer Ink/Cursor Buffer Dual Panel Buffer 0FFFFFh 100000h 17FFFFh 180000h Ink/Cursor Buffer 1FFFFFh Dual Panel Buffer Figure 10-1: Display Buffer Addressing S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 183 10.1 Image Buffer The image buffer contains the formatted display mode data – see Section 11.1, “Display Mode Data Format” on page 184. The displayed image(s) may occupy only a portion of this space; the remaining area may be used for multiple images – possibly for animation or general storage. Section 11, “Display Configuration” on page 184 for the relationship between the image buffer and the displayed image. 10.2 Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Buffers The Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor buffers contain formatted image data for the Ink Layer and Hardware Cursor. There may be several Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor images stored in the display buffer but only one may be active at any given time. For details see Section 14, “Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Architecture” on page 197. 10.3 Dual Panel Buffer In dual panel mode a buffer is required and allocated by hardware. With this Dual Panel Buffer enabled, the top of the display buffer is allocated to the Dual Panel Buffer. The size of the Dual Panel Buffer is a function of the panel resolution and whether the panel is color or monochrome: Dual Panel Buffer Size (in bytes) = (panel width x panel height) x factor / 16 where factor: = 4 for color panel = 1 for monochrome panel Note Calculating the size of the Dual Panel Buffer is required to avoid overwriting the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer buffer. Example 1: For a 640x480 8 bpp color panel the Dual Panel Buffer size is 75K bytes. In a 512K byte display buffer, the Dual Panel Buffer resides from 6D400h to 7FFFFh. In a 2M byte display buffer, the Dual Panel Buffer resides from 1ED400h to 1FFFFFh. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 184 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 11 Display Configuration 11.1 Display Mode Data Format The following diagrams show the display mode data formats for a little endian system: . 4 bpp: bit 7 bit 0 Byte 0 A0 B0 C0 D0 A1 B1 C1 D1 Byte 1 A2 B2 C2 D2 A3 B3 C3 D3 Byte 2 A4 B4 C4 D4 A5 B5 C5 D5 Host Address P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 Pn = (An, Bn, Cn, Dn) Panel Display Display Buffer 8 bpp: bit 7 bit 0 G0 H0 A0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 Byte 1 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1 F1 G1 H1 Byte 2 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 F2 G2 H2 Byte 0 Host Address P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 Pn = (An, Bn, Cn, Dn,En, Fn, Gn, Hn) Panel Display Display Buffer 15 bpp: 5-5-5 RGB bit 7 bit 0 Byte 0 G02 G01 G00 B04 B03 B02 B01 B00 Byte 1 R04 R03 R02 R01 R00 G04 G03 Byte 2 G12 G11 G10 B14 B13 B12 B11 B10 Byte 3 R14 R13 R12 R11 R10 G14 G13 Host Address P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 Pn = (Rn4-0, Gn 4-0, Bn4-0) Panel Display Display Buffer 16 bpp: 5-6-5 RGB bit 7 2 G0 1 0 3 bit 0 2 1 B0 4 G 03 G0 Byte 1 R04 Byte 2 G12 G11 G10 B14 B13 B12 B11 B10 Byte 3 R14 R13 R12 R11 R10 G15 G14 G13 Host Address G0 R02 R0 1 B0 R0 0 B0 G0 5 B0 G0 P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 0 Byte 0 R03 B0 4 Pn = (Rn4-0, Gn 5-0, Bn4-0) Panel Display Display Buffer Figure 11-1: 4/8/15/16 Bit-per-pixel Format Memory Organization Note 1. The Host-to-Display mapping shown here is for a little endian system. 2. For 15/16 bit-per-pixel formats, Rn, Gn, Bn represent the red, green, and blue color components. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 185 11.2 Image Manipulation The figure below shows how the screen image is stored in the image buffer and positioned on the LCD display. The screen image on the CRT/TV is manipulated similarly. When EISD is enabled (see Section 16, “EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD)” on page 210), the images on the LCD and on the CRT/TV are independent of each other. • For LCD: REG[047h], REG[046h] defines the width of the virtual image. For CRT/TV: REG[067h], REG[066h] defines the width of the virtual image. • For LCD: REG[044h], REG[043h], REG[042h] defines the starting word of the displayed image. For CRT/TV: REG[064h], REG[063h], REG[062h] defines the starting word of the displayed image. • For LCD: REG[048h] defines the starting pixel within the starting word. For CRT/TV: REG[068h] defines the starting pixel within the starting word. • For LCD: REG[032h] defines the width of the LCD display. For CRT/TV: REG[050h] defines the width of the CRT/TV display. • For LCD: REG[039h], REG[038h] defines the height of the LCD display. For CRT/TV: REG[057h], REG[056h] defines the height of the CRT/TV display. Image Buffer LCD Display Starting Word (REG[044h], REG[043h], REG[042h]) Starting Pixel of Word (REG[048h]) Height of LCD Display ((REG[039h], REG[038h])+1) lines Screen Line 0 Line 1 Screen Width of LCD Display ((REG[032h]+1)×8) pixels Width of Virtual Image (REG[047h], REG[046h]) Figure 11-2: Image Manipulation Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 186 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 12 Look-Up Table Architecture The following depictions are intended to show the display data output path only. 12.1 Monochrome Modes The green LUT is used for all monochrome modes. 4 Bit-Per-Pixel Monochrome Mode Green Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 4-bit Gray Data FC FD FE FF 4 bit-per-pixel data from Image Buffer Figure 12-1: 4 Bit-Per-Pixel Monochrome Mode Data Output Path S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 187 12.2 Color Modes 4 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Red Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 4-bit Red Data FC FD FE FF Green Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 4-bit Green Data FC FD FE FF Blue Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 4-bit Blue Data FC FD FE FF 4 bit-per-pixel data from Image Buffer Figure 12-2: 4 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Mode Data Output Path Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 188 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Red Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 F8 F9 FA FB FC FD FE FF Green Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 F8 F9 FA FB FC FD FE FF Blue Look-Up Table 256x4 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 F8 F9 FA FB FC FD FE FF 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 4-bit Red Data 4-bit Green Data 4-bit Blue Data 8 bit-per-pixel data from Image Buffer Figure 12-3: 8 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Mode Data Output Path 15/16 Bit-Per-Pixel Color Modes The LUT is bypassed and the color data is directly mapped for these color depths– See “Display Configuration” on page 184. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 189 13 TV Considerations 13.1 NTSC/PAL Operation NTSC or PAL video is supported in either composite or S-video format. Filters may be enabled to reduce the distortion associated with displaying high resolution computer images on an interlaced TV display. The image can be vertically and horizontally positioned on the TV. Additionally, a dedicated Hardware Cursor (independent from the LCD display) is supported. 13.2 Clock Source The required clock frequencies for NTSC/PAL are given in the following table: Table 13-1: Required Clock Frequencies for NTSC/PAL TV Format NTSC PAL Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Required Clock Frequency 14.318180 MHz (3.579545 MHz subcarrier) 17.734475 MHz (4.43361875 MHz subcarrier) S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 190 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 13.3 Filters When displaying computer images on a TV, several image distortions are likely to arise: • cross-luminance distortion. • cross-chrominance distortion. • flickering. These distortions are caused by the high-resolution nature of computer images which typically contain sharp color transitions, and sharp luminance transitions (e.g., high contrast one pixel wide lines and fonts, window edges, etc.). Three filters are available to reduce these distortions. 13.3.1 Chrominance Filter (REG[05Bh] bit 5) The chrominance filter adjusts the color of the TV by limiting the bandwidth of the chrominance signal (reducing cross-luminance distortion). This reduces the “ragged edges” seen at boundaries between sharp color transitions. This filter is controlled using REG[05Bh] bit 5 and is most useful for composite video output. 13.3.2 Luminance Filter (REG[05Bh] bit 4) The luminance filter adjusts the brightness of the TV by limiting the bandwidth of the luminance signal (reducing cross-chrominance distortion). This reduces the “rainbow-like” colors at boundaries between sharp luminance transitions. This filter is controlled using REG[05Bh] bit 4 and is most useful for composite video output. 13.3.3 Anti-flicker Filter (REG[1FCh] bits [2:1]) The “flickering” effect seen on interlaced displays is caused by sharp vertical image transitions that occur over one line (1 vertical pixel). For example, one pixel high lines, edges of window boxes, etc. Flickering occurs because these high resolution lines are effectively displayed at half the refresh frequency due to interlacing. The anti-flicker filter averages adjacent lines on the TV display to reduce flickering. This filter is controlled using the Display Mode register (REG[1FCh] bits [2:1]). S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 191 13.4 TV Output Levels Vwhite Vyellow Vcyan Vgreen Vmagenta Vred Vblue Vblank Vblack Vsync Figure 13-1: NTSC/PAL SVideo-Y (Luminance) Output Levels Table 13-2: NTSC/PAL SVideo-Y (Luminance) Output Levels Symbol Vwhite Vyellow Vcyan Vgreen Vmagenta Vred Vblue Vblack Vblanking Vsync Parameter White Yellow Cyan Green Magenta Red Blue Black Blanking Sync Tip RGB 1F 1F 00 00 1F 1F 00 00 3F 1F 3F 00 3F 1F 3F 00 00 1F 00 00 00 1F 00 00 N.A. N.A. NTSC / PAL (mv) 996 923 798 725 608 536 410 338 284 0 NTSC / PAL (IRE) 99.5 89 72 62 45 35 17 7.3 0 -40 Note RGB values assume a 16 bpp color depth with 5-6-5 pixel packing. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 192 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center V1red V1cyan V1green V1magenta V1yellow V1blue V2yellow V2blue V1burst Vblanking V2burst V2green V2magenta V2cyan V2red Figure 13-2: NTSC/PAL SVideo-C (Chrominance) Output Levels Table 13-3: NTSC/PAL SVideo-C (Chrominance) Output Levels Symbol V1burst V1yellow V1cyan V1green V1magenta V1red V1blue Vblanking V2burst V2yellow V2cyan V2green V2magenta V2red V2blue Parameter Burst positive peak Yellow positive peak Cyan positive peak Green positive peak Magenta positive peak Red positive peak Blue positive peak Blanking Burst negative peak Yellow negative peak Cyan negative peak Green negative peak Magenta negative peak Red negative peak Blue negative peak RGB N.A. 3F 00 3F 1F 3F 00 00 1F 00 00 00 1F N.A. N.A. 1F 3F 00 00 3F 1F 00 3F 00 1F 00 1F 1F 00 00 00 00 1F 1F 00 00 1F 1F 00 NTSC / PAL (mv) 552 / 541 700 815 751 751 815 700 410 268 / 279 121 5 70 70 5 121 NTSC / PAL (IRE) Note RGB values assume a 16 bpp color depth with 5-6-5 pixel packing. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 193 V1 yellow V1cyan V1green Vwhite V2yellow V1magenta V2cyan V1red V2green V3yellow V2magenta V1blue V2red V1burst Vblank V2blue V3cyan Vblack V3green V2burst Vsync V3magenta V3red V3blue Figure 13-3: NTSC/PAL Composite Output Levels Table 13-4: NTSC/PAL Composite Output Levels Symbol V1yellow V1cyan V1green V1magenta V1red V1blue Vwhite V2yellow V2cyan V2green V2magenta V2red V2blue Vblack V3yellow V3cyan V3green V3magenta V3red V3blue Vblank V1burst V2burst Vsync Parameter Yellow chrominance positive peak Cyan chrominance positive peak Green chrominance positive peak Magenta chrominance positive peak Red chrominance positive peak Blue chrominance positive peak White luminance level Yellow luminance level Cyan luminance level Green luminance level Magenta luminance level Red luminance level Blue luminance level Black luminance level Yellow chrominance negative peak Cyan chrominance negative peak Green chrominance negative peak Magenta chrominance negative peak Red chrominance negative peak Blue chrominance negative peak Blank Level Burst positive peak Burst negative peak Sync Tip RGB 1F 3F 00 00 3F 1F 00 3F 00 1F 00 1F 1F 00 00 00 00 1F 1F 3F 1F 1F 3F 00 00 3F 1F 00 3F 00 1F 00 1F 1F 00 00 00 00 1F 00 00 00 1F 3F 00 00 3F 1F 00 3F 00 1F 00 1F 1F 00 00 00 00 1F N.A. N.A. N.A. N.A. NTSC / PAL (mv) NTSC / PAL (IRE) 1211 130 1202 128 1065 109 948 93 939 92 699 58 995 99 923 89 797 72 725 62 608 45 535 35 411 18 338 7.3 634 49 392 15 384 14 267 -2.6 130 -22 122 -23 284 0 426 / 415 20 / 18 142 / 153 -20 / -19 0 -40 Note RGB values assume a 16 bpp color depth with 5-6-5 pixel packing. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 194 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 13.5 TV Image Display and Positioning This section describes how to setup and position an image to be displayed on a TV. Figure 13-4: “NTSC/PAL Image Positioning,” on page 195 shows an image positioned on the TV display with the related programmable parameters. The TV display area is shaded. The size of the display image determines the register values for the Horizontal Display Period, Horizontal Non-Display Period, Vertical Display Period, and Vertical Non-Display Period. The maximum and minimum values for these registers are given in Table 13-5: “Minimum and Maximum Values for NTSC/PAL”. The line period and frame period determined by these registers must also satisfy the following equations: NTSC: (((REG[050] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 8) + (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 6) = 910 ({(REG[057] bits[1:0]), (REG[056] bits[7:0])}+1) + ((REG[058] bits[6:0])+1)x2+1) = 525 PAL: (((REG[050] bits[6:0]) + 1) x 8) + (((REG[052] bits[5:0]) x 8) + 7) = 1135 ({(REG[057] bits[1:0]), (REG[056] bits[7:0])}+1) + ((REG[058] bits[6:0])+1)x2+1) = 625 The HRTC Start Position and VRTC Start Position registers position the image horizontally and vertically. The maximum and minimum register values for these registers are given in Table 13-5: “Minimum and Maximum Values for NTSC/PAL”. Increasing the HRTC Start Position will move the image left, while increasing the VRTC Start Position will move the image up. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 195 t1 t2 t3 t6 t5 Vertical Sync Odd Field 1, 3 t4 / 2 Image Odd Lines (1, 3, 5, ...) t6 Vertical Sync t5 + 1TLINE Even Field 2, 4 t4 / 2 Even Lines (2, 4, 6, ...) t3 0 909 (NTSC) 1134 (PAL) Horizontal Sync Figure 13-4: NTSC/PAL Image Positioning The maximum Horizontal and Vertical Display Widths shown in Table 13-5: “Minimum and Maximum Values for NTSC/PAL” include display areas that are normally hidden by the edges of the TV. The visible display dimensions are shown in Figure 13-5: “Typical Total Display and Visible Display Dimensions for NTSC and PAL,” on page 196 as a guideline. The actual visible display area for a particular TV may differ slightly from those dimensions given. Table 13-6: “Register Values for Example NTSC/PAL Images” lists register values for some example images. Table 13-5: Minimum and Maximum Values for NTSC/PAL Symbol t1 t2 t3 t4 t5 t6 Parameter TV Horizontal Non-Display Period TV Horizontal Display Width TV HRTC Start Position TV Vertical Display Height TV Vertical Non-Display Period TV VRTC Start Position Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Register(s) 52 50 53 57, 56 58 59 NTSC min max 158 510 400 752 25 t2 - 158 396 484 20 64 0 t5 - 20 PAL min 215 624 25 496 26 0 max 511 920 t2 - 215 572 64 t5 - 26 Units T4SC T4SC T4SC TLINE TLINE TLINE S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 196 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Total Display 752 x 484 Total Display 920 x 572 Visible Display 696 x 436 Visible Display 856 x 518 NTSC PAL Figure 13-5: Typical Total Display and Visible Display Dimensions for NTSC and PAL Note For most implementations, the visible display does not equal the total display. The total display dimensions and the visible display dimensions must be determined for each specific implementation. Table 13-6: Register Values for Example NTSC/PAL Images Parameter Register TV Horizontal Display Width TV Horizontal Non-Display Period TV HRTC Start Position 50 52 53 57 56 58 59 TV Vertical Display Height TV Vertical Non-Display Period TV VRTC Start Position NTSC PAL 752x484 696x436 640x480 920x572 856x518 800x572 640x480 5Dh 56h 4Fh 72h 6Ah 63h 4Fh 13h 1Ah 21h 1Ah 22h 29h 3Dh 02h 04h 08h 02h 05h 09h 13h 01h 01h 01h 02h 02h 02h 01h E3h B3h DFh 3Bh 05h 3Bh DFh 13h 2Bh 15h 19h 34h 19h 47h 00h 0Ch 01h 00h 0Dh 00h 16h 13.6 TV Cursor Operation See Section 14, “Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Architecture” on page 197. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 197 14 Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Architecture 14.1 Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor Buffers The Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor buffers contain formatted image data for the Ink Layer or Hardware Cursor. There may be several Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor images stored in the display buffer but only one may be active at any given time. The active Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor buffer is selected by the Ink/Cursor Start Address register (REG[071h] for LCD, REG[081h] for CRT/TV). This register defines the start address for the active Ink/Cursor buffer. The Ink/Cursor buffer must be positioned where it does not conflict with the image buffer and Dual Panel Buffer. The start address for the Ink/Cursor buffer is programmed as shown in the following table. Table 14-1: Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Start Address (Bytes) 0 Display Buffer Size - 1024 Comments This default value is suitable for a cursor when there is no Dual Panel Buffer. These positions can be used to: n = 255...1 Display Buffer Size (n × 8192) • position an Ink buffer at the top of the display buffer; • position an Ink buffer between the image and Dual Panel Buffers; • position a Cursor buffer between the image and Dual Panel Buffers; • select from a multiple of Cursor buffers. The Ink/Cursor image is stored contiguously. The address offset from the starting word of line n to the starting word of line n+1 is calculated as follows: LCD Ink Address Offset (words) = REG[032h] + 1 CRT/TV Ink Address Offset (words) = REG[050h] + 1 LCD or CRT/TV Cursor Address Offset (words) = 8 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 198 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2 Ink/Cursor Data Format The Ink/Cursor image is always 2 bit-per-pixel. The following diagram shows the Ink/Cursor data format for a little endian system. 2-bpp: bit 7 bit 0 Byte 0 A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 Byte 1 A4 B4 A5 B5 A6 B6 A7 B7 P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 Pn = (An, Bn) Panel Display Host Address Ink/Cursor Buffer Figure 14-1: Ink/Cursor Data Format The image data for pixel n, (An,Bn), selects the color for pixel n as follows. Table 14-2: Ink/Cursor Color Select (An,Bn) Color 00 Color 0 Ink/Cursor Color 0 Register, (REG[078h], REG[077h], REG[076h] for LCD, REG[088h], REG[087h], REG[086h] for CRT/TV) 01 Color 1 Ink/Cursor Color 1 Register, (REG[07Ah], REG[07Bh],REG[07Ah] for LCD, REG[08Ah], REG[08Bh], REG[08Ah] for CRT/TV) 10 Background 11 Inverted Background S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Comments Ink/Cursor is transparent – show background Ink/Cursor is transparent – show inverted background Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 199 14.3 Ink/Cursor Image Manipulation 14.3.1 Ink Image The Ink image should always start at the top left pixel, i.e. Cursor X Position and Cursor Y Position registers should always be set to zero. The width and height of the ink image are automatically calculated to completely cover the display. 14.3.2 Cursor Image The Cursor image size is always 64 x 64 pixels. The Cursor X Position and Cursor Y Position registers specify the position of the top left pixel. The following diagram shows how to position an unclipped cursor. P(0;0) P(x;y) P(x+63;y) P(x;y+63) P(x+63;y+63) Figure 14-2: Unclipped Cursor Positioning where For LCD: x = (REG[073h] bits [1:0], REG[072h]) and REG[073h] bit 7 = 0 y = (REG[075h] bits [1:0], REG[074h]) and REG[075h] bit 7 = 0 For CRT/TV: x = (REG[083h] bits [1:0], REG[082h]) and REG[083h] bit 7 = 0 y = (REG[085h] bits [1:0], REG[084h]) and REG[085h] bit 7 = 0 The following diagram shows how to position a cursor that is clipped at the top and left sides of the display. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 200 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center P(-x;-y) P(0;0) P(63-x;63-y) Figure 14-3: Clipped Cursor Positioning where For LCD: x = (REG[073h] bits [1:0], REG[072h]) <= 63 and REG[073h] bit 7 = 1 y = (REG[075h] bits [1:0], REG[074h]) <= 63 and REG[075h] bit 7 = 1 For CRT/TV: x = (REG[083h] bits [1:0], REG[082h]) <= 63 and REG[083h] bit 7 = 1 y = (REG[085h] bits [1:0], REG[084h]) <= 63 and REG[085h] bit 7 = 1 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 201 15 SwivelView™ 15.1 Concept Most computer displays are refreshed in landscape – from left to right and top to bottom. Computer images are stored in the same manner. SwivelView™ is designed to rotate the displayed image on an LCD by 90°, 180°, or 270° in a clockwise direction. The rotation is done in hardware and is transparent to the user for all display buffer reads and writes. By processing the rotation in hardware, SwivelView™ offers a performance advantage over software rotation of the displayed image. 15.2 90° SwivelView™ 90° SwivelView™ uses a 1024 × 1024 pixel virtual window. The following figures show how the display buffer memory map changes in 90° SwivelView™. The display is refreshed in the following sense: C–A–D–B. The application image is written to the S1D13506 in the following sense: A–B–C–D. The S1D13506 rotates and stores the application image in the following sense: C–A–D–B, the same sense as display refresh. The user can read/write to the display buffer naturally, without the need to rotate the image first in software. The registers that control the panning and scrolling of the panel window are designed for a landscape window. However, it is still possible to pan and scroll the portrait window in 90° SwivelView™, but the user must program these registers somewhat differently (See Section 15.2.1, “Register Programming” on page 202). 1024 pixels B portrait window H B D W 1024 pixels display start address portrait window A C A 1024 pixels W D C H Image seen by the user Rotated image in the display buffer Figure 15-1: Relationship Between Screen Image and 90° Rotated Image in the Display Buffer Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 202 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Note W is the width of the LCD panel in number of pixels, (or the height of the portrait window in number of lines). H is the height of the panel in number of lines, (or the width of the portrait window in number of pixels). Note The image must be written with a 1024 pixel offset between adjacent lines (1024 bytes for 8 bpp mode or 2048 bytes for 15/16 bpp mode) and the display start address must be calculated (see below). 15.2.1 Register Programming Enabling 90° Rotation on CPU Read/Write to Display Buffer Set SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 to 1. All CPU accesses to the display buffer are translated to provide 90° clockwise rotation of the display image. SwivelView™ Enable bit 1 should be set to 0. Memory Address Offset The LCD Memory Address Offset register (REG[046h], REG[047h]) must be set for a 1024 pixel offset: LCD Memory Address Offset (words) = 1024 for 15/16 bpp mode = 512 for 8 bpp mode Display Start Address As seen in Figure 15-1: “Relationship Between Screen Image and 90° Rotated Image in the Display Buffer,” on page 201, the Display Start Address is determined by the location of the image corner “C”, and it is generally non-zero. The LCD Display Start Address register (REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h]) must be set accordingly. LCD Display Start Address (words) = (1024 - W) = (1024 - W) / 2 for 15/16 bpp mode for 8 bpp mode where W is the width of the panel in number of pixels. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 203 Horizontal Panning Horizontal panning is achieved by changing the LCD Display Start Address register: • Increase/decrease LCD Display Start Address register by 1024 (15/16 bpp mode) or 512 (8 bpp mode) pans the display window to the right/left by 1 pixel. The amount the display window can be panned to the right is limited to 1024 pixels and limited by the amount of physical memory installed. Vertical Scrolling Vertical scrolling is achieved by changing the LCD Display Start Address register and/or the LCD Pixel Panning register: • Increment/decrement LCD Display Start Address register in 8 bpp mode scrolls the display window up/down by 2 lines. • Increment/decrement LCD Display Start Address register in 15/16 bpp mode scrolls the display window up/down by 1 line. • Increment/decrement LCD Pixel Panning register in 8 bpp mode scrolls the display window up/down by 1 line. 15.2.2 Physical Memory Requirement Because the user must now deal with a 1024×1024 virtual display, the amount of image buffer required for a particular display mode has increased. The minimum amount of image buffer required is: Minimum Required Image Buffer (bytes) = (1024 × H) × 2 for 15/16 bpp mode = (1024 × H) for 8 bpp mode where H is the height of the panel in number of lines. This minimum amount is required to display a 90° SwivelView™ image without panning; scrolling, however, is permissible. The degree an image can be panned depends on the amount of physical memory installed and how much of that is used by the Dual Panel Buffer, Ink Layer, or Hardware Cursor. An image cannot be panned outside the 1024×1024 virtual display. Often it cannot be panned within the entire virtual display because part of the virtual display memory may be taken up by the Dual Panel Buffer, Ink Layer, Hardware Cursor, or even the CRT/TV display buffer. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 204 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The Dual Panel Buffer is used for dual panel mode. Its memory requirement is: Dual Panel Buffer (bytes) =(W × H) / 4 =(W × H) / 16 for color mode for monochrome mode where W is the width of the panel in number of pixels, and H is the height of the panel in number of lines. The Dual Panel Buffer is always located at the end of the physical memory. The Hardware Cursor or Ink Layer also takes up memory. If this memory is > 1KB, it must be located at an 8KB boundary, otherwise it may be located at the last 1KB area. The Hardware Cursor or Ink Layer must not overlap the image buffer or the Dual Panel Buffer. The following table summarizes the DRAM size requirement for 90° SwivelView™ for different panel sizes and display modes. Note that DRAM size for the S1D13506 is limited to either 512K byte or 2M byte. The calculation is based on the minimum required image buffer size and the Dual Panel Buffer size. The Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer may or may not fit within this minimum DRAM configuration – this is noted in the table. The hardware cursor requires only 1KB of memory and so may resides at the last 1KB area if there is no Dual Panel Buffer, otherwise it must reside at an 8KB boundary. The 2-bit ink layer requires (W × H) / 4 bytes of memory; it must reside at an 8KB boundary. The table shows only one possible Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer location – at the highest possible location without interfering with the Dual Panel Buffer. It is also assumed that CRT/TV is not used. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 205 Table 15-1: Minimum DRAM Size Required for SwivelView™ Panel Size Panel Type Color 320 × 240 Single Mono Color Single Mono 640 × 480 Color Dual Mono Color Single Mono 800 × 600 Color Dual Mono Display Mode Min. Image Buffer Size 8 bpp 240KB 15/16 bpp 480KB 8 bpp 240KB 15/16 bpp 480KB 8 bpp 480KB 15/16 bpp 960KB 8 bpp 480KB 15/16 bpp 960KB 8 bpp 480KB 15/16 bpp 960KB 8 bpp 480KB 15/16 bpp 960KB 8 bpp 600KB 15/16 bpp 1.2MB 8 bpp 600KB 15/16 bpp 1.2MB 8 bpp 600KB 15/16 bpp 1.2MB 8 bpp 600KB 15/16 bpp 1.2MB Dual Panel Buffer Size Minimum DRAM Size 0KB 512KB Ink/Cursor Buffer Size Ink/Cursor Location 18.75KB/1KB 488KB/511KB --/511KB 0KB 75KB 18.75KB 2MB 1968KB/2047KB 512KB 2MB --/511KB 75KB/1KB 1968KB/2047KB 1896KB/1968KB 512KB --/488KB 1952KB/2024KB 0KB 1928KB/2047KB 2MB 117.19KB/1KB 117.19KB 1808KB/1928KB 29.30KB 1896KB/2016KB Where KB = 1024 bytes and MB = 1024KB 15.2.3 Limitations The following limitations apply to 90° SwivelView™: • Only 8/15/16 bpp modes are supported – 4 bpp mode is not supported. • Hardware cursor and ink images are not rotated – software rotation must be used. SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 must be set to 0 when the user is accessing the Hardware Cursor or the Ink Layer buffer. • CRT/TV mode is not supported. SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 must be set to 0 when the user is accessing the CRT/TV display buffer. • 90° SwivelView™ does not support BitBlts. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 206 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 15.3 180° SwivelView™ 180° SwivelView™ is accomplished by fetching the display buffer image in the reverse address direction, starting at the bottom-right corner of the image. Unlike 90° SwivelView™, the 180° SwivelView™ image is not rotated in the display buffer. The image is simply displayed 180° clockwise rotated. Furthermore, a virtual window is not required and all color depths (4/8/15/16 bpp) are supported. 15.3.1 Register Programming Reverse Display Buffer Fetching Address Direction Set SwivelView™ Enable bit 1 to 1. During screen refresh, the direction of the address for display buffer fetching is reversed. This setting does not affect CPU to display buffer access in any way. SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 should be set to 0. Display Start Address The Display Start Address must be programmed to be at the bottom-right corner of the image, since the display is now refreshed in the reverse direction. The LCD Display Start Address register (REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h]) must be set accordingly. LCD Display Start Address (words) = (MA_Offset × H) − (MA_Offset − W) − 1 = (MA_Offset × H) − (MA_Offset − W/2) − 1 = (MA_Offset × H) − (MA_Offset − W/4) − 1 for 15/16 bpp mode for 8 bpp mode for 4 bpp mode where H is the height of the panel in number of lines, W is the width of the panel in number of pixels, and MA_Offset is the LCD Memory Address Offset. Horizontal Panning Horizontal panning works in the same way as when SwivelView™ is not enabled, except that the effect of the LCD Pixel Panning register is reversed: • Increment/decrement LCD Display Start Address register pans the display window to the right/left. • Increment/decrement LCD Pixel Panning register pans the display window to the left/right. Vertical Panning Vertical panning works in the same way as when SwivelView™ is not enabled: • Increase/decrease LCD Display Start Address register by one memory address offset scrolls the display window down/up by 1 line. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 207 15.3.2 Limitations The following limitations apply to 180° SwivelView™: • Hardware Cursor and Ink Layer images are not rotated – software rotation must be used. • CRT/TV mode is not supported. • 180° SwivelView™ does not support all BitBlts. 15.4 270° SwivelView™ 270° SwivelView™ is a combination of 90° SwivelView™ and 180° SwivelView™. The image stored in the display buffer is 90° rotated, and the image is further 180° rotated during screen refresh, resulting in a 270° rotated display image. The user must use a 1024 × 1024 pixel virtual window as in 90° SwivelView™. See Figure 15-1: “Relationship Between Screen Image and 90° Rotated Image in the Display Buffer,” on page 201. 15.4.1 Register Programming Enabling 90° Rotation on CPU Read/Write to Display Buffer Set SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 to 1. All CPU access to the display buffer is translated to provide 90° clockwise rotation of the display image. Reverse Display Buffer Fetching Address Direction Set SwivelView™ Enable bit 1 to 1. During screen refresh, the direction of the address for display buffer fetching is reversed. This setting does not affect CPU to display buffer access in any way. Memory Address Offset The LCD Memory Address Offset register (REG[046h], REG[047h]) must be set for a 1024 pixel offset. LCD Memory Address Offset (words) = 1024 for 15/16 bpp mode = 512 for 8 bpp mode Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 208 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Display Start Address The Display Start Address must be programmed to be at the bottom-right corner of the image, since the display is now refreshed in the reverse direction. The LCD Display Start Address register (REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h]) must be set accordingly. LCD Display Start Address (words) = ((LCD Memory Address Offset) × H) − 1 where H is the height of the panel in number of lines. Horizontal Panning Horizontal panning is achieved by changing the LCD Display Start Address register. It works in the same way as in 90° SwivelView™ mode: • Increase/decrease LCD Display Start Address register by 1024 (15/16 bpp mode) or 512 (8 bpp mode) pans the display window to the right/left by 1 pixel. The amount the display window can be panned to the right is limited to 1024 pixels and limited by the amount of physical memory installed. Vertical Scrolling Vertical scrolling is achieved by changing the LCD Display Start Address register and/or the LCD Pixel Panning register. It works in the same way as in 90° SwivelView™ mode, except that the effect of the LCD Pixel Panning register is reversed: • Increment/decrement LCD Display Start Address register in 8 bpp mode scrolls the display window up/down by 2 lines. • Increment/decrement LCD Display Start Address register in 15/16 bpp mode scrolls the display window up/down by 1 line. • Increment/decrement LCD Pixel Panning register in 8 bpp mode scrolls the display window down/up by 1 line. 15.4.2 Physical Memory Requirement 270° SwivelView™ mode has the same physical memory requirement as in 90° SwivelView™ mode. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 209 15.4.3 Limitations The following limitations apply to 270° SwivelView™: • Only 8/15/16 bpp modes are supported – 4 bpp mode is not supported. • Hardware Cursor and Ink Layer images are not rotated – software rotation must be used. SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 must be set to 0 when the user is accessing the Hardware Cursor or the Ink Layer memory. • CRT/TV mode is not supported. SwivelView™ Enable bit 0 must be set to 0 when the user is accessing the CRT/TV display buffer. • 270° SwivelView™ does not support BitBlts. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 210 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 16 EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD) 16.1 Introduction EPSON Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD) allows the S1D13506 to display independent images on two different displays (LCD panel and CRT or TV). The LCD panel timings and mode setup are programmed through the Panel Configuration Registers (REG[03Xh]) and the LCD Display Mode Registers (REG[04Xh]). The CRT/TV timings and mode setup are programmed through the CRT/TV Configuration Registers (REG[05Xh]) and the CRT/TV Display Mode Registers (REG[06Xh]). The Ink Layer or Hardware Cursor can also be independently controlled on the two displays. The LCD Ink/Cursor Registers (REG[07Xh]) control the Ink/Cursor on the LCD display; the CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Registers (REG[08Xh]) control the Ink/Cursor on the CRT or TV. Each display uses its own Look-Up Table (LUT), although there is only one set of LUT Registers (REG[1E0h], REG[1E2h], REG[1E4h]). Use the LUT Mode Register (REG[1E0h]) to select access to the LCD and/or CRT/TV LUTs. The pixel clock source for the two displays may also be independent. Use the Clock Configuration Registers (REG[014h], REG[018h]) to select the LCD pixel clock source and the CRT/TV pixel clock source, respectively. Typically, CLKI2 is used for the CRT/TV display, while CLKI is used for the LCD display. Memory clock may come from CLKI or BUSCLK. To display different images on the LCD and CRT/TV, the two images should reside in nonoverlapping areas of the display buffer, and the display start addresses point to the corresponding areas. The display buffer is mapped to the CPU address AB[20:0] linearly. Example 1: Assuming a 2M byte display buffer, the LCD image may locate in the first 1M byte of the display buffer (AB[20:0] = 000000h-0FFFFFh), and the CRT/TV image may locate in the second 1M byte of the display buffer (AB[20:0] = 100000h-1FFFFFh). The LCD and CRT/TV may display identical images by setting the display start addresses for the LCD and the CRT/TV to the same address. In this case only one image is needed in the display buffer. However, the display pipelines are still independent so the same image is fetched twice from the display buffer; once for the LCD refresh and once for the CRT/TV refresh. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 211 16.2 Bandwidth Limitation When EISD is enabled, the LCD and CRT/TV displays must share the total bandwidth available to the S1D13506. The result is that display modes with a high resolution or color depth may not be supported. In some cases, Ink Layers may not be possible on one or both of the displays. EISD increases the total demand for display refresh bandwidth and reduces CPU bandwidth, resulting in lower CPU performance. In a few cases when EISD is enabled, the default LCD and CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Control register values are not optimally set, causing display problems with one or both of the displays. This condition may be corrected by adjusting the values of the LCD and CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold Control registers (REG[04Ah] for LCD and REG[06Ah] for CRT/TV). When the FIFO High Threshold Control register is set to 00h (default), the following settings are used: • 11h for 4 bpp mode • 21h for 8 bpp mode • 23h for 15/16 bpp mode Changing this register to a non-zero value sets the high threshold FIFO level to this value. This register may not exceed 59 decimal. The high threshold FIFO level controls how often display fetch requests are issued by the FIFO. In general, a higher high threshold FIFO level increases the bandwidth to that display pipe, and a lower level reduces it. Most display problems may be corrected by increasing the associated high threshold FIFO level for that display. However, because the total available bandwidth is fixed, this change may create display problem for the other display. In this case, reducing the high threshold FIFO level for the other display instead may work. Sometimes, a combination of these two methods is required. Correcting EISD display problems by adjusting the FIFO High Threshold Control registers is mostly a trial-and-error process. While the user is free to experiment with these registers, recommended FIFO level settings for some of the more common EISD modes requiring non-default FIFO level settings are listed in Section 18.2, “Example Frame Rates” on page 216. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 212 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 17 MediaPlug Interface Winnov's MediaPlug Slave interface has been incorporated into the S1D13506. The MediaPlug Slave follows the Specification For Winnov MediaPlug Slave, Local module, Document Rev 0.3 with the following exceptions. 17.1 Revision Code The MediaPlug Slave Revision Code can be determined by reading bits 11:8 of the LCMD register. The revision code for this implementation is 0011b. 17.2 How to enable the MediaPlug Slave The MediaPlug Slave interface uses the upper eight pins of the LCD data bus (FPDAT[15:8]) for the data bus, clock, and control lines. When pin MD13 is high at the rising edge of RESET#, FPDAT[15:8] are dedicated to the MediaPlug interface. Table 17-1: MediaPlug Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names IO Type MediaPlug I/F FPDAT8 O VMPLCTL FPDAT9 I VMPRCTL FPDAT10 IO VMPD0 FPDAT11 IO VMPD1 FPDAT12 IO VMPD2 FPDAT13 IO VMPD3 FPDAT14 O VMPCLK FPDAT15 O VMPCLKN DRDY or MA11 O VMPEPWR Note If MediaPlug is enabled, any 16-bit LCD panel must use an external circuit to support FPDAT[15:8]. Either pin MA11 or pin DRDY can be configured as the MediaPlug power control output, VMPEPWR. This is selected by the states of MD14, MD7, MD6 at the rising edge of RESET# - see Table 5-6:, “Summary of Power-On/Reset Options,” on pag e39. VMPEPWR is controlled by bit 1 of the MediaPlug LCMD register. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 213 18 Clocking 18.1 Frame Rate Calculation 18.1.1 LCD Frame Rate Calculation The maximum LCD frame rate is calculated using the following formula. LCD PCLKmax max. LCD Frame Rate = --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------LVDP ( LHDP + LHNDP ) × ---------------- + LVNDP n Where: LCD PCLKmax= maximum LCD pixel clock frequency LVDP = LCD Vertical Display Height = (REG[039h] bits [1:0], REG[038h] bits [7:0]) + 1 LVNDP = LCD Vertical Non-Display Period = REG[03Ah] bits [5:0] + 1 LHDP = LCD Horizontal Display Width = (REG[032h] bits [6:0] + 1) x 8Ts LHNDP = LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period = (REG[034h] bits [4:0] + 1) x 8Ts Ts = minimum LCD pixel clock (LPCLK) period n = 1 for single panel = 2 for dual panel Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 214 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 18.1.2 CRT Frame Rate Calculation The maximum CRT frame rate is calculated using the following formula. CRT PCLK max max. CRT Frame Rate = --------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------( CHDP + CHNDP ) × ( CVDP + CVNDP ) Where: CRT PCLKmax= maximum CRT pixel clock frequency S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 CVDP = CRT Vertical Display Height = (REG[057h] bits [1:0], REG[056h] bits [7:0]) + 1 CVNDP = CRT Vertical Non-Display Period = REG[058h] bits [6:0] + 1 CHDP = CRT Horizontal Display Width = (REG[050h] bits [6:0] + 1) x 8Ts CHNDP = CRT Horizontal Non-Display Period = (REG[052h] bits [5:0] + 1) x 8Ts Ts = minimum CRT pixel clock (CPCLK) period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 215 18.1.3 TV Frame Rate Calculation The maximum TV frame rate is calculated using the following formula. TV PCLK max max. TV Frame Rate = ---------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------------( THDP + THNDP ) × ( TVDP + TVNDP + 0.5 ) Where: TV PCLKmax= maximum TV pixel clock frequency TVDP = TV Vertical Display Height = (REG[057h] bits [1:0], REG[056h] bits [7:0]) + 1 TVNDP = TV Vertical Non-Display Period = REG[058h] bits [6:0] + 1 THDP = TV Horizontal Display Width = (REG[050h] bits [6:0] + 1) x 8Ts THNDP = TV Horizontal Non-Display Period = (REG[052h] bits [5:0] x 8Ts) + 6 for NTSC output = (REG[052h] bits [5:0] x 8Ts) + 7 for PAL output Ts = minimum TV pixel clock (TPCLK) period Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 216 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 18.2 Example Frame Rates For all example frame rates the following conditions apply: • Dual panel buffer is enabled for dual panel. • TV flicker filter is enabled for TV. • MCLK is 40MHz. 18.2.1 Frame Rates for 640x480 with EISD Disabled Table 18-1: Frame Rates for 640x480 with EISD Disabled LCD Type Ink (pixels) (lines) 640 480 No 640 No 640 No No Passive Single / TFT Mono Passive Dual Color Passive Dual Passive Single / TFT Mono Passive Dual Color Passive Dual Horiz Vert Res Res max max min min Frame CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) Ink (Hz) Horiz Vert Res Res (pixels) (lines) bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) 4 40 56 1 119 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 480 8 40 64 1 118 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 480 16 34 56 1 101 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 640 480 4 40 64 1 235 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- No 640 480 8 40 72 1 233 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- No 640 480 16 27 56 1 161 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- No 640 480 4 35 64 1 206 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- No 640 480 8 33 64 1 194 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- No 640 480 16 23 48 1 138 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 4 40 56 1 119 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 8 40 64 1 118 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 16 30 48 1 90 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 4 39 64 1 229 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 8 31 56 1 184 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 16 22 48 1 132 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 4 31 56 1 184 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 8 26 48 1 156 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 640 480 16 20 40 1 122 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT No 640 480 4 36 192 29 85 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT No 640 480 8 36 192 29 85 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT No 640 480 16 36 192 29 85 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- NTSC TV No 640 480 16 14.32 270 22 62 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- PAL TV No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- PAL TV No 640 480 16 17.73 495 72 56 = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 217 Table 18-1: Frame Rates for 640x480 with EISD Disabled (Continued) LCD Type Ink Horiz Vert Res Res (pixels) (lines) max max min min Frame CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) Ink (Hz) Horiz Vert Res Res (pixels) (lines) bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT Yes 640 480 4 36 192 29 85 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT Yes 640 480 8 36 192 29 85 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT Yes 640 480 16 31.5 200 20 75 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- NTSC TV Yes 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- NTSC TV Yes 640 480 16 14.32 270 22 62 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- PAL TV Yes 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- PAL TV Yes 640 480 16 17.73 495 72 56 = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled 18.2.2 Frame Rates for 800x600 with EISD Disabled Table 18-2: Frame Rates for 800x600 with EISD Disabled LCD Type Color Passive Dual Color Passive Dual Ink Horiz Vert Res Res (pixels) (lines) No 800 600 No 800 No 800 Yes max min min max CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) Ink (Hz) Horiz Vert Res Res (pixels) (lines) bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) 4 40 64 1 153 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 600 8 33 64 1 126 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 600 16 23 48 1 90 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- 800 600 4 31 56 1 120 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 800 600 8 26 48 1 101 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- Yes 800 600 16 20 40 1 79 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT No 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT No 800 600 16 36 224 25 56 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT Yes 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- -- CRT Yes 800 600 16 31.5 224 25 49 = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 218 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 18.2.3 Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (640x480) with EISD Enabled Table 18-3: Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (640x480) with EISD Enabled LCD Type Ink Horiz Vert Res Res max max min min Frame CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) Ink Horiz Vert Res Res bpp PCLK( HNDP VNDP Frame Rate MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) (pixels) (lines) No 320 240 16 9.7 40 1 111 CRT No 640 240 16 9.7 40 1 59 No 640 480 4 40 112 1 No 640 480 8 27 96 1 Color Passive Dual No 640 480 8 18 72 TFT No 800 600 8 27 Color Passive Dual No 800 600 4 27 No 800 600 8 18 72 1 68 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 480 4 32 88 1 91 CRT No 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 8 20 72 1 58 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 25 80 1 144 CRT No 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 8 17 64 1 100 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 4 22 64 1 129 CRT No 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 8 15 56 1 89 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 800 600 4 22 64 1 84 CRT No 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Passive Single / TFT Color Passive Dual (pixels) (lines) No 640 480 16 25.175 160 44 60 CRT No 640 480 16 25.175 160 44 60 110 CRT No 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 76 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 1 104 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 96 1 50 CRT No 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 80 1 101 CRT No 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 (Hz) No 640 240 8 20 72 1 116 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 No 640 480 4 32 88 1 91 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 No 640 480 8 20 72 1 58 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 No 640 480 4 24 72 1 139 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 No 640 480 8 16 64 1 94 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 No 640 480 4 21 64 1 123 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 No 640 480 8 14 56 1 83 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 No 800 600 4 21 64 1 80 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 240 8 16 56 1 95 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 4 24 64 1 70 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 20 64 1 117 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 8 13 56 1 77 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 4 17 56 1 101 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 640 480 8 12 48 1 72 CRT Yes 640 480 8 25.175 160 44 60 Yes 800 600 4 17 56 1 66 CRT Yes 640 480 4 25.175 160 44 60 Passive Single / TFT Mono Passive Dual Color Passive Dual Color Passive Dual = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 219 18.2.4 Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (800x600) with EISD Enabled Table 18-4: Frame Rates for LCD and CRT (800x600) with EISD Enabled LCD Type Passive Single / TFT Ink Horiz Vert Res Res max max min min Frame CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (pixels) (lines) No 640 240 8 20 72 1 116 CRT No 640 480 4 40 112 1 110 Ink Horiz Vert Res Res bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) (pixels) (lines) No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 CRT No 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 (Hz) No 640 480 8 20 72 1 58 CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 Color Passive Dual 1 No 640 480 8 13 56 1 77 CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 Color Passive Dual No 800 600 4 24 72 1 91 CRT No 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Color Passive Dual 2 No 800 600 8 15 56 1 58 CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 TFT3 No 800 600 8 30 72 28 54 CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 240 8 15 56 1 89 CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 Yes 640 480 4 29 80 1 83 CRT No 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 23 72 1 134 CRT No 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Yes 640 480 8 11 56 1 65 CRT No 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 Yes 640 480 4 19 56 1 113 CRT No 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 No 640 240 4 27 72 1 157 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 No 640 240 8 13 48 1 78 CRT Yes 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 No 640 480 4 27 72 1 78 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 No 640 480 4 21 64 1 123 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Color Passive Dual No 640 480 4 17 56 1 101 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 No 640 480 8 8.8 40 1 53 CRT Yes 800 600 8 40 256 28 60 Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 240 4 20 56 1 119 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Color Passive Dual Passive Single / TFT Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 20 56 1 59 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 17 56 1 101 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 Color Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 14 48 1 84 CRT Yes 800 600 4 40 256 28 60 = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled The FIFO values for these display modes must be set as follows: 1. REG[04Ah] must be set to 1Ah. 2. REG[04Ah] must be set to Fh. 3. REG[04Ah], REG[06Ah] must be set to 30h. REG[04Bh], REG[06Bh] must be set to 32h. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 220 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 18.2.5 Frame Rates for LCD and NTSC TV with EISD Enabled Table 18-5: Frame Rates for LCD and NTSC TV with EISD Enabled LCD Type Passive Single / TFT Ink Horiz Vert Res Res max max min min Frame CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (pixels) (lines) No 320 240 16 5.3 32 1 62 NTSC TV No 640 240 16 9 32 1 55 No 640 480 4 31 120 1 No 640 480 8 18 88 1 Ink Horiz Vert Res Res bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) (pixels) (lines) No 640 480 16 14.32 270 22 62 NTSC TV No 640 480 16 14.32 270 22 62 84 NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 51 NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 (Hz) Mono Passive Dual No 640 480 4 25 104 1 139 NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 8 15 80 1 86 NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Color Passive Dual No 640 480 4 21 88 1 119 NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 8 13 72 1 75 NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Color Passive Dual No 800 600 8 13 72 1 49 NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 480 4 24 96 1 67 NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 20 80 1 115 NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 Yes 640 480 8 12 64 1 70 NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Color Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 17 72 1 99 NTSC TV No 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 Yes 640 480 8 11 64 1 64 NTSC TV No 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 240 4 19 72 1 110 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 240 8 12 64 1 70 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 4 19 72 1 55 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 4 16 64 1 94 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 8 10 56 1 59 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 4 14 56 1 83 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 No 640 480 8 9.3 48 1 56 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 240 4 16 64 1 94 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 Yes 640 240 8 10 56 1 59 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Mono Passive Dual Yes 640 480 4 14 56 1 83 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 Yes 640 480 8 9 48 1 54 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 8 14.32 270 22 62 Yes 640 480 4 12 48 1 72 NTSC TV Yes 640 480 4 14.32 270 22 62 Passive Single / TFT Mono Passive Dual Color Passive Dual Color Passive Dual = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 221 18.2.6 Frame Rates for LCD and PAL TV with EISD Enabled Table 18-6: Frame Rates for LCD and PAL TV with EISD Enabled LCD Type Ink No Passive Single / TFT No Horiz Vert Res Res max max min min Frame CRT/ bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Rate TV (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (pixels) (lines) 640 480 4 31 120 1 84 PAL TV 640 480 8 18 88 1 51 Ink Horiz Vert Res Res bpp PCLK HNDP VNDP Frame Rate (MHz) (pixels) (lines) (MHz) (pixels) (lines) No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 (Hz) Mono Passive No Dual No 640 480 4 25 104 1 139 PAL TV No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 8 15 80 1 86 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 No 640 480 4 21 88 1 119 PAL TV No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 Color Passive No Dual 640 480 8 13 72 1 75 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 No 800 600 8 16 72 1 60 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 No 800 600 8 23 88 1 43 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 Passive Yes Single / TFT 640 480 4 24 96 1 67 PAL TV No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 Mono Passive Yes Dual Yes 640 480 4 20 80 1 115 PAL TV No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 8 12 64 1 70 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 Color Passive Yes Dual Yes 640 480 4 17 72 1 99 PAL TV No 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 8 11 64 1 64 PAL TV No 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 TFT No 640 240 4 19 72 1 110 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 Passive No Single / TFT 640 240 8 12 64 1 70 PAL TV Yes 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 No 640 480 4 19 72 1 55 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 Mono Passive No Dual No 640 480 4 16 64 1 94 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 8 10 56 1 59 PAL TV Yes 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 4 14 56 1 83 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 8 9.3 48 1 56 PAL TV Yes 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 Yes Passive Single / TFT Yes 640 240 4 16 64 1 94 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 240 8 10 56 1 59 PAL TV Yes 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 Mono Passive Yes Dual Yes 640 480 4 14 56 1 83 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 640 480 8 9 48 1 54 PAL TV Yes 640 480 8 17.73 495 72 56 Color Passive Yes Dual 640 480 4 12 48 1 72 PAL TV Yes 640 480 4 17.73 495 72 56 Color Passive No Dual No = Example Frame Rates with Ink Layer Enabled Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 222 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 19 Power Save Mode The S1D13506 has been designed for very low-power applications. During normal operation, internal clock networks are dynamically disabled when not required. Similarly, the LCD and/or CRT/TV pipelines are shut down when not required in the selected display mode. Additionally, the S1D13506 has a software initiated power save mode. 19.1 Display Modes The S1D13506 resets with both displays inactive, i.e. neither the LCD nor CRT/TV pipelines are active. The displays are independently enabled/disabled by REG[1FCh] bits 2-0: the CRT/TV is instantaneously enabled/disabled by these bits; the LCD is powered up/down according to the sequences in Section 7.4, “Power Sequencing” on page 78. 19.2 Power Save Mode Power save mode is invoked by setting REG[1F0h] bit 0 to 1. In power save mode, both displays are disabled: the CRT/TV is instantaneously disabled; the LCD is powered down according to the sequences in Section 7.4, “Power Sequencing” on page 78. Access to memory is not allowed and the memory controller merely refreshes the memory in the method selected by REG[021h]. Register access is allowed. 19.3 Power Save Status Bits LCD Power Save Status bit The LCD Power Save Status bit (REG[1F1h] bit 0), when 1, indicates that the panel is powered down. When this bit is 0, the panel is powered up, or in transition of powering up or down. The system may disable the LCD pixel clock source when this bit is 1. This bit is 1 after chip reset. Memory Controller Power Save Status bit The Memory Controller Power Save Status bit (REG[1F1h] bit 1, when 1, indicates that the DRAM interface is powered down - the DRAM is either in self-refresh mode or completely idle. This condition occurs shortly after power save mode is invoked, provided Self-Refresh or No Refresh is pre-selected (see REG[021h] bits 7-6); this condition will never occur if CBR Refresh is selected. When this bit is 0, the DRAM interface is active. The system may disable the memory clock source when this bit is 1. This bit is 0 after chip reset. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 223 19.4 Power Save Mode Summary Table 19-1: Power Save Mode Summary Function LCD Disabled CRT/TV Disabled Power Save Mode Enabled LCD Display Active? no -- No CRT/TV Display Active? -- no No Register Access Possible? Yes Yes Yes Memory Access Possible? Yes Yes No -- Yes LCD LUT Access Possible? Yes CRT/TV LUT Access Possible? -- 1 Yes 2 Yes LCD interface Forced Low -- Forced Low CRT/TV interface -- No Output Current No Output Current DRAM interface Active Active Refresh Only3 Host Interface Active Active Active Note 1. LCD pixel clock required. 2. CRT/TV pixel clock required. 3. Selectable; may observe CBR refresh, self-refresh or no refresh at all. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 224 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 20 Clocks 20.1 Clock Selection The following diagram provides a logical representation of the S1D13506 internal clocks. CLKI BUSCLK CLKI2 0 0 1 ÷2 MCLK 1 00 REG[010h] bit 0 REG[014h] bit 4 01 00 10 11 ÷2 01 ÷3 10 ÷4 11 LCD PCLK REG[014h] bits 1,0 REG[014h] bits 5,4 00 00 01 10 ÷2 11 ÷3 01 x2 10 Enable ÷4 CRT/TV PCLK 11 REG[018h] bits 1,0 REG[018h] bit 7 00 REG[018h] bits 5,4 01 00 10 11 ÷2 01 ÷3 10 ÷4 11 MediaPlug Clock REG[01Ch] bits 1,0 REG[01Ch] bits 5,4 Figure 20-1: Clock Selection S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 225 20.2 Clock Descriptions 20.2.1 MCLK MCLK should be configured as close to its maximum (40MHz) as possible. The S1D13506 contains sophisticated clock management, therefore, very little power is saved by reducing the MCLK frequency. The frequency of MCLK is directly proportional to the bandwidth of the video memory. The bandwidth available to the CPU (for screen updates) is that left over after screen refresh takes its share. CPU bandwidth can be seriously reduced when the MCLK frequency is reduced, especially for high-resolution, high-color modes where screen refresh has high bandwidth requirements. 20.2.2 LCD PCLK LCD PCLK should be chosen to match the optimum frame rate of the panel. See Section 18, “Clocking” on page 213 for details on the relationship between PCLK and frame rate, and for the maximum supportable PCLK frequencies for any given video mode. Some flexibility is possible in the selection of PCLK. Panels typically have a range of permissible frame rates making it possible to choose a higher PCLK frequency and adjust the horizontal non-display period (see REG[052h]) to bring the frame-rate down to its optimal value. 20.2.3 CRT/TV PCLK TVs and older CRTs usually have very precise frequency requirements, so it may be necessary to dedicate one of the clock inputs to this function. More recent CRTs work within a range of frequencies, so it may be possible to support them with BUSCLK or MCLK. TV mode with flicker filter requires PCLK to be twice (2x) the standard NTSC (14.xxxMHz) and PAL (17.xxxMHz) clocks. A clock multiplier is used to create this clock, REG[018h] bit 7 is used to enable it. Note that the clock 2x clock could also be used for CRT support. 20.2.4 MediaPlug Clock The MediaPlug Clock must be twice (2x) the frequency of VMPCLK. For timing see Section 7.7, “MediaPlug Interface Timing” on page 123. VMPCLK is typically in the range 6-8MHz so MediaPlug Clock must be in the range of 12-16MHz. Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 226 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 20.3 Clocks vs. Functions The S1D13506 has five clock signals. Not all clock signals must be active for certain chip functions to be carried out. The following table shows which clocks are required for each chip function. Table 20-1: Clocks vs. Functions Function Required Clocks BUSCLK LCD PCLK CRT/TV PCLK MCLK MediaPlug Clock Register read/write Yes No No No No LCD LUT read/write Yes Yes -- -- -- CRT/TV LUT read/write Yes -- Yes -- -- Memory read/write Yes -- -- Yes -- 2D Operation Yes -- -- Yes -- MediaPlug Registers read/write Yes -- -- -- Yes Power Save -- -- -- -- -- Note The S1D13506 contains sophisticated power management that dynamically shuts down clocks when not needed. S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 227 21 Mechanical Data Unit: mm 128-pin QFP15 surface mount package 16.0 ± 0.4 14.0 ± 0.1 96 65 16.0 ± 0.4 64 14.0 ± 0.1 97 Index 128 33 32 0.4 0.16 ± 0.1 1.4 ± 0.1 0.125 ± 0.1 1 0.1 0~10° 0.5 ± 0.2 1.0 Figure 21-1: Mechanical Drawing QFP15 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Page 228 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-A-001-10 Hardware Functional Specification Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Programming Notes and Examples Document Number: X25B-G-003-03 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 2 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 3 Memory Models . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.1 Display Buffer Location . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 3.2 Memory Organization for 4 Bpp (16 Colors/16 Gray Shades) . . . 3.3 Memory Organization for 8 Bpp (256 Colors/16 Gray Shades) . . 3.4 Memory Organization for 15 Bpp (32768 Colors/32 Gray Shades) . 3.5 Memory Organization for 16 Bpp (65536 Colors/64 Gray Shades) . 4 Look-Up Table (LUT) . . . . . . . . 4.1 Registers . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Look-Up Table Organization . . 4.2.1 Color Modes . . . . . . . . . 4.2.2 Gray Shade Modes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 Virtual Displays . . . . . 5.1 Virtual Display . . . 5.1.1 Registers . . . . 5.1.2 Examples . . . 5.2 Panning and Scrolling 5.2.1 Registers . . . . 5.2.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Power Save Mode . . . . . . . . . . 6.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . 6.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . 6.2.1 Enabling Power Save Mode . 6.2.2 Power Save Status Bits . . . 6.2.3 DRAM Refresh Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 LCD Power Sequencing . . . . . . 7.1 Automatic Sequencing . . . . . 7.2 Manual Sequencing . . . . . . 7.2.1 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . 7.2.2 Enabling the LCD Panel . . . 7.2.3 Disabling the LCD Panel . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer . . . 8.1 Introduction . . . . . . . . 8.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . 8.3 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 16 16 17 17 18 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 19 20 21 24 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 26 27 28 30 31 33 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35 35 35 35 36 37 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38 38 38 39 39 39 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40 . 40 . 41 . 47 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.1 Memory Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.3.2 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4 Writing Cursor/Ink Layer Images . . . . . . . . 8.4.1 Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer Data Format . . . . 8.4.2 Cursor Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.4.3 Ink Layer Image . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.5 Cursor Movement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.5.1 Move Cursor in Landscape Mode (no rotation) . 8.5.2 Move Cursor in SwivelView 90° Rotation . . . 8.5.3 Move Cursor in SwivelView 180° Rotation . . . 8.5.4 Move Cursor in SwivelView 270° Rotation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . SwivelView™ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.1 S1D13506 SwivelView . . . . . . 9.2 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.3 Limitations . . . . . . . . . . . 9.4 Examples . . . . . . . . . . . . 9.5 Simultaneous Display Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 2D BitBLT Engine . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.1 Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2 BitBLT Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.1 Write Blit with ROP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.2 Color Expand BitBLT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.3 Color Expand BitBLT With Transparency . . . . . . . 10.2.4 Solid Fill BitBLT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.5 Move BitBLT in a Positive Direction with ROP . . . . 10.2.6 Move BitBLT in Negative Direction with ROP . . . . . 10.2.7 Transparent Write Blit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.8 Transparent Move BitBLT in Positive Direction . . . . 10.2.9 Pattern Fill BitBLT with ROP . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.10 Pattern Fill BitBLT with Transparency . . . . . . . . . 10.2.11 Move BitBLT with Color Expansion . . . . . . . . . . 10.2.12 Transparent Move Blit with Color Expansion . . . . . . 10.2.13 Read Blit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10.3 S1D13506 BitBLT Synchronization . . . . . . . . . . 10.4 S1D13506 BitBLT Known Limitations . . . . . . . . . 10.5 Sample Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47 . 48 .50 . 50 . 51 . 52 . 53 . 53 . 54 . 54 . 55 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56 .56 .56 .58 .59 . 60 . . 61 . .61 . .68 . . 69 . . 71 . . 76 . . 76 . . 77 . . 79 . . 81 . . 83 . . 85 . . 87 . . 88 . . 90 . . 90 . .92 . .94 . . 94 11 CRT/TV Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 11.1 CRT Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .95 11.1.1 Generating CRT timings with 13506CFG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 11.1.2 DAC Output Level Selection 11.1.3 Examples . . . . . . . . . . 11.2 TV Considerations . . . . . . 11.2.1 NTSC Timings . . . . . . . 11.2.2 PAL Timings . . . . . . . . 11.2.3 TV Filters . . . . . . . . . . 11.2.4 Examples . . . . . . . . . . 11.3 Simultaneous Display . . . . . Page 5 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 95 96 96 96 96 97 97 98 12 MediaPlug . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 12.1 Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99 12.2 Considerations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 100 13 Identifying the S1D13506 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101 14 Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.1 API for 13506HAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2 Initialization . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.1 General HAL Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.2 Advance HAL Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.3 Surface Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.4 Register Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.5 Memory Access . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.6 Color Manipulation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.7 Virtual Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.8 Drawing . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.9 Hardware Cursor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.10 Ink Layer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.2.11 PCI Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3 Porting LIBSE to a new target platform . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14.3.1 Building the LIBSE library for SH3 target example . . . . . . . . . 14.3.2 Building a complete application for the target example . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102 . . . . 102 . . . . 107 . . . . .110 . . . . .115 . . . . .117 . . . . .120 . . . . .122 . . . . .124 . . . . .128 . . . . .130 . . . . .136 . . . . .143 . . . . .149 . . . . 150 . . . . . 151 . . . . . 151 15 Sample Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 152 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 List of Tables Table 2-1: S1D13506 Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-1: Look-Up Table Configurations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 4-2: Suggested LUT Values to Simulate VGA Default 16 Color Palette . Table 4-3: Suggested LUT Values to Simulate VGA Default 256 Color Palette . Table 4-4: Suggested LUT Values for 4 Bpp Gray Shade . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 5-1: Number of Pixels Panned When Start Address Changed By 1 . . . . Table 5-2: Active Pixel Pan Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 6-1: Refresh Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-1: Ink/Cursor Mode . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-2: Cursor/Ink Start Address Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-3: LCD Hardware Cursor Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-4: Ink Layer Start Address Encoding . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-5: LCD Ink Layer Initialization Sequence . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 8-6: Ink/Cursor Color Select . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 9-1: SwivelView Enable Bits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 9-2: LCD Memory Address Offset Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 9-3: LCD Display Start Address Values . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 10-1: BitBLT ROP Code/Color Expansion Function Selection . . . . . . . Table 10-2: BitBLT Operation Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 10-3: BitBLT Source Start Address Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 10-4: Possible Blit FIFO Writes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 10-5: Possible Blit FIFO Writes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 10-6: Possible Blit FIFO Writes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 10-7: Possible Blit FIFO Reads . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Table 14-1: HAL Functions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 . . . . . . . . . . 12 . . . . . . . . . . 20 . . . . . . . . . . 21 . . . . . . . . . . 22 . . . . . . . . . . 24 . . . . . . . . . . 31 . . . . . . . . . . 32 . . . . . . . . . . 37 . . . . . . . . . . 41 . . . . . . . . . . 41 . . . . . . . . . . 48 . . . . . . . . . . 49 . . . . . . . . . . 49 . . . . . . . . . . 50 . . . . . . . . . . 57 . . . . . . . . . . 57 . . . . . . . . . . 58 . . . . . . . . . . 63 . . . . . . . . . . 64 . . . . . . . . . . 65 . . . . . . . . . . 71 . . . . . . . . . . 75 . . . . . . . . . . 83 . . . . . . . . . . 92 . . . . . . . . . .102 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 List of Figures Figure 3-1: Figure 3-2: Figure 3-3: Figure 3-4: Figure 5-1: Figure 8-1: Figure 10-1: Figure 14-1: Pixel Storage for 4 Bpp in One Byte of Display Buffer . . . . . . . . . . Pixel Storage for 8 Bpp in One Byte of Display Buffer . . . . . . . . . . Pixel Storage for 15 Bpp in Two Bytes of Display Buffer . . . . . . . . Pixel Storage for 16 Bpp in Two Bytes of Display Buffer . . . . . . . . Viewport Inside a Virtual Display . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer Data Format . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Move BitBLT Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Components needed to build 13506 HAL application . . . . . . . . . . . Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 . . . . . . . . 16 . . . . . . . . 17 . . . . . . . . 17 . . . . . . . . 18 . . . . . . . . 26 . . . . . . . . 50 . . . . . . . . 78 . . . . . . . 150 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 1 Introduction This guide provides information on programming the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller. Included are algorithms which demonstrate how to program the S1D13506. This guide discusses Power-on Initialization, Panning and Scrolling, LUT initialization, LCD Power Sequencing, SwivelView™, etc. The example source code referenced in this guide is available on the web at www.eea.epson.com. This guide also introduces the Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL), which is designed to simplify the programming of the S1D13506. Most S1D1350x and S1D1370x products have HAL support, thus allowing OEMs to do multiple designs with a common code base. This document will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document and source before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Initialization This section describes how to initialize the S1D13506. Sample code for performing initialization of the S1D13506 is provided in the file init13506.c which is available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 initialization can be broken into three steps. • Enable the S1D13506 controller (if necessary identify the specific controller). • Set all the registers to their initial values. • Program the Look-Up Table (LUT) with color values. This section does not deal with programming the LUT, for details see Section 4, “Look-Up Table (LUT)” . The simplest way to generate initialization tables for the S1D13506 is to use the utility program 13506CFG.EXE which to generates a header file that can be used by Windows CE or the HAL. Otherwise modify the init13506.c file directly. The following table represents the sequence and values written to the S1D13506 registers to control a configuration with these specifications: • 640x480 color format 1 dual passive LCD @ 78Hz. • 16-bit data interface. • 8 bit-per-pixel (bpp) color depth - 256 colors. • 40 MHz input clock CLKI. • CLKI used for BUSCLK (1:1); PCLK (2:1); MCLK (1:1). • 50 ns EDO-DRAM, 2 CAS, 32 ms refresh. Table 2-1: S1D13506 Initialization Sequenc e Register Value [001h] 0000 0000 Enable the Memory/Register Select Bit. Notes See Also [1FCh] 0000 0000 Disable the display outputs. [004h] 0000 0000 [008h] 0000 0000 Setup GPIO as inputs; force low if outputs. The OEM may wish GPIO for other purposes which our example does not accommodate for. Program the Clock Source selects. [010h] 0000 0000 [014h] 0001 0000 [018h] 0000 0010 [01Ch] 0000 0010 [01Eh] 0000 0001 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 In this case we have a single input clock source attached to the CLKI pin. This example uses this as BUSCLK, as MCLK and divide by 2 for PCLK. The CRT clock and MediaPlug clocks are set to CLKI2 reducing power consumption (there is no CLKI2 in this example). If either the CRT or MediaPlug is to be used an input clock must be enabled before accessing the control registers or LUT. Program CPU Wait States. see REG[01Eh] for details Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 Table 2-1: S1D13506 Initialization Sequence (Continued) Register Value [020h] 0000 0000 [021h] 0000 0110 [02Ah] 0000 0001 [02Bh] 0000 0001 [030h] 0010 0110 Program the LCD Panel type and Panel Timing Registers. [031h] 0000 0000 [032h] 0100 1111 Panel width = 16-bit; Color Format = don’t care; Color Panel selected; Dual Panel selected; Passive LCD selected. [034h] 0001 1111 [035h] 0000 0000 [036h] 0000 0000 Horizontal and Vertical Non-display time has been adjusted to provide 78Hz frame rate. [038h] 1101 1111 TFT FPLINE registers = don’t care for passive panels. [039h] 0000 0001 Display height = 480 therefore register = 1DFh [03Ah] 0010 1100 TFT FPFRAME = don’t care for passive panels. [03Bh] 0000 0000 [03Ch] 0000 0000 [040h] 0000 0003 [041h] 0000 0000 [042h] 0000 0000 [043h] 0000 0000 [044h] 0000 0000 [046h] 0100 0000 LCD Start Address should typically be from location 0 in the frame buffer. [047h] 0000 0001 Pixel Pan register is 0 for normal operation. [048h] 0000 0000 [04Ah] 0000 0000 Memory offset register is set to ‘the panel width for normal operation, therefore 640 ÷ 2 for words = 320 words= 140h words [04Bh] 0000 0000 Set FIFO values to 0 for “automatic” calculation. [050h] 0000 0000 Program the CRT/TV Timing control registers. [052h] 0000 0000 All values are = don’t care for this example. [053h] 0000 0000 [054h] 0000 0000 [056h] 0000 0000 [057h] 0000 0000 [058h] 0000 0000 [059h] 0000 0000 [05Ah] 0000 0000 [05Bh] 0000 0000 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Notes See Also Program the Frame Buffer Memory Configuration Registers. see REG[020h] REG[02Bh] for details MOD rate = don’t care; Display width = 640 pixels = 4Fh. Program the Display Output Format and Start Locations for the LCD output. This includes programming the FIFOs. Select 8 bpp in REG[040h] Ensure that the Dual Panel Buffer is enabled REG [41h] bit 0 = 0 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 2-1: S1D13506 Initialization Sequence (Continued) Register Value [060h] 0000 0000 [062h] 0000 0000 [063h] 0000 0000 [064h] 0000 0000 [066h] 0000 0000 [067h] 0000 0000 [068h] 0000 0000 [06Ah] 0000 0000 [06Bh] 0000 0000 [070h] 0000 0000 [071h] 0000 0000 [072h] 0000 0000 [073h] 0000 0000 [074h] 0000 0000 [075h] 0000 0000 [076h] 0000 0000 [077h] 0000 0000 [078h] 0000 0000 [07Ah] 0000 0000 [07Bh] 0000 0000 [07Ch] 0000 0000 [07Eh] 0000 0000 [080h] 0000 0000 [081h] 0000 0000 [082h] 0000 0000 [083h] 0000 0000 [084h] 0000 0000 [085h] 0000 0000 [086h] 0000 0000 [087h] 0000 0000 [088h] 0000 0000 [08Ah] 0000 0000 [08Bh] 0000 0000 [08Ch] 0000 0000 [08Eh] 0000 0000 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Notes See Also Program the CRT/TV Display Output Format and Configuration Registers including the FIFOs. For this example, these values are = don’t care. Program the LCD Ink Layer/Cursor Control, Position, Color and FIFO registers. For this example, since no Ink Layer or Cursor is used, these registers are = don’t care. Program the CRT/TV Ink Layer/Cursor Control, Position, Color and FIFO registers. For this example, since no Ink Layer or Cursor is used, these registers are = don’t care. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 Table 2-1: S1D13506 Initialization Sequence (Continued) Register Value Notes [100h] 0000 0000 [101h] 0000 0000 Program the 2D acceleration (BitBLT) registers to a known state. [102h] 0000 0000 [103h] 0000 0000 [104h] 0000 0000 [105h] 0000 0000 [106h] 0000 0000 [108h] 0000 0000 [109h] 0000 0000 [10Ah] 0000 0000 [10Ch] 0000 0000 [10Dh] 0000 0000 [110h] 0000 0000 [111h] 0000 0000 [112h] 0000 0000 [113h] 0000 0000 [114h] 0000 0000 [115h] 0000 0000 [116h] 0000 0000 [118h] 0000 0000 [119h] 0000 0000 [1E0]h 0000 0001 Program the Look-Up Table to a known state. [1E2h] 0000 0000 [1E4h] 0000 0000 Selects LUT access to the LCD LUT only. Programming the Look-Up Table is dealt with in a separate section of this document. The init13506.c file shows the example. [1F0h]] 0000 0000 Turn off Power Save Mode [1F4h] 0000 0000 [1FCh] 0000 0001 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Disable Watchdog Timer Enable the Display For this example, enable LCD only See Also see Section Section 4, “Look-Up Table (LUT)” on page 19. ‘ see REG[1FCh] S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3 Memory Models The S1D13506 is capable of several color depths. The memory model for each color depth is packed pixel. The S1D13506 supports 4, 8, 15 and 16 bit-per-pixel (bpp) memory models. 3.1 Display Buffer Location The S1D13506 supports either a 512k byte or 2M byte display buffer. The display buffer is memory mapped and is accessible directly by software. The memory block location assigned to the S1D13506 display buffer varies with each individual hardware platform. For further information on the display buffer, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. 3.2 Memory Organization for 4 Bpp (16 Colors/16 Gray Shades) Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Pixel 0 Bits 3-0 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Pixel 1 Bits 3-0 Figure 3-1: Pixel Storage for 4 Bpp in One Byte of Display Buffer In this memory format each byte of display buffer contains two adjacent pixels. Setting or resetting any pixel will require reading the entire byte, masking out the upper or lower nibble (4 bits) and setting the appropriate bits to 1. Four bit pixels provide 16 gray shades/color possibilities. For monochrome panels the gray shades are generated by indexing into the first 16 elements of the green component of the Look-Up Table (LUT). For color panels the 16 colors are derived by indexing into the first 16 positions of the LUT. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 3.3 Memory Organization for 8 Bpp (256 Colors/16 Gray Shades) Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Pixel 0 Bits 7-0 Figure 3-2: Pixel Storage for 8 Bpp in One Byte of Display Buffer At a color depth of eight bpp each byte of display buffer represents one pixel on the display. At this color depth the read-modify-write cycles of 4 bpp are eliminated making the update of each pixel faster. Each byte indexes into one of the 256 positions of the LUT. The S1D13506 LUT supports four bits per primary color. This translates into 4096 possible colors when color mode is selected. Therefore the displayed mode has 256 colors available out of a possible 4096. When a monochrome panel is selected, the green component of the LUT is used to determine the gray shade intensity. The green indices, with only four bits, can resolve 16 gray shades. Note When a monochrome panel (REG[030h] bit 2 = 0) is selected, a four bpp color depth also provides 16 gray shades and uses less display buffer. 3.4 Memory Organization for 15 Bpp (32768 Colors/32 Gray Shades) Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Red Component Bits 4-0 Reserved Bit 7 Bit 12 Bit 6 Bit 5 Green Component Bits 2-0 Bit 4 Bit 8 Green Component Bits 4-3 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Blue Component Bits 4-0 Figure 3-3: Pixel Storage for 15 Bpp in Two Bytes of Display Buffer At a color depth of 15 bpp the S1D13506 is capable of displaying 32768 colors. The 32768 color pixel is divided into four parts: one reserved bit, five bits for red, five bits for green, and five bits for blue. In this mode the LUT is bypassed and output goes directly into the Frame Rate Modulator. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center When dithering is enabled (REG[041h) bit 1) the full color range is available on all display types. If dithering is disabled the full color range is only available on TFT/D-TFD or CRT displays. Passive LCD displays are limited to using the four most significant bits from each of the red, green and blue portions of each color resulting in 4096 (24 × 24 × 24) possible colors. Should a monochrome panel be used at this color depth, the output sends the five bits of the green LUT component to the modulator for a total of 32 possible gray shades. If dithering is disabled, the maximum number of gray shades is 16. 3.5 Memory Organization for 16 Bpp (65536 Colors/64 Gray Shades) Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Red Component Bits 4-0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Green Component Bits 2-0 Bit 9 Bit 8 Green Component Bits 5-3 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Blue Component Bits 4-0 Figure 3-4: Pixel Storage for 16 Bpp in Two Bytes of Display Buffer At a color depth of 16 bpp the S1D13506 is capable of displaying 65536 colors. The 65536 color pixel is divided into three parts: five bits for red, six bits for green, and five bits for blue. In this mode the LUT is bypassed and output goes directly into the Frame Rate Modulator. When dithering is enabled (REG[041h) bit 1) the full color range is available on all display types. If dithering is disabled the full color range is only available on TFT/D-TFD or CRT displays. Passive LCD displays are limited to using the four most significant bits from each of the red, green and blue portions of each color resulting in 4096 (24 × 24 × 24) possible colors. Should monochrome mode be chosen at this color depth, the output sends the six bits of the green LUT component to the modulator for a total of 64 possible gray shades. If dithering is disabled, the maximum number of gray shades is 16. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 4 Look-Up Table (LUT) This section discusses programming the S1D13506 Look-Up Table (LUT). Included is a summary of the LUT registers, recommendations for color/gray shade LUT values, and additional programming considerations. For a discussion of the LUT architecture, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The S1D13506 is designed with a separate LUT for both the LCD and CRT/TV. Each LUT consists of 256 indexed red/green/blue entries. Each LUT entry is four bits wide. The color depth determines how many indices are used to output the image to the display. 4 bpp uses the first 16 indices, 8 bpp uses all 256 indices, and 15/16 bpp color depths bypass the LUT entirely. In color modes, the pixel values stored in the display buffer index directly to an RGB value stored in the LUT. In monochrome modes, the pixel value indexes into the green component of the LUT and the amount of green at that index controls the intensity. Monochrome mode look-ups are done based on the Color/Mono Panel Select bit (REG[030h] bit 2). The CRT interface receives the RGB values from the LUT even if simultaneous display is used with a monochrome panel. Therefore, it is important to program the R, G, and B components of the CRT LUT either with a unique set of values, or with R, G, and B values all equivalent. 4.1 Registers REG[1E0h] Look-Up Table Mode Register n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a LUT Mode Bit 1 LUT Mode Bit 0 The S1D13506 is designed with a separate LUT for both the LCD and CRT/TV. The LUT Mode register selects which of the LUTs will be accessed by the CPU when reads/writes are made to REG[1E2h] and REG[1E4h]. LUT mode selection allows the LUTs to be individually written or have identical data written to both LUTs. Individual writes to these registers are useful for Epson Independent Simultaneous Display (EISD) modes where independent images are displayed on the LCD and the CRT/TV. For further information on Epson Independent Simultaneous Display, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. For normal operation, this register should be set to 00h which will read the LCD LUT and write both the LCD and CRT/TV LUTs with identical data. For selection of other LUT modes, see REG[1E0h] in the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. REG[1E2h] Look-Up Table Address Register LUT Address Bit 7 LUT Address Bit 6 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 LUT Address Bit 5 LUT Address Bit 4 LUT Address Bit 3 LUT Address Bit 2 LUT Address Bit 1 LUT Address Bit 0 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The LUT address register selects which of the 256 LUT entries will be accessed. Writing to this register will select the red bank. After three successive reads or writes to the data register (REG[1E4h]) this register is automatically incremented by one. REG[1E4h] Look-Up Table Data Register LUT Data Bit 3 LUT Data Bit 2 LUT Data Bit 1 LUT Data Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a n/a This register is where the 4-bit red/green/blue data is written to/read from. With each successive read or write the internal bank select is incremented. Three successive reads from this register will result in reading the red, then the green, and finally the blue values associated with the index set in the LUT address register. After the third read the LUT address register is incremented and the internal bank select points to the red bank again. 4.2 Look-Up Table Organization • The Look-Up Table treats the value of a pixel as an index into an array of colors or gray shades. For example, a pixel value of zero would point to the first LUT entry, whereas a pixel value of seven would point to the eighth LUT entry. • The value contained in each LUT entry represents the intensity of the given color or gray shade. This intensity can range in value between 0 and 0Fh. • The S1D13506 Look-Up Table is linear. This means increasing the LUT entry number results in a lighter color or gray shade. For example, a LUT entry of 0Fh in the red bank results in bright red output while a LUT entry of 05h results in dull red. Table 4-1: Look-Up Table Configurations Display Mode 4-Bit Wide Look-Up Table RED 4 bpp gray 8 bpp gray 15 bpp gray 16 bpp gray 4 bpp color 8 bpp color 15 bpp color 16 bpp color 16 256 GREEN 16 16 BLUE 16 256 16 256 Effective Gray Shades/Colors on an Passive Panel With Dithering Disabled Effective Gray Shades/Colors on a Passive Panel With Dithering Enabled 16 gray shades 16 gray shades 16 gray shades 16 gray shades 16 colors 256 colors 4096 colors 4096 colors 16 gray shades 16 gray shades 64 gray shades 64 gray shades 16 colors 256 colors 32768 colors 65536 colors = Indicates the Look-Up Table is not used for that display mode S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 21 4.2.1 Color Modes In color display modes, the number of LUT entries used is automatically selected depending on the color depth. 4 bpp color When the S1D13506 is configured for 4 bpp color mode the first 16 entries in the LUT are used. Each byte in the display buffer contains two adjacent pixels. The upper and lower nibbles of the byte are used as indices into the LUT. The following table shows LUT values that will simulate those of a VGA operating in 16 color mode. Table 4-2: Suggested LUT Values to Simulate VGA Default 16 Color Palette Index 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 10 ... FF Red 00 00 00 00 0A 0A 0A 0A 00 00 00 00 0F 0F 0F 0F 00 00 00 Green 00 00 0A 0A 00 00 0A 0A 00 00 0F 0F 00 00 0F 0F 00 00 00 Blue 00 0A 00 0A 00 0A 00 0A 00 0F 00 0F 00 0F 00 0F 00 00 00 = Indicates unused entries in the LUT Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 22 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8 bpp color When the S1D13506 is configured for 8 bpp color mode all 256 entries in the LUT are used. Each byte in the display buffer corresponds to one pixel and is used as an index value into the LUT. The S1D13506 LUT has four bits (16 intensities) of intensity control per primary color while a standard VGA RAMDAC has six bits (64 intensities). This four to one difference must be considered when attempting to match colors between a VGA RAMDAC and the S1D13506 LUT. (i.e. VGA levels 0 - 3 map to LUT level 0, VGA levels 4 - 7 map to LUT level 1...). Additionally, the significant bits of the color tables are located at different offsets within their respective bytes. After calculating the equivalent intensity value the result must be shifted into the correct bit positions. The following table shows LUT values that will approximate the VGA default color palette. Table 4-3: Suggested LUT Values to Simulate VGA Default 256 Color Palette Index 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 1A 1B 1C 1D 1E R 00 00 00 00 A0 A0 A0 A0 50 50 50 50 F0 F0 F0 F0 00 10 20 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 A0 B0 C0 E0 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 G 00 00 A0 A0 00 00 50 A0 50 50 F0 F0 50 50 F0 F0 00 10 20 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 A0 B0 C0 E0 B 00 A0 00 A0 00 A0 00 A0 50 F0 50 F0 50 F0 50 F0 00 10 20 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 A0 B0 C0 E0 Index 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 4A 4B 4C 4D 4E 4F 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 5A 5B 5C 5D 5E R F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 D0 B0 90 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 E0 D0 G 70 90 B0 D0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 D0 B0 90 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 F0 F0 B 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 90 B0 D0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 E0 D0 C0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 Index 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 87 88 89 8A 8B 8C 8D 8E 8F 90 91 92 93 94 95 96 97 98 99 9A 9B 9C 9D 9E R 30 40 50 60 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 60 50 40 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 50 50 60 60 70 70 70 G 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 40 50 60 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 60 50 40 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 B 70 70 70 70 70 60 50 40 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 30 40 50 60 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 60 60 Index C0 C1 C2 C3 C4 C5 C6 C7 C8 C9 CA CB CC CD CE CF D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 D8 D9 DA DB DC DD DE R 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 20 20 30 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 G 40 40 40 40 40 30 20 10 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 30 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 B 00 10 20 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 30 30 40 40 40 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 23 Table 4-3: Suggested LUT Values to Simulate VGA Default 256 Color Palette (Continued) Index 1F 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 2A 2B 2C 2D 2E 2F 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 3A 3B 3C 3D 3E 3F R F0 00 40 70 B0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 B0 70 40 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 70 90 B0 D0 F0 F0 F0 F0 G F0 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 40 70 B0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 B0 70 40 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 B F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 B0 70 40 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 40 70 B0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 D0 B0 90 Index 5F 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 6A 6B 6C 6D 6E 6F 70 71 72 73 74 75 76 77 78 79 7A 7B 7C 7D 7E 7F R C0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 B0 00 10 30 50 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 50 30 10 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 G F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 F0 E0 D0 C0 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 10 30 50 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 50 30 10 B B0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 F0 F0 F0 70 70 70 70 70 50 30 10 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 10 30 50 70 70 70 70 Index 9F A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8 A9 AA AB AC AD AE AF B0 B1 B2 B3 B4 B5 B6 B7 B8 B9 BA BB BC BD BE BF R 70 70 70 70 70 70 60 60 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 00 10 20 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 20 10 G 50 50 50 60 60 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 70 60 60 50 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 10 20 30 40 40 40 40 B 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 50 60 60 70 70 70 70 40 40 40 40 40 30 20 10 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 Index DF E0 E1 E2 E3 E4 E5 E6 E7 E8 E9 EA EB EC ED EE EF F0 F1 F2 F3 F4 F5 F6 F7 F8 F9 FA FB FC FD FE FF R 20 20 30 30 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 30 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 G 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 30 30 30 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 30 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 B 40 40 40 40 40 40 30 30 30 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 20 30 30 30 40 40 40 40 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 00 15 bpp color The Look-Up Table is bypassed at this color depth, hence programming the LUT is not required. 16 bpp color The Look-Up Table is bypassed at this color depth, hence programming the LUT is not required. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 24 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.2.2 Gray Shade Modes This discussion of gray shade (monochrome) modes only applies to the panel interface. Monochrome mode is selected when REG[030h] bit 2 returns a 0. In this mode the value output to the panel is derived solely from the green component of the LUT. The CRT/TV image is formed from all three LUT components (RGB). Note In order to match the colors on a CRT/TV with the colors on a monochrome panel when displaying identical images on the panel and CRT/TV, the red and blue components of the LUT must be set to the same intensity as the green component. 4 bpp gray shade The 4 bpp gray shade mode uses the green component of the first 16 LUT entries. The remaining indices of the LUT are unused. Table 4-4: Suggested LUT Values for 4 Bpp Gray Shade Index 00 01 02 03 04 05 06 07 08 09 0A 0B 0C 0D 0E 0F 10 ... FF Red 00 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 A0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 00 00 00 Green 00 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 A0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 00 00 00 Blue 00 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 A0 B0 C0 D0 E F0 00 00 00 Required to match CRT to panel Unused entries S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 25 8 bpp gray shade The 8 bpp gray shade mode uses the green component of the first 16 LUT entries. The green portion of the LUT provides 16 possible intensities. There is no increase in gray shades when selecting 8 bpp mode over 4 bpp mode; however, Swivelview and the BitBLT engine can be used in 8 bpp mode but not in 4 bpp mode. 15 bpp gray shade The Look-Up Table is bypassed at this color depth, hence programming the LUT is not required. As with 8 bpp there are limitations to the colors which can be displayed. In this mode the five bits of green are used to set the absolute intensity of the image. This results in 32 gray shades when dithering is enabled and 16 gray shades when dithering is disabled. 16 bpp gray shade The Look-Up Table is bypassed at this color depth, hence programming the LUT is not required. As with 8 bpp there are limitations to the colors which can be displayed. In this mode the six bits of green are used to set the absolute intensity of the image. This results in 64 gray shades when dithering is enabled and 16 gray shades when dithering is disabled. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 26 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5 Virtual Displays This section discusses the concept of a virtual display and covers navigation within a virtual display using panning and scrolling. 5.1 Virtual Display Virtual display is where the image to be viewed is larger than the physical display. This can be in the horizontal, vertical or both dimensions. To view the image, the display is used as a window (or viewport) into the display buffer. At any given time only a portion of the image is visible. Panning and scrolling are used to view the full image. For further information on panning and scrolling, see Section 5.2, “Panning and Scrolling” on page 30. The Memory Address Offset registers determine the number of horizontal pixels in the virtual image. The offset registers can be set for a maximum of 211 or 2048 words. At a color depth of 4 bpp, 2048 words cover 8,192 pixels. At a color depth of 16 bpp, 2048 words cover 2048 pixels. The maximum number of lines of the virtual image is the size of the display buffer divided by the number of bytes per horizontal line. The number of bytes per line equals the number of words in the offset register multiplied by two. At the maximum horizontal size, the greatest number of lines that can be displayed using 2M bytes of display memory is 512. Reducing the horizontal size makes more display buffer available, thus increasing the available virtual vertical size. In addition to the calculated limit, the virtual vertical size is limited by the size and location of the Dual Panel Buffer and the Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor (if present). The maximum horizontal/vertical sizes are seldom used. Figure 5-1: “Viewport Inside a Virtual Display,” shows a more typical use of a virtual display. With a display panel of 320x240 pixels, an image of 640x480 pixels can be viewed by navigating a 320x240 pixel viewport around the image using panning and scrolling. 320x240 Viewport 640x480 “Virtual” Display Figure 5-1: Viewport Inside a Virtual Display S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 27 5.1.1 Registers REG[046h] LCD Memory Address Offset Register 0 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 7 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 6 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 5 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 4 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 3 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 2 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 1 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 0 n/a LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 10 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 9 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 8 REG[047h] LCD Memory Address Offset Register 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a These registers form the 11-bit memory address offset for the LCD display. This offset equals the number of words from the beginning of one line of the LCD display to the beginning of the next line. To maintain a constant virtual width as color depth changes, the memory address offset must also change. At a color depth of 4 bpp each word contains 4 pixels, at 16 bpp each word contains one pixel. The formula to determine the value for the memory address registers is: = PixelsPerVirtualLine ÷ PixelsPerWord Offset This value may not necessarily represent the number of words shown on the LCD display. This is the virtual width of the display image and may be greater than or equal to the physical display width. If PixelsPerVirtualLine equals the physical display width as set in the LCD Horizontal Display Width register (REG[032h]), then the virtual display and physical display are the same size. REG[066h] CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Register 0 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 7 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 6 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 5 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 4 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 3 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 2 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 1 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 0 n/a CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 10 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 9 CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 8 REG[067h] CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Register 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a These registers form the 11-bit memory address offset for the CRT/TV display. This offset equals the number of words form the beginning of one line of the CRT/TV display to the beginning of the next line. To maintain a constant virtual width as color depth changes, the memory address offset must also change. At a color depth of 4 bpp each word contains 4 pixels, at 16 bpp each word contains one pixel. The formula to determine the value for the memory address registers is: Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 28 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Offset = PixelsPerVirtualLine ÷ PixelsPerWord This value may not necessarily represent the number of words shown on the CRT/TV display. This is the virtual width of the display image and may be greater than or equal to the physical display width. If PixelsPerVirtualLine equals the physical display width as set in the CRT/TV Horizontal Display Width register (REG[050h]), then the virtual display and physical display are the same size. 5.1.2 Examples Example 1: Determine the offset value required for a line of 800 pixels at a color depth of 8 bpp. At a color depth of 8 bpp each byte contains one pixel, therefore each word contains two pixels. PixelsPerWord = 16 ÷ bpp = 16 ÷ 8 =2 To calculate the offset value for this example, the following formula is used. Offset = PixelsPerVirtualLine ÷ PixelsPerWord = 800 ÷ 2 = 400 = 190h words For the LCD, REG[047h] is set to 01h and REG[046h] is set to 90h. For the CRT/TV, REG[067h] is set to 01h and REG[066h] is set to 90h. Example 2: Program the Memory Address Offset Registers to support a 16 color (4 bpp) 800x600 virtual display on a 640x480 LCD panel. To create a virtual display the offset registers must be programmed to the horizontal size of the larger “virtual” image. After determining the amount of memory used by each line (see example 1), calculate whether there is enough memory to support the desired number of lines. 1. Initialize the S1D13506 registers for a 640x480 panel. (See Section 2, “Initialization” on page 12). 2. Calculate the number of pixels per word. PixelsPerWord = 16 ÷ bpp = 16 ÷ 4 =4 3. Determine the offset register value. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 29 Offset = PixelsPerVirtualLine ÷ PixelsPerWord = 800 ÷ 4 = 200 words = 0C8h words For the LCD, REG[047h] is set to 00h and REG[046h] is set to C8h. For the CRT/TV, REG[067h] is set to 00h and REG[066h] is set to C8h. 4. To confirm whether there is enough memory for the required virtual height, the following formula is used. MemoryRequired = WordsPerVirtualLine x 2 x NumberOfLines = 200 x 2 x 600 = 240,000 bytes This display configuration is supported on a system with the minimum supported memory size of 512K bytes. It is safe to continue with these values. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 30 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5.2 Panning and Scrolling The terms panning and scrolling refer to the actions used to move a viewport about a virtual display. Although the entire image is stored in the display buffer, only a portion is visible at any given time. Panning describes the horizontal (side to side) motion of the viewport. When panning to the right the image in the viewport appears to slide to the left. When panning to the left the image to appears to slide to the right. Scrolling describes the vertical (up and down) motion of the viewport. Scrolling down causes the image to appear to slide up and scrolling up causes the image to appear to slide down. Both panning and scrolling are performed by modifying the start address registers. The start address refers to the word offset in the display buffer where the beginning of the image is displayed from. At color depths less than 15 bpp, another register is required for smooth movement. The pixel pan registers (REG[048h] for LCD, REG[068h] for CRT/TV) allow panning in smaller increments than changing the start address alone. Internally, the S1D13506 latches different signals at different times. Due to this internal sequence, the start address and pixel pan registers should be accessed in a specific order during panning and scrolling operations, in order to provide the smoothest scrolling. Setting the registers in the wrong sequence, or at the wrong time, results in a “tearing” or jitter effect on the display. The start address is latched at the beginning of each frame, so the start address can be set within the vertical non-display period (VNDP). The pixel pan register values are latched at the beginning of each display line and must be set during the vertical non-display period. The correct sequence for programing these registers is: 1. Wait for the beginning of the vertical non-display period - For the LCD, REG[03Ah] bit 7 will return a 1 during VNDP; for the CRT/TV, REG[058h] bit 7 will return a 1 during VNDP. Wait for the transition of the appropriate bit to go from 0 to 1. This ensures the register updates are carried out at the beginning of VNDP. 2. Update the start address registers - For the LCD, REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h]; for the CRT/TV, REG[062h], REG[063h], REG[064h]. 3. Update the pixel panning register - For the LCD, REG[048h] bits 1-0; for the CRT/TV REG[068h] bits 1-0. Sample code for panning and scrolling is available in the file hal_virt.c which is included in the HAL source code available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 31 5.2.1 Registers REG[042h] LCD Display Start Address Register 0 LCD Display Start Address Bit 7 LCD Display Start Address Bit 6 LCD Display Start Address Bit 5 LCD Display Start Address Bit 4 LCD Display Start Address Bit 3 LCD Display Start Address Bit 2 LCD Display Start Address Bit 1 LCD Display Start Address Bit 0 LCD Display Start Address Bit 11 LCD Display Start Address Bit 10 LCD Display Start Address Bit 9 LCD Display Start Address Bit 8 LCD Display Start Address Bit 19 LCD Display Start Address Bit 18 LCD Display Start Address Bit 17 LCD Display Start Address Bit 16 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 3 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 2 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 1 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 0 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 11 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 10 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 9 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 8 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 19 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 18 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 17 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 16 REG[043h] LCD Display Start Address Register 1 LCD Display Start Address Bit 15 LCD Display Start Address Bit 14 LCD Display Start Address Bit 13 LCD Display Start Address Bit 12 REG[044h] LCD Display Start Address Register 2 n/a n/a n/a n/a REG[062h] CRT/TV Display Start Address Register 0 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 7 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 6 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 5 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 4 REG[063h] CRT/TV Display Start Address Register 1 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 15 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 14 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 13 CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 12 REG[064h] CRT/TV Display Start Address Register 2 n/a n/a n/a n/a The Display Start Address registers form the word address to the display buffer where the LCD or CRT/TV starts displaying from. An address of 0 points to the beginning of the display buffer. Changing the start address registers by one pans from 1 to 4 pixels depending on the current color depth. The following table lists the maximum number of pixels affected by a change of one to these registers. Table 5-1: Number of Pixels Panned When Start Address Changed By 1 Color Depth (bpp) 4 8 15 16 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Pixels per Word 4 2 1 1 Number of Pixels Panned 4 2 1 1 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 32 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[048h] LCD Pixel Panning Register n/a n/a n/a n/a Reserved Reserved LCD Pixel Panning Bit 1 LCD Pixel Panning Bit 0 n/a Reserved Reserved CRT/TV Pixel Panning Bit 1 CRT/TV Pixel Panning Bit 0 REG[068h] CRT/TV Pixel Panning Register n/a n/a n/a The pixel panning register offers finer control over panning than is available using the start address registers. Using the pixel panning register, it is possible to pan the displayed image one pixel at a time. The number of bits required to pan a single pixel at a time, change with the color depth. The following table shows the bits of the pixel pan register which are used for each color depth. Table 5-2: Active Pixel Pan Bits Color Depth (bpp) 4 8 15/16 Pixel Pan bits used bits [1:0] bit 0 none Note The pixel panning registers are not required for color depths of 15 or 16 bpp. The pixel panning registers must be updated in conjunction with the start address registers. The pixel panning registers can be thought of as the least significant bit(s) of the start address registers. When panning to the right on an LCD set for a color depth of 4 bpp, the registers would be updated as follows. 1. Pan right by 1 pixel - increment the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 01b. 2. Pan right by 1 pixel - increment the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 10b. 3. Pan right by 1 pixel - increment the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 11b. 4. Pan right by 1 pixel - reset the pixel panning register to 0: REG[048h] = 00b. - increment the start address register by 1: (REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h]) + 1. Note The above example assumes the pixel panning register is initially set at 0. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 33 When panning to the left on an LCD set for a color depth of 4 bpp, the registers would be updated as follows. 1. Pan left by 1 pixel - decrement the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 11b. - decrement the start address register by 1: (REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h]) - 1. 2. Pan left by 1 pixel - decrement the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 10b. 3. Pan left by 1 pixel - decrement the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 01b. 4. Pan left by 1 pixel - decrement the pixel panning register by 1: REG[048h] = 00b. Note The above example assumes the pixel panning register is initially set at 0. 5.2.2 Examples The following examples assume the display system has been configured to view a 800x600 pixel image in a 640x480 viewport. Refer to Section 2, “Initialization” on page 12 and Section 5.1, “Virtual Display” on page 26 for assistance with these settings. Example 3: Panning - Right and Left To pan to the right, increment the value in the pixel panning register (REG[048h] for LCD, REG[068h] for CRT/TV). When the pixel pan value reaches the maximum value for the current color depth (i.e. 11b for 4 bpp, 1b for 8 bpp) then set the pixel pan value to zero and increment the start address value. To pan to the left (assuming the pixel panning register is zero), decrement the value in the pixel panning register and decrement the start address register. When the pixel pan value reaches zero then decrement both the pixel panning register and start address register again. If the pixel panning register contains a value other than zero, decrement the value in the pixel panning register only and when the pixel pan value reaches zero, decrement both the pixel panning register and start address register. Note Panning operations are easier to follow if a variable (e.g. PanValue) is used to track both the pixel panning and start address registers. The least significant bits of PanValue will represent the pixel panning register value and the more significant bits are the start address register value. The following example pans to the right by one pixel when the color depth is 4 bpp. 1. Increment PanValue. PanValue = PanValue + 1 2. Mask off the values from PanValue for the pixel panning and start address register portions. In this case, 4 bpp, the lower two bits are the pixel panning value and the upper bits are the start address. PixelPan Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 = PanValue AND 3 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 34 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center StartAddress = PanValue SHR 2 (remove PixelPan bits) 3. Write the pixel panning and start address register values using the procedure outlined in Section 5.2.1, “Registers” on page 31. Example 4: Scrolling - Up and Down To scroll down, increase the value in the Display Start Address Registers (REG[042h], REG[043h], REG[044h] for LCD, REG[062h], REG[063h], REG[064h] for CRT/TV) by the number of words in one virtual scan line. To scroll up, decrease the value in the Display Start Address Registers by the number of words in one virtual scan line. The following example scrolls down one line for a 16 color (4 bpp) 800x600 virtual image using a 640x480 single panel LCD. 1. Determine the number of words in each line of the virtual image. For a color depth of 4 bpp each byte contains two pixels so each word contains 4 pixels. OffsetWords = PixelsPerVirtualLine ÷ PixelsPerWord = 800 ÷ 4 = 200 = C8h 2. Increment the display start address by the number of words per virtual line. StartAddress = StartAddress + OffsetWords = StartAddress + C8h 3. Separate the display start address value into three bytes. For the LCD, write the LSB to REG[042h] and the MSB to REG[044h]. For the CRT/TV, write the LSB to REG[062h] and the MSB to REG[064h]. For the LCD, REG[044h] is set to 00h, REG[043h] is set to 00h, and REG[042h] is set to C8h. For the CRT/TV, REG[064h] is set to 00h, REG[063h] is set to 00h, and REG[062h] is set to C8h. Note The above example assumes the display start address was initially 0 (the beginning of the display buffer). S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 35 6 Power Save Mode The S1D13506 has been designed for very low-power applications. During normal operation, the internal clocks are dynamically disabled when not required. The S1D13506 design also includes a Power Save Mode to further save power. When Power Save Mode is initiated, automatic LCD power sequencing takes place to ensure the LCD bias power supply is disabled properly. For further information on LCD power sequencing, see Section 7, “LCD Power Sequencing” on page 38. For Power Save Mode AC Timing, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. 6.1 Overview The S1D13506 supports a software initiated Power Save Mode. Enabling/disabling Power Save Mode is controlled using the Power Save Mode Enable bit (REG[1F0h] bit 0). The type of DRAM refresh used during Power Save Mode can also be selected by software. While Power Save Mode is enabled the following conditions apply. • Display(s) are inactive. • Registers are accessible. • Memory is in-accessible. • LUT is accessible. 6.2 Registers 6.2.1 Enabling Power Save Mode REG[1F0h] Power Save Configuration Register n/a n/a n/a Reserved n/a n/a n/a Power Save Mode Enable The Power Save Mode Enable bit initiates Power Save Mode when set to 1. Setting the bit back to 0 returns the S1D13506 back to normal mode. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 36 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6.2.2 Power Save Status Bits REG[1F1h] Power Save Status Register n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Power Save Status Memory Controller Power Save Status The LCD Power Save Status bit is a read-only status bit which indicates the power save state of the LCD panel. When this bit returns a 1, the panel is powered-off. When this bit returns a 0, the LCD panel is powered up or in transition of powering up or down. This bit will return a 1 after a chip reset. Note The LCD pixel clock source may be disabled when this bit returns a 1. REG[1F1h] Power Save Status Register n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Power Save Status Memory Controller Power Save Status The Memory Controller Power Save Status bit is a read-only status bit which indicates the power save state of the S1D13506 DRAM interface. When this bit returns a 1, the DRAM interface is powered down (the DRAM is either in self-refresh mode or completely idle). When this bit returns a 0, the DRAM interface is active. This bit will return a 0 after a chip reset. For this bit to return a 1, the DRAM Refresh Select bits must select either self-refresh or no refresh. For information on the DRAM Refresh Select bits, see Section 6.2.3, “DRAM Refresh Selection” on page 37. Note The memory clock source may be disabled when this bit returns a 1. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 37 6.2.3 DRAM Refresh Selection REG[021h] DRAM Refresh Rate Register Refresh Select Bit 1 Refresh Select Bit 0 n/a n/a DRAM Refresh Rate Bit 2 n/a DRAM Refresh Rate Bit 1 DRAM Refresh Rate Bit 0 The Refresh Select bits specify the type of DRAM refresh used while Power Save Mode is enabled. DRAM refresh selection is as follows. Table 6-1: Refresh Selection Refresh Select Bits [1:0] DRAM Refresh Type 00 CAS-before-RAS (CBR) refresh 01 Self-Refresh 1X No Refresh The Refresh Select bits must be set before Power Save Mode is enabled. While CBR refresh is selected the memory controller cannot be powered down and the memory clock source must remain active. If either self-refresh or no refresh is selected the memory controller may be powered down and the memory clock source may be disabled. For further information, see Section 6.2.2, “Power Save Status Bits” on page 36. Note The Refresh Select bits must not be changed while in power save mode. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 38 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7 LCD Power Sequencing The S1D13506 is designed with internal circuitry which automates LCD power sequencing (the process of powering-on and powering-off the LCD panel). LCD power sequencing allows the LCD bias voltage to discharge prior to shutting down the LCD signals, preventing long term damage to the panel and avoiding unsightly “lines” at poweron/power-off. Proper LCD power sequencing for power-off requires a delay from the time the LCD power is disabled to the time the LCD signals are shut down. Power-on requires the LCD signals to be active prior to applying power to the LCD. This time interval varies depending on the LCD bias power supply design. For example, the LCD bias power supply on the S5U13506 Evaluation board requires 0.5 seconds to fully discharge. Other power supply designs may vary. For most applications automatic power sequencing is the appropriate choice, see Section 7.1, “Automatic Sequencing” . However, there may be situations where the internal time delay is insufficient to discharge the LCD bias power supply before the LCD signals are shut down. For the sequence used to manually power-off the LCD panel, see Section 7.2, “Manual Sequencing” . 7.1 Automatic Sequencing LCD power sequencing is automatically provided when the S1D13506 is powered-on or powered-off using the built-in Power Save Mode. The Power Save Mode is enabled using REG[1F0h] bit 0. For more information on Power Save Mode, see Section 6, “Power Save Mode” . For LCD power sequencing AC Timing, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. 7.2 Manual Sequencing In cases where automatic LCD power sequencing is not applicable, manual sequencing can be done. This section assumes the LCD bias power is controlled through GPIO1. The S1D13506 GPIO pins are multi-use pins and may not be available in all system designs. For further information on the availability of GPIO pins, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-B-001-xx. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 39 7.2.1 Registers REG[040h] LCD Display Mode Register LCD Display Blank n/a n/a SwivelView Enable Bit 1 n/a LCD Bit-per-pixel Select Bit 2 LCD Bit-per-pixel Select Bit 1 LCD Bit-per-pixel Select Bit 0 When set to 1, this bit disables the LCD display pipeline and forces all LCD data outputs to zero. This effectively blanks the screen. Note If a dual panel is used, the Dual Panel Buffer must be disabled before blanking the LCD display. This is done by setting REG[041h] bit 0 to 1b. 7.2.2 Enabling the LCD Panel If the LCD bias power supply timing requirements are different than those timings built into the S1D13506 automated LCD power sequencing, it may be necessary to manually enable the LCD panel. In such a case, the following procedure applies. 1. Enable the LCD signals - Set REG[040h] = 0. Note If a dual panel is used, enable the Dual Panel Buffer by setting REG[041h] bit 0 = 0b. 2. Enable GPIO1 to activate the LCD bias power. 7.2.3 Disabling the LCD Panel If the LCD bias power supply timing requirements are different than those timings built into the S1D13506 automated LCD power sequencing, it may be necessary to manually disable the LCD panel. In such a case, the following procedure applies. 1. Disable the LCD power using GPIO1. 2. Wait the required delay time for the LCD bias power supply to discharge. 3. Disable the LCD signals - Set REG[040h] = 1. 4. Disable the LCD pixel clock source if desired. (Optional) Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 40 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8 Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer 8.1 Introduction The S1D13506 supports either a Hardware Cursor or an Ink Layer for the LCD, and either a Hardware Cursor or an Ink Layer for the CRT/TV. The LCD and CRT/TV are supported independently, so it is possible to select combinations such as a Hardware Cursor on the LCD and an Ink Layer on the CRT/TV. A Hardware Cursor improves video throughput in graphical operating systems by offloading much of the work typically assigned to software. For example, consider the actions which must be performed when the user moves the mouse. On a system without hardware support, the operating system must restore the area under the current cursor position, save the area under the new location, and finally draw the cursor shape. Contrast that with the hardware assisted system where the operating system must simply update the cursor X and cursor Y position registers. An Ink Layer is designed to support stylus or pen input. Without an ink layer, the operating system must save the area of the display buffer (possibly all) where pen input is to occur. After the system recognizes the characters entered, the display would have to be restored and the characters redrawn in a system font. When an Ink Layer is present, the stylus path is drawn in the Ink Layer where it overlays the displayed image. After character recognition finishes the display is updated with the new characters and the ink layer is simply cleared. Saving and restoring the display data is not required providing faster throughput. The S1D13506 Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer supports a 2 bpp (four color) overlay image. Two of the available colors are transparent and invert. The remaining two colors are user definable. The Hardware Cursor uses many of the same registers as the Ink Layer. Additionally, the cursor has positional registers for movement. The cursor resolution is 64x64 at a color depth of 2 bpp. The Ink Layer resolution is the width of the display by the height of the display at a color depth of 2 bpp. Both the Hardware Cursor and the Ink Layer use the same pixel values to select colors. The Hardware Cursor requires 1024 bytes of display buffer and the Ink Layer requires (display width x display height ÷ 4) bytes of display buffer. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 41 8.2 Registers REG[070h] LCD Ink/Cursor Control Register n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 0 n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Mode Bit 0 REG[080h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Control Register n/a n/a n/a n/a The Ink/Cursor mode bits determine which of the Hardware Cursor or Ink Layer is active as shown in following table. Table 8-1: Ink/Cursor Mode bit 1 0 0 1 1 Ink/Cursor Control bit 0 0 1 0 1 Operating Mode Inactive Cursor Ink Reserved Note When cursor mode is selected the cursor image is always 64x64 pixels. Selecting an ink layer will result in an area which completely covers the display. REG[071h] LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Register LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[081h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Register CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 REG[071h] and REG[081h] determine the display buffer location of the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer for the LCD and CRT/TV respectively. The Ink/Cursor Start Address register does not contain an actual address, but a value based on the following table. Table 8-2: Cursor/Ink Start Address Encoding Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] 0 1 - FFh Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Start Address (Bytes) Display Buffer Size - 1024 Display Buffer Size - (n × 8192) S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 42 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[072h] LCD Cursor X Position Register 0 LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[073h] LCD Cursor X Position Register 1 LCD Cursor X Sign n/a n/a n/a LCD Cursor X LCD Cursor X Position Position Bit 9 Bit 8 n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 3 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 2 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 1 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 0 n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 9 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 8 REG[082h] CRT/TV Cursor X Position Register 0 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 7 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 6 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 5 CRT/TV Cursor X Position Bit 4 REG[083h] CRT/TV Cursor X Position Register 1 CRT/TV Cursor X Sign n/a n/a n/a REG[072h], REG[073h] and REG[082h], REG[083h] control the horizontal position of the Hardware Cursor for the LCD and CRT/TV respectively. The value in these registers specify the location of the left edge of the cursor. When ink mode is selected these registers must be set to zero. The Cursor X Position supports values of the range -63 to 1023. Negative values allow for the Cursor to be clipped (partially off the screen). The following procedure sets the Cursor X Position. 1. Write the absolute (non-negative) value of the position in bits 9-0. 2. If the position is negative, write a 1 in the Cursor X Sign bit; otherwise write a 0 to the sign bit. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 43 REG[074h] LCD Cursor Y Position Register 0 LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Position Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[075h] LCD Cursor Y Position Register 1 LCD Cursor Y Sign n/a n/a n/a LCD Cursor Y LCD Cursor Y Position Position Bit 9 Bit 8 n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 3 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 2 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 1 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 0 n/a n/a CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 9 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 8 REG[084h] CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Register 0 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 7 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 6 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 5 CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 4 REG[085h] CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Register 1 CRT/TV Cursor Y Sign n/a n/a n/a REG[074h], REG[075h] and REG[084h], REG[085h] control the vertical position of the Hardware Cursor for the LCD and CRT/TV respectively. The value in these registers specify the location of the top edge of the cursor. When ink mode is selected these registers must be set to zero. The Cursor Y Position supports values of the range -63 to 1023. Negative values allow for the Cursor to be clipped (partially off the screen). The following procedure sets the Cursor X Position. 1. Write the absolute (non-negative) value of the position in bits 9-0. 2. If the position is negative, write a 1 in the Cursor Y Sign bit; otherwise write a 0 to the sign bit. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 44 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[076h] LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Register n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 0 REG[077h] LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Register n/a n/a LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[078h] LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Register n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 0 These registers form the 16 bpp (5-6-5) RGB values of user-defined color 0 for the LCD Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor. REG[07Ah] LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Register n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 0 REG[07Bh] LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Register n/a n/a LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD LCD Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[07Ch] LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Register n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 4 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 0 These registers form the 16 bpp (5-6-5) RGB values of user-defined color 1 for the LCD Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 45 REG[086h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Register n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 4 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 0 REG[087h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Register n/a CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Green Color 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a REG[088h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Register n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 4 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 Bit 0 These registers form the 16 bpp (5-6-5) RGB values of user-defined color 0 for the CRT/TV Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor. REG[08Ah] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Register n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 4 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 Bit 0 REG[08Bh] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Register n/a CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Green Color 1 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a REG[08Ch] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Register n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 4 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 3 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 0 These registers form the 16 bpp (5-6-5) RGB values of user-defined color 1 for the CRT/TV Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 46 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[07Eh] LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Register n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 3 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 2 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 1 LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 2 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 1 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 0 REG[08Eh] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Register n/a n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO High Threshold Bit 3 These registers control the Ink Layer/Hardware Cursor FIFO depth in order to sustain uninterrupted display fetches. REG[07Eh] determines the FIFO high threshold for the LCD Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer. REG[08Eh] determines the FIFO high threshold for the CRT/TV Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer. When this register is set to 00h, the threshold is automatically set in hardware. For further information, see the 13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 47 8.3 Initialization This section describes the process of initializing the S1D13506 for a Hardware Cursor or Ink Layer. 8.3.1 Memory Considerations Both the Hardware Cursor and Ink Layer are positioned in the display buffer by the LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address register (REG[071h]) and CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address register (REG[081h]). The Hardware Cursor and Ink Layer should be allocated the highest possible available memory address. If a Dual Panel Buffer is required, or if another Hardware Cursor or Ink Layer is required, additional memory must be allocated and programmed in the appropriate Ink/Cursor Start Address register. The size of the Dual Panel Buffer is determined by the following. Dual Panel Buffer Size (in bytes) = (Panel Width x Panel Height) x factor ÷ 16 where: factor = 4 for color panel = 1 for monochrome panel Note The dual panel buffer always starts at (Display Memory Size - Dual Panel Buffer Size). The size of a hardware cursor is always 1024 bytes. The size of the ink layer in bytes is (display width x display height ÷ 4). Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 48 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.3.2 Examples Example 5: Initializing the Hardware Cursor The following example places an LCD Hardware Cursor at the end of a 2M byte display buffer. SwivelView™ modes require software rotation of the Ink Layer. This can only occur when a Dual Panel Buffer is not required. Color 0 is set to black, and color 1 is set to white. Note The Hardware Cursor always requires 1024 (400h) bytes. Table 8-3: LCD Hardware Cursor Initialization Sequence Register [070h] [071h] [072h] [073h] [074h] [075h] [076h] [077h] [078h] [07Ah] [07Bh] [07Ch] [07Eh] S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Value 0000 0001 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 1111 0011 1111 0001 1111 0000 0000 Notes Enable LCD hardware cursor Set cursor start address to Memory Size - 1024 Set LCD Cursor X Position to 0 Set LCD Cursor Y Position to 0 Set Color 0 to black Set Color 1 to white Set FIFO High Threshold to default Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 49 Example 6: Initializing the Ink Layer The following example places an Ink Layer at the end of a 2M byte display buffer. SwivelView™ modes require software rotation of the Ink Layer. Color 0 is set to black, and color 1 is set to white. For a system with a 640x480 LCD display, the ink layer size is calculated as follows. InkLayerSize = (PanelWidth x PanelHeight) ÷ 4 = (640 x 480) ÷ 4 = 76,800 bytes The Ink Layer must be allocated in 8K byte blocks. The value of the LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address register is determined from the following table and calculation. Table 8-4: Ink Layer Start Address Encoding Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Start Address (Bytes) 0 Display Buffer Size - 1024 1 - FFh Display Buffer Size - (n x 8192) n = InkLayerSize ÷ RequiredBlockSize = 76,800 ÷ 8192 = 9.375 Fractional values cannot be programmed, therefore round up to an address of 10 (0Ah). This reserves 10 x 8192 = 81,920 bytes for the Ink Layer from the end of display buffer. Note Always round up the Ink/Cursor Start Address when calculating, otherwise insufficient memory will be allocated for the Ink Layer. Table 8-5: LCD Ink Layer Initialization Sequence Register [070h] [071h] [076h] [077h] [078h] [07Ah] [07Bh] [07Ch] [07Eh] Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Value 0000 0010 0000 1010 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0000 0001 1111 0011 1111 0001 1111 0000 0000 Notes Enable LCD ink layer Set cursor start address to 0Ah (Memory Size - (8192 x 10)) Set Color 0 to black Set Color 1 to white Set FIFO High Threshold to default S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 50 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.4 Writing Cursor/Ink Layer Images This section describes how to write images to the Hardware Cursor and Ink Layer. The Hardware Cursor is a 64x64 image at a color depth of 2 bpp. The Ink Layer is the same size as the virtual display (width x height) at a color depth of 2 bpp. The Ink Layer may be described as a non-moveable cursor with the same resolution as the display device. 8.4.1 Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer Data Format The Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer image is fixed at a color depth of 2 bpp. The following diagram shows the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer data format for a little endian system. 2 bpp: bit 7 bit 0 Byte 0 A0 B0 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 Byte 1 A4 B4 A5 B5 A6 B6 A7 B7 P0 P1 P2 P3 P4 P5 P6 P7 Pn = (An, Bn) Panel Display Host Address Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer Buffer Figure 8-1: Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer Data Format The image data for pixel n, (An,Bn), selects the color for pixel n as follows: Table 8-6: Ink/Cursor Color Select (An,Bn) Color 00 Color 0 Ink/Cursor Color 0 Register: For LCD, REG[076h], REG[077h], REG[078h]. For CRT/TV, REG[086h], REG[087h], REG[088h]. 01 Color 1 Ink/Cursor Color 1 Register: For LCD, REG[07Ah], REG[07Bh],REG[07Ch]. For CRT/TV, REG[08Ah], REG[08Bh], REG[08Ch]. 10 Background 11 Inverted Background S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Comments Ink/Cursor is transparent – show background Ink/Cursor is transparent – show inverted background Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.4.2 Page 51 Cursor Image The following procedures demonstrate how to write an image to the Hardware Cursor buffer. Landscape Mode (no rotation) 1. For the LCD cursor, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[071h]. For the CRT/TV cursor, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[081h]. Refer to the REG[071h] and REG[081h] register descriptions for more information. 2. Write the cursor image to the display buffer. The image must be exactly 1024 bytes. SwivelView Modes 1. Save the current state of REG[1FCh] bit 6. 2. Set REG[1FCh] bit 6 to 0. 3. For the LCD cursor, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[071h]. For the CRT/TV cursor, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[081h]. Refer to the REG[071h] and REG[081h] register descriptions for more information. 4. Perform a software rotate of the cursor image. 5. Write the rotated cursor image to the display buffer. The image must be exactly 1024 bytes. 6. Restore the original state of REG[1FCh] bit 6. Note It is possible to use the same cursor image for both LCD and CRT/TV displays. Program the LCD and CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address registers (REG[071h] and REG[081h]) to the same location. This saves some display buffer which would otherwise be used by a second cursor image. Note this saves 8192 bytes of display buffer, not 1024 bytes, because the start address moves in steps of 8192 bytes. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 52 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.4.3 Ink Layer Image The following procedures demonstrate how to write an image to the Ink Layer buffer. Landscape Mode (no rotation) 1. For the LCD, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[071h]. For the CRT/TV, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[081h]. Refer to the REG[071h] and REG[081h] register descriptions for more information. 2. Write the Ink Layer image to the display buffer. The image must be exactly (display width x display height ÷ 4) bytes. SwivelView Modes 1. Save the current state of REG[1FCh] bit 6. 2. Set REG[1FCh] bit 6 to 0. 3. For the LCD, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[071h]. For the CRT/TV, calculate the start address based on the value in REG[081h]. Refer to the REG[071h] and REG[081h] register descriptions for more information. 4. Perform a software rotate of the Ink Layer image. 5. Write the rotated Ink Layer image to the display buffer. The image must be exactly (display width x display height ÷ 4) bytes. 6. Restore the original state of REG[1FCh] bit 6. Note It is possible to use the same Ink Layer image for both LCD and CRT/TV displays. Program the LCD and CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address registers (REG[071h] and REG[081h]) to the same location. This save some display buffer which would otherwise be used by a second Ink Layer. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 53 8.5 Cursor Movement The following section discusses cursor movement in landscape, SwivelView 90°, SwivelView 180°, and SwivelView 270° modes. It is possible to move the top left corner of the cursor to a negative position (-63, -63). This allows the cursor to be clipped (only a portion is visible on-screen). Cursor positions don’t take effect until the most significant byte of the Y position register is written. Therefore, the following register write order is recommended. 1. Set X Position Register 0 2. Set X Position Register 1 3. Set Y Position Register 0 4. Set Y Position Register 1. 8.5.1 Move Cursor in Landscape Mode (no rotation) In the following example, (x, y) represents the desired cursor position. 1. Calculate abs(x), the absolute (non-negative) value of x. 2. Write the least significant byte of abs(x) to X Position Register 0. 3. If x is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(x) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to X Position Register 1. If x is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(x) to X Position Register 1. 4. Calculate abs(y), the absolute (non-negative) value of y. 5. Write the least significant byte of abs(y) to Y Position Register 0. 6. If y is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(y) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to Y Position Register 1. If y is positive, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(y) and write to Y Position Register 1. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 54 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8.5.2 Move Cursor in SwivelView 90° Rotation In the following example, (x, y) represent the desired cursor position. 1. Calculate abs(x), the absolute (non-negative) value of x. 2. Write the least significant byte of abs(x) to Y Position Register 0. 3. If x is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(x) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to Y Position Register 1. If x is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(x) to Y Position Register 1. 4. Calculate a value for y2, where y2 = display width - y - 64. 5. Calculate abs(y2), the absolute (non-negative) value of y2. 6. Write the least significant byte of abs(y2) to X Position Register 0. 7. If y2 is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(y2) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to X Position Register 1. If y2 is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(y2) to X Position Register 1. 8.5.3 Move Cursor in SwivelView 180° Rotation In the following example, (x, y) represent the desired cursor position. 1. Calculate the value of x2, where x2 = display width - x - 64 2. Calculate abs(x2), the absolute (non-negative) value of x2. 3. Write the least significant byte of abs(x2) to X Position Register0. 4. If x2 is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(x2) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to X Position Register 1. If x2 is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(x2) to X Position Register 1. 5. Calculate the value of y2, where y2 = display height - y - 64 6. Calculate abs(y2), the absolute (non-negative) value of y2. 7. Write the least significant byte of abs(y2) to Y Position Register 0. 8. If y2 is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(y2) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to Y Position Register 1. If y2 is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(y2) to Y Position Register 1. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 55 8.5.4 Move Cursor in SwivelView 270° Rotation In the following example, (x, y) represent the desired cursor position. 1. Calculate the value of x2, where x2 = display width - x - 64 2. Calculate abs(x2), the absolute (non-negative) value of x2. 3. Write the least significant byte of abs(x2) to Y Position Register 0. 4. If x2 is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(x2) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to Y Position Register 1. If x2 is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(x2) to Y Position Register 1. 5. Calculate abs(y), the absolute (non-negative) value of y. 6. Write the least significant byte of abs(y) to X Position Register 0. 7. If y is negative, take the value of the most significant byte of abs(y) and logically OR with 80h. Write the result to X Position Register 1. If y is positive, write the most significant byte of abs(y) to X Position Register 1. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 56 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 9 SwivelView™ Most computer displays operate in landscape mode. In landscape mode the display is wider than it is high. For example, a standard display size of 640x480 is 640 pixels wide and 480 pixels wide. SwivelView rotates the display image clockwise in ninety degree increments, possibly resulting in a display that is higher than it is wide. Rotating the image on a 640x480 display by 90 or 270 degrees yields a display that is now 480 pixels wide and 640 pixels high. SwivelView also works with panels that are designed with a "portrait" orientation. In this case, when SwivelView 0° is selected, the panel will be in a “portrait” orientation. A selection of SwivelView 90° or SwivelView 270° rotates to a landscape orientation. 9.1 S1D13506 SwivelView The S1D13506 provides hardware support for SwivelView in 8, 15 and 16 bpp color depths on LCD panels. SwivelView is not supported on CRT or TV displays. Certain conditions must be considered when SwivelView is enabled. • The virtual display offset (scan line) must be set to 1024 pixels (1024 bytes in 8 bpp, 2048 bytes in 15/16 bpp) when SwivelView Enable Bit 0 is set to 1. • The display start address is calculated differently when SwivelView is enabled. • Calculations that would result in panning in landscape mode, may result in scrolling when SwivelView is enabled and vice-versa. 9.2 Registers REG[01FCh] Display Mode Register n/a SwivelView Enable Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a Display Mode Display Mode Display Mode Select Bit 2 Select Bit 1 Select Bit 0 SwivelView Enable Bit 1 n/a Bit-Per-Pixel Select Bit 2 REG[040h] LCD Display Mode Register LCD Display Blank n/a n/a Bit-Per-Pixel Select Bit 1 Bit-Per-Pixel Select Bit 0 The SwivelView modes are enabled using a combination of 2 enable bits - SwivelView Enable Bit 0 (REG[1FCh]) and SwivelView Enable Bit 1 (REG[040h]). The combinations of these bits provide the following rotations. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 57 Table 9-1: SwivelView Enable Bits SwivelView Enable SwivelView Enable Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 Display Rotated (degrees) 0 90 180 270 REG[046h] LCD Memory Address Offset Register 0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[047h] LCD Memory Address Offset Register 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a The LCD Memory Address Offset Registers must be adjusted according to the desired SwivelView rotation and color depth. Set the LCD Memory Address Offset Registers based on the values provided for each color depth in the following table. Panel Width (PW) is the horizontal panel size in pixels (i.e. for a 640x480 panel, PW is 640 regardless of the display rotation). Table 9-2: LCD Memory Address Offset Values SwivelView Enable Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Display Rotated 0 degrees 90 degrees 180 degrees 270 degrees Memory Address Offset Value 15/16 bpp 8 bpp PW PW ÷ 2 1024 512 PW PW ÷ 2 1024 512 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 58 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[042h] LCD Display Start Address Register 0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 REG[043h] LCD Display Start Address Register 1 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 REG[044h] LCD Display Start Address Register 2 n/a n/a n/a n/a The LCD Display Start Address Registers must be adjusted according to the desired SwivelView rotation and color depth. Set the LCD Display Start Address Registers based on the values provided for each color depth in the following table. Panel Width (PW) is the horizontal panel size in pixels. Panel Height (PH) is the vertical panel size in lines (i.e. for a 640x480 panel, PW is 640 and PH is 480 regardless of display rotation). Stride is the based on the previously calculated memory offset in bytes (Stride = MemoryOffset × 2). Table 9-3: LCD Display Start Address Values SwivelView Enable Bit 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 Display Rotated 0 degrees 90 degrees 180 degrees 270 degrees (Stride × LCD Display Start Address Value 15/16 Bpp mode 8 Bpp mode 0 0 (1024 - PW) (1024 - PW) ÷ 2 PH - (Stride - 2 × PW)) ÷ 2 - 1 (Stride × PH - (Stride - PW)) ÷ 2 - 1 (Stride × PH) ÷ 2 - 1 (Stride × PH) ÷ 2 - 1 9.3 Limitations The following limitations apply when SwivelView bit 0 is set to 1 (rotation by 90° or 270°): • Only 8/15/16 bpp modes can be rotated 90 or 270 degrees. • Hardware Cursor and Ink Layer images are not rotated - software rotation must be used. SwivelView must be turned off when the programmer is accessing the Hardware Cursor or the Ink Layer. The blit engine ignores the SwivelView bits also. • Pixel panning works vertically. • It is not possible to rotate an already displayed image. The image must be redrawn. Note Drawing into the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer with SwivelView enabled requires disabling SwivelView, drawing in the Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer buffer, then re-enabling SwivelView. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 59 9.4 Examples Source code demonstrating various SwivelView rotations is provided in the file 13506swivel.c available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. Example 7: Rotate Image 90° for a 640x480 display at a color depth of 8 bpp. Before enabling SwivelView, the display buffer should be cleared. This makes the transition smoother as existing display images cannot be rotated by hardware - a repaint is necessary. 1. Set the line offset to 1024 pixels. The Memory Offset register is the offset in words. Write 02h to REG[047h] and write 00h to REG[046h]. 2. Set the LCD Display Start Address. The Display Start Address registers form a pointer to a word, therefore the value to set the start. Write C0h (192 or (1024 - 480)÷2) to REG[042h], REG[043h] and REG[044h]. That is write C0h) to REG[042h], 00h to REG[043h] and 00h to REG[044h]. 3. Enable SwivelView Bit 0 and clear SwivelView Bit 1. Set REG[1FCh] to 1 and REG[040h] to 0. 4. The display is now configured for SwivelView 90° mode. Offset zero into the display buffer corresponds to the upper left corner of the display. The only difference seen by the programmer is the display offset is now 1024 pixels regardless of the physical dimensions of the display. 5. Draw the desired image. Example 8: Rotate Image 180 degrees for a 640x480 display at a color depth of 16 bpp. Assuming the existing image is unrotated, the display buffer does not have to be cleared. Existing display images are simply be rotated by hardware. In this case a repaint is not necessary. 1. The Memory Offset register does not need to be modified. 2. Set the LCD Display Start Address. The Display Start Address registers form a pointer to a word, therefore the value to set the start. Calculate the value based on the following formula. StartAddress = (ScanBytes × PanelHeight - (ScanBytes - 2 × PanelWidth)) ÷ 2 - 1 = (1280 × 480 - (1280 -2 × 640)) ÷ 2 - 1 = (1280 × 480) ÷ 2 - 1 = 307199 = 4AFFFh Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 60 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Program the LCD Display Start Address Registers. REG[044h] is set to 04h, REG[043h] is set to AFh, and REG[042h] is set to FFh. 3. Set SwivelView Bit 1 by setting bit 4 of REG[040h] 4. The display will now show the previous image rotated by 180 degrees. Offset zero into display memory will correspond to the lower right corner of the display. 5. Draw any new desired image. The drawing software can be completely unaware of the display being rotated. 9.5 Simultaneous Display Considerations Although only the LCD panel image can be rotated, it is possible to simultaneously display an independent image on the CRT or TV display. In this case, the programmer should be aware of the following: • As the LCD display buffer must start at offset 0 when a rotated display is required, the CRT display buffer must be located after the LCD display buffer. • When modifying the CRT display buffer, SwivelView Enable Bit 0 must be cleared and then restored when finished. The following demonstrates this principle. 1. Save SwivelView Bit 0 2. Clear SwivelView Bit 0 3. Draw the CRT/TV image 4. Restore the saved SwivelView Bit 0. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 61 10 2D BitBLT Engine The term BitBLT is an acronym for Bit Block Transfer. During a BitBLT operation data is transferred from one memory location (source) to another memory location (destination). With current graphical user interfaces (GUIs) this term generally refers to the transfer of bitmap images to or from video memory (display buffer). The resulting bitmap image may be derived from up to three items or operands: • the source data. • an optional pattern. • the current destination data. The operands are combined using logical AND, OR, XOR and NOT operations. The combining process is called a Raster Operation (ROP). The S1D13506 2D Accelerator supports all possible 16 ROPs between source data and destination data. The destination is always the display buffer and the source is either data in the display buffer, a pattern in the display buffer, or data provided by the host CPU. The 2D BitBLT Engine in the S1D13506 is designed to increase the speed of the most common GUI operations by off-loading work from the CPU, thus reducing traffic on the system bus and improving the efficiency of the display buffer interface. The 2D BitBLT Engine is designed to work at color depths of 8 bpp, 15 bpp, and 16 bpp. 10.1 Registers The BitBLT control registers on the S1D13506 are located at registers 100h through 119h. The following is a description of all BitBLT registers. REG[100h] BitBLT Control Register 0 BitBLT Active Status BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT Destination Source Linear Linear Select Select The BitBLT Active Status bit has two data paths, one for write and one for read. Write Data Path When this bit is set to 1, the BitBLT as selected in the BitBLT Operation Register (REG[103h]) is started. Read Data Path When this bit is read, it returns the status of the blit engine. When a read from this bit returns 0, the blit engine is idle and is ready for the next operation. When a read from this bit returns a 1, the blit engine is busy. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 62 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[100h] BitBLT Control Register 0 BitBLT Active Status BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT Destination Source Linear Linear Select Select The BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status bit is a read-only status bit. When this bit returns a 0, the BitBLT FIFO is empty. When this bit returns a 1, the BitBLT FIFO contains at least one data. REG[100h] BitBLT Control Register 0 BitBLT Active Status BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT Destination Source Linear Linear Select Select The BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status bit is a read-only status bit. When this bit returns a 0, the BitBLT FIFO is less than half full (contains 7 or less data). When this bit returns a 1, the BitBLT FIFO is half full or greater than half full (contains 8 or more data). REG[100h] BitBLT Control Register 0 BitBLT Active Status BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT Destination Source Linear Linear Select Select The BitBLT FIFO Full Status bit is a read-only status bit. When this bit returns a 0, the BitBLT FIFO is not full (contains less than 16 data). When this bit returns a 1, the BitBLT FIFO is full (contains 16 data). REG[100h] BitBLT Control Register 0 BitBLT Active Status BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT Destination Source Linear Linear Select Select The BitBLT Destination Linear Select bit specifies the storage method of the destination blit. If this bit = 0, the destination blit is stored as a rectangular region of memory. If this bit = 1, the destination blit is stored as a contiguous linear block of memory. REG[100h] BitBLT Control Register 0 BitBLT Active Status BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status (RO) BitBLT FIFO Full Status (RO) n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT Destination Source Linear Select Linear Select The BitBLT Source Linear Select bit specifies the storage method of the source blit. If this bit = 0, the source blit is stored as a rectangular region of memory. If this bit = 1, the source blit is stored as a contiguous linear block of memory. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 63 REG[101h] BitBLT Control Register 1 n/a n/a n/a Reserved n/a n/a n/a BitBLT Color Format Select n/a n/a BitBLT Color Format Select This bit is reserved and must be set to 0. REG[101h] BitBLT Control Register 1 n/a n/a n/a Reserved n/a The BitBLT Color Format Select bit selects the color format that the BitBLT operation is applied to. When this bit = 0, 8 bpp (256 color) format is selected. When this bit = 1, 16 bpp (64K color) format is selected. REG[102h] BitBLT ROP Code/Color Expansion Register n/a n/a n/a n/a BitBLT ROP Code Bit 3 BitBLT ROP Code Bit 2 BitBLT ROP Code Bit 1 BitBLT ROP Code Bit 0 The BitBLT ROP Code/Color Expansion Register selects the Raster Operation (ROP) used for the Write blit, Move blit, and Pattern fill. It is also used to specify the start bit position for BitBLTs with color expansion. The following table summarizes the functionality of this register. Table 10-1: BitBLT ROP Code/Color Expansion Function Selection BitBLT ROP Code Bits [3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 1101 1110 1111 Boolean Function for Write Blit and Move Blit 0 (Blackness) ~S . ~D or ~(S + D) ~S . D ~S S . ~D ~D S^D ~S + ~D or ~(S . D) S.D ~(S ^ D) D ~S + D S S + ~D S+D 1 (Whiteness) Boolean Function for Pattern Fill 0 (Blackness) ~P . ~D or ~(P + D) ~P . D ~P P . ~D ~D P^D ~P + ~D or ~(P . D) P.D ~(P ^ D) D ~P + D P P + ~D P+D 1 (Whiteness) Start Bit Position for Color Expansion bit 0 bit 1 bit 2 bit 3 bit 4 bit 5 bit 6 bit 7 bit 0 bit 1 bit 2 bit 3 bit 4 bit 5 bit 6 bit 7 S = Source, D = Destination, P = Pattern Operators: ~ = NOT, . = Logical AND, + = Logical OR, ^ = Logical XOR Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 64 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[103h] BitBLT Operation Register n/a n/a n/a BitBLT Operation Bit 3 n/a BitBLT Operation Bit 2 BitBLT Operation Bit 1 BitBLT Operation Bit 0 The BitBLT Operation Register selects the BitBLT operation to be carried out based on the following table: Table 10-2: BitBLT Operation Selection BitBLT Operation Bits [3:0] 0000 0001 0010 0011 0100 0101 0110 0111 1000 1001 1010 1011 1100 Other combinations Blit Operation Write Blit with ROP Read Blit Move Blit in positive direction with ROP Move Blit in negative direction with ROP Transparent Write Blit Transparent Move Blit in positive direction Pattern Fill with ROP Pattern Fill with transparency Color Expansion Color Expansion with transparency Move Blit with Color Expansion Move Blit with Color Expansion and transparency Solid Fill Reserved REG[104h] BitBLT Source Start Address Register 0 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 7 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 6 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 5 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 4 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 3 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 2 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 1 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 0 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 11 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 10 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 9 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 8 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 19 BitBLT Source Start Bit 18 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 17 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 16 REG[105h] BitBLT Source Start Address Register 1 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 15 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 14 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 13 BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 12 REG[106h] BitBLT Source Start Address Register 2 n/a n/a n/a BitBLT Source Start Address Bit 20 The BitBLT Source Start Address Registers form a 21-bit register that specifies the source start address for the BitBLT operation selected by the BitBLT Operation Register (REG[103h]). S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 65 If data is sourced from the CPU, then bit 0 is used for byte alignment within a 16-bit word and the other address bits are ignored. In pattern fill operation, the BitBLT Source Start Address is defined by the following equation: Source Start Address Register = Pattern Base Address + Pattern Line Offset + Pixel Offset. The following table shows how Source Start Address Register is defined for 8 and 16 bpp color depths: Table 10-3: BitBLT Source Start Address Selection Color Format 8 bpp 16 bpp Pattern Base Address[20:0] BitBLT Source Start Address[20:6], 6’b0 BitBLT Source Start Address[20:7], 7’b0 Pattern Line Offset[2:0] BitBLT Source Start Address[5:3] BitBLT Source Start Address[6:4] Pixel Offset[3:0] 1’b0, BitBLT Source Start Address[2:0] BitBLT Source Start Address[3:0] REG[108h] BitBLT Destination Start Address Register 0 BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[109h] BitBLT Destination Start Address Register 1 BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[10Ah] BitBLT Destination Start Address Register 2 n/a n/a n/a BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT BitBLT Destination Destination Destination Destination Destination Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Start Address Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 The BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers form a 21-bit register that specifies the destination start address for the BitBLT operation selected by the BitBLT Operation Register (REG[103h]). The destination address represents the upper left corner of the BitBLT rectangle (lower right corner of the BitBLT rectangle for Move Blit in Negative Direction). Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 66 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center REG[10Ch] BitBLT Memory Address Offset Register 0 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 7 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 6 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 5 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 4 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 3 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 2 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 1 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 0 n/a BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 10 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 9 BitBLT Memory Address Offset Bit 8 REG[10Dh] BitBLT Memory Address Offset Register 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a The BitBLT Memory Address Offset Registers form the BitBLTs 11-bit address offset from the starting word of line “n” to the starting word of line “n + 1”. They are used for address calculation only when the BitBLT is configured as a rectangular region of memory using the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits (REG[100h] bits 1-0). They are not used for the displays. REG[110h] BitBLT Width Register 0 BitBLT Width Bit 7 BitBLT Width Bit 6 BitBLT Width Bit 5 BitBLT Width Bit 4 BitBLT Width Bit 3 BitBLT Width Bit 2 BitBLT Width Bit 1 BitBLT Width Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a BitBLT Width Bit 9 BitBLT Width Bit 8 REG[111h] BitBLT Width Register 1 n/a n/a n/a The BitBLT Width Registers form a 10-bit register that specifies the BitBLT width in pixels less 1. Note The BitBLT operations Pattern Fill with ROP and Pattern Fill with transparency require a BitBLT Width ≥ 2. REG[112h] BitBLT Height Register 0 BitBLT Height BitBLT Height BitBLT Height BitBLT Height BitBLT Height BitBLT Height BitBLT Height BitBLT Height Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[113h] BitBLT Height Register 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a BitBLT Height BitBLT Height Bit 9 Bit 8 The BitBLT Height Registers form a 10-bit register that specifies the BitBLT height in pixels less 1. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 67 REG[114h] BitBLT Background Color Register 0 BitBLT Background Color Bit 7 BitBLT Background Color Bit 6 BitBLT Background Color Bit 5 BitBLT Background Color Bit 4 BitBLT Background Color Bit 3 BitBLT Background Color Bit 2 BitBLT Background Color Bit 1 BitBLT Background Color Bit 0 BitBLT Background Color Bit 11 BitBLT Background Color Bit 10 BitBLT Background Color Bit 9 BitBLT Background Color Bit 8 REG[115h] BitBLT Background Color Register 1 BitBLT Background Color Bit 15 BitBLT Background Color Bit 14 BitBLT Background Color Bit 13 BitBLT Background Color Bit 12 The BitBLT Background Color Registers form a 16-bit register that specifies the BitBLT background color for Color Expansion or the key color for transparent blits. For 16 bpp color depth (REG[101h] bit 0 = 1), all 16 bits are used. For 8 bpp color depth (REG[101h] bit 0 = 0), only bits 7-0 are used. REG[118h] BitBLT Foreground Color Register 0 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 7 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 6 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 5 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 4 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 3 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 2 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 1 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 0 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 11 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 10 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 9 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 8 REG[119h] BitBLT Foreground Color Register 1 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 15 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 14 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 13 BitBLT Foreground Color Bit 12 The BitBLT Foreground Color Registers form a 16-bit register that specifies the BitBLT foreground color for Color Expansion or the Solid Fill BitBLT. For 16 bpp color depth (REG[101h] bit 0 = 1), all 16 bits are used. For 8 bpp color depth (REG[101h] bit 0 = 0), only bits 7-0 are used. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 68 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 10.2 BitBLT Descriptions The S1D13506 supports 13 fundamental BitBLT operations: • Write Blit with ROP. • Read Blit. • Move Blit in positive direction with ROP. • Move Blit in negative direction with ROP. • Transparent Write Blit. • Transparent Move Blit in positive direction. • Pattern Fill with ROP. • Pattern Fill with Transparency. • Color Expansion. • Color Expansion with Transparency. • Move Blit with Color Expansion. • Move Blit with Color Expansion and Transparency. • Solid Fill. Most of the 13 operations are self completing. This means once they begin they complete on their own, not requiring data transfers with the CPU. The remaining five BitBLT operations (Write Blit with ROP, Transparent Write Blit, Color Expansion, Color Expansion with Transparency, Read Blit) require data to be written/read to/from the display buffer. This data must be transferred one word (16-bits) at a time. This does not imply only 16-bit CPU instructions are acceptable. If a system is able to separate one DWORD write into two WORD writes, then 32-bit CPU instructions are acceptable. Otherwise, two back to back 16-bit CPU instructions are required. The data is not directly written/read to/from the display buffer. It is written/read to/from the BitBLT FIFO through the 1M blit aperture specified at the address of REG[100000h]. The 16 word FIFO can be written to only when not full and can be read from only when not empty. Failing to monitor the FIFO status can result in a BitBLT FIFO overflow or underflow. While the FIFO is being written to by the CPU, it is also being emptied by the S1D13506. If the S1D13506 empties the FIFO faster than the CPU can fill it, it may not be possible to cause an overflow/underflow. In these cases, performance can be improved by not monitoring the FIFO status. However, this is very much platform dependent and must be determined for each system. Note When TV with flicker filter is enabled or simultaneous display is active, always test the FIFO status before reading from/writing to the FIFO. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 69 10.2.1 Write Blit with ROP The Write Blit increases the speed of transferring data from system memory to the display buffer. The Write Blit with ROP fills a specified area of the display buffer with data supplied by the CPU. This blit is typically used to copy a bitmap image from system memory to the display buffer. The Write Blit supports all 16 ROPs, although the most frequent ROP is ROP 0Ch (Copy Source into Destination). It also supports both Destination Linear and Destination Rectangular modes. The Write Blit requires the CPU to provide data. The blit engine expects to receive a certain number of WORDS. For 15/16 bpp color depths, the number of WORDS is the same as the number of pixels due to the fact that each pixel is one WORD wide. The number of WORD writes the blit engine expects is calculated using the following formula. nWORDS = nPixels = BlitWidth × BlitHeight For 8 bpp color depths, the formula must take into consideration that the blit engine accepts only WORD accesses and each pixel is one BYTE. The blit engine needs to know whether the first pixel of a line is stored in the low byte or high byte. This is determined by bit 0 of the Source Start Address Register 0 (REG[104h]). If the Source Phase is 1 (bit 0 of the Source Start Address Register 0 is set), the first pixel of each line is in the high byte of the WORD and the contents of the low byte are ignored. If the Source Phase is 0, the first pixel is in the low byte and the second pixel is in the high byte. Depending on the Source Phase and the Blit Width, the last WORD may contain only one pixel. In this case it is always in the low byte. The number of WORD writes the blit engine expects for 8 bpp color depths is shown in the following formula. nWORDS = ((BlitWidth + 1 + SourcePhase) ÷ 2) × BlitHeight Note The blit engine counts WORD writes in the blit address space. This does not imply only 16-bit CPU instructions are acceptable. If a system is able to separate one DWORD write into two WORD writes, then 32-bit CPU instructions are acceptable. Otherwise, two back to back 16-bit CPU instructions are required. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 70 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Example 9: Write a 100 x 20 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 25, y = 38 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 8 bpp. 1. Calculate the destination address (upper left corner of the screen blit rectangle) using the following formula. DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (38 × 640) + (25 × 1) = 24345 = 5F19h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 640 for 8 bpp Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 5Fh, and REG[108h] is set to 19h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 100 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 63h (99 decimal). 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 20 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 00h and REG[112h] is set to 13h (19 decimal). 4. Program the Source Phase in the BitBLT Source Start Address Register. In this example the data is WORD aligned, so the source phase is 0. REG[104h] is set to 00h. 5. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Write Blit with ROP. REG[103h] is set to 00h. 6. Program the BitBLT ROP Code Register to select Destination = Source. REG[102h] is set to 0Ch. 7. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 8 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 00h. 8. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS: BltMemoryOffset = DisplayWidthInPixels ÷ BytesPerPixel = 640 ÷ 2 = 140h REG[10Dh] is set to 01h and REG[10Ch] is set to 40h. 9. Calculate the number of WORDS the blit engine expects to receive. nWORDS S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 = ((BlitWidth + 1 + SourcePhase) ÷ 2) × BlitHeight = (100 + 1) ÷ 2 × 20 = 1000 = 3E8h Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 71 10. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation and wait for the blit engine to start. REG[100h] is set to 80h, then wait until REG[100h] bit 7 returns a 1. 11. Prior to writing all nWORDS to the Blit FIFO, confirm the Blit FIFO is not full (REG[100h] bit 4 returns a 0). If the BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status returns a 0 (the FIFO is empty), write up to 16 WORDS. If the BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status returns a 1 and the BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status returns a 0 then you can write up to 8 WORDS. If the BitBLT FIFO Full Status returns a 1, do not write to the BitBLT FIFO until it returns a 0. The following table summarizes how many words can be written to the Blit FIFO. Table 10-4: Possible Blit FIFO Writes BitBLT Control Register 0 (REG[100h]) FIFO Not Empty Status FIFO Half Full Status FIFO Full Status 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 Word Writes Available 16 8 up to 8 0 (do not write) Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is started. 10.2.2 Color Expand BitBLT This Color Expand BitBLT is similar to the Write BitBLT. It differs in that a bit set to 1 in the source data becomes a pixel of foreground color. A source bit set to 0 is converted to a pixel of background color. This function increases the speed of writing text while in graphical modes. This BitBLT operation includes several options which enhance its text handling capabilities. As with the Write BitBLT, all data sent to the blit engine must be word (16-bit) writes. The blit engine expands the low byte, then the high byte starting at bit 7 of each byte. The start byte of the first WORD to be expanded and the start bit position within this byte must be specified. The start byte position is selected by setting source address bit 0 to 0 to start expanding the low byte or 1 to start expanding the high byte. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 72 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Partially “masked” color expand BitBLT can be used when drawing a portion of a pattern (i.e. a portion of a character) on the screen. The following examples illustrate how one WORD is expanded using the Color Expand BitBLT. 1. To expand bits 0-1 of the word: Source Address = 0 Start Bit Position = 1 Blit Width = 2 The following bits are expanded. 15 Word Sent To BitBLT Engine 8 7 7 0 7 High Byte 0 0 Low Byte 2. To expand bits 0-15 of the word (entire word) Source Address = 0 Start Bit Position = 7 (bit seven of the low byte) Blit Width = 16 The following bits are expanded. 15 Word Sent To BitBLT Engine 8 7 7 0 7 High Byte 0 0 Low Byte 3. To expand bits 8-9 of the word Source Address = 1 Start Bit Position = 1 Blit Width = 2 The following bits are expanded. 15 Word Sent To BitBLT Engine 8 7 7 0 High Byte 7 0 0 Low Byte 4. To expand bits 0,15-14 of the word S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 73 Source Address = 0 Start Bit Position = 0 Blit Width = 3 The following bits are expanded. Word Sent To BitBLT Engine 8 7 15 7 0 7 0 0 High Byte Low Byte All subsequent WORDS in one blit line are then serially expanded starting at bit 7 of the low byte until the end of the blit line. All unused bits in the last WORD are discarded. It is extremely important that the exact number of WORDS is provided to the blit engine. The number of WORDS is calculated from the following formula. This formula is valid for all color depths (8/15/16 bpp). nWords = ((Sx MOD 16 + BltWidth + 15) ÷ 16) × BltHeight where: Sx is the X coordinate of the starting pixel in a word aligned monochrome bitmap. Monochrome Bitmap Byte 1 Sx = 0 1 2 3 Byte 2 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 Example 10: Color expand a rectangle of 12 x 18 starting at the coordinates Sx = 125, Sy = 17 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 8 bpp. This example assumes a monochrome, WORD aligned bitmap of dimensions 300 x 600 with the origin at an address A. The color expanded rectangle will be displayed at the screen coordinates X = 20, Y = 30. The foreground color corresponds to the LUT entry at index 134, the background color to index 124. 1. First we need to calculate the address of the WORD within the monochrome bitmap containing the pixel x = 125,y = 17. SourceAddress Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 = BitmapOrigin + (y × SourceStride) + (x ÷ 8) = A + (Sy × SourceStride) + (Sx ÷ 8) = A + (17 × 38) + (125 ÷ 8) = A + 646 + 15 = A + 661 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 74 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center where: SourceStride = (BitmapWidth + 15) ÷ 16 = (300 + 15) ÷ 16 = 19 WORDS per line = 38 BYTES per line 2. Calculate the destination address (upper left corner of the screen blit rectangle) using the following formula. DestinationAddress = (Y × ScreenStride) + (X × BytesPerPixel) = (30 × 640) + (20 × 1) = 19220 = 4B14h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 640 for 8 bpp Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 4Bh, and REG[108h] is set to 14h. 3. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 12 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h, REG[110h] is set to 0Bh (11 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 18 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 00h, REG[112h] is set to 11h (17 decimal). 5. Program the Source Phase in the BitBLT Source Start Address Register. In this example the source address equals A + 661 (odd), so REG[104h] is set to 1. Since only bit 0 flags the source phase, more efficient code would simply write the low byte of the SourceAddress into REG[104h] directly -- not needing to test for an odd/even address. Note that in 15/16 bpp color depths the Source address is guaranteed to be even. 6. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Color Expand Blit. REG[103h] is set to 08h. 7. Program the Color Expansion Register. The formula for this example is as follows. Reg[102h] = 7 - (Sx MOD 8) = 7 - (125 MOD 8) =7-5 =2 REG[102h] is set to 02h. 8. Program the Background Color Registers to the background color. REG[115h] is set to 00h and REG[114h] is set to 7Ch (124 decimal). Note that for 15/16 bpp color depths, REG[115h] and REG[114h] are both required and programmed directly with the value of the background color. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 75 9. Program the Foreground Color Registers to the foreground color. REG[119h] is set to 00h and REG[118h] is set to 86h (134 decimal). Note that for 15/16 bpp color depths REG[119h] and Reg[118h] are both required and programmed directly with the value of the foreground color. 10. Program the BitBLT Color Format Register for 8 bpp operation. REG[101h] is set to 00h. 11. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 ÷ 2 = 140h REG[10Dh] is set to 01h and REG[10Ch] is set to 40h. 12. Calculate the number of WORDS the blit engine expects to receive. First, the number of WORDS in one blit line must be calculated as follows. nWordsOneLine = ((125 MOD 16) + 12 + 15) ÷ 16 = (13 + 12 + 15) ÷ 16 = 40 ÷ 16 =2 Therefore, the total WORDS the blit engine expects to receive is calculated as follows. nWords = nWordsOneLine × 18 = 2 × 18 = 36 13. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation and wait for the Blit Engine to start. REG[100h] is set to 80h, then wait until REG[100h] bit 7 returns a 1. 14. Prior to writing all nWORDS to the Blit FIFO, confirm the Blit FIFO is not full (REG[100h] bit 4 returns a 0). One WORD expands into 16 pixels which fills all 16 FIFO words in 15/16 bpp or 8 FIFO words in 8 bpp. The following table summarizes how many words can be written to the Blit FIFO. Table 10-5: Possible Blit FIFO Writes BitBLT Control Register 0 (REG[100h]) FIFO Not Empty Status FIFO Half Full Status FIFO Full Status 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 8 bpp Word Writes Available 16 bpp Word Writes Available 2 1 1 0 (do not write) 0 (do not write) S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 76 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.3 Color Expand BitBLT With Transparency This BitBLT operation is virtually identical to the Color Expand BitBLT, except the background color is completely ignored. All bits set to 1 in the source monochrome bitmap are color expanded to the foreground color. All bits set to 0 that would be expanded to the background color in the Color Expand BitBLT are not expanded at all. Program REG[103h] to 09h instead of 08h. Programming the background color is not required. 10.2.4 Solid Fill BitBLT The Solid Fill BitBLT fills a rectangular area of the display buffer with a solid color. This operation is used to paint large screen areas or to set areas of the display buffer to a given value. Example 11: Fill a red 9 x 321 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 100, y = 10 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 16 bpp. 1. Calculate the destination address (upper left corner of the destination rectangle) using the following formula. DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (10 × (640 × 2)) + (100 × 2) = 13000 = 32C8h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 1280 for 16 bpp. Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 32h, and REG[108h] is set to C8h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 9 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 08h. 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 321 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 01h and REG[112h] is set to 40h (320 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Foreground Color Registers. REG[119h] is set to F8h and REG[118h] is set to 00h (Full intensity red in 16 bpp is F800h). 5. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select Solid Fill. REG[103h] is set to 0Ch. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 77 6. Program the BitBLT Color Format Register for 16 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 01h. 7. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 = 280h REG[10Dh] is set to 02h and REG[10Ch] is set to 80h. 8. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.5 Move BitBLT in a Positive Direction with ROP The Move BitBLT moves an area of the display buffer to a different area of the display buffer. This operation has two intended purposes: • Copying unattended display buffer to display buffer. • Saving a visible bitmap to off-screen display buffer. The Move BitBLT may move data from one rectangular area to another, or it may be specified as linear. This allows the temporary saving of a portion of the visible display buffer to an area off-screen. The linear configuration may be applied to the source or destination. Defining the Move BitBLT as linear allows each line of the Move BitBLT area to be placed directly after the previous line, rather than requiring a complete row of address space for each line. Note When the destination area overlaps the original source area and the destination address is greater then the source address, use the Move BitBLT in Negative Direction with ROP. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 78 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center S D D S Destination Address less than Source Address Destination Address greater than Source Address Use Move BitBLT in Positive Direction Use Move BitBLT in Negative Direction Figure 10-1: Move BitBLT Usage Example 12: Copy a 9 x 321 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 100, y = 10 to screen coordinates x = 200, y = 20 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 16 bpp. 1. Calculate the source and destination addresses (upper left corners of the source and destination rectangles), using the following formula. SourceAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (10 × (640 × 2)) + (100 × 2) = 13000 = 32C8h DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (20 × (640 × 2)) + (200 × 2) = 26000 = 6590h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 1280 for 16 bpp Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 00h, REG[105h] is set to 32h, and REG[104h] is set to C8h. Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 65h, and REG[108h] is set to 90h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 9 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 08h. 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 321 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 01h and REG[112h] is set to 40h (320 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Move BitBLT in Positive Direction with ROP. REG[103h] is set to 02h. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 79 5. Program the BitBLT ROP Code Register to select Destination = Source. REG[102h] is set to 0Ch. 6. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 16 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 01h. 7. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 = 280h REG[10Dh] is set to 02h and REG[10Ch] is set to 80h. 8. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.6 Move BitBLT in Negative Direction with ROP The Move BitBLT in Negative Direction with ROP is very similar to the Move BitBLT in Positive direction and must be used when the source and destination blit areas overlap and the destination address is greater then the source address. Note For the Move BitBLT in Negative Direction it is necessary to calculate the addresses of the last pixel as opposed to the first pixel. This means calculating the addresses of the lower right corners as opposed to the upper left corners. Example 13: Copy a 9 x 321 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 100, y = 10 to screen coordinates X = 105, Y = 20 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 16 bpp. In the following example, the coordinates of the source and destination rectangles intentionally overlap. 1. Calculate the source and destination addresses (lower right corners of the source and destination rectangles) using the following formula. SourceAddress = ((y + Height - 1) × ScreenStride) + ((x + Width - 1) × BytesPerPixel) = ((10 + 321 - 1) × (640 × 2)) + ((100 + 9 - 1) × 2) = 422616 = 672D8h Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 80 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center DestinationAddress = ((Y + Height - 1) × ScreenStride) + ((X + Width - 1) × BytesPerPixel) = ((20 + 321 - 1) × (640 × 2)) + ((105 + 9 - 1) × 2) = 435426 = 6A4E2h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 1280 for 16 bpp Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 06h, REG[105h] is set to 72h, and REG[104h] is set to D8h. Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 06h, REG[109h] is set to A4h, and REG[108h] is set to E2h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 9 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 08h. 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 321 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 01h and REG[112h] is set to 40h (320 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Move Blit in Negative Direction with ROP. REG[103] is set to 03h. 5. Program the BitBLT ROP Code Register to select Destination = Source. REG[102h] is set to 0Ch. 6. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 16 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 01h. 7. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 = 280h REG[10Dh] is set to 02h and REG[10Ch] is set to 80h. 8. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 81 10.2.7 Transparent Write Blit The Transparent Write Blit increases the speed of transferring data from system memory to the display buffer. Once the Transparent Write Blit begins, the blit engine remains active until all pixels have been written. The Transparent Write Blit updates a specified area of the display buffer with data supplied by the CPU. This blit is typically used to copy a bitmap image from system memory to the display buffer with one color marked as transparent. Any pixel of the transparent color is not transferred. This allows fast display of non-rectangular images. For example, consider a source bitmap having a red circle on a blue background. By selecting the blue color as the transparent color and using the Transparent Write Blit on the whole rectangle, the effect is a blit of the red circle only. The Transparent Write Blit supports both Destination Linear and Destination Rectangular modes. This Transparent Write Blit requires the CPU to provide data. The blit engine expects to receive a certain number of WORDS. For 15/16 bpp color depths, the number of WORDS is the same as the number of pixels due to the fact that each pixel is one WORD wide. The number of WORD writes the blit engine expects is calculated using the following formula. nWORDS = nPixels = Blit Width × Blit Height For 8 bpp color depths, the formula must take into consideration that the blit engine accepts only WORD accesses and each pixel is one BYTE. The blit engine needs to know whether the first pixel of a line is stored in the low byte or high byte. This is determined by bit 0 of the Source Start Address Register 0 (REG[104h]). If the Source Phase is 1 (bit 0 of the Source Start Address Register 0 is set), the first pixel of each line is in the high byte of the WORD and the contents of the low byte are ignored. If the Source Phase is 0, the first pixel is in the low byte and the second pixel is in the high byte. Depending on the Source Phase and the Blit Width, the last WORD in each line may contain only one pixel. It is always in the low byte if more than one WORD per line is required. The number of WORD reads the blit engine expects for 8 bpp color depths is shown in the following formula. nWORDS = ((BlitWidth + 1 + SourcePhase) ÷ 2) × BlitHeight Note The blit engine counts WORD writes in the blit address space. This does not imply only 16-bit CPU instructions are acceptable. If a system is able to separate one DWORD write into two WORD writes, then 32-bit CPU instructions are acceptable. Otherwise, two back to back 16-bit CPU instructions are required. Example 14: Write 100 x 20 pixels at the screen coordinates x = 25, y = 38 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 8 bpp. Transparent color is high intensity blue (assumes LUT Index 124). 1. Calculate the destination address (upper left corner of the screen blit rectangle), using the formula: Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 82 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (38 × 640) + (25 × 1) = 24345 = 5F19h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 640 for 8 bpp Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 5Fh, and REG[108h] is set to 19h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 100 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 63h (99 decimal). 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 20 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 00h and REG[112h] is set to 13h (19 decimal). 4. Program the Source Phase in the BitBLT Source Start Address Register. In this example, the data is WORD aligned, so the source phase is 0. REG[104h] is set to 00h. 5. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select Transparent Write Blit. REG[103h] is set to 04h. 6. Program the BitBLT Background Color Registers to select transparent color. REG[114h] is set to 7Ch (124 decimal). Note that for 15/16 bpp color depths, REG[115h] and REG[114h] are both required and programmed directly with the value of the transparent background color. 7. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 8 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 00h. 8. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 ÷ 2 = 320 = 140h REG[10Dh] is set to 01h and REG[10Ch] is set to 40h. 9. Calculate the number of WORDS the blit engine expects to receive. nWORDS S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 = ((BlitWidth + 1 + SourcePhase) ÷ 2) × BlitHeight = (100 + 1 + 0) ÷ 2 × 20 = 1000 = 3E8h Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 83 10. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation and wait for the blit engine to start. REG[100h] is set to 80h, then wait until REG[100h] bit 7 returns a 1. 11. Prior to writing all nWORDS to the Blit FIFO, confirm the Blit FIFO is not full (REG[100h] bit 4 returns a 0). If the BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status returns a 0 (the FIFO is empty), write up to 16 WORDS. If the BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status returns a 0 and the BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status returns a 0 then you can write up to 8 WORDS. If the BitBLT FIFO Full Status returns a 1, do not write to the BitBLT FIFO until it returns a 0. The following table summarizes how many words can be written to the Blit FIFO. Table 10-6: Possible Blit FIFO Writes BitBLT Control Register 0 (REG[100h]) FIFO Not Empty Status FIFO Half Full Status FIFO Full Status 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 Word Writes Available 16 8 less than 8 0 (do not write) Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.8 Transparent Move BitBLT in Positive Direction The Transparent Move BitBLT in Positive Direction moves an area of the display buffer to a different area of the display buffer. It allows for selection of a transparent color which is not copied during the blit. This allows fast display of non-rectangular images. For example, consider a source bitmap having a red circle on a blue background. By selecting the blue color as the transparent color and using the Transparent Move Blit on the whole rectangle, the effect is a blit of the red circle only. The Transparent Move BitBLT may move data from one rectangular area to another, or it may be specified as linear. The linear configuration may be applied to the source or destination. Defining the Move BitBLT as linear allows each line of the Move BitBLT area to be placed directly after the previous line, rather than requiring a complete row of address space for each line. Note The Transparent Move BitBLT is supported only in a positive direction. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 84 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Example 15: Copy a 9 x 321 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 100, y = 10 to screen coordinates X = 200, Y = 20 using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 16 bpp. Transparent color is blue. 1. Calculate the source and destination addresses (upper left corners of the source and destination rectangles), using the formula: SourceAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (10 × (640 × 2)) + (100 × 2) = 13000 = 32C8h DestinationAddress = (Y × ScreenStride) + (X × BytesPerPixel) = (20 × (640 × 2)) + (200 × 2) = 26000 = 6590h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixel = 1280 for 16 bpp Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 00h, REG[105h] is set to 32h, and REG[104h] is set to C8h. Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 65h, and REG[108h] is set to 90h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 9 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 08h. 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 321 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 01h and REG[112h] is set to 40h (320 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Transparent Move Blit in Positive Direction. REG[103h] is set to 05h. 5. Program the BitBLT Background Color Registers to select blue as the transparent color. REG[115h] is set to 00h and REG[114h] is set to 1Fh (Full intensity blue in 16 bpp is 001Fh). 6. Program the BitBLT Color Format Register to select 16 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 01h. 7. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 = 280h REG[10Dh] is set to 02h and REG[10Ch] is set to 80h. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 85 8. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.9 Pattern Fill BitBLT with ROP The Pattern Fill BitBLT with ROP fills a specified rectangular area of the display buffer with a pattern. The fill pattern is an array of pixels stored in off-screen display buffer. The fill pattern is limited to an eight by eight pixel array and must be loaded to off-screen memory prior to the BitBLT starting. The pattern can be logically combined with the destination using all 16 ROP codes, but typically the copy pattern ROP is used (ROP code 0Ch). The pattern itself must be stored in a consecutive array of pixels. As a pattern is defined to be eight pixels square, this results in 64 consecutive bytes for 8 bpp color depths and 128 bytes for 15/16 bpp color depths. For 8 bpp color depths the pattern must begin on a 64 byte boundary, for 15/16 bpp color depths the pattern must begin on a 128 byte boundary. To fill an area using the pattern BitBLT, the blit engine requires the location of the pattern, the destination rectangle position and size, and the ROP code. The blit engine also needs to know which pixel from the pattern is the first pixel in the destination rectangle (the pattern start phase). This allows seamless redrawing of any part of the screen using the pattern fill. Example 16: Fill a 100 x 250 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 10, y = 20 with the pattern in off-screen memory at offset 10 0000h using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 8 bpp. The first pixel (upper left corner) of the rectangle is the pattern pixel at x = 3, y = 4. 1. Calculate the destination address (upper left corner of the destination rectangle), using the formula: DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (20 × 640) + (10 × 1) = 12810 = 320Ah where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixels = 640 for 8 bpp Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 32h, and REG[108h] is set to 0Ah. 2. Calculate the source address. This is the address of the pixel in the pattern that is the origin of the destination fill area. The pattern begins at offset 1M, but the first pattern pixel is at x = 3, y = 4. Therefore, an offset within the pattern itself must be calculated. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 86 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center SourceAddress = PatternOffset + StartPatternY × 8 × BytesPerPixel + StartPatternX × BytesPerPixel = 1M + (4 × 8 × 1) + (3 × 1) = 1M + 35 = 1048611 = 100023h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 10h, REG[105h] is set to 00h, and REG[104h] is set 23h. 3. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 100 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h, REG[110h] is set to 63h (99 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 250-1. REG[113h] is set to 00h, and REG[112h] is set to F9h (249 decimal). 5. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Pattern Fill with ROP. REG[103h] is set to 06h. 6. Program the BitBLT ROP Code Register to select Destination = Source. REG[102h] is set to 0Ch. 7. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 8 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 00h. 8. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 ÷ 2 = 320 = 140h REG[10Dh] is set to 01h and REG[10Ch] is set to 40h. 9. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 87 10.2.10 Pattern Fill BitBLT with Transparency The Pattern Fill BitBLT with Transparency fills a specified rectangular area of the display buffer with a pattern. When a transparent color is selected, pattern pixels of the transparent color will not get copied, allowing creation of hatched patterns. The fill pattern is an eight by eight array of pixels stored in off-screen display buffer. The fill pattern must be loaded to off-screen display buffer prior to the BitBLT starting. The pattern itself must be stored in a consecutive array of pixels. As a pattern is defined to be eight pixels square, this results in 64 consecutive bytes for 8 bpp color depths and 128 bytes for 15/16 bpp color depths. For 8 bpp color depths the pattern must begin on a 64 byte boundary, for 15/16 bpp color depths the pattern must begin on a 128 byte boundary. To fill an area using the Pattern Fill BitBLT with Transparency, the blit engine requires the location of the pattern, the destination rectangle position and size, and the transparency color. The blit engine also needs to know which pixel from the pattern is the first pixel in the destination rectangle (the pattern start phase). This allows seamless redrawing of any part of the screen using the pattern fill. Example 17: Fill a 100 x 250 rectangle at the screen coordinates x = 10, y = 20 with the pattern in off-screen memory at offset 10000h using a 640x480 display at a color depth of 8 bpp. The first pixel (upper left corner) of the rectangle is the pattern pixel at x = 3, y = 4. Transparent color is blue (assumes LUT index 1). 1. Calculate the destination address (upper left corner of destination rectangle), using the formula: DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (20 × 640) + (10 × 1) = 12810 = 320Ah where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixels = 640 for 8 bpp Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 32h, and REG[108h] is set to 0Ah. 2. Calculate the source address. This is the address of the pixel in the pattern that is the origin of the destination fill area. The pattern begins at offset 1M, but the first pattern pixel is at x = 3, y = 4. Therefore, an offset within the pattern itself must be calculated. SourceAddress = PatternOffset + StartPatternY × 8 × BytesPerPixel + StartPatternX × BytesPerPixel = 1M + (4 × 8 × 1) + (3 × 1) = 1M + 35 = 1048611 = 100023h Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 88 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 10h, REG[105h] is set to 00h, and REG[104h] is set 23h. 3. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 100 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 63h (99 decimal). 4. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 250-1. REG[113h] is set to 00h, and REG[112h] is set to F9h (249 decimal). 5. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Pattern Fill BitBLT with Transparency. REG[103h] is set to 07h. 6. Program the BitBLT Background Color Registers to select transparent color. This example uses blue (LUT index 1) as the transparent color. REG[114h] is set to 01h. Note that for 15/16 bpp color depths, REG[115h] and REG[114h] are both required and programmed directly with the value of the transparent background color. For example, for full intensity green to be the transparent color in 16 bpp, REG[115h] is set to 07h and REG[114h] is set to E0h. 7. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 8 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 00h. 8. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 ÷ 2 = 320 = 140h REG[10Dh] is set to 01h and REG[10Ch] is set to 40h. 9. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.11 Move BitBLT with Color Expansion The Move BitBLT with Color Expansion takes a monochrome bitmap as the source and color expands it into the destination. Color expansion moves all bits in the monochrome source to pixels in the destination. All bits in the source set to one are expanded into destination pixels of the selected foreground color. All bits in the source set to zero are expanded into pixels of the selected background color. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 89 The Move BitBLT with Color Expansion is used to accelerate text drawing on the screen. A monochrome bitmap of a font in off-screen memory occupies very little space and takes advantage of the hardware acceleration. Since the foreground and background colors are programmable, text of any color can be created. The Move BitBLT with Color Expansion may move data from one rectangular area to another, or it may be specified as linear. The linear configuration may be applied to the source or destination. Defining the Move BitBLT as linear allows each line of the Move BitBLT area to be placed directly after the previous line, rather than requiring a complete row of address space for each line. Note The BitBLT ROP Code/Color Expansion Register must be programmed to value 07h because in the first word in a line color expansion is started with the most significant bit of the low byte. Example 18: Color expand a 9 x 16 rectangle using the pattern in off-screen memory at 10 0000h and move it to the screen coordinates x = 200, y = 20. Assume a 640x480 display at a color depth of 16 bpp, Foreground color of black, and background color of white. 1. Calculate the destination and source addresses (upper left corner of the destination and source rectangles), using the formula. DestinationAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (20 × (640 × 2)) + (200 × 2) = 26000 = 6590h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixels = 1280 for 16 bpp SourceAddress = 1M = 100000h Program the BitBLT Destination Start Address Registers. REG[10Ah] is set to 00h, REG[109h] is set to 65h, and REG[108h] is set to 90h. Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 10h, REG[105h] is set to 00h, and REG[104h] is set to 00h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 9 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 08h. 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 16 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 00h and REG[112h] is set to 0Fh. 4. Program the BitBLT ROP Code/Color Expansion Register. REG[102h] is set to 07h. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 90 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5. Program the BitBLT Operation Register to select the Move Blit with Color Expansion. REG[103h] is set to 0Bh. 6. Program the BitBLT Foreground Color Register to select black (in 16 bpp black = 0000h). REG[119h] is set to 00h and REG[118h] is set to 00h. 7. Program the BitBLT Background Color Register to select white (in 16 bpp white = FFFFh). REG[115h] is set to FFh and REG[114h] is set to FFh. 8. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 16 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 01h. 9. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 = 280h REG[10Dh] is set to 02h and REG[10Ch] is set to 80h. 10. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation. REG[100h] is set to 80h. Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.2.12 Transparent Move Blit with Color Expansion The Transparent Move Blit with Color Expansion is virtually identical to the Move Blit with Color Expansion. The background color is ignored and bits in the monochrome source bitmap set to 0 are not color expanded. 10.2.13 Read Blit This Read Blit increases the speed of transferring data from the display buffer to system memory. This blit complements the Write Blit and is typically used to save a part of the display buffer to the system memory. Once the Read Blit begins, the blit engine remains active until all the pixels have been read. The blit engine requires the address to copy from and the size of the area to copy (width x height). The blit engine expects to read a certain number of words. For 15/16 bpp color depths, the number of words is the same as the number of pixels due to the fact that each pixel is one WORD wide. The number of WORD reads the blit engine expects is calculated using the following formula. nWORDS S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 = nPixels = Blit Width × Blit Height Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 91 For 8 bpp color depths, the formula must take into consideration that the blit engine accepts only WORD accesses and each pixel is one BYTE. The blit engine needs to know whether the first pixel of each line is stored in the low byte or high byte. This is determined by bit 0 of the Destination Start Address Register 0 (REG[108h]). If the Destination Phase is 1 (bit 0 of the Destination Start Address Register 0 is set), the first pixel of each line is placed in the high byte of the WORD and the contents of the low byte is undefined. If the Destination Phase is 0, the first pixel is placed in the low byte and the second pixel is placed in the high byte. Depending on the Destination Phase and the Blit Width, the last WORD in each line may contain only one pixel. It is always in the low byte if more than one WORD per line is required. The number of WORD reads the blit engine expects for 8 bpp color depths is shown in the following formula. nWORDS = ((BlitWidth + 1 + DestinationPhase) ÷ 2) × BlitHeight Example 19: Read 100 x 20 pixels at the screen coordinates x = 25, y = 38 and save to system memory. Assume a display of 640x480 at a color depth of 8 bpp. 1. Calculate the source address (upper left corner of the screen blit rectangle), using the formula. SourceAddress = (y × ScreenStride) + (x × BytesPerPixel) = (38 × 640) + (25 × 1) = 24345 = 5F19h where: BytesPerPixel = 1 for 8 bpp BytesPerPixel = 2 for 15/16 bpp ScreenStride = DisplayWidthInPixels × BytesPerPixels = 640 for 8 bpp Program the BitBLT Source Start Address Registers. REG[106h] is set to 00h, REG[105h] is set to 5Fh, and REG[104h] is set to 19h. 2. Program the BitBLT Width Registers to 100 - 1. REG[111h] is set to 00h and REG[110h] is set to 63h (99 decimal). 3. Program the BitBLT Height Registers to 20 - 1. REG[113h] is set to 00h and REG[112h] is set to 13h (19 decimal). 4. Program the Destination Phase in the BitBLT Destination Start Address Register. In this example, the data is WORD aligned, so the destination phase is 0. REG[108h] is set to 0. 5. Program the BitBLT Operation to select the Read Blit. REG[103h] is set to 01h. 6. Program the BitBLT Color Format Select bit for 8 bpp operations. REG[101h] is set to 00h. 7. Program the BitBLT Memory Offset Registers to the ScreenStride in WORDS. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 92 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center BltMemoryOffset = ScreenStride ÷ 2 = 640 ÷ 2 = 320 = 140h REG[10Dh] is set to 01h and REG[10Ch] is set to 40h. 8. Calculate the number of WORDS the blit engine expects to receive. nWORDS = ((BlitWidth + 1 + DestinationPhase) ÷ 2) × BlitHeight = (100 + 1 + 0) ÷ 2 × 20 = 1000 = 3E8h 9. Program the BitBLT Destination/Source Linear Select bits for a rectangular blit (BitBLT Destination Linear Select = 0, BitBLT Source Linear Select = 0). Start the blit operation and wait for the blit engine to start. REG[100h] is set to 80h, then wait until REG[100h] bit 7 returns a 1. 10. Prior to reading all nWORDS from the Blit FIFO, confirm the Blit FIFO is not empty (REG[100h] bit 4 returns a 1). If the BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status returns a 1 and the BitBLT FIFO Half Full Status returns a 0 then you can read up to 8 WORDS. If the BitBLT FIFO Full Status returns a 1, read up to 16 WORDS. If the BitBLT FIFO Not Empty Status returns a 0 (the FIFO is empty), do not read from the BitBLT FIFO until it returns a 1. The following table summarizes how many words can be read from the Blit FIFO. Table 10-7: Possible Blit FIFO Reads BitBLT Control Register 0 (REG[100h]) FIFO Not Empty Status FIFO Half Full Status FIFO Full Status 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 1 0 1 1 1 Word Reads Available 0 (do not read) up to 8 8 16 Note The order of register initialization is irrelevant as long as all relevant registers are programmed before the BitBLT is initiated. 10.3 S1D13506 BitBLT Synchronization A BitBLT operation can only be started if the blit engine is not busy servicing another blit. Before a new BitBLT operation is started, software must confirm the BitBLT Active Status bit (REG[100h] bit 7) returns a 0. Software can either test this bit after each BitBLT operation, or before each BitBLT operation. Testing the BitBLT Status After S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 93 Testing the BitBLT Active Status after starting a new BitBLT is simpler and less prone to errors. To test after each BitBLT operation, perform the following. 1. Program and start the blit engine. 2. Wait for the current BitBLT operation to finish -- Poll the BitBLT Active Status bit (REG[100h] bit) until it returns a 0. 3. Continue the program. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 94 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Testing the BitBLT Status Before Testing the BitBLT Active Status before starting a new BitBLT results in better performance, as both CPU and blit engine can be running at the same time. This is most useful for BitBLTs that are self completing (once started they don’t require any CPU assistance). While the blit engine is busy, the CPU can do other tasks. To test before each BitBLT operation, perform the following. 1. Wait for the current BitBLT operation to finish -- Poll the BitBLT Active Status bit (REG[100h] bit 7) until it returns a 0. 2. Program and start the new BitBLT operation. 3. Continue the program (CPU and blit engine work independently). However, this approach can pose problems if the CPU writes a pixel while the blit engine is running a blit. If the CPU writes the pixel before the BitBLT finishes, the pixel may be overwritten by the blit. To avoid this scenario, always assure no BitBLT is in progress before accessing the display buffer with the CPU, or don’t use the CPU to access display buffer at all. 10.4 S1D13506 BitBLT Known Limitations The S1D13506 blit engine has the following limitations. • BitBLT Width must be greater than 0. • BitBLT Height must be greater than 0. • The blit engine is not SwivelView aware. If BitBLTs are used when SwivelView is enabled, the coordinates and verticies are swapped. It may be possible to recalculate these coordinates and vertices allowing use of some of the BitBLT functions. However the coordinate transformations required may nullify the benefits of the BitBLT. • The Pattern Fill with ROP (0Ch or 03h) and Transparent Pattern Fill are designed such that the BitBLT Width must be > 1 for 15/16 bpp color depths and > 2 for 8 bpp. 10.5 Sample Code Sample code demonstrating how to program the S1D13506 BitBLT engine is provided in the file 13506BLT.ZIP. This file is available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 95 11 CRT/TV Considerations The S1D13506 is capable of driving an LCD panel, CRT display, or a TV monitor. However, only an LCD panel and CRT or an LCD panel and TV can be driven simultaneously. It is not possible to drive both a CRT and TV at the same time. The horizontal and vertical timing requirements of LCD panels allows for a wide timing variance. In comparison, a CRT display has very strict timing requirements with even a very small timing variance degrading the displayed image. TV monitors require timings based on the NTSC or PAL specifications. The utility 13506CFG.EXE can be used to generate a header file containing the register values required for CRT/TV or LCD panel timings. For further information on 13506CFG.EXE, see the 13506CFG Users Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx. 11.1 CRT Considerations CRT timings are based on the VESA Monitor Timing Specifications. The VESA specification details all the parameters of the display and non-display times, as well as the input clock required to meet the times. Failing to use correct timings can result in an unsynchronized image on a particular monitor, which can permanently damage the monitor. Virtually all VGA monitors sync if VESA timings are used. For more information on VESA timings, contact the Video Electronics Standards Association on the internet at www.vesa.org. 11.1.1 Generating CRT timings with 13506CFG 13506CFG.EXE will generate correct VESA timings for 640x480 and 800x600 if provided the correct VESA input clock. The following timings can be generated: • 640x480 @ 60Hz (Input Clock = 25.175 MHz) • 640x480 @ 72Hz (Input Clock = 31.500 MHz) • 640x480 @ 75Hz (Input Clock = 31.500 MHz) • 640x480 @ 85 Hz (Input Clock = 36.000 MHz) • 800x600 @ 56 Hz (Input Clock = 36.000 MHz) • 800x600 @ 60 Hz (Input Clock = 40.000 MHz) 11.1.2 DAC Output Level Selection When the CRT is active, the DAC Output Level Select bit (REG[05Bh] bit 3) can be used to double values outpu to the DAC. This would normally result in very bright colors on the display, but if IREF is reduced at the same time the display will remain at its intended brightness and power consumption is reduced. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 96 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 11.1.3 Examples Example 20: Enable the CRT display. Assume the CRT timing registers are already programmed. 1. Confirm the TV PAL/NTSC Output Select bit is clear. REG[05Bh] bit 0 is set to 0. 2. Confirm the CRT and TV displays are disabled. REG[1FCh] bits 2-1 are set to 0. 3. Enable the CRT. REG[1FCh] is set to 1. Sample code demonstrating how to enable the CRT display is provided in the file 56_CRT.c. This file is available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. 11.2 TV Considerations TV timings are based on either the NTSC or PAL specifications. The TV display can be output in either composite video or S-video format. 11.2.1 NTSC Timings NTSC timings require a 14.318 MHz input clock. With the correct input clock the following resolutions are supported. • 640x480 • 696x436 • 752x484 11.2.2 PAL Timings PAL timings require a 17.734 MHz input clock. With the correct input clock the following resolutions are supported. • 640x480 • 800x572 • 856x518 • 920x572 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 97 11.2.3 TV Filters The S1D13506 is designed with three filters which improve TV picture quality. • Flicker Filter. • Chrominance Filter. • Luminance Filter. Each filter is independent and can be enabled/disabled separately. The TV picture quality varies depending on the actual picture displayed (static image, moving image, number of colors etc.) and may be improved using the filters. Flicker Filter The Flicker Filter is controlled by the Display Mode Select bits (REG[1FCh] bits 2-0). It reduces the “flickering” effect seen on interlaced displays caused by sharp vertical image transitions that occur over one line (e.g. one pixel high lines, edges of window boxes, etc.). The Flicker Filter may be used to for both composite video and S-video formats. Note The CRT/TV PCLK 2X Enable bit (REG[018h] bit 7) must be set to 1 when the Flicker Filter is enabled. Chrominance Filter The Chrominance Filter is controlled by the TV Chrominance Filter Enable bit (REG[05Bh] bit 5). It adjusts the color of the TV, reducing the “ragged edges” seen a the boundaries between sharp color transitions. The Chrominance Filter may improve the TV picture quality when in composite video format. Luminance Filter The Luminance Filter is controlled by the TV Luminance Filter Enable bit (REG[05Bh] bit 4). It adjusts the brightness of the TV, reducing the “rainbow-like” colors at the boundaries between sharp brightness transitions. The Luminance Filter may improve the TV picture quality when in composite video format. For further information on the TV filters, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. 11.2.4 Examples Example 21: Enable the TV display and set the Flicker Filter. Assume the TV timing registers are already programmed. 1. Enable the TV with Flicker Filter enabled. REG[1FCh] is set to 06h. 2. Enable the CRT/TV PCLK 2X bit (REG[018h] bit 7). REG[018h] bit 7 is set to 1b. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 98 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Sample code demonstrating how to enable the TV display is provided in the file 156_TV.c. This file is available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. 11.3 Simultaneous Display The S1D13506 supports simultaneous display of an LCD panel and CRT or an LCD panel and TV. Both display images are completely independent. Each display can show separate areas of the display buffer and display different color depths. There are separate Look-Up Tables and Hardware Cursors/Ink Layers for both the LCD and CRT/TV. If desired, the LUTs for the LCD and CRT/TV may be written to simultaneously (REG[1E0h] bit 0 = 0). Note Not all combinations of panel and CRT/TV display resolutions are possible. For further information, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 99 12 MediaPlug The S1D13506 is designed with support for MediaPlug. MediaPlug is a digital interface supporting the Winnov Videum camera. The Videum camera supports simultaneous video and audio capture of streaming (real-time) and still images. It also supports streaming live video at speeds near 30 frames per second on fast host systems (i.e. Pentium-2 300MHz or faster). 12.1 Programming MediaPlug and the Winnov Videum camera are a proprietary design of Winnov. Due to the complexity of the digital interface, all software and drivers for the camera are provided by Winnov. Customers intending to use the MediaPlug interface in their design should contact Epson Electronics America to obtain the latest S1D13506 MediaPlug drivers for testing purposes. The MediaPlug interface on the S1D13506 must be enabled to function correctly. To enable the MediaPlug interface, MD13 and MD14 must be high (1) on the rising edge of RESET#. When the MediaPlug interface is enabled, GPIO2 is controlled by the MediaPlug LCMD register, and the GPIO2 bits in both REG[004h] and REG[008h] have no effect. Also when the MediaPlug interface is enabled, the camera power (VMPEPWR) is controlled by MA11/GPIO2 pin. The MediaPlug LCMD 16-bit register REG[1000h] contains status bits which can be read by software. For further information on these status bits, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The MediaPlug IC Revision bits (REG[1000h] bits 11-8) contain the revision of the interface. The 16-bit value read from REG[1000h] should be masked with 0F00h and compared with 0300h (the current revision of the interface). The MediaPlug Cable Detected Status bit (REG[1000h] bit 7) determines if a camera is connected to the MediaPlug interface. When this bit returns a 0, a camera is connected. When this bit returns a 1, a camera is not connected. The MediaPlug Power Enable to Remote bit (REG[1000h], bit 1) controls the power to the remote camera. GPIO2 is controlled by this bit when the MediaPlug interface is enabled. Therefore, this bit must be used instead of the GPIO2 control bits in REG[004h] and REG[008h] when programming the external ICD2061A clock chip used on the S5U13506B00x evaluation boards. Writing this bit is necessary only when software needs to control the MA11/GPIO2 pin. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 100 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 12.2 Considerations Software can determine if the MediaPlug interface is enabled or disabled by reading the MD Configuration Readback Register (REG[00Dh]) and masking the data with 60h. If the masked result equals 60h, the MediaPlug Interface is enabled. When the MediaPlug interface is enabled, FPDAT[15:8] are used exclusively for the MediaPlug interface. Therefore, when the MediaPlug interface is enabled, Color 16-bit panels cannot be used without an external multiplexing circuit. For further information on the external circuit required, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The MediaPlug interface requires a source clock between 8MHz and 19MHz to operate (optimal is 14.318MHz). By default, the MediaPlug software assumes a 14.318MHz frequency is available on CLKI2. If the frequency of CLKI2 is changed, software should reprogram the MediaPlug Clock Register (REG[01Ch]) to select a clock source that is suitable, or program the clock divide bits to obtain a frequency within the correct range. If the S5U13506B00x evaluation board is used, the clock chip should be programmed to support a valid clock for the MediaPlug interface. The ICD2061A clock chip selects frequencies based on the states of GPIO1 and GPIO2. Since the MediaPlug interface uses the GPIO2 pin for camera power, it is important to program the clock chip for the correct MediaPlug interface frequency when the camera is both on or off (GPIO2 low or high). A HAL function is available which programs the clock chip for the MediaPlug interface. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 101 13 Identifying the S1D13506 The S1D13506 can only be identified once the Memory/Register Select bit is set to 0. The steps to identify the S1D13506 are: 1. Set the Memory/Register Select bit to 0 by writing 00h to REG[001h]. 2. Read REG[000h]. 3. The production version of the S1D13506 will return a value of 11h (00010001b). 4. The product code is 4 (000100b based on bits 7-2). 5. The revision code is 1 (01b based on bits 1-0). Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 102 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14 Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL) The HAL is a processor independent programming library designed to help port applications and utilities from one S1D13x0x product to another. Epson has provided this library as a result of developing test utilities for the S1D13x0x LCD controller products. The HAL contains functions which are designed to be consistent between S1D13x0x products, but as the semiconductor products evolve, so must the HAL; consequently there are some differences between HAL functions for different S1D13x0x products. Note As the S1D13x0x line of products changes, the HAL may change significantly or cease to be a useful tool. Seiko Epson reserves the right to change the functionality of the HAL or discontinue its use if no longer required. 14.1 API for 13506HAL This section is a description of the HAL library Application Programmers Interface (API). Updates and revisions to the HAL may include new functions not included in the following documentation. Table 14-1: HAL Functions Function Description Initialization seRegisterDevice Registers the S1D13506 parameters with the HAL. seRegisterDevice MUST be the first HAL function called by an application. seInitReg Initializes the registers, LUT, and allocates memory for and assigns. seGetHalVersion Returns HAL library version information seGetId Identifies the controller by interpreting the revision code register. seGetLibseVersion Return version information on the LIBSE libraries (for non-x86 platforms) General HAL Support: seGetInstalledMemorySize Returns the total size of the display buffer memory. seGetAvailableMemorySize Determines the last byte of display memory, before the Dual Panel buffer, available to an application seGetResolution seGetLcdResolution seGetCrtResolution seGetTvResolution Retrieve the width and height of the physical display device. seGetBytesPerScanline seGetLcdBytesPerScanline seGetCrtBytesPerScanline seGetTvBytesPerScanline Returns the number of bytes in each scanline of the display including non-display size. seSetSoftwareSuspend Sets/resets software suspend mode. seGetSoftwareSuspend Returns the current software suspend state. seCheckEndian Retrieves the “endian-ness” of the host CPU platform. seGetLcdOrientation Returns the SwivelView orientation of the LCD panel. seDelay Delays the given number of seconds before returning. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 103 Table 14-1: HAL Functions (Continued) Function Description seDisplayBlank seDisplayLcdBlank seDisplayCrtBlank seDisplayTvBlank Blank/unblank the display by disabling the FIFO. seDisplayEnable seLcdDisplayEnable seCrtDisplayEnable seTvDisplayEnable Enable/disable the display. seBeginHighPriority Increase thread priority for time critical routines. seEndHighPriority Return thread priority to normal. seSetClock Set the programmable clock. seGetSurfaceDisplayMode Returns the display surface associated with the active surface. seGetSurfaceSize Returns the number of bytes allocated to the active surface. seGetSurfaceLinearAddress Returns the linear address of the start of display memory for the active surface. seGetSurfaceOffsetAddress Returns the offset from the start of display memory to the start of surface memory. seAllocLcdSurface seAllocCrtSurface> seAllocTvSurface Use to manually allocate display buffer memory for a surface. seFreeSurface Free any allocated surface memory. seSetLcdAsActiveSurface seSetCrtAsActiveSurface seSetTvAsActiveSurface Call one of these function to change the active surface. seReadRegByte Reads one register using a byte access. seReadRegWord Reads two registers using a word access. seReadRegDword Reads four registers using a dword access. seWriteRegByte Writes one register using a byte access. Advanced HAL Functions: Surface Support Register Access: seWriteRegByte Writes two registers using a word access. seWriteRegByte Writes four registers using a dword access. Memory Access seReadDisplayByte Reads one byte from display memory. seReadDisplayWord Reads one word from display memory. seReadDisplayDword Reads one dword from display memory. seWriteDisplayBytes Writes one or more bytes to display memory. seWriteDisplayWords Writes one or more words to display memory. seWriteDisplayDwords Writes one or more dwords to display memory. Color Manipulation: seWriteLutEntry seWriteLcdLutEntry seWriteCrtLutEntry seWriteTvLutEntry Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Writes one RGB element to the lookup table. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 104 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 14-1: HAL Functions (Continued) Function Description seReadLutEntry seReadLcdLutEntry seReadCrtLutEntry seReadTvLutEntry Reads one RGB element from the lookup table. seWriteLut seWriteLcdLut seWriteCrtLut seWriteTvLut Write the entire lookup table. seReadLut seReadLcdLut seReadCrtLut seReadTvLut Read the entire lookup table. seSetBitsPerPixel seSetLcdBitsPerPixel seSetCrtBitsPerPixel seSetTvBitsPerPixel seSetLcdCrtBitsPerPixel seSetLcdTvBitsPerPixel Sets the color depth. In addition to setting the control bits to set the color depth this action sets a default lookup table for the selected color depth. Virtual Display seVirtInit seLcdVirtInit seCrtVirtInit seTvVirtInit seLcdCrtVirtInit seLcdTvVirtInit Initialize a surface to hold an image larger than the physical display size. seVirtPanScroll seVirtPanScroll seVirtPanScroll seVirtPanScroll seVirtPanScroll seVirtPanScroll Pan (right/left) and Scroll (up/down) the display device over the indicated virtual surface. Drawing seSetPixel seSetLcdPixel seSetCrtPixel seSetTvPixel Set one pixel at the specified x,y co-ordinate and color. seGetPixel seGetLcdPixel seGetCrtPixel seGetTvPixel Returns the color of the pixel at the specified x,y co-ordinate. seDrawLine seDrawLcdLine seDrawCrtLine seDrawTvLine Draws a line between two endpoints in the specified color seDrawRect seDrawLcdRect seDrawCrtRect seDrawTvRect Draws a rectangle. The rectangle can be outlined or filled. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 105 Table 14-1: HAL Functions (Continued) Function Description seDrawCircle seDrawLcdCircle seDrawCrtCircle seDrawTvCircle Draws a circle of given radius and color at the specified center point. seDrawEllipse seDrawLcdEllipse seDrawCrtEllipse seDrawTvEllipse Draws an ellipse centered on a given point with the specified horizontal and vertical radius. Hardware Cursor seInitCursor seInitLcdCursor seInitCrtCursor seInitTvCursor Prepares the hardware cursor for use. seFreeCursor seFreeLcdCursor seFreeCrtCursor seFreeTvCursor Releases the memory allocated to the hardware cursor by the cursor init function. seEnableCursor seEnableLcdCursor seEnableCrtCursor seEnableTvCursor Enable (show) or disable (hide) the hardware cursor. seGetCursorLinearAddress seGetLcdCursorLinearAddress seGetCrtCursorLinearAddress seGetTvCursorLinearAddress Returns the linear address of the start of the cursor. seGetCursorOffsetAddress seGetLcdCursorOffsetAddress seGetCrtCursorOffsetAddress seGetTvCursorOffsetAddress Returns the offset from the start of display memory to the start of the cursor memory. seMoveCursor seMoveLcdCursor seMoveCrtCursor seMoveTvCursor Moves the top-left corner of the hardware cursor to the specified x,y co-ordinates. seSetCursorColor seSetLcdCursorColor seSetCrtCursorColor seSetTvCursorColor Allows the application to set the color values for either of the two changeable elements of the hardware cursor. seSetCursorPixel seSetLcdCursorPixel seSetCrtCursorPixel seSetTvCursorPixel Set one pixel at the specified x,y co-ordinate within the hardware cursor. seDrawCursorLine seDrawLcdCursorLine seDrawCrtCursorLine seDrawTvCursorLine Draws a line between two endpoints within the hardware cursor, in the specified color. seDrawCursorRect seDrawLcdCursorRect seDrawCrtCursorRect seDrawTvCursorRect Draws a hollow or filled rectangle within the hardware cursor. Ink Layer Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 106 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 14-1: HAL Functions (Continued) Function Description seInitInk seInitLcdInk seInitCrtInk seInitTvInk Prepares the hardware ink layer for use. seFreeInk seFreeLcdInk seFreeCrtInk seFreeTvInk Frees memory allocated to the hardware ink layer. seEnableInk seEnableLcdInk seEnableCrtInk seEnableTvInk Enable (show) or disable (hide) the hardware ink layer. seGetInkLinearAddress seGetLcdInkLinearAddress seGetCrtInkLinearAddress seGetTvInkLinearAddress Returns the linear address of the start of the hardware ink layer. seGetInkOffsetAddress seGetLcdInkOffsetAddress seGetCrtInkOffsetAddress seGetTvInkOffsetAddress Returns the offset from the start of display memory to the start of ink layer memory. seSetInkColor seSetLcdInkColor seSetCrtInkColor seSetTvInkColor Allows the application to set the color values for either of the two changeable elements of the ink layer. seSetInkPixel seSetLcdInkPixel seSetCrtInkPixel seSetTvInkPixel Set one pixel at the x,y co-ordinate within the ink layer. seDrawInkLine seDrawLcdInkLine seDrawCrtInkLine seDrawTvInkLine Draws a line between two endpoints within the hardware ink layer. seDrawInkRect seDrawLcdInkRect seDrawCrtInkRect seDrawTvInkRect Draws an outlined or solid rectangle within the hardware ink layer. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 107 14.2 Initialization Initialization functions are normally the first functions in the HAL library that an application calls. These routine allow the application to learn a little about the controller and to prepare the HAL library for use. int seRegisterDevice(const LPHAL_STRUC lpHalInfo) Description: This function registers the S1D13506 device parameters with the HAL library. The device parameters include such item as address range, register values, desired frame rate, and more which are stored in the HAL_STRUCT structure pointed to by lpHalInfo. Additionally this routine allocates system memory as address space for accessing registers and the display buffer. Parameters: lpHalInfo A pointer to a HAL_STRUCT structure. This structure must be filled with appropriate values prior to calling seRegisterDevice. Return Value: ERR_OK operation completed with no problems ERR_UNKNOWN_DEVICE The HAL was unable to locate the S1D13506. ERR_FAILED The HAL was unable to map S1D13506 display memory to the host platform. In addition, on Win32 platforms, the following two error values may be returned: ERR_PCI_DRIVER_NOT_FOUND The HAL was unable to locate file S1D13X0X.VXD ERR_PCI_BRIDGE_ADAPTER_NOT_FOUND The driver file S1D13X0X.VXD was unable to locate the S1D13506. Note seRegisterDevice() MUST be called before any other HAL functions. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 108 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center int seInitReg(unsigned DisplayMode, unsigned Flags) Description: This function initializes the S1D13506 registers, the LUT, assigns default surfaces and allocates memory accordingly. Parameters: DisplayMode Set this parameter according to the type of initialization desired. Valid values for DisplayMode are: 0 LCD CRT TV LCD | CRT LCD | TV Flags Use the values configured by 13506CFG.EXE Initialize for use with an LCD panel. Initialize for use with a monitor. Initialize for use with a TV Initialize for both LCD panel and monitor. Initialize for both LCD panel and TV. Provides additional information about how to perform the initialization. Valid values for Flags are: CLEAR_MEMZero display memory as part of the initialization DISP_BLANKBlank the display, for aesthetics, during initialization. Return Value: ERR_OK ERR_FAILED The initialization completed with no problems. seInitReg failed to initialize the system correctly. void seGetHalVersion(const char ** pVersion, const char ** pStatus, const char **pStatusRevision) Description: Retrieves the HAL library version information. By retrieving and displaying the HAL version information along with application version information it is possible to determine at a glance whether the latest version of the software is being run. Parameters: pVersion A pointer to the array to receive the HAL version code. pStatus A pointer to the array to receive the HAL status code A “B” designates a beta version of the HAL, a NULL indicates the release version pStatusRevision A pointer to the array to receive the HAL revision status. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 The version information is returned as the contents of the pointer arguments. A typical return might be: *pVersion == “1.01” (HAL version 1.01) *pStatus == “B” (BETA release) *pStatusRevision == “5” (fifth update of the beta) Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 109 int seGetId(int * pId) Description: Reads the S1D13506 revision code register to determine the controller product and revision. Parameters: pId A pointer to an integer to receive the controller ID. The value returned is an interpreted version of the controller identification. For the S1D13506 the return values are: ID_S1D13506_REV0 ID_S1D13506_REV1 ID_UNKNOWN Return Value: ERR_OK ERR_UNKNOWN_DEVICE S1D13506 Test Sample version. S1D13506 Production version The HAL was unable to identify the controller. The operation completed with no problems Return value when pID is ID_UNKNOWN. Note seGetId() will disable hardware suspend on x86 platforms, and enables the Memory/Register Select bit (REG[001h] bit 7) on all platforms. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 110 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.1 General HAL Support This category of HAL functions provide several essential services which do not readily group with other functions. DWORD seGetInstalledMemorySize(void) Description: This function returns the size of display buffer memory in bytes. Memory size is determined during the call to seRegisterDevice() by reading the status of MD6 and MD7. seGetInstalledMemorySize() returns the memory size determined during the HAL initialization. Parameters: None Return Value: The return value is the size of the video memory buffer in bytes and will be either 80000h (512kb) or 200000h (2 MB). DWORD seGetAvailableMemorySize(void) Description: This function returns an offset to the last byte memory, before the Dual Panel buffer, accessible to an application. An application can directly access memory from offset zero to the offset returned by this function. On most systems the return value will be the last byte of physical display memory. On systems configured for a dual STN panel the return value will account for the presence of the Dual Panel buffer. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is an offset to the last byte memory directly accessible to an application. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 111 int seGetResolution(unsigned *Width, unsigned *Height) void seGetLcdResolution(unsigned *Width, unsigned *Height) void seGetCrtResolution(unsigned *Width, unsigned *Height) void seGetTvResolution(unsigned *Width, unsigned *Height) Description: These functions return the width and height of the physical display device. Virtual dimensions are not accounted for in the return value. seGetResolution() returns the width and height of the active surface. If there is more than one display associated with the surface then precedence is given to the LCD. seGetLcdResolution() returns the width and height of the LCD panel. The width and height are adjusted for SwivelView orientation. seGetCrtResolution() and seGetTvResolution() return the width and height of the display indicated by the function name. Parameters: Return Value: Width A pointer to an unsigned integer which will receive the width, in pixels, for the indicated surface. Height A pointer to an unsigned integer which will receive the height, in pixels, for the indicated surface. seGetResolution() returns one of the following: ERR_OK ERR_FAILED Function completed successfully Returned when there is not an active display surface. seGetLcdResolution(), seGetCrtResolution(), and seGetTvResolution() do not return any value. unsigned seGetBytesPerScanline(void) unsigned seGetLcdBytesPerScanline(void) unsigned seGetTvBytesPerScanline(void) unsigned seGetCrtBytesPerScanline(void) Description: These functions return the number of bytes per scanline, including both displayed and non-displayed for the current video mode. seGetBytesPerScanline() returns the number of bytes per scanline for the current active surface. seGetLcdBytesPerScanline(), seGetTvBytesPerScanline(), and seGetCrtBytesPerScanline() return the number of bytes per scanline for the surface indicated in the function name. To work correctly the S1D13505 registers have been initialized prior to calling any of these routines. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the “stride” or number of bytes from the first byte of one scanline to the first byte of the next scanline. This value includes both the displayed and the non-displayed bytes on each logical scanline. For rotated display modes the return value will be either 1024 (8 bpp) or 2048 (15/16 bpp) to reflect the 1024 x 1024 virtual area of the rotated memory. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 112 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seSetSoftwareSuspend(BOOL Enable) Description: This function enables or disables software power suspend. When software suspend is enabled the S1D13506 reduces power consumption by making the displays inactive and ignoring memory accesses. Disabling software suspend reenables the video system to full functionality. Parameters: Enable Return Value: None. Call with Enable set to TRUE to set software power suspend Call with Enable set to FALSE to disable software power suspend. BOOL seGetSoftwareSuspend(void) Description: seGetSoftwareSuspend() returns the current state of software power suspend. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is TRUE if software suspend is enabled. The return FALSE if software suspend is not enabled. int seCheckEndian(BOOL *ReverseBytes) Description: This function returns the “endian-ness” of the CPU the application is running on. Parameters: ReverseBytes Return Value: The return value is always ERR_OK. A pointer to boolean value to receive the endian-ness of the system. On return from this function ReverseBytes is FALSE if the CPU is little endian (i.e. Intel). ReverseBytes will be TRUE if the CPU is big-endian (i.e. Motorola) unsigned seGetLcdOrientation(void) Description: This function retrieves the SwivelView orientation of the LCD display. The SwivelView status is read directly from the S1D13506 registers. Calling this function when the LCD display is not enabled will result in an erroneous return a value. Note Only the LCD interface supports SwivelView. A CRT/TV is always assumed to be in LANDSCAPE mode. Parameters: None. Return Value: LANDSCAPE ROTATE90 ROTATE180 ROTATE270 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Not rotated. Display is rotated 90 degrees clockwise. Display is rotated 180 degrees clockwise. Display is rotated 270 degrees. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 113 int seDelay(DWORD Seconds) Description: This function, intended for non-Intel platforms, delays for the specified number of seconds then returns to the calling routine. On several evaluation platforms it was not readily apparent where to obtain an accurate source of time delays. seDelay() was the result of the need to delay a specified amount of time on these platforms. seDelay works by calculating and counting the number of vertical non-display periods in the requested delay time. This implies two conditions for proper operation: a) The S1D13506 control registers must be configured to correct values. b) Either the CRT or LCD display interface must be enabled. On Intel and other supported platforms seDelay() calls the C library time functions to delay the desired amount of time. Parameters: Seconds The number of seconds to delay for. Return Value: ERR_OK ERR_FAILED Returned by all platforms at the completion of a successful delay. Returned by platforms which do not have time functions in their standard C library and either of the operating conditions is violated. void seDisplayBlank(BOOL Blank) void seDisplayLcdBlank(BOOL Blank) void seDisplayCrtBlank(BOOL Blank) void seDisplayTvBlank(BOOL Blank) Description: These functions blank the display by disabling the FIFO for the specified surface. Blanking the display is a fast convenient means of temporarily shutting down a display device For instance updating the entire display in one write may produce a flashing or tearing effect. If the display is blanked prior to performing the update then the operation is perceived to be smoother and cleaner. seDisplayBlank() will blank the display associated with the current active surface. seDisplayLcdBlank(), seDisplayCrtBlank(), and seDisplayTvBlank() blank the display for the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: Blank Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Call with Blank set to TRUE to blank the display. Call with Blank set to FALSE to un-blank the display. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 114 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seDisplayEnable(BOOL Enable) void seLcdDisplayEnable(BOOL Enable) void seCrtDisplayEnable(BOOL Enable) void seTvDisplayEnable(BOOL Enable) Description: These functions enable or disable the selected display device. seDisplayEnable() enables or disables the display for the active surface. seLcdDisplayEnable() enables or disables the LCD display. seCrtDisplayEnable() enables or disables the CRT display. seCrtDisplayEnable() will disable CRT/TV PCLK 2X clock and as a side effect will disable TV, if the TV was enabled. seTvDisplayEnable() enables or disables the TV display. If the CRT is enabled then seTvDisplayEnable() disables it. When seTvDisplayEnable is called the TV flicker filter is enabled or disabled based on the values saved by the configuration program. Parameters: Enable Return Value: None. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Call with Enable set to TRUE to enable the display device. Call with Enable set to FALSE to disable the device. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 115 14.2.2 Advance HAL Functions The advanced HAL functions include a level of access that most applications don’t will never need to access. int seBeginHighPriority(void) Description: Writing and debugging software under the Windows operating system greatly simplifies the developing process for the S1D13506 evaluation system. One issue which impedes application programming is that of latency. Time critical operations, performance measurement for instance, are not guaranteed any set amount of processor time. This function raises the priority of the thread and virtually eliminates the question of latency for programs running on a Windows platform. Note The application should not leave it’s thread running in a high priority state for long periods of time. As soon as a time critical operation is complete the application should call seEndHighPriorty(). Parameters: None. Return Value: ERR_OK If the function completes successfully. int seEndHighPriority(void) Description: The function returns the thread priority of the calling application to normal. After performing some time critical operation the application should call seEndHighPriority() to return the thread priority to a normal level. Parameters: None. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 116 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center int seSetClock(CLOCKSELECT ClockSelect, FREQINDEX FreqIndex) Description: Call seSetClock() to set the clock rate of the programmable clock. Parameters: ClockSelect The ICD2061A programmable clock chip supports two output clock signals. ClockSelect chooses which of the two output clocks to adjust. Valid ClockSelect values are defined by the HAL contents CLKI or CLKI2 FreqIndex FreqIndex is an enumerated constant and determines what the output frequency should be. Valid values for FreqIndex are: FREQ_6000 FREQ_10000 FREQ_14318 FREQ_17734 FREQ_20000 FREQ_24000 FREQ_25000 FREQ_25175 FREQ_28318 FREQ_30000 FREQ_31500 FREQ_32000 FREQ_33000 FREQ_33333 FREQ_34000 FREQ_35000 FREQ_36000 FREQ_40000 FREQ_49500 FREQ_50000 FREQ_56250 FREQ_65000 FREQ_80000 Return Value: ERR_OK ERR_FAILED 6.000 MHz 10.000 MHz 14.318 MHz 17.734 MHz 20.000 MHz 24.000 MHz 25.000 MHz 25.175 MHz 28.318 MHz 30.000 MHz 31.500 MHz 32.000 MHz 33.000 MHz 33.333 MHz 34.000 MHz 35.000 MHz 36.000 MHz 40.000 MHz 49.500 MHz 50.000 MHz 56.250 MHz 65.000 MHz 80.000 MHz The function completed with no problems. seSetClock failed the cause may be an invalid ClockSelect or an invalid frequency index Note If seSetClock is called with a ClockSelect of CLKI2 and FreqIndex of FREQ_17734 then the HAL will bypass the programmable clock and select the Feature Clock as the input clock source. This is done with the assumption that the application is setting up for TV output and the Feature Clock oscillator will provide a more stable clock for use with TV. (The feature oscillator must be 17.734 MHz) S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 117 14.2.3 Surface Support The S1D13506 HAL library depends heavily on the concept of surfaces. Through surfaces the HAL tracks memory requirements of the attached display devices, hardware cursor and ink layers, and the Dual Panel buffer. Surfaces allow the HAL to permit or fail function calls which change the geometry of the S1D13506 display memory. Most HAL functions either allocate surface memory or manipulate a surface that has been allocated. The functions in this sections allow the application programmer a little greater control over surfaces. int seGetSurfaceDisplayMode(void) Description: This function determines the type of display associated with the current active surface. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value indicates the active surface display type. Return values will be one of: LCD CRT TV The LCD panel is the active surface. The CRT display is the active surface. The TV is the active display. DWORD seGetSurfaceSize(void) Description: This function returns the number of display memory bytes allocated to the current active surface. The return value does not account for the size for the hardware cursor or ink layer which may be associated with the surface. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the number of bytes allocated to the current active surface. The return value can be 0 if this function is called before initializing and making active a surface. DWORD seGetSurfaceLinearAddress(void) Description: This function returns the linear address of the start of memory for the active surface. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the linear address to the start of memory for the active surface. A linear address is a 32-bit offset, in CPU address space. The return value will be NULL if this function is called before a surface has been initialized and made active. Note On 16-bit Intel platforms, this function will always return NULL. The PCI memory may be located beyond the addressing range of 16-bit programs so all S1D13505 controller accesses must be made through the HAL. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 118 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center DWORD seGetSurfaceOffsetAddress(void) Description: This function returns the offset, from the first byte of display memory to the first byte of memory associated with the active display surface. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the offset, in bytes, from the start of display memory to the start of the active surface. An address of 0 indicates the surface starts in the first byte of display buffer memory. Note This function also returns 0 if there is no memory allocated to an active surface. You must ensure that memory is allocated before calling seGetSurfaceOffsetAddress(). DWORD seAllocLcdSurface(DWORD Size) DWORD seAllocCrtSurface(DWORD Size) DWORD seAllocTvSurface(DWORD Size) Description: These functions allocate display buffer memory for a surface. If the surface previously had memory allocated then that memory is first released. Newly allocated memory is not cleared. Call seAllocLcdSurface(), seAllocCrtSurface(), and seAllocTvSurface() to allocate the requested amount of display memory for the indicated surface. These functions allow an application to bypass the automatic surface allocation which occurs when functions such as seInitReg() or seSetBitsPerPixel() are called. Parameters: Size The size in bytes of the requested memory block. Return Value: If the memory allocation succeeds then the return value is the linear address of the allocated memory. If the allocation fails then the return value is 0. A linear address is a 32-bit offset, in CPU address space. int seFreeSurface(DWORD LinearAddress) Description: This function can be called to free any previously allocated display buffer memory. This function is intended to complement seAllocLcdSurface(), seAllocCrtSurface(), and seAllocTvSurface(). seFreeSurface can be used to free memory allocated for the hardware cursor and ink layer however it is recommended that seFreeCursor() or seFreeInk() be called for these surfaces. After calling one of these functions the application must switch the active surface to one which has memory allocated before calling any drawing functions. Parameters: LinearAddress A valid linear address. The linear address is a dword returned to the application by any surface allocation call. Return Value: ERR_OK ERR_FAILED Function completed successfully. Function failed. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 119 void seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(void) void seSetCrtAsActiveSurface(void) void seSetTvAsActiveSurface(void) Description: These functions set the active surface to the display indicated in the function name. Before calling one of these surface selection routines, that surface must have been allocated using any of the surface allocation methods. Parameters: None. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 120 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.4 Register Access The Register Access functions provide convenient method of accessing the control registers of the S1D13506 controller using byte, word or dword widths. To reduce the overhead of the function call as much as possible, two steps were taken: • To gain maximum efficiency on all compilers and platforms, byte and word size arguments are passed between the application and the HAL as unsigned integers. This typically allows a compiler to produce more efficient code for the platform. • Index alignment for word and dword accesses is not tested. On non-Intel platforms attempting to access a word or dword on a non-aligned boundary may result in a processor trap. It is the responsibility of the caller to ensure that the requested index offset is correctly aligned for the target platform. unsigned seReadRegByte(DWORD Index) Description: This routine reads the register specified by Index and returns the value. Parameters: Index Return Value: The return value is the byte read from the register. Offset, in bytes, to the register to read. unsigned seReadRegWord(DWORD Index) Description: This routine read two consecutive registers as a word and returns the value. Parameters: Index Return Value: The return value is the word read from the S1D13506 registers. Offset to the first register to read. DWORD seReadRegDword(DWORD Index) Description: This routine reads four consecutive registers as a dword and returns the value. Parameters: Index Return Value: The return value is the dword read from the S1D13506 registers. Offset to the first of the four registers to read. int seWriteRegByte(DWORD Index, unsigned Value) Description: This routine writes Value to the register specified by Index. Parameters: Index Offset to the register to be written Value The value, in the least significant byte, to write to the register Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 121 void seWriteRegWord(DWORD Index, unsigned Value) Description: This routine writes the word contained in Value to the specified index. Parameters: Index Offset to the register pair to be written. Value The value, in the least significant word, to write to the registers. Return Value: None. void seWriteRegDword(DWORD Index, DWORD Value) Description: This routine writes the value specified to four registers starting at Index. Parameters: Index Offset to the register to be written to. Value The dword value to be written to the registers. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 122 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.5 Memory Access The Memory Access functions provide convenient method of accessing the display memory on an S1D13506 controller using byte, word or dword widths. To reduce the overhead of these function calls as much as possible, two steps were taken: • To gain maximum efficiency on all compilers and platforms, byte and word size arguments are passed between the application and the HAL as unsigned integers. This typically allows a compiler to produce more efficient code for the platform. • Offset alignment for word and dword accesses is not tested. On non-Intel platforms attempting to access a word or dword on a non-aligned boundary may result in a processor trap. It is the responsibility of the caller to ensure that the requested offset is correctly aligned for the target platform. unsigned seReadDisplayByte(DWORD Offset) Description: Reads a byte from the display buffer memory at the specified offset and returns the value. Parameters: Offset Return Value: The return value, in the least significant byte, is the byte read from display memory. Offset, in bytes, from start of the display buffer to the byte to read. unsigned seReadDisplayWord(DWORD Offset) Description: Reads one word from display buffer memory at the specified offset and returns the value. Parameters: Offset Return Value: The return value, in the least significant word, is the word read from display memory. Offset, in bytes, from start of the display buffer to the word to read. DWORD seReadDisplayDword(DWORD Offset) Description: Reads one dword from display buffer memory at the specified offset and returns the value. Parameters: Offset Return Value: The DWORD read from display memory. Offset, in bytes, from start of the display buffer to the dword to read. void seWriteDisplayBytes(DWORD Offset, unsigned Value, DWORD Count) Description: This routine writes one or more bytes to the display buffer at the offset specified by Offset. Parameters: Offset Offset, in bytes, from start of display memory to the first byte to be written. Value An unsigned integer containing the byte to be written in the least significant byte. Count Number of bytes to write. All bytes will have the same value. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 123 Note If ((Offset + Count) > memory size) then this function limits the writes to the end of display memory. void seWriteDisplayWords(DWORD Offset, unsigned Value, DWORD Count) Description: This routine writes one or more words to display memory starting at the specified offset. Parameters: Offset Offset, in bytes, from the start of display memory to the first word to write. Value An unsigned integer containing the word to written in the least significant word Count Number of words to write. All words will have the same value. Return Value: None. Note If ((Offset + (Count * 2)) > memory size) then this function limits the writes to the end of display memory. void seWriteDisplayDwords(DWORD Offset, DWORD Value, DWORD Count) Description: This routine writes one or more dwords to display memory starting at the specified offset. Parameters: Offset Return Value: Value Offset, in bytes, from the start of display memory to the first dword to write. The value to be written to display memory. Count Number of dwords to write. All dwords will have the same value. None. Note If ((Offset + (Count * 4)) > memory size) then this function limits the writes to the end of display memory. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 124 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.6 Color Manipulation The functions in the Color Manipulation section deal with altering the color values in the Look-Up Table directly through the accessor functions and indirectly through the color depth setting functions. Keep in mind that all lookup table data is contained in the upper nibble of each byte. void seWriteLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) void seWriteLcdLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) void seWriteCrtLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) void seWriteTvLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) ¦Description: These routines write one lookup table entry to the specified index of the lookup table. seWriteLutEntry() writes to the specified index of the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. seWriteLcdLutEntry(), seWriteCrtLutEntry() and seWriteTvLutEntry() modify one entry of the lookup table of the surface indicated in by the function name. Parameter: Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Index Offset to the lookup table entry to be modified. (i.e. a 0 will write the first entry and a 255 will write the last lookup table entry) pRGB A pointer to byte array of data to write to the lookup table. The array must consist of three bytes; the first byte contains the red value the second byte contains the green value and the third byte contains the blue value. None Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 125 void seReadLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) void seReadLcdLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) void seReadCrtLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) void seReadTvLutEntry(int Index, BYTE *pRGB) ¦Description: These routines read one lookup table entry and return the results in the byte array pointed to by pRGB. seReadLutEntry() reads the specified index from the lookup table of the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. seReadLcdLutEntry(), seReadCrtLutEntry(), and seReadTvLutEntry() read one entry form the lookup table for the surface indicated by the function name. Parameter: Return Value: Index Offset to the lookup table entry to be read. (i.e. setting index to 2 will return a the value of the third element of the lookup table) pRGB A pointer to an array to receive the lookup table data. The array must be at least three bytes long. On return from this function the first byte of the array will contain the red data, the second byte will contain the green data and the third byte will contain the blue data. None. void seWriteLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) void seWriteLcdLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) void seWriteCrtLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) void seWriteTvLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) ¦Description: These routines write one or more lookup table entries starting at offset zero. seWriteLut() modifies Count entries in the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. seWriteLcdLut(), seWriteCrtLut(), and seWriteTvLut() modifies the lookup table for the surface indicated in the function name. This routine is intended to allow setting as many lookup table entries as the current color depth allows in call. Parameter: Return Value: pRGB A pointer to an array of lookup table entry values to write to the LUT. Each lookup table entry must consist of three bytes. The first byte must contain the red value, the second byte must contain the green value and the third byte must contain the blue value to modify the lookup table with. Count The number of lookup table entries to modify. None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 126 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seReadLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) void seReadLcdLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) void seReadCrtLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) void seReadTvLut(BYTE *pRGB, int Count) ¦Description: This routine reads one or more lookup table entries and returns the result in the array pointed to by pRGB. The read always begins at the first lookup table entry. seReadLut() reads the first Count lookup table entries from the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. seReadLcdLut(), seReadCrtLut(), and seReadTvLut() read the first Count entries from the surface indicated by the function name. This routine allows reading all the lookup table elements used by the current color depth in one library call. Parameters: Return Value: pRGB A pointer to an array of bytes large enough to hold the requested number of lookup table entries. Each lookup table entry consists of three bytes; the first byte will contain the red data, the second the green data and the third the blue data. Count The number of lookup table entries to read. None. DWORD seSetBitsPerPixel(unsigned BitsPerPixel) DWORD seSetLcdBitsPerPixel(unsigned BitsPerPixel) DWORD seSetCrtBitsPerPixel(unsigned BitsPerPixel) DWORD seSetTvBitsPerPixel(unsigned BitsPerPixel) DWORD seSetLcdCrtBitsPerPixel(unsigned BitsPerPixel) DWORD seSetLcdTvBitsPerPixel(unsigned BitsPerPixel) Description: These functions change the color depth of the display and update the appropriate LUT. Display memory is automatically released and then reallocated as necessary for the display size. seSetBitsPerPixel() changes the bits-per-pixel mode for the active surface. Memory is reassigned according to the descriptions for each of the following mode sets. seSetLcdBitsPerPixel() changes the bits-per-pixel mode for the panel display. This function uses the current register settings for SwivelView to determine the amount of memory to allocate, and what starting register addresses are required. Note seSetLcdBitsPerPixel() frees CRT/TV memory in order to guarantee the LCD image starts at the beginning of display buffer memory. seSetCrtBitsPerPixel() and seSetTvBitsPerPixel() change the bits-per-pixel mode for the indicated display device. These functions ignore the rotate90 and rotate180 register bits. Memory is allocated only for the landscape mode. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 127 seSetLcdCrtBitsPerPixel() and seSetLcdTvBitsPerPixel() change the color depth for a surface which combines LCD and CRT/TV. Portrait (SwivelView 90) is disabled. If the display resolution is not the same for the two displays then memory is allocated based on the larger of the two. IMPORTANT When the LCD color depth is changed, memory allocated for the display buffer and ink layer/hardware cursors is freed and the display buffer memory is reassigned. The application must redraw the display and re-initialize the cursor/ink and redraw after calling seSetBitsPerPixel(). seSetLcdCrtBitsPerPixel(), and seSetLcdTvBitsPerPixel() will free all allocated memory for all displays and all ink layers/hardware cursors, then allocate memory only for the display(s) mentioned in the function name. The cursor/ink must be re-initialized and restored after making one of these calls. If the active surface is the panel then seSetBitsPerPixel() will free all allocated memory for all displays and all ink layers/hardware cursors, then allocate memory ONLY for the active surface (LCD). If the active surface is the CRT or TV, seSetBitsPerPixel() will free memory only for the active surface (CRT or TV), and then reallocate memory for this surface as required. Parameters: BitsPerPixel The new color depth. BitsPerPixel can be one of the following: 4, 8, 15, 16. Return Value: The return value is the thirty-two bit offset to the start of the surface display memory. If there is an error the return value is 0. A linear address is the 32-bit offset, in CPU address space, where the application can directly read or write display memory. The thirty-two bit address must be converted to a segment:offset for use with a 16-bit Intel platform. unsigned seGetBitsPerPixel(void) unsigned seGetLcdBitsPerPixel(void) unsigned seGetCrtBitsPerPixel(void) unsigned seGetTvBitsPerPixel(void); Description: These functions returns the current color depth for a the associated display surface. seGetBitsPerPixel() returns the color depth for the current active surface. seGetLcdBitsPerPixel(), seGetCrtBitsPerPixel(), and seGetTvBitsPerPixel() return the color depth for the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The color depth of the surface. This value will be 4, 8, 15 or 16. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 128 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.7 Virtual Display int seVirtInit(DWORD Width, DWORD Height) int seLcdVirtInit(DWORD Width, DWORD Height) int seCrtVirtInit(DWORD Width, DWORD Height) int seTvVirtInit(DWORD Width, DWORD Height) int seLcdCrtVirtInit(DWORD Width, DWORD Height) int seLcdTvVirtInit(DWORD Width, DWORD Height) Description: These functions prepare the S1D13506 for displaying a virtual image. “Virtual Image” describes the condition where the image contained in display memory is larger than the physical display. In this situation the display surface is used as a window into the larger display memory area. Panning (right/left) and scrolling (up/down) are used move the display surface in order to view the entire image a portion at a time. seVirtInit() prepares the current active surface for virtual image display. Memory is allocated based on width, height and the current color depth. seLcdVirtInit initializes and allocates memory for the LCD based on width and height and color depth. If the panel surface is rotated 90 or 270 degrees then the height is limited to a maximum 1024 lines. seCrtVirtInit and seTvVirtInit initialize and allocate memory for the given display based on current width and height and color depth. seLcdCrtVirtInit and seLcdTvVirtInit initialize and allocate memory for a surface which combines both LCD and CRT/TV. Memory is allocated based on the requirements of the larger of the two surfaces (if different). If the panel surface is rotated 90 or 270 degrees then the height is limited to a maximum of 1024 lines. Memory previously allocated for this surface is released then reallocated to the larger size. Parameters: Width The desired virtual width of the display in pixels. Width must be a multiple of the number of pixels contained in one word of display memory. At 15/16 bit per pixel Width may be any value. At 8 bit per pixel Width must be a multiple of two and at 4 bit per pixel Width must be a multiple of four. Height The desired virtual height of the display in pixels. The HAL performs internal memory management to ensure that all display surfaces and cursor/ink layer have sufficient memory for operation. The Height parameter is required so the HAL can determine the amount of memory the application requires for the virtual image. Return Value: ERR_OK The function completed successfully. ERR_HAL_BAD_ARG The requested virtual dimensions are smaller than the physical display size. ERR_NOT_ENOUGH_MEMORY There is insufficient free display memory to set the requested virtual display size. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 129 void seVirtPanScroll(DWORD x, DWORD y) void seLcdVirtPanScroll(DWORD x, DWORD y) void seCrtVirtPanScroll(DWORD x, DWORD y) void seTvVirtPanScroll(DWORD x, DWORD y) void seLcdCrtVirtPanScroll(DWORD x, DWORD y) void seLcdTvVirtPanScroll(DWORD x, DWORD y) Description: When displaying a virtual image the display surface is smaller than the virtual image contained in display memory. In order to view the entire image the display is treated as a window into the virtual image. These functions allow an application to pan (right and left) and scroll (up and down) the display over the virtual image. seVirtPanScroll() will pan and scroll the current active surface. seLcdVirtPanScroll(), seCrtVirtPanScroll(), seTvVirtPanScroll(), seLcdCrtVirtPanScroll(), and seLcdTvVirtPanScroll() will pan and scroll the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: Return Value: x The new x offset, in pixels, of the upper left corner of the display. y The new y offset, in pixels, of the upper left corner of the display. None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 130 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.8 Drawing Functions in this category perform primitive drawing on the specified display surface. Supported drawing primitive include pixels, lines, rectangles, ellipses and circles. void seSetPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) void seSetLcdPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) void seSetCrtPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) void seSetTvPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) Description: These routines set a pixel at the location x,y with the specified color. Use seSetPixel() to set one pixel on the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. Use seSetLcdPixel(), seSetCrtPixel(), and seSetTvPixel() to set one pixel on the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: x The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the pixel to set. y The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the pixel to set. Color Specifies the color to draw the pixel with. Color is interpreted differently at different color depths. At 4 and 8 bit per pixel display colors are derived from the lookup table values. The least significant byte of Color forms an index into the lookup table. At 15 and 16 bit per pixel the lookup table is bypassed and each word of display memory forms the color to display. At 15 bit per pixel the least significant word directly represents the color to draw the pixel with as a 5-5-5 RGB value with the most significant bit of the word discarded. In 16 bit per pixel display mode the least significant word describes the color to draw the pixel with in 5-6-5 RGB format. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 131 DWORD seGetPixel(long x, long y) DWORD seGetLcdPixel(long x, long y) DWORD seGetCrtPixel(long x, long y) DWORD seGetTvPixel(long x, long y) Description: Returns the pixel color at the specified display location Use seGetPixel() to read the pixel color at the specified x,y co-ordinates on the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. Use seGetLcdPixel(), seGetCrtPixel(), and seGetTvPixel() to read the pixel color at the specified x,y co-ordinate on the display surface referenced in the function name. Parameters: Return Value: x The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the pixel to read y The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the pixel to read The return value is a dword describing the color read at the x,y co-ordinate. Color is interpreted differently at different color depths. At 4 and 8 bit per pixel, display colors are derived from the lookup table values. The return value is an index into the lookup table. The red, green and blue components of the color can be determined by reading the lookup table values at the returned index. At 15 and 16 bit per pixel the lookup table is bypassed and each word of display memory form the color to display. At 15 bit per pixel the least significant word of the return value directly represents the color of the pixel as a 5-5-5 RGB value with the most significant bit of the word discarded. In 16 bit per pixel display mode the least significant word of the return value describes the color as a 5-6-5 RGB value. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 132 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seDrawLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) void seDrawLcdLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) void seDrawCrtLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) void seDrawTvLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) Description: These functions draw a line between two points in the specified color. Use seDrawLine() to draw a line on the current active surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. Use seDrawLcdLine(), seDrawCrtLine(), and seDrawTvLine() to draw a line on the surface referenced by the function name Parameters: x1 The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the first endpoint of the line to be drawn. y1 The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, or the first endpoint of the line to be drawn. x2 The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the second endpoint of the line to be drawn. y2 The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the second endpoint of the line to be drawn. Color Specifies the color to draw the line with. Color is interpreted differently at different color depths. At 4 and 8 bit per pixel display colors are derived from the lookup table values. The least significant byte of Color is an index into the lookup table. At 15 and 16 bit per pixel the lookup table is bypassed and each word of display memory forms the color to display. At 15 bit per pixel the least significant word directly represents the color to draw the line with as a 5-5-5 RGB value with the most significant bit of the word discarded. In 16 bit per pixel display mode the least significant word describes the color to draw the line with in 5-6-5 RGB format. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 133 void seDrawRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawLcdRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawCrtRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawTvRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color, BOOL SolidFill) Description: These routines draw a rectangle on the screen in the specified color. The rectangle is bounded on the upper left by the co-ordinate x1,y1 and on the lower right by the co-ordinate x2,y2. The SolidFill parameter allows the programmer to select whether to fill the interior or the rectangle or to only draw the border. Use seDrawRect() to draw a rectangle on the current active display surface.See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. Use seDrawLcdRect(), seDrawCrtRect(), and seDrawTvRect() to draw a rectangle on the display surface indicated by the function name. Parameters: x1 The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the upper left corner of the rectangle. y1 The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the upper left corner of the rectangle. x2 The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the lower right corner of the rectangle. y2 The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the lower right corner of the rectangle. Color Specifies the color to draw the line with. Color is interpreted differently at different color depths. At 4 and 8 bit per pixel display colors are derived from the lookup table values. The least significant byte of Color is an index into the lookup table. At 15 and 16 bit per pixel the lookup table is bypassed and each word of display memory forms the color to display. At 15 bit per pixel the least significant word directly represents the color to draw the line with as a 5-5-5 RGB value with the most significant bit of the word discarded. In 16 bit per pixel display mode the least significant word describes the color to draw the line with in 5-6-5 RGB format. SolidFill A boolean value specifying whether to fill the interior of the rectangle. Set to FALSE “0” to draw only the rectangle border. Set to TRUE “non-zero” to instruct this routine to fill the interior of the rectangle. Return Value: None Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 134 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seDrawCircle(long xCenter, long yCenter, long Radius, DWORD Color) void seDrawLcdCircle(long xCenter, long yCenter, long Radius, DWORD Color) void seDrawCrtCircle(long xCenter, long yCenter, long Radius, DWORD Color) void seDrawTvCircle(long xCenter, long yCenter, long Radius, DWORD Color) Description: These routines draw a circle on the screen in the specified color. The circle is centered at the co-ordinate x,y and is drawn with the specified radius and Color. Circles cannot be solid filled. Use seDrawCircle() to draw the circle on the current active display surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. Use seDrawLcdCircle(), seDrawCrtCircle(), seDrawTvCircle() draw the circle on the display surface indicated by the function name Parameters: x The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the center of the circle. y The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, or the center of the circle. Radius Specifies the radius of the circle in pixels. Color Specifying the color to draw the circle. Color is interpreted differently at different color depths. At 4 and 8 bit per pixel display colors are derived from the lookup table values. The least significant byte of Color is an index into the lookup table. At 15 and 16 bit per pixel the lookup table is bypassed and each word of display memory forms the color to display. At 15 bit per pixel the least significant word directly represents the color to draw the circle with as a 5-5-5 RGB value with the most significant bit of the word discarded. In 16 bit per pixel display mode the least significant word describes the color to draw the circle with in 5-6-5 RGB format. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 135 void seDrawEllipse(long xc, long yc, long xr, long yr, DWORD Color) void seDrawLcdEllipse(long xc, long yc, long xr, long yr, DWORD Color) void seDrawCrtEllipse(long xc, long yc, long xr, long yr, DWORD Color) void seDrawTvEllipse(long xc, long yc, long xr, long yr, DWORD Color) Description: These routines draw an ellipse on the screen in the specified color. The circle is centered at the co-ordinate x,y and is drawn in the specified color with the indicated radius for the x and y axis. Ellipses cannot be solid filled. Use seDrawEllipse() to draw the circle on the current active display surface. See seSetLcdAsActiveSurface(), seSetCrtAsActiveSurface() and seSetTvAsActiveSurface() for information about changing the active surface. Use seDrawLcdEllipse(), seDrawCrtEllipse(), seDrawTvEllipse() draw the ellipse on the display surface indicated by the function name Parameters: xc The X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the center of the ellipse. yc The Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the center of the ellipse. xr A long integer specifying the X radius of the ellipse, in pixels. yr A long integer specifying the Y radius of the ellipse, in pixels. Color A dword specifying the color to draw the ellipse. Color is interpreted differently at different color depths. At 4 and 8 bit per pixel display colors are derived from the lookup table values. The least significant byte of Color is an index into the lookup table. At 15 and 16 bit per pixel the lookup table is bypassed and each word of display memory forms the color to display. At 15 bit per pixel the least significant word directly represents the color to draw the ellipse with as a 5-5-5 RGB value with the most significant bit of the word discarded. In 16 bit per pixel display mode the least significant word describes the color to draw the circle with in 5-6-5 RGB format. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 136 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.2.9 Hardware Cursor The routines in this section support hardware cursor. Most of the calls look similar to normal drawing calls (i.e. seDrawCursorLine()); however, these calls remove the programmer from having to know the particulars of the cursor memory location, layout and whether portrait mode is enabled. The same S1D13506 uses the same hardware for both hardware cursor and ink layer which means that only the cursor or the ink layer can be active at any given time.The difference between the hardware cursor and the ink layer is that in cursor mode the image is a maximum of 64x64 pixels and can be moved around the display while in ink layer mode the image is as large as the physical size of the display and is fixed in position. Both the ink layer and hardware cursor have the same number of colors and handle these colors identically. DWORD seInitCursor(void) DWORD seInitLcdCursor(void) DWORD seInitCrtCursor(void) DWORD seInitTvCursor(void) Description: These functions allocate cursor memory, fills the cursor image with a transparent block, and enable the cursor. If memory was previously allocated for the cursor, this memory is first released. The S1D13506 supports two independent hardware cursors, one on a panel surface and one on the CRT/TV surface. Use seInitCursor() to initialize the cursor for the active surface. Use seInitLcdCursor(), seInitCrtCursor(), and seInitTvCursor() initialize the cursor on the display surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the thirty-two bit offset to the start of the hardware cursor memory. If there is an error the return value is 0. Note On a 16-bit DOS the return value must be converted into a segment:offset before use. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 137 void seFreeCursor(void) void seFreeLcdCursor(void) void seFreeCrtCursor(void) void seFreeTvCursor(void) Description: These functions release memory allocated to the hardware cursor by seInitCursor() functions. Use seFreeCursor() to free the hardware cursor memory for the current active surface. Use seFreeLcdCursor(), seFreeCrtCursor(), and seFreeTvCursor() to free the resources associated with the surface indicated by the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: None. void seEnableCursor(int Enable) void seEnableLcdCursor(int Enable) void seEnableCrtCursor(int Enable) void seEnableTvCursor(int Enable) Description: These functions enable or disable the hardware cursor. When enabled the cursor will be visible on the display surface. When disabled the cursor will not be displayed. Call seEnableCursor() to enable/disable the hardware cursor of the active surface. Call seEnableLcdCursor(), seEnableCrtCursor(), and seEnableTvCursor() to enable/disable the hardware cursor for the surface indicated by the function name. Recall that the CRT and TV share the same cursor. Enabling/disabling the cursor for one device will affect the other display as well. Parameters: Enable A flag indicating whether to enable or disable the hardware cursor. Call with Enable set to FALSE “0” to disable the hardware cursor for the surface. Call with Enable set to TRUE “non-0” to enable the hardware cursor for the device. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 138 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center DWORD seGetCursorLinearAddress(void) DWORD seGetLcdCursorLinearAddress(void) DWORD seGetCrtCursorLinearAddress(void) DWORD seGetTvCursorLinearAddress(void) Description: These routines return address for the hardware cursor through which the application can directly access the cursor memory. Call seGetCursorLinearAddress() to retrieve the address of the hardware cursor associated with the current active surface. Call seGetLcdCursorLinearAddress(), seGetCrtCursorLinearAddress(), or seGetTvCursorLinearAddress() to retrieve the address of the hardware cursor associated with the display surface indicated by the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the linear address of the hardware cursor. A linear address is the 32 bit offset in CPU address space where the application can directly read or write the hardware cursor. DWORD seGetCursorOffsetAddress(void) DWORD seGetLcdCursorOffsetAddress(void) DWORD seGetCrtCursorOffsetAddress(void) DWORD seGetTvCursorOffsetAddress(void) Description: These routines return the offset in display memory of the hardware cursor. Using this offset the application can use HAL API calls such as seSetWriteDisplayBytes() to access the hardware cursor image. Call seGetCursorOffsetAddress() to get the offset to the hardware cursor associated with the current active surface. Call seGetLcdCursorOffsetAddress(), seGetCrtCursorOffsetAddress(), and seGetTvCursorOffsetAddress() to retrieve the offset to the hardware cursor for the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the offset, in bytes, from the start of display memory to the start of the hardware cursor. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 139 void seMoveCursor(long x, long y) void seMoveLcdCursor(long x, long y) void seMoveCrtCursor(long x, long y) void seMoveTvCursor(long x, long y) Description: These routines are move where the hardware cursor is shown on the display surface. Call seMoveCursor() to move the hardware cursor on the current active surface. Call seMoveLcdCursor(), seMoveCrtCursor(), and seMoveTvCursor() to move the hardware cursor associated with the surface indicated in the function name. Parameter: Return Value: x The desired display surface X co-ordinate, in pixels, of the upper left corner of the cursor. y The desired display surface Y co-ordinate, in pixels, of the upper left corner of the cursor. None. void seSetCursorColor(int Index, DWORD Color) void seSetLcdCursorColor(int Index, DWORD Color) void seSetCrtCursorColor(int Index, DWORD Color) void seSetTvCursorColor(int Index, DWORD Color) Description: These routines allow the user to set the either of the two user definable colors. The hardware cursor can be thought of as a four color image. Two of the colors cannot be changed. Displaying these two colors in a cursor image will always result in transparent and inverse video being displayed. The remaining two colors can be changed. Call seSetCursorColor() to change the cursor colors for the current active surface. Call seSetLcdCursorColor(), seSetCrtCursorColor(), or seSetTvCursorColor() to change the color for the surface associated with the function name. Parameters: Index Specifies which of the two application changeable colors this operation is to affect. Legal values for Index are 0 and 1. Color The new color to set as the hardware cursor color. The color values in the dword are arranged as follows: xxxx xxxx xxxR RRRR xxGG GGGG xxxB BBB Where x is don’t care (set to 0), R is five bits of red intensity, G is six bits of green intensity and B is five bits of blue intensity. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 140 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seSetCursorPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) void seSetLcdCursorPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) void seSetCrtCursorPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) void seSetTvCursorPixel(long x, long y, DWORD Color) Description: These functions are intended for drawing in the hardware cursor area a pixel at a time. Call seSetCursorPixel() to set a pixel in the cursor associated with the current active surface. Call seSetLcdCursorPixel(), seSetCrtCursorPixel(), and seSetTvCursorPixel() to set pixels in the cursor associated with the display surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: x The X co-ordinate of the cursor, in pixels, at which to set the pixel color. Valid values for x range from 0 to 63. y The Y co-ordinate of the cursor, in pixels, a which to set the pixel color. Valid values for y range from 0 to 63. Color Specifies which of the four cursor colors set the pixel to. Valid values for Color are: 0 - to set the pixel to the solid color 0 1 - to set the pixel to the solid color 1 2 - to set the pixel to the transparent color 3 - to set the pixel to the inverted color. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 141 void seDrawCursorLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) void seDrawLcdCursorLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) void seDrawCrtCursorLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) void seDrawTvCursorLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD Color) Description: These routines assist in defining the cursor shape by drawing a line in the hardware cursor between the specified points. Call seDrawCursorLine() to draw a line in the hardware cursor image associated with the current active surface. Call seDrawLcdCursorLine(), seDrawCrtCursorLine(), or seDrawTvCursorLine() to draw a line in the hardware cursor image associated with the display surface indicated in the function name. Parameter: x1 Specifies the X co-ordinate of the first endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the left edge of the cursor image. y1 Specifies the Y co-ordinate of the first endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the top edge of the cursor image. x2 Specifies the X co-ordinate of the second endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the left edge of the cursor image. y2 Specifies the Y co-ordinate of the second endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the top edge of the cursor image. Color Specifies which of the four cursor colors to draw the line with. Valid values for Color are: 0 - to draw the line in solid color 0 1 - to draw the line in solid color 1 2 - to draw the line in the transparent color 3 - to draw the line in the inverted color. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 142 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seDrawCursorRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFIll) void seDrawLcdCursorRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawCrtCursorRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawTvCursorRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFill) Description: These routines draw rectangles on the hardware cursor surface. The rectangle may be drawn as just a border or as a solid filled area. Call seDrawCursorRect() to draw a rectangle in the hardware cursor image associated with the current active surface. Call seDrawLcdCursorRect(), seDrawCrtCursorRect(), or seDrawTvCursorRect() to draw a rectangle in the hardware cursor image associated with the display surface indicated by the function name. Parameter: x1 The X co-ordinate for the top left corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the left edge of the cursor image. y1 The Y co-ordinate for the top left corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the top of the cursor image. x2 The X co-ordinate for the bottom right corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the left edge of the cursor image. y2 The Y co-ordinate for the bottom right corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the top edge of the cursor image. Color Specifies which of the four cursor colors to draw the line with. Valid values for Color are: 0 - to draw the rectangle in solid color 0 1 - to draw the rectangle in solid color 1 2 - to draw the rectangle to the transparent color 3 - to draw the rectangle in the inverted color. SolidFill Flags whether to fill the rectangle as or to only draw the border. Set SolidFill to FALSE (“0”) to draw only the outline of the rectangle. Set SolidFill to TRUE (“1”) to fill the interior of the rectangle. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 143 14.2.10 Ink Layer The functions in this section support the hardware ink layer. These functions are nearly identical to the routines to control the hardware cursor. The same S1D13506 uses the same hardware for both hardware cursor and ink layer which means that only the cursor or the ink layer can be active at any given time.The difference between the hardware cursor and the ink layer is that in cursor mode the image is a maximum of 64x64 pixels and can be moved around the display while in ink layer mode the image is as large as the physical size of the display and is fixed in position. Both the ink layer and hardware cursor have the same number of colors and handle these colors identically. DWORD seInitInk(void) DWORD seInitLcdInk(void) DWORD seInitCrtInk(void) DWORD seInitTvInk(void) Description: These functions initialize the ink layer for use. The initialization includes: allocating ink layer memory, filling the ink layer image with a transparent color, and enabling the ink layer. If memory was previously allocated for the ink layer or a hardware cursor on the surface then this memory is first released. Call seInitInk() to initialize the ink layer for the current active surface. Call seInitLcdInk(), seInitCrtInk(), and seInitTvInk() to initialize the ink layer for the surface indicated in the display name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the thirty-two bit offset in CPU address space to the start of the ink layer memory. If there is an error the return value is 0. Note On 16-bit DOS systems the return value must be converted into a segment:offset before use. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 144 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seFreeInk(void) void seFreeLcdInk(void) void seFreeCrtInk(void) void seFreeTvInk(void) Description: These functions release the memory allocations made by the call to the seInitInk() calls. Prior to calling the seFreeInk() functions the application must make a call to seEnableInk() to hide the ink layer. Call seFreeInk() to Free the ink layer memory associated with the current active surface. Call seFreeLcdInk(), seFreeCrtInk(), or seFreeTvInk() to free the ink layer memory associated with the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: None. void seEnableInk(int Enable) void seEnableLcdInk(int Enable) void seEnableCrtInk(int Enable) void seEnableTvInk(int Enable) Description: These functions enable or disable the hardware ink layer. When enabled the ink layer will be visible and when disabled the ink layer will be hidden. Call seEnableInk() to enable/disable the ink layer associated with the current active surface. Call seEnableLcdInk(), seEnableCrtInk(), and seEnableTvInk() to enable/disable the hardware ink layer for the surface indicated by the function name. Recall that the CRT and TV share the same ink layer. Enabling/disabling the ink layer for one device will affect the other display as well. Parameters: Enable A flag indicating whether to enable or disable the ink layer. Set Enable to FALSE (0) to disable the ink layer or set Enable to TRUE (non-0) to enable the ink layer. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 145 DWORD seGetInkLinearAddress(void) DWORD seGetLcdInkLinearAddress(void) DWORD seGetCrtInkLinearAddress(void) DWORD seGetTvInkLinearAddress(void) Description: These routines return address for the hardware ink layer through which the application can directly access the ink layer memory. Call seGetInkLinearAddress() to retrieve the address of the ink layer associated with the current active surface. Call seGetLcdInkLinearAddress(), seGetCrtInkLinearAddress(), or seGetTvInkLinearAddress() to retrieve the address of the ink layer associated with the display surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the linear address of the hardware cursor. A linear address is the 32 bit offset in CPU address space where the application can directly read or write the hardware ink layer memory DWORD seGetInkOffsetAddress(void) DWORD seGetLcdInkOffsetAddress(void) DWORD seGetCrtInkOffsetAddress(void) DWORD seGetTvInkOffsetAddress(void) Description: These routines return the offset in display memory of the hardware ink layer. Using this offset an application can use HAL API calls such as seSetWriteDisplayBytes() to access the ink layer memory. Call seGetInkOffsetAddress() to get the offset to the ink layer associated with the current active surface. Call seGetLcdInkOffsetAddress(), seGetCrtInkOffsetAddress(), and seGetTvInkOffsetAddress() to retrieve the offset to the ink layer for the surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the offset, in bytes, from the start of display memory to the start of ink layer memory. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 146 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seSetInkColor(int index, DWORD color) void seSetLcdInkColor(int index, DWORD color) void seSetCrtInkColor(int index, DWORD color) void seSetTvInkColor(int index, DWORD color) Description: These routines allow the user to set the either of the two user definable hardware ink layer colors. The hardware ink layer can be thought of as a four color image of which only two colors can be changed. The non-changeable colors will displays as transparent and inverted colors. Call seSetInkColor() to change the in colors for the current active surface. Call seSetLcdInkColor(), seSetCrtInkColor(), or seSetTvInkColor() to change the color for the surface indicated by the function name. Parameters: Index Index to specifies which of the two changeable colors to access. Valid values for Index are 0 and 1. Color The new color to set as the ink layer color. The color values in the dword are arranged as follows: xxxx xxxx xxxR RRRR xxGG GGGG xxxB BBB Where x is don’t care (set to 0), R is five bits of red intensity, G is six bits of green intensity and B is five bits of blue intensity. Return Value: None. void seSetInkPixel(long x, long y, DWORD color) void seSetLcdInkPixel(long x, long y, DWORD color) void seSetCrtInkPixel(long x, long y, DWORD color) void seSetTvInkPixel(long x, long y, DWORD color) Description: These functions are intended for drawing on the hardware ink layer a pixel at a time. Call seSetInkPixel() to set a pixel in the ink layer associated with the current active surface. Call seSetLcdInkPixel(), seSetCrtInkPixel(), and seSetTvInkPixel() to set pixels in the ink layer associated with the display surface indicated in the function name. Parameters: x The X co-ordinate of the ink layer, in pixels, at which to set the pixel color. Valid values for x range from 0 to display width - 1. y The Y co-ordinate of the ink layer, in pixels, a which to set the pixel color. Valid values for y range from 0 to display height - 1. Color Specifies which of the four cursor colors set the pixel to. Valid values for Color are: 0 - to set the pixel to the solid color 0 1 - to set the pixel to the solid color 1 2 - to set the pixel to the transparent color 3 - to set the pixel to the inverted color. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 147 void seDrawInkLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color) void seDrawLcdInkLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color) void seDrawCrtInkLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color) void seDrawTvInkLine(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color) Description: These routines draw lines on the hardware ink layer between two points in the specified color. Call seDrawInkLine() to draw a line in the hardware ink layer associated with the current active surface. Call seDrawLcdInkLine(), seDrawCrtInkLine(), or seDrawTvInkLine() to draw a line in the hardware ink layer image associated with the display surface indicated in the function name. Parameter: x1 Specifies the X co-ordinate of the first endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the left edge of the display. y1 Specifies the Y co-ordinate of the first endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the top edge of the display. x2 Specifies the X co-ordinate of the second endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the left edge of the display. y2 Specifies the Y co-ordinate of the second endpoint of the line measured in pixels from the top edge of the display. Color Specifies which of the four ink layer colors to draw the line with. Valid values for Color are: 0 - to draw the line in solid color 0 1 - to draw the line in solid color 1 2 - to draw the line in the transparent color 3 - to draw the line in the inverted color. Return Value: None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 148 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center void seDrawInkRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawLcdInkRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawCrtInkRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFill) void seDrawTvInkRect(long x1, long y1, long x2, long y2, DWORD color, BOOL SolidFIll) Description: These routines draw rectangles on the hardware ink layer surface. The rectangle may be drawn as just a border or as a solid filled area. Call seDrawInkRect() to draw a rectangle in the hardware ink layer cursor image associated with the current active surface. Call seDrawLcdInkRect(), seDrawCrtInkRect(), or seDrawTvInkRect() to draw a rectangle in the hardware ink layer associated with the display surface indicated by the function name. Parameter: x1 The X co-ordinate for the top left corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the left edge of the display surface. y1 The Y co-ordinate for the top left corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the top edge of the display surface. x2 The X co-ordinate for the bottom right corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the left edge of the display surface. y2 The Y co-ordinate for the bottom right corner of the rectangle measured in pixels from the top edge of the display surface. Color Specifies which of the four ink layer colors to draw the line with. Valid values for Color are: 0 - to draw the rectangle in solid color 0 1 - to draw the rectangle in solid color 1 2 - to draw the rectangle to the transparent color 3 - to draw the rectangle in the inverted color. SolidFill Flags whether to fill the rectangle as or to only draw the border. Set SolidFill to FALSE (“0”) to draw only the outline of the rectangle. Set SolidFill to TRUE (“1”) to fill the interior of the rectangle. Return Value: S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 None. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 149 14.2.11 PCI Support The S1D13506 utilizes up to two megabytes of display memory. Addressing that much memory on Intel ISA based evaluation platforms is difficult and prone to introducing conflicts. To overcome these obstacles the standard PCI evaluation boar is PCI based. By placing the S1D13506 evaluation board on a PCI bus the issue of address space is eliminated. In addition 32 bit software can be written and debugged in a Microsoft Windows environment before being ported to an embedded platform. In order for an application to access the S1D13506 memory and register the following two functions are provided. DWORD seGetLinearDisplayAddress(void) Description: This function returns the linear address for the start of physical display memory on a PCI system Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the linear address of the start of display memory. A linear address is a 32-bit offset, in CPU address space. DWORD seGetLinearRegAddress(void) Description: This function returns the linear address of the start of S1D13506 control registers. Parameters: None. Return Value: The return value is the linear address of the start of S1D13506 control registers. A linear address is a 32-bit offset, in CPU address space. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 150 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 14.3 Porting LIBSE to a new target platform Building Epson applications like a simple HelloApp for a new target platform requires 3 things, the HelloApp code, the 13506HAL library, and a some standard C functions (portable ones are encapsulated in our mini C library LIBSE). HelloApp Source code HelloApp C Library Functions (LIBSE for embedded platforms) 13506HAL Library Figure 14-1: Components needed to build 13506 HAL application For example, when building HELLOAPP.EXE for the x86 16-bit platform, you need the HELLOAPP source files, the 13506HAL library and its include files, and some Standard C library functions (which in this case would be supplied by the compiler as part of its runtime library). As this is a DOS .EXE application, you do not need to supply start-up code that sets up the chip selects or interrupts, etc... What if you wanted to build the application for an SH-3 target, one not running DOS? Before you can build that application to load onto the target, you need to build a C library for the target that contains enough of the Standard C functions (like sprintf and strcpy) to let you build the application. Epson supplies the LIBSE for this purpose, but your compiler may come with one included. You also need to build the 13506HAL library for the target. This library is the graphics chip dependent portion of the code. Finally, you need to build the final application, linked together with the libraries described earlier. The following examples assume that you have a copy of the complete source code for the S1D13506 utilities, including the nmake makefiles, as well as a copy of the GNU Compiler v2.7-96q3a for Hitachi SH3. These are available on the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 151 14.3.1 Building the LIBSE library for SH3 target example In the LIBSE files, there are three main types of files: • C files that contain the library functions. • assembler files that contain the target specific code. • makefiles that describe the build process to construct the library. The C files are generic to all platforms, although there are some customizations for targets in the form of #ifdef LCEVBSH3 code (the ifdef used for the example SH3 target Low Cost Eval Board SH3). The majority of this code remains constant whichever target you build for. The assembler files contain some platform setup code (stacks, chip selects) and jumps into the main entry point of the C code that is contained in the C file entry.c. For our example, the assembler file is STARTSH3.S and it performs only some stack setup and a jump into the code at _mainEntry (entry.c). In the embedded targets, printf (in file rprintf.c), putchar (putchar.c) and getch (kb.c) resolve to serial character input/output. For SH3, much of the detail of handling serial IO is hidden in the monitor of the evaluation board, but in general the primitives are fairly straight forward, providing the ability to get characters to/from the serial port. For our target example, the nmake makefile is makesh3.mk. This makefile calls the Gnu compiler at a specific location (TOOLDIR), enumerates the list of files that go into the target and builds a .a library file as the output of the build process. With nmake.exe in your path run: nmake -fmakesh3.mk 14.3.2 Building a complete application for the target example Source code for this example is available in the file 56_sh3_target.c. This file is available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Page 152 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 15 Sample Code Example source code demonstrating programming the S1D13506 using the HAL library is availble on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. Also included are three header files that may make some of the structures used clearer. S1D13506 X25B-G-003-03 Programming Notes and Examples Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Register Summary X25B-R-001-02 REG[000h] REVISION CODE REGISTER 2 (For S1D13506: Product Code=000100b, Revision Code=01b)RO Product Code Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Revision Code Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 1 Reserved Reserved RW REG[032h] LCD HORIZONTAL DISPLAY WIDTH REGISTER n/a Bit 0 LCD Horizontal Display Width Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW REG[034h] LCD HORIZONTAL NON-DISPLAY PERIOD REGISTER 1/0 REG[001h] MISCELLANEOUS REGISTER Register/ Memory Select n/a n/a n/a n/a RW Reserved n/a n/a LCD Horizontal Non-Display Period n/a Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW REG[035h] TFT FPLINE START POSITION REGISTER REG[004h] GENERAL I/O P INS CONFIGURATION REGISTER 3 Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved 1/0 RW n/a GPIO3 Pin I/O Config GPIO2 Pin I/O Config GPIO1 Pin I/O Config GPIO3 Pin I/O Status GPIO2 Pin I/O Status GPIO1 Pin I/O Status Reserved Reserved Reserved Reserved MD[2] Status MD[1] Status MD[0] Status RW RW REG[00Ch] MD CONFIGURATION READBACK REGISTER 0 MD[7] Status MD[6] Status MD[5] Status MD[4] Status MD[3] Status RW REG[00Dh] MD CONFIGURATION READBACK REGISTER 1 MD[15] Status MD[14] Status MD[13] Status MD[12] Status MD[11] Status MD[10] Status MD[9] Status MD[8] Status n/a n/a MCLK Divide Slct n/a LCD PCLK Divide Select Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a MCLK Source Slct RW n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 RW CRT/TV PCLK Divide Slct n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a n/a Bit 1 n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a RW n/a Bit 0 MediaPlug Clock Source Select Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[01Eh] CPU TO MEMORY WAIT STATE S ELECT REGISTER 11 n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a CPU to Memory Wait State Select Bit 0 REG[020h] MEMORY CONFIGURATION REGISTER 12 n/a n/a n/a LCD FPLINE Polarity Slct Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a n/a Bit 7 Bit 4 n/a n/a n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Page 1 n/a n/a n/a Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 n/a RW n/a n/a n/a n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW LCD Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW CRT/TV Horizontal Display Width Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW REG[052h] CRT/TV HORIZONTAL NON-D ISPLAY PERIOD REGISTER n/a CRT/TV Horizontal Non-Display Period Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[053h] CRT/TV HRTC START POSITION REGISTER n/a Bit 0 LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 3 REG[050h] CRT/TV HORIZONTAL DISPLAY WIDTH REGISTER n/a Bit 9 RW CRT/TV HRTC Start Position Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[054h] CRT HRTC PULSE WIDTH REGISTER CRT HRTC Polarity Slct n/a n/a n/a RW CRT HRTC Pulse Width Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 8 REG[056h] CRT/TV VERTICAL DISPLAY HEIGHT REGISTER 0 RW REG[03Ah] LCD VERTICAL NON-D ISPLAY PERIOD REGISTER LCD VNDP Status(RO) n/a LCD Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 RW CRT/TV Vertical Display Height Bit 7 Bit 1 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 0 REG[057h] CRT/TV VERTICAL DISPLAY HEIGHT REGISTER 1 REG[03Bh] TFT FPFRAME S TART POSITION REGISTER n/a n/a RW RW n/a TFT FPFRAME Start Position Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a CRT/TV Vertical Display Height n/a Bit 9 Bit 0 REG[03Ch] TFT FPFRAME P ULSE WIDTH REGISTER 18 LCD FPFRAME Polarity Slct RW TFT FPFRAME Pulse Width n/a n/a n/a n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[040h] LCD DISPLAY MODE REGISTER 19 LCD Display Blank n/a n/a RW SwivelView Enable Bit 1 LCD Bit-per-pixel Select n/a Bit 8 REG[058h] CRT/TV VERTICAL NON-DISPLAY PERIOD REGISTER CRT/TV VNDP Status (RO) Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a Dithering Disable Dual Panel Buffer Disable RW CRT/TV Vertical Non-Display Period Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[059h] CRT/TV VRTC START P OSITION REGISTER n/a Bit 2 REG[041h] LCD MISCELLANEOUS REGISTER n/a n/a n/a RW n/a n/a RW LCD Display Start Address Bit 6 Bit 5 RW CRT/TV VRTC Start Position Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 4 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 n/a Bit 8 n/a RW n/a CRT VRTC Pulse Width n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a TV S-Video/ Composite Output Slct TV PAL/ NTSC Output Slct REG[05Bh] CRT/TV OUTPUT CONTROL REGISTER RW TV DAC Output Luminance Level Select Filter Enable Filter Enable TV n/a Bit 0 RW Bit 12 REG[05Ah] CRT/TV VRTC PULSE WIDTH REGISTER CRT VRTC Polarity Slct n/a LCD Display Start Address Bit 0 Bit 3 REG[044h] LCD DISPLAY START ADDRESS REGISTER 2 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Chrominance REG[060h] CRT/TV DISPLAY M ODE REGISTER 21 CRT/TV Display Blank RW CRT/TV Bit-per-pixel Select n/a n/a n/a n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a RW REG[062h] CRT/TV DISPLAY S TART ADDRESS REGISTER 0 LCD Display Start Address n/a Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 RW CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 16 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW n/a n/a DRAM Timing Control Bit 9 REG[046h] LCD MEMORY ADDRESS OFFSET REGISTER 0 RW REG[063h] CRT/TV DISPLAY S TART ADDRESS REGISTER 1 LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 8 Bit 0 Panel Data Color/Mono Dual/Single TFT/Passive Format Panel Select Panel Select Panel Select Select Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 RW CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[047h] LCD MEMORY ADDRESS OFFSET REGISTER 1 n/a n/a n/a RW REG[048h] LCD PIXEL PANNING REGISTER MOD Rate Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 4 RW REG[031h] MOD RATE REGISTER n/a RW Bit 5 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 RW Panel Data Width Bit 1 Bit 5 n/a Bit 0 REG[039h] LCD VERTICAL DISPLAY HEIGHT REGISTER 1 Bit 7 n/a Bit 1 REG[043h] LCD DISPLAY START ADDRESS REGISTER 1 DRAM Refresh Rate n/a REG[030h] PANEL TYPE REGISTER 16 EL Panel Mode Enable Bit 2 RW REG[02Bh] DRAM TIMING CONTROL REGISTER 1 15 n/a Bit 6 Bit 0 DRAM Timing Control Bit 5 Bit 3 LCD Display FIFO High Threshold REG[04Bh] LCD DISPLAY FIFO LOW THRESHOLD CONTROL REGISTER n/a LCD Vertical Display Height Bit 15 Bit 6 n/a REG[042h] LCD DISPLAY START ADDRESS REGISTER 0 Memory Type Bit 1 REG[02Ah] DRAM TIMING CONTROL REGISTER 0 15 Bit 7 n/a REG[038h] LCD VERTICAL DISPLAY HEIGHT REGISTER 0 Bit 7 Refresh Select RW TFT FPLINE Pulse Width n/a RW REG[021h] DRAM REFRESH RATE REGISTER 13,14 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a RW Bit 1 n/a Bit 1 n/a CRT/TV PCLK Source Slct REG[01Ch] MEDIAPLUG CLOCK CONFIGURATION REGISTER 9,10 MediaPlug Clock Divide Select Bit 2 LCD PCLK Source Select REG[018h] CRT/TV PIXEL CLOCK CONFIGURATION REGISTER 7,8 CRT/TV PCLK 2X Enable Bit 3 RW REG[014h] LCD PIXEL CLOCK CONFIGURATION REGISTER 5,6 n/a Bit 4 REG[036h] TFT FPLINE PULSE WIDTH REGISTER 17 n/a REG[010h] MEMORY CLOCK CONFIGURATION REGISTER 4 n/a TFT FPLINE Start Position n/a Reserved REG[008h] GENERAL I/O P INS CONTROL REGISTER Reserved n/a RW REG[04Ah] LCD DISPLAY FIFO HIGH THRESHOLD CONTROL REGISTER Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a n/a RW n/a LCD Memory Address Offset Bit 10 Bit 9 20 n/a Bit 8 RW Reserved Reserved REG[064h] CRT/TV DISPLAY S TART ADDRESS REGISTER 2 n/a n/a n/a Bit 0 RW CRT/TV Display Start Address Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 REG[066h] CRT/TV MEMORY ADDRESS OFFSET REGISTER 0 LCD Pixel Panning Bit 1 n/a RW CRT/TV Memory Address Offset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 01/02/08 S1D13506 Register Summary X25B-R-001-02 REG[067h] CRT/TV MEMORY ADDRESS OFFSET REGISTER 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a REG[068h] CRT/TV PIXEL PANNING REGISTER n/a n/a n/a RW CRT/TV Memory Address Offset n/a Bit 10 Bit 9 22 RW n/a Reserved Reserved n/a Bit 1 n/a n/a REG[071h] LCD Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW CRT/TV Display FIFO Low Threshold Bit 5 Bit 4 n/a Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a Bit 1 23 n/a Bit 0 RW Bit 1 Bit 0 RW Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 REG[072h] LCD CURSOR X P OSITION REGISTER 0 Bit 0 RW LCD Cursor X Position Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a Bit 1 REG[073h] LCD CURXOR X P OSITION REGISTER 1 LCD Cursor X Sign n/a n/a Bit 0 RW n/a LCD Cursor X Position Bit 9 REG[074h] LCD CURSOR Y P OSITION REGISTER 0 Bit 8 RW LCD Cursor Y Position Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a Bit 1 REG[075h] LCD CURSOR Y P OSITION REGISTER 1 LCD Cursor Y Sign n/a n/a LCD Cursor Y Position Bit 9 REG[076h] LCD INK/C URSOR BLUE COLOR 0 R EGISTER n/a n/a n/a n/a LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 n/a RW Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 n/a n/a n/a RW Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 n/a RW Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 n/a Bit 4 n/a Page 2 n/a n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 26 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW RW Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[083h] CRT/TV CURSOR X P OSITION REGISTER 1 CRT/TV Cursor X Sign Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 REG[105h] BITBLT SOURCE START ADDRESS REGISTER 1 n/a RW n/a Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[084h] CRT/TV CURSOR Y P OSITION REGISTER 0 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 n/a n/a RW Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 RW CRT/TV Cursor Y Position n/a n/a n/a Bit 9 n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 0 n/a Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[087h] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR GREEN COLOR 0 R EGISTER n/a n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 4 RW Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[08Ah] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR BLUE COLOR 1 REGISTER n/a n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 n/a Bit 4 Bit 3 n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 4 RW Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW REG[08Ch] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR RED COLOR 1 REGISTER n/a n/a CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 n/a Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 7 n/a n/a n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 RW Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a BitBlt Destination Linear Slct BitBlt Source Linear Slct REG[100h] BITBLT CONTROL REGISTER 0 27 RW BitBlt FIFO BitBlt FIFO BitBlt FIFO BitBlt Active Not Empty Half Full Full Status Status (RO) Status (RO) Status (RO) n/a Bit 8 RW Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 RW Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[10Ah] BITBLT DESTINATION START ADDRESS REGISTER 2 n/a n/a RW BitBlt Destination Start Address n/a Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 REG[10Ch] BITBLT MEMORY ADDRESS OFFSET REGISTER 0 RW BitBlt Memory Address Offset Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[10Dh] BITBLT MEMORY ADDRESS OFFSET REGISTER 1 n/a n/a n/a n/a RW BitBlt Memory Address Offset Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[110h] BITBLT WIDTH REGISTER 0 RW BitBlt Width Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[111h] BITBLT WIDTH REGISTER 1 n/a n/a RW BitBlt Width Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[112h] BITBLT HEIGHT REGISTER 0 RW BitBlt Height Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 n/a n/a n/a Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[113h] BITBLT HEIGHT REGISTER 1 n/a n/a RW Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor FIFO Threshold Bit 3 Bit 9 REG[109h] BITBLT DESTINATION START ADDRESS REGISTER 1 n/a REG[08Eh] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR FIFO THRESHOLD REGISTER n/a Bit 10 Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Bit 5 Bit 11 BitBlt Destination Start Address n/a REG[08Bh] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR GREEN COLOR 1 R EGISTER n/a RW Bit 0 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 n/a Bit 0 REG[108h] BITBLT DESTINATION START ADDRESS REGISTER 0 n/a REG[088h] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR RED COLOR 0 REGISTER n/a Bit 1 BitBlt Source Start Address Bit 8 REG[086h] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR BLUE COLOR 0 REGISTER n/a Bit 2 BitBlt Destination Start Address REG[085h] CRT/TV CURSOR Y P OSITION REGISTER 1 CRT/TV Cursor Y Sign Bit 12 n/a CRT/TV Cursor Y Position Bit 7 Bit 3 30 REG[106h] BITBLT SOURCE START ADDRESS REGISTER 2 30 CRT/TV Cursor X Position n/a RW BitBlt Source Start Address BitBlt Source Start Address REG[082h] CRT/TV CURSOR X P OSITION REGISTER 0 BitBlt Height Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[114h] BITBLT BACKGROUD COLOR REGISTER 0 RW BitBlt Background Color Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[115h] BITBLT BACKGROUND COLOR REGISTER 1 RW BitBlt Background Color Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[118h] BITBLT FOREGROUND COLOR REGISTER 0 n/a n/a n/a RW BitBlt FIFO Depth n/a n/a n/a REG[102h] BITBLT ROP CODE/C OLOR EXPANSION REGISTER 28 n/a n/a n/a n/a RW Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 REG[103h] BITBLT OPERATION REGISTER 29 n/a n/a n/a BitBlt Color Format Slct Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 0 BitBlt Operation Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 REG[119h] BITBLT FOREGROUND COLOR REGISTER 1 RW BitBlt Foreground Color RW n/a RW BitBlt Foreground Color BitBlt ROP Code LCD Ink/Cursor FIFO Threshold Bit 3 REG[104h] BITBLT SOURCE START ADDRESS REGISTER 0 30 CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 1 Bit 4 n/a REG[101h] BITBLT CONTROL REGISTER 1 REG[07Eh] LCD INK/CURSOR FIFO T HRSHOLD REGISTER n/a Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 1 Bit 5 n/a RW REG[07Ch] LCD INK/CURSOR RED COLOR 1 REGISTER n/a Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Blue Color 1 REG[07Bh] LCD INK/CURSOR GREEN COLOR 1 REGISTER n/.a Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Red Color 0 REG[07Ah] LCD INK/CURSOR BLUE COLOR 1 R EGISTER n/a Bit 0 LCD Ink/Cursor Green Color 0 REG[078h] LCD INK/C URSOR RED COLOR 0 REGISTER n/a Bit 8 RW REG[077h] LCD INK/C URSOR GREEN COLOR 0 REGISTER n/a Bit 0 RW n/a n/a REG[081h] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR S TART ADDRESS REGISTER LCD Ink/Cursor Mode INK/C URSOR START ADDRESS REGISTER 24 Bit 6 n/a RW CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Mode CRT/TV Cursor X Position LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Bit 7 n/a CRT/TV Display FIFO High Threshold REG[070h] LCD INK/C URSOR CONTROL REGISTER n/a Bit 1 RW REG[06Bh] CRT/TV DISPLAY FIFO LOW THRESHOLD CONTROL REGISTER n/a n/a CRT/TV Pixel Panning REG[06Ah] CRT/TV DISPLAY FIFO H IGH THRESHOLD CONTROL REGISTER n/a Bit 8 REG[080h] CRT/TV INK/CURSOR CONTROL REGISTER 25 Bit 15 REG[1E0h] n/a Bit 0 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 n/a n/a Bit 9 Bit 8 LOOK-UP TABLE MODE REGISTER 31 n/a n/a n/a RW LUT Mode Bit 1 Bit 0 01/02/08 S1D13506 Register Summary X25B-R-001-02 RW REG[1E2h] LOOK-UP TABLE ADDRESS REGISTER LUT Address Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 RW REG[1E4h] LOOK-UP TABLE DATA REGISTER LUT Data Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 n/a n/a n/a 11 REG[01Eh] Minimum Memory Timing Selection Pin MD14 on Reset MD[7:6] on Reset MA9/GPIO3 MA10/GPIO1 MA11/GPIO2 1 00 GPIO3 GPIO1 VMPEPWR 1 01 MA9 GPIO1 VMPEPWR 1 10 MA9 GPIO1 VMPEPWR 1 11 MA9 MA10 MA11 Wait State Bits [1:0] Condition 00 no restrictions 01 2 * period (MCLK) - 4ns > period(BCLK) 10 period(MCLK) - 4ns > period(BCLK) 11 Reserved n/a 4 REG[010h] MCLK Source Select n/a n/a Reserved n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a n/a Bit 5 RW Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 REG[1FCh] DISPLAY MODE REGISTER 32 n/a SwivelView Enable Bit 0 0 CLKI 1 BUSCLK Memory Type Bits [1:0] Memory Type 00 EDO-DRAM with 2-CAS# 01 FPM-DRAM with 2-CAS# 10 EDO-DRAM with 2-WE# 11 FPM-DRAM with 2-WE# 5 REG[014h] LCD PCLK Divide Select CPU-to-Memory Access Watchdog Timer n/a MCLK Source RO Memory LCD Power Controller Save Status Power Save Status REG[1F4h] CPU-TO-MEMORY ACCESS WATCHDOG TIMER REGISTER n/a MCLK Source Select Power Save Mode Enbl REG[1F1h] POWER SAVE STATUS REGISTER n/a 12 REG[020h] Memory Type Select RW REG[1F0h] POWER SAVE CONFIGURATION REGISTER Bit 0 LCD PCLK Divide Select Bits [1:0] LCD PCLK Source to LPCLK Frequency Ratio 00 1:1 01 2:1 10 3:1 11 4:1 13 REG[021h] DRAM Refresh Select DRAM Refresh Select Bits [1:0] DRAM Refresh Type 00 CBR Refresh 01 Self-Refresh 1X No Refresh RW n/a n/a Display Mode Select n/a Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 6 REG[014h] LCD PCLK Source Select RW REG[1000h] MEDIAPLUG LCMD REGISTER MediaPlug LCMD LCD PCLK Source Select Bits [1:0] LCD PCLK Source 00 CLKI Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 01 BUSCLK Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 10 CLKI2 11 MCLK RW REG[1002h] MEDIAPLUG RESERVED LCMD REGISTER MediaPlug Reserved LCMD Bit 23 Bit 22 Bit 21 Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 Bit 31 Bit 30 Bit 29 Bit 28 Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24 REG[1004h] MEDIAPLUG CMD REGISTER 7 REG[018h] CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select RW MediaPlug CMD Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 REG[1006h] MEDIAPLUG RESERVED CMD REGISTER RW 14 REG[021h] DRAM Refresh Rate DRAM Refresh Rate Bits [2:0] MCLK Source Divide Amount Refresh Rate for 40MHz MCLK Source DRAM Refresh Time/256 cycles 000 64 625 kHz 0.4 ms 001 128 312 kHz 0.8 ms 010 256 156 kHz 1.6 ms 011 512 78 kHz 3.3 ms 100 1024 39 kHz 6.6 ms CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select Bits [1:0] CRT/TV PCLK Source to DPCLK Frequency Ratio 101 2048 20 kHz 13.1 ms 00 1:1 110 4096 10 kHz 26.2 ms 01 2:1 111 8192 5 kHz 52.4 ms 10 3:1 11 4:1 8 REG[018h] CRT/TV PCLK Source Select MediaPlug Reserved CMD Bit 23 Bit 22 Bit 21 Bit 20 Bit 19 Bit 18 Bit 17 Bit 16 Bit 31 Bit 30 Bit 29 Bit 28 Bit 27 Bit 26 Bit 25 Bit 24 REG[1008h] TO REG[1FFEh], even address MEDIAPLUG DATA REGISTERS CRT/TV PCLK Source Select Bits [1:0] RW MediaPlug Data Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 CRT/TV PCLK Source 00 CLKI 01 BUSCLK 10 CLKI2 11 MCLK 9 REG[01Ch] MediaPlug Clock Divide Select A20-A0 = 100000h-1FFFFEh, even address BITBLT DATA REGISTER 0 RW BitBlt Data Bit 7 Bit 6 Bit 5 Bit 4 Bit 3 Bit 2 Bit 1 Bit 0 MediaPlug Clock Divide Select Bits [1:0] MediaPlug Clock Source to CRT/TV Pixel Clock Frequency Ratio Bit 15 Bit 14 Bit 13 Bit 12 Bit 11 Bit 10 Bit 9 Bit 8 00 1:1 01 2:1 10 3:1 11 4:1 1 N/A bits should be written 0. Reserved bits must be written 0. 2 REG[000h] These bits are used to identify the S1D13506. For the S1D13506 the product code should be 4; the revision code should be 1. The host interface must be enabled before reading this register (set REG[001] b7=0). 3 REG[004h] MA[11:9]/GPIO[1:3] Pin Functionality Page 3 10 REG[01Ch] MediaPlug Clock Source Select Pin MD14 on Reset MD[7:6] on Reset MA9/GPIO3 MA10/GPIO1 MA11/GPIO2 0 00 GPIO3 GPIO1 GPIO2 0 01 MA9 GPIO1 GPIO2 0 10 MA9 GPIO1 GPIO2 0 11 MA9 MA10 MA11 MediaPlug Clock Source Select Bits [1:0] MediaPlug Clock Source 00 CLKI 01 BUSCLK 10 CLKI2 11 MCLK 01/02/08 S1D13506 Register Summary X25B-R-001-02 15 REG[02Ah], REG[02Bh] DRAM Timing Control Registers DRAM Type 21 REG[060h] CRT/TV Bit-per-pixel Select DRAM Speed (ns) MCLK Frequency (MHz) DRAM Timing Control Reg 0 DRAM Timing Control Reg 1 Bit-per-pixel Select Bits 1:0 Bit-per-pixel (bpp) 000-001 Reserved 50 40 01h 01h 010 4 bpp 01h 01h 011 8 bpp 50 33 60 50 60 EDO 30 ~D ~D bit 5 0110 S^D P^D bit 6 0111 ~S + ~D or ~(S . D) ~P + ~D or ~(P . D) bit 7 01h 100 15 bpp 1000 S.D P.D bit 0 02h 101 16 bpp 1001 ~(S ^ D) ~(P ^ D) bit 1 110-111 Reserved 1010 D D bit 2 1011 ~S + D ~P + D bit 3 1100 S P bit 4 1101 S + ~D P + ~D bit 5 1110 S+D P+D bit 6 1111 1 (Whiteness) 1 (Whiteness) bit 7 01h 00h 00h 50 12h 02h 60 12h 02h 01h 01h 22 REG[068h] CRT/TV Pixel Planning Color Depth Screen 2 Pixel Panning Bits Used 4 bpp Bits [1:0] 8 bpp Bit 0 15/16 bpp --- 80 00h 01h 50 12h 02h 12h 02h 12h 02h 01h 01h 12h 02h 01h 01h 12h 02h LCD Ink/Cursor Bits [1:0] Mode 0001 Read Blit. 12h 02h 00 Inactive 0010 Move Blit in positive direction with ROP. 11h 02h 01 Cursor 0011 Move Blit in negative direction with ROP. 01h 01h 10 Ink 0100 Transparent Write Blit. 11 Reserved 0101 Transparent Move Blit in positive direction. 60 20 70 80 50 25 60 50 FPM 0101 Start Bit Positon for Color Expansion 01h 01h 25 Boolean Function for Pattern Fill 12h 70 70 Boolean Function for Write Blit and Move Blit BitBlt ROP Code Bits [3:0] 60 20 70 80 29 REG[103h] BitBlt Operation Selection BitBlt Operation Bits [3:0] 23 REG[070h] LCD Ink/Cursor Selection 0000 16 REG[030h] Panel Data Width 24 REG[071h] LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding Panel Data Width Bits [1:0] Passive LCD Panel Data Width TFT/D-TFD Panel Data Width 00 4-bit 9-bit LCD Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Start Address 01 8-bit 12-bit 0 Memory Size - 1024 10 16-bit 18-bit (64K color) n = 255...1 Memory Size - n * 8192 11 Reserved Reserved Blit Operation Write Blit with ROP. 0110 Pattern Fill with ROP. 0111 Pattern Fill with transparency. 1000 Color Expansion. 1001 Color Expansion with transparency. 1010 Move Blit with Color Expansion. 1011 Move Blit with Color Expansion and transparency. 1100 Solid Fill. Other combinations Reserved 25 REG[080h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Selection 17 REG[036h] LCD FPLINE Polarity Select 30 REG[104h],[105h],[106h] BitBlt Source Start Address Selection CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Bits [1:0] Mode TFT FPLINE Polarity 00 Inactive active high active low 01 Cursor active low active high 10 Ink 11 Reserved LCD FPLINE Polarity Select Passive LCD FPLINE Polarity 0 1 18 REG[03Ch] LCD FPFRAME Polarity Select Color Format Pattern Base Address[20:0] Pattern Line Offset[2:0] Pixel Offset[3:0] 8 bpp BitBlt Source Start Address[20:6], 6’b0 BitBlt Source Start Address[5:3] 1’b0, BitBlt Source Start Address[2:0] 16 bpp BitBlt Source Start Address[20:7], 7’b0 BitBlt Source Start Address[6:4] BitBlt Source Start Address[3:0] 26 REG[081h] CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Encoding LCD FPFRAME Polarity Select Passive LCD FPFRAME Polarity 0 active high TFT FPFRAME Polarity active low CRT/TV Ink/Cursor Start Address Bits [7:0] Start Address 1 active low active high 0 Memory Size - 1024 n = 255...1 Memory Size - n * 8192 31 REG[1E0h] LUT Mode Selection 19 REG[040h] LCD Bit-per-pixel Select 27 REG[100h] BitBlt Active Status Bit-per-pixel Select Bits [1:0] Color Depth (bpp) 000-001 Reserved 4 bpp Write Read 011 8 bpp 0 0 Idle 100 15 bpp 0 1 Reserved 101 16 bpp 1 0 Initiatiating operation 110-111 Reserved 1 1 Operation in progress Screen 2 Pixel Panning Bits Used 4 bpp Bits [1:0] 8 bpp Bit 0 15/16 bpp --- BitBlt ROP Code Bits [3:0] 0000 Write LCD LUT LCD and CRT/TV LUT’s 01 LCD LUT LCD LUT 10 CRT/TV LUT CRT/TV LUT 11 Reserved Reserved 32 REG[1FCh] Display Mode Select 28 REG[102h] BitBlt ROP Code/Color Expansion Function Selection Color Depth Read 00 State 010 20 REG[048h] LCD Pixel Planning Page 4 BitBlt Active Status LUT Mode Bits [1:0] Boolean Function for Write Blit and Move Blit Boolean Function for Pattern Fill 0 (Blackness) 0 (Blackness) Start Bit Positon for Color Expansion bit 0 0001 ~S . ~D or ~(S + D) ~P . ~D or ~(P + D) bit 1 0010 ~S . D ~P . D bit 2 0011 ~S ~P bit 3 0100 S . ~D P . ~D bit 4 Display Mode Select Bits [2:0] Display Mode Enabled 000 no display 001 LCD only 010 CRT only 011 Double CRT and LCD 100 TV with flicker filter off 101 Double Display TV with flicker filter off and LCD 110 TV with flicker filter on 111 Double Display TV with flicker filter on and LCD 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller 13506CFG Configuration Program Document Number: X25B-B-001-02 Copyright © 2000, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 13506CFG . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms Installation . . . . . . . . . . . . . Usage . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13506CFG Configuration Tabs . . . . . General Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Preferences Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . Memory Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Clocks Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Panel Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CRT/TV Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Registers Tab . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13506CFG Menus . . . . . . . . . . Open... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Save . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Save As... . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Configure Multiple . . . . . . . . . . . Export . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Enable Tooltips . . . . . . . . . . . . ERD on the Web . . . . . . . . . . . . About 13506CFG . . . . . . . . . . . Comments . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .5 .6 .6 .7 .7 .9 10 12 16 20 22 23 23 24 24 25 26 27 27 27 27 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 13506CFG 13506CFG is an interactive Windows® 9x/ME/NT/2000 program that calculates register values for a user defined S1D13506 configuration. The configuration information can be used to directly alter the operating characteristics of the S1D13506 utilities or any program built with the Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL) library. Alternatively, the configuration information can be saved in a variety of text file formats for use in other applications. S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms 13506CFG runs on PC systems running Windows 9x/ME/NT/2000 and can modify the executable files based on the S1D13506 HAL for the following evaluation platforms: • PC system with an Intel 80x86 processor. • M68EC000IDP (Integrated Development Platform) board, revision 3.0, with a Motorola M68EC000 processor. • MC68030IDP (Integrated Development Platform) board, revision 3.0, with a Motorola MC68030 processor. • SH3-LCEVB board, revision B, with an Hitachi SH-3 HD6417780 processor. • MPC821ADS (Applications Development System) board, revision B, with a Motorola MPC821 processor. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Installation Create a directory for 13506cfg.exe and the S1D13506 utilities. Copy the files 13506cfg.exe and panels.def to that directory. Panels.def contains configuration information for a number of panels and must reside in the same directory as 13506cfg.exe. Usage 13506CFG can be started from the Windows desktop or from a Windows command prompt. To start 13506CFG from the Windows desktop, double click the program icon or the link icon if one was created during installation. To start 13506CFG from a Windows command prompt, change to the directory 13506cfg.exe was installed to and type the command 13506cfg. The basic procedure for using 13506CFG is: 1. Start 13506CFG as described above. 2. Open an existing file to serve as a starting reference point (this step is optional). 3. Modify the configuration. For specific information on editing the configuration, see “13506CFG Configuration Tabs” on page 7. 4. Save the new configuration. The configuration information can be saved in two ways; as an ASCII text file or by modifying the executable image on disk. Several ASCII text file formats are supported. Most are formatted C header files used to build display drivers or standalone applications. Utility files based on the Hardware Abstraction Layer (HAL) can be modified directly by 13506CFG. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 13506CFG Configuration Tabs 13506CFG provides a series of tabs which can be selected at the top of the main window. Each tab allows the configuration of a specific aspect of S1D13506 operation. The tabs are labeled “General”, “Preference”, “Memory”, “Clocks”, “Panel”, “CRT/TV”, and “Registers”. The following sections describe the purpose and use of each of the tabs. General Tab Decode Addresses Register Address Display Buffer Address The General tab contains S1D13506 evaluation board specific information. The values presented are used for configuring HAL based executable utilities. The settings on this tab specify where in CPU address space the registers and display buffer are located. Decode Addresses 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Selecting one of the listed evaluation platforms changes the values for the “Register address” and “Display buffer address” fields. The values used for each evaluation platform are examples of possible implementations as used by the Epson S1D13506 evaluation board. If your hardware implementation differs from the addresses used, select the User-Defined option and enter the correct addresses for “Register address” and “Display buffer address”. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Register Address The physical address of the start of register decode space (in hexadecimal). This field is automatically set according to the Decode Address unless the “User-Defined” decode address is selected. Display Buffer Address The physical address of the start of display buffer decode space (in hexadecimal). This field is automatically set according to the Decode Address unless the “User-Defined” decode address is selected. Note When “Epson S5U13506B00B/B00C Evaluation Board” is selected, the register and display buffer addresses are blanked because the evaluation board uses the PCI interface and the decode addresses are determined by the system BIOS during boot-up. If using the S1D13506 Evaluation Board on a PCI based platform, both Windows and the S1D13XXX device driver must be installed. For further information on the S1D13XXX device driver, see the S1D13XXX Windows 9x/NT/2000 Device Driver Installation Guide, document number X00A-E-003-xx. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 Preferences Tab Initial Display Panel SwivelView Panel Color Depth CRT/TV Color Depth The Preference tab contains settings pertaining to the initial display state. During runtime the display or color depth may be changed. Initial Display Sets which display device is used for the initial display. Selections made on the CRT/TV tab may cause selections on this tab to be grayed out. The selections “None” and “Panel” are always available. Panel SwivelView The S1D13506 SwivelView feature is capable of rotating the image displayed on an LCD panel 90°, 180°, or 270° in a clockwise direction. This sets the initial orientation of the panel. This setting is greyed out when any display device other than “Panel” is selected as the Initial Display. Panel Color Depth Sets the initial color depth on the LCD panel. CRT/TV Color Depth Sets the initial color depth on the CRT or TV display. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Memory Tab Access Time Refresh Time Memory Type WE# Control Suspend Mode Installed Memory The Memory tab contains settings that control the configuration of the DRAM used for the S1D13506 display buffer. Note The DRAM memory type and access time determines the optimal memory clock (MCLK). See “Clocks Tab” on page 12 for an explanation on how to determine the optimal memory clock. Memory Configuration Access Time These four settings must be configured based on the specification of the DRAM being used. For each of the following settings refer to the DRAM manufacturer’s specification, unless otherwise noted. Selects the access time of the DRAM. The S1D13506 evaluation boards use 50ns DRAM. Memory Type Selects the memory type, either Extended Data Out (EDO) or Fast Page Mode (FPM). The S1D13506 evaluation boards use EDO DRAM. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 WE# Control Selects the WE# control used for the DRAM. DRAM uses one of two methods of control when writing to memory. These methods are referred to as 2-CAS# and 2-WE#. The S5U13506 evaluation boards use DRAM requiring the 2-CAS# method. Refresh Time Suspend Mode Refresh Selects the number of ms required to refresh 256 rows of DRAM. Selects the DRAM refresh method used during power save mode. The S5U13506 evaluation boards use DRAM requiring CAS before RAS. For all other implementations, refer to the manufacturer’s specification for DRAM refresh requirements. CAS before RAS This setting is selected for DRAM that requires timing where the CAS signal occurs just before the RAS signal. Self refresh This setting is selected for DRAM that requires no signal from the S1D1306 to maintain memory refresh. No refresh This setting does not refresh the memory during power save mode. If this option is selected, the memory contents are lost during power save. Installed Memory Selects the amount of DRAM available for the display buffer. The S1D13506 evaluation board use 2M bytes of DRAM. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Clocks Tab LCD PCLK Source LCD PCLK Divide CLKI MediaPlugCLK Source MediaPlugCLK Divide CLKI2 CRT/TV PCLK Source CRT/TV PCLK Divide BUSCLK BCLK=BUSCLK/2 MCLK Source MCLK Divide The Clocks tab is intended to simplify the selection of input clock frequencies and the source of internal clocking signals. For further information regarding clocking and clock sources, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. In automatic mode the values for CLKI and CLKI2 are calculated based on selections made for LCD and CRT/TV timings from the “Panel” and “CRT/TV” tabs. In this mode, the required frequencies for the input clocks are displayed in blue in the “Auto” section of each group. It is the responsibility of the system designer to ensure that the correct CLKI frequencies are supplied to the S1D13506. Making a selection other than “Auto” indicates that the values for CLKI or CLKI2 are known and are fixed by the system design. Options for LCD and CRT/TV frame rates are limited to ranges determined by the clock values. Note Changing clock values may modify or invalidate Panel or CRT/TV settings. Confirm all settings on these two tabs after changing any clock settings. Note If the same source clock is selected for use by both CRT/TV and LCD panels, the available LCD pixel clock selections are limited due to more stringent CRT/TV timings. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 The S1D13506 may use as many as three input clocks or as few as one. The more clocks used the greater the flexibility of choice in display type and memory speed. CLKI This setting determines the frequency of CLKI. CLKI is typically used for the panel and CRT/TV pixel clocks. Select “Auto” to have the CLKI frequency determined automatically based on settings made on other configuration tabs. After completing the other configurations, the required CLKI frequency will be displayed in blue in the Auto section. If the CLKI frequency must be fixed to a particular rate, set this value by selecting a preset frequency from the drop down list or entering the desired frequency in MHz. CLKI2 This setting determines the frequency of CLKI2. If the MediaPlug interface is required, CLKI2 is typically used as the clock source. Select “Auto” to have the CLKI2 frequency determined automatically based on settings made on other configuration tabs. After completing the other configurations, the required CLKI2 frequency will be displayed in blue in the Auto section. If the CLKI2 frequency must be fixed to a particular rate, set this value by selecting a preset frequency from the drop down list or entering the desired frequency in MHz. BUSCLK This setting determines the frequency of the bus interface clock (BUSCLK). This value is required for calculating internal divisors which will yield the best performance. The BUSCLK frequency must be fixed to a particular rate. Set this value by selecting a preset frequency from the drop down list or entering the desired frequency in MHz. BCLK=BUSCLK/2 Indicates the BCLK to BUSCLK ratio. This ratio is set at RESET# by the configuration pin CONF5. Under normal circumstances BCLK = BUSCLK. This option is only for configuring Toshiba/Philips interfaces when DCLKOUT is connected to the S1D13506 BUSCLK signal. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center LCD PCLK These settings select the signal source and input clock divisor for the panel pixel clock (LCD PCLK). Source Selects the LCD PCLK source. Possible sources include CLKI, CLKI2, BUSCLK or MCLK. Typically the LCD PCLK is derived from CLKI. Divide Specifies the divide ratio for the clock source signal. Selecting “Auto” for the divisor allows the configuration program to calculate the best clock divisor. Unless a very specific clocking is being specified, it is best to leave this setting on “Auto”. Timing CRT/TV PCLK This field shows the actual LCD PCLK used by the configuration process. These settings select the signal source and input clock divisor for the CRT/TV pixel clock (CRT/TV PCLK). Source Selects the CRT/TV PCLK source. Possible sources include CLKI, CLKI2, BUSCLK or MCLK. Typically the CRT/TV PCLK is derived from CLKI. Divide Specifies the divide ratio for the clock source signal. Selecting “Auto” for the divisor allows the configuration program to calculate the best clock divisor. Unless a very specific clocking is required, it is best to leave this setting on “Auto”. Timing S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 This field shows the actual CRT/TV PCLK used by the configuration process. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 MCLK These settings select the signal source and input clock divisor for the memory clock (MCLK). MCLK should be set based on the type and speed of DRAM as follows. Memory Type EDO FPM Optimal Memory Clock (MCLK) 50ns 60ns 70ns 40MHz 33MHz 30MHz — 25MHz 20MHz Source Selects the MCLK source. Possible sources include CLKI or BUSCLK. Typically MCLK is derived from BUSCLK. Divide Specifies the divide ratio for the clock source signal. Unless the MCLK source frequency is very high, resulting in more than a 50MHz MCLK, this ratio should be set at 1:1. Timing MediaPlugCLK 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 This field shows the actual MCLK frequency used by the configuration process. These settings select the signal source and input clock divide for the MediaPlug clock (MediaPlugCLK). Source Selects the MediaPlug clock source. Divide Selects the divide ratio for the MediaPlug clock source. Timing This field shows the actual MediaPlugCLK frequency used by the configuration process. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Panel Tab Panel Data Width Single/Dual Dual Panel Buffer Disable Mono/Color Format 2 Panel Type FPLINE Polarity EL Support FPFRAME Polarity Frame Rate Panel Dimensions Pixel Clock Predefined Panels TFT/FPLINE Non-Display Period TFT/FPFRAME The S1D13506 supports many panel types. This tab allows configuration of most panel settings such as panel dimensions, type and timings. Panel Type Selects between passive (STN) and active (TFT) panel types. Select TFT for TFT compatible D-TFD panel types. Several options may change or become unavailable when the STN/TFT setting is switched. Therefore, confirm all settings on this tab after the Panel Type is changed. EL Support S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Enable Electro-Luminescent panel support. This option is only available when the selected panel type is STN. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Panel Data Width Page 17 Selects the panel data width. Panel data width is the number of bits of data transferred to the LCD panel on each clock cycle and shouldn’t be confused with color depth which determines the number of displayed colors. When the panel type is STN, the available options are 4 bit, 8 bit, and 16 bit. When the panel type is TFT the available options are 9 bit, 12 bit, and 18 bit. Single / Dual Selects between a single or dual panel. When the panel type is TFT, “Single” is automatically selected and the “Dual” option is grayed out. Disable Dual Panel Buffer The Dual Panel Buffer is used with dual STN panels to improve image quality by buffering display data in a format directly usable by the panel. This option is primarily intended for testing purposes. It is not recommended that the Dual Panel Buffer be disabled as a reduction of display quality will result. Mono / Color Selects between a monochrome or color panel. Format 2 Selects color STN panel format 2. This option is specifically for configuring 8-bit color STN panels. See the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx, for description of format 1 / format 2 data formats. Most new panels use the format 2 data format. FPLINE Polarity Selects the polarity of the FPLINE pulse. Refer to the panel specification for the correct polarity of the FPLINE pulse. FPFRAME Polarity Selects the polarity of the FPFRAME pulse. Refer to the panel specification for the correct polarity of the FPFRAME pulse. Panel Dimensions These fields specify the panel width and height. A number of common widths and heights are available in the selection boxes. If the width/height of your panel is not listed, enter the actual panel dimensions into the edit field. Manually entered panel widths must be a multiple of 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center eight pixels. If a manually entered panel width is not a multiple of eight pixels a notification box appears and 13506CFG rounds up the value to the next allowable width. Non-display period It is recommended that these automatically generated non-display values be used without adjustment. However, manual adjustment may be useful in fine tuning the non-display width and the non-display height. As a general rule passive LCD panels and some CRTs are tolerant of a wide range of non-display times. Active panels, TVs and some CRTs are far less tolerant of changes to the non-display period. Frame Rate Select the desired frame rate (in Hz) from the dropdown list. The values in the list are the range of possible frame rates using the currently selected pixel clock. To change the range of frame rates, select a different Pixel Clock rate (in MHz). Panel dimensions are fixed therefore frame rate can only be adjusted by changing either PCLK or nondisplay period values. Higher frame rates correspond to smaller horizontal and vertical non-display values, or higher frequencies. Pixel Clock Select the desired Pixel Clock (in MHz) from the dropdown list. The range of frequencies displayed is dependent on settings selected on the Clocks tab. For example: If CLKI is chosen to be Auto and LCD PCLK is sourced from CLKI on the Clocks tab, then the range for Pixel Clock will range from 1.5 MHz to 80 MHz. Selecting a fixed LCD PCLK on the Clocks tab, say 25.175 MHz, will result in only four selections: 6.293, 8.392, 12.587, and 25.175 MHz. (these frequencies represent the four possible frequencies from a fixed 25.175 MHz input clock divided by the PCLK divider). TFT/FPLINE (pixels) S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 These settings allow fine tuning of the TFT/D-TFT line pulse parameters and are only available when the selected panel type is TFT. Refer to S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx for a complete description of the FPLINE pulse settings. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 Start pos Specifies the delay (in pixels) from the start of the horizontal non-display period to the leading edge of the FPLINE pulse. Pulse Width Specifies the delay (in pixels) from the start of the horizontal non-display period to the leading edge of the FPLINE pulse. TFT/FPFRAME (lines) These settings allow fine tuning of the TFT/D-TFT frame pulse parameters and are only available when the selected panel type is TFT. Refer to S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx, for a complete description of the FPFRAME pulse settings. Start pos Specify the delay (in lines) from the start of the vertical non-display period to the leading edge of the FPFRAME pulse. Pulse width Specifies the pulse width (in lines) of the FPFRAME output signal. Predefined Panels 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 13506CFG uses a file (panels.def) which lists various panel manufacturers recommended settings. If the file panels.def is present in the same directory as 13506cfg.exe, the settings for a number of predefined panels are available in the drop-down list. If a panel is selected from the list, 13506CFG loads the predefined settings contained in the file. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center CRT/TV Tab Display Dimensions TV Filters Display Selection TV Output CRT DAC Output Level The CRT/TV tab configures settings specific to CRT/TV display devices. Display Selection Select the type of alternate display from: CRT, TV/NTSC, or TV/PAL. Note that CRT and TV cannot be simultaneously selected. Display Dimensions Selects the resolution and frame rate from the dropdown list. The available selections vary based on selections made in the Clocks tab and which Display Selection is chosen on this tab (CRT, TV/NTSC, TV/PAL). If no selections are available, the CRT/TV pixel clock settings on the Clocks tab must be changed. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 21 TV Filters When displaying computer images on a TV, several image distortions may arise. The S1D13506 incorporates three filters which reduce these distortions. Each filter type is enabled by checking the associated box. Luminance The luminance filter adjusts the brightness of the TV and reduces the “rainbow-like” colors at the boundaries between sharp luminance transitions. This filter is most useful for composite video output. Chrominance The chrominance filter adjusts the color of the TV and reduces the “ragged edges” seen at the boundaries between sharp color transitions. This filter is most useful for composite video output. Flicker The “flickering” effect seen on interlaced displays is caused by sharp vertical image transitions such as window edges. Turning on the anti-flicker filter averages adjacent lines on the TV display to reduce flickering. TV Output Selects the TV output format: Composite or S-Video. CRT DAC output level When the CRT is active, the CRT DAC Output Level can be used to double values output to the DAC. This would normally result in very bright colors on the display, but if IREF is reduced at the same time the display will remain at its intended brightness and power consumption is reduced. For more information on setting the CRT DAC output level, see the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. Note For CRT operations, 13506CFG supports VESA timings only. For TV operations, 13506CFG supports NTSC and PAL timings only. Overriding these register values on the Registers page may cause the CRT or TV to display incorrectly. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 22 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Registers Tab The Registers tab allows viewing and direct editing the S1D13506 register values. Scroll up and down the list of registers and view their configured value. Individual register settings may be changed by double-clicking on the register in the listing. Manual changes to the registers are not checked for errors, so caution is warranted when directly editing these values. It is strongly recommended that the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx be referred to before making an manual register settings. Manually entered values may be changed by 13506CFG if further configuration changes are made on the other tabs. In this case, the user is notified of the changes when they return to the registers tab. Note Manual changes to the registers may have unpredictable results if incorrect values are entered. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 23 13506CFG Menus The following sections describe each of the options in the File and Help menus. Open... From the Menu Bar, select “File”, then “Open...” to display the Open File Dialog Box. The Open option allows 13506CFG to open files containing HAL configuration information. When 13506CFG opens a file it scans the file for an identification string, and if found, reads the configuration information. This may be used to quickly arrive at a starting point for register configuration. The only requirement is that the file being opened must contain a valid S1D13506 HAL library information block. 13506CFG supports a variety of executable file formats. Select the file type(s) 13506CFG should display in the Files of Type drop-down list and then select the filename from the list and click on the Open button. Note 13506CFG is designed to work with utilities programmed using a given version of the HAL. If the configuration structure contained in the executable file differs from the version 13506CFG expects the Open will fail and an error message is displayed. This may happen if the version of 13506CFG is substantially older, or newer, than the file being opened. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 24 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Save From the Menu Bar, select “File”, then “Save” to initiate the save action. The Save menu option allows a fast save of the configuration information to a file that was opened with the Open menu option. Note This option is only available once a file has been opened. Note 13506cfg.exe can be configured by making a copy of the file 13506cfg.exe and configuring the copy. It is not possible to configure the original while it is running. Save As... From the Menu Bar, select “File”, then “Save As...” to display the Save As Dialog Box. “Save as” is very similar to Save except a dialog box is displayed allowing the user to name the file before saving. Using this technique a tester can configure a number of files differing only in configuration information and name (e.g. BMP60Hz.EXE, BMP72Hz.EXE, BMP75Hz.EXE where only the frame rate changes in each of these files). Note When “Save As” is selected then an exact duplicate of the file as opened by the “Open” option is created containing the new configuration information. S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 25 Configure Multiple After determining the desired configuration, “Configure Multiple” allows the information to be saved into one or more executable files built with the HAL library. From the Menu Bar, select “File”, then “Configure Multiple” to display the Configure Multiple Dialog Box.This dialog box is also displayed when a file(s) is dragged onto the 13506CFG window. The left pane lists files available for configuration; the right pane lists files that have been selected for configuration. Files can be selected by clicking the “Add” or “Add All” buttons, double clicking any file in the left pane, or by dragging the file(s) from Windows Explorer. Selecting “Show all files” displays all files in the selected directory, whereas selecting “Show conf. files only” will display only files that can be configured using 13506CFG. The configuration values can be saved to a specific EXE file for Intel platforms, or to a specific S9 or ELF file for non-Intel platforms. The file must have been compiled using the 13506 HAL library. Checking “Preserve Physical Addresses” instructs 13506CFG to use the register and display buffer address values the files were previously configured with. Addresses specified in the General Tab are discarded. This is useful when configuring several programs for various hardware platforms at the same time. For example, if configuring PCI, MPC and IDP based programs at the same time for a new panel type, the physical addresses for each are retained. This feature is primarily intended for the test lab where multiple hardware configurations exist and are being tested. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 26 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Export After determining the desired configuration, “Export” permits the user to save the register information as a variety of ASCII text file formats. The following is a list and description of the currently supported output formats: • a C header file for use in writing HAL library based applications. • a C header file which lists each register and the value it should be set to. • a C header file for use in developing Window CE display drivers. • a C header file for use in developing display drivers for other operating systems such as Linux, QNX, and VxWorks UGL or WindML. • a comma delimited text file containing an offset, a value, and a description for each S1D13506 register. After selecting the file format, click the “Export As..." button to display the file dialog box which allows the user to enter a filename before saving. Before saving the configuration file, clicking the “Preview” button starts Notepad with a copy of the configuration file about to be saved. When the C Header File for S1D13506 WinCE Drivers option is selected as the export type, additional options are available and can be selected by clicking on the Options button. The options dialog appears as: Mode Number selects the mode number for use in the header file CRT/TV=Primary Display sets the CRT/TV as the primary display in the header file Cursor Support selects the type of cursor support enabled in the header file (for primary device context) HW Acceleration enables hardware acceleration (BitBLT engine) in the header file (for primary device context) S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Cursor Support selects the type of cursor support enabled in the header file (for secondary device context) HW Acceleration enables hardware acceleration (BitBLT engine) in the header file (for secondary device context) 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 27 Enable Tooltips Tooltips provide useful information about many of the items on the configuration tabs. Placing the mouse pointer over nearly any item on any tab generates a popup window containing helpful advice and hints. To enable/disable tooltips check/uncheck the “Tooltips” option form the “Help” menu. Note Tooltips are enabled by default. ERD on the Web This “Help” menu item is actually a hotlink to the Epson Research and Development website. Selecting “Help” then “ERD on the Web” starts the default web browser and points it to the ERD product web site. The latest software, drivers, and documentation for the S1D13506 is available at this website. About 13506CFG Selecting the “About 13506CFG” option from the “Help” menu displays the about dialog box for 13506CFG. The about dialog box contains version information and the copyright notice for 13506CFG. Comments • On any tab particular options may be grayed out if selecting them would violate the operational specification of the S1D13506 (i.e. Selecting extremely low CLK frequencies on the Clocks tab may result in no possible CRT/TV options. Selecting TFT or STN on the Panel tab enables/disables options specific to the panel type). • The file panels.def is a text file containing operational specifications for several supported, and tested, panels. This file can be edited with any text editor. • 13506CFG allows manually altering register values. The manual changes may violate memory and LCD timings as specified in the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. If this is done, unpredictable results may occur. Epson Research and Development, Inc. does not assume liability for any damage done to the display device as a result of configuration errors. 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 Page 28 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-001-02 13506CFG Configuration Program Issue Date: 01/03/14 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Document Number: X25B-B-002-03 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 13506SHOW 13506SHOW is designed to demonstrate and test some of the S1D13506 display capabilities. The program can cycle through all color depths and display a pattern showing all available colors or shades of gray. Alternately, the user can specify a color depth and display configuration. 13506SHOW supports SwivelView™ (90°, 180°, and 270° hardware rotation of the display image). The 13506SHOW demonstration program must be configured and/or compiled to work with your hardware platform. The program 13506CFG.EXE can be used to configure 13506SHOW. Consult the 13506CFG users guide, document number X25B-B-001-xx, for more information on configuring S1D13506 utilities. This software is designed to work in both embedded and personal computer (PC) environments. For the embedded environment, it is assumed that the system has a means of downloading software from the PC to the target platform. Typically this is done by serial communications, where the PC uses a terminal program to send control commands and information to the target processor. Alternatively, the PC can program an EPROM, which is then placed in the target platform. Some target platforms can also communicate with the PC via a parallel port connection, or an Ethernet connection. S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms 13506SHOW supports the following S1D13506 evaluation platforms: • PC system with an Intel 80x86 processor. • M68EC000IDP (Integrated Development Platform) board, revision 3.0, with a Motorola M68EC000 processor. • MC68030IDP (Integrated Development Platform) board, revision 3.0, with a Motorola MC68030 processor. • SH3-LCEVB board, revision B, with an Hitachi SH-3 HD6417780 processor. • MPC821ADS (Applications Development System) board, revision B, with a Motorola MPC821 processor. Installation PC platform: Copy the file 13506show.exe to a directory specified in the path (e.g. PATH=C:\13506. Embedded platform: Download the program 13506show to the system. 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Usage PC Platform At the prompt, type: 13506SHOW [/a] [bl=n] [bc=n] [ds=n | ds=?] [/g] [/noinit] [/r90 | /r180 | /r270] [/read] [/s] [/write] [/?] Embedded platform Execute 13506show and type the command line argument at the prompt. Where: S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 /a cycles through all video modes automatically. bl=n shows the LCD display at a user specified color depth (bpp) where n = (4, 8, 15, 16). bc=n shows the CRT/TV display at a user specified color depth (bpp) where n = (4, 8, 15, 16). ds=n selects display surfaces (see Section , “Display Surfaces” on page 5). ds=? shows the available display surfaces (see Section , “Display Surfaces” on page 5). /g shows a grid on the image. /noinit skips full register initialization. Only registers used for changing the color depth (bpp), selecting the memory/registers and programming the clock synthesizer are updated. Additionally, some registers are read to determine information such as display size and type (LCD, CRT, TV). /r90 SwivelView™ 90°, clockwise hardware rotation of LCD image by 90 degrees /r180 SwivelView™ 180°, clockwise hardware rotation of LCD image by 180 degrees /r270 SwivelView™ 270°, clockwise hardware rotation of LCD image by 270 degrees 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 /read after drawing the image, continually reads from the screen (for testing purposes). /s displays a vertical stripe pattern. /write continually writes to one word of offscreen memory (for testing purposes only). /? displays the help screen. Note Pressing the Esc key will exit the program. Display Surfaces A surface is a block of memory assigned to one or more physical display devices. 13506SHOW provides 7 display surfaces (0-6) which cover the possible combinations of display types. Table 1:, “Display Surfaces” lists the predefined display surfaces that may be selected. Table 1: Display Surfaces Display Surfaces (ds=) Display Display Device(s) using Device(s) using Memory Block 0 Memory Block 1 0 LCD 1 CRT 2 TV 3 LCD & CRT 4 LCD & TV 5 LCD CRT 6 LCD TV Display surfaces 0 through 2 each display data from a single memory block to an individual display device (LCD, CRT, or TV). Display surfaces 3 and 4 output to two separate display devices, but generate the output from the same memory block. This may be useful when the same image is to be displayed on both display devices. It also reduces the total amount of display memory required. Display surfaces 5 and 6 output to two separate devices from different memory blocks. This allows two completely different images to be displayed at the same time. When using display surfaces 5 or 6, some combinations of display modes with a high resolution and/or high color depth may not be supported within a 2MB display buffer. 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 13506SHOW Examples 13506SHOW is designed to both demonstrate and test some of the features of the S1D13506. The following examples show how to use the program in both instances. Using 13506SHOW For Demonstration 1. To show color patterns which must be manually stepped through, type the following: 13506SHOW The program displays the default color depth and display surface as selected in 13506CFG. Press any key to go to the next screen. Once all screens are shown the program exits. To exit the program immediately press the Esc key. 2. To show color patterns which automatically step through all color depths beginning with the default color depth (as selected in 13506CFG), type the following: 13506SHOW /a The program will display the default color depth. Each screen is shown for approximately 1 second before the next screen is automatically shown. The program exits after the last screen is shown. To exit the program immediately press CTRL+BREAK. 3. To show a color pattern for a specific color depth on the LCD, type the following: 13506SHOW bl=[mode] where mode = 4, 8, 15, or 16. The program displays the requested screen and then exits. Note If a monochrome LCD panel is used, the image is formed using only the green component of the Look-Up Table. 4. To show a color pattern for a specific color depth on the CRT, type the following: 13506SHOW bc=[mode] where mode = 4, 8, 15, or 16. The program display the requested screen and then exits. S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 5. To show the color patterns in SwivelView™ 90° mode, type the following: 13506SHOW /r90 The program will display the default color depth (as selected in 13506CFG). Press any key to go to the next screen. Since SwivelView™ 90° is limited to color depths of 8, 15 and 16 bpp the program exits. To exit the program immediately press the Esc key. The “/r90”, “/r180”, and “/r270” switches can be used in combination with other command line switches. 6. To show solid vertical stripes, type the following: 13506SHOW /s The program will display the default color depth (as selected in 13506CFG). Press any key to go to the next screen. Once all screens are shown the program exits. To exit the program immediately press the Esc key. The “/s” switch can be used in combination with other command line switches. Using 13506SHOW For Testing 1. To show a test grid over the 8 bpp color pattern on an LCD, type the following: 13506SHOW bl=8 /g The program will display the 8 bpp color pattern overlaid with a white grid 20 pixels wide and then exit. The grid makes it obvious if the image is shifted or if pixels are missing. Note the grid is not aligned with the color pattern, therefore the color boxes will not match the grid boxes. The “/g” switch can be used in combination with other command line switches. 2. To test background memory reads to the CRT, type the following: 13506SHOW bc=16 /read The program will test screen reads. If there is a problem with memory access, the displayed pattern will appear different than when the “/read” switch is not used. If there is a problem, check the configuration parameters of 13506SHOW using the utility 13506CFG. See the 13506CFG user guide, document number X25B-B-001-xx, for more information. The “/read” switch should be used in combination with the “b=” setting, otherwise the test will always start with the default color depth (as selected in 13506CFG). To exit the program after using “/read”, press the Esc key and wait for a couple of seconds (the keystroke is checked after reading a full screen). 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Comments • If 13506SHOW is started without defining the color depth, the program automatically cycles through the available color depths from highest to lowest. The first color depth shown is the default color depth value saved to 13506SHOW using 13506CFG. This approach avoids showing color depths not supported by a given hardware configuration. • 13506SHOW checks if the display(s) selected from the DS= option have been previously configured by 13506CFG. If these display(s) have not been configured, 13506SHOW displays an error message. For example, if the system is configured for the CRT, an error is displayed if the user selects the TV with the DS= option. • If the DS= option is used to combine two displays of different resolutions into the same surface, the program will display an error message. • 13506SHOW cannot show a greater color depth than the display allows. • SwivelView™ (/r90, /r270) is available only for color depths of 8, 15, and 16 bpp. • SwivelView™ (/r180) is available for color depths of 4, 8, 15, and 16 bpp. • If the “bl=” or “bc=” options are not used, 13506SHOW will cycle through all available color depths. S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 Program Messages ERROR: Could not detect S1D13506. The ID register did not indicate the presence of the 13506. ERROR: Could not map memory from evaluation board to host platform. This message should only be shown for DOS platforms. In this case the DOS extender could not be initialized, or was unable to get the linear address of the display memory. ERROR: In the given display surface configuration, the user must select the same BPP for both LCD and CRT/TV. When two displays are using an image from the same display memory block, both displays must be configured for the same color depth (bpp). ERROR: Invalid display surface number. The "ds=" command line option included an invalid value. The parameter "ds=?" lists the valid numbers. ERROR: LCD and CRT resolutions must be identical. LCD: (width, height) CRT: (width, height) When the LCD and CRT are using an image from the same display memory block, both displays must be the same resolution. ERROR: LCD and TV resolutions must be identical. LCD: (width, height) TV: (width, height) When the LCD and TV are using an image from the same display memory block, both displays must be the same resolution. ERROR: LCD must be in landscape mode. The LCD panel must be configured for SwivelView 0° mode (landscape) if both the LCD display and CRT/TV are active. ERROR: Not enough display buffer memory. There was insufficient display buffer memory for the given configuration. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center ERROR: Not enough memory for LCD/CRT/TV in 4/8/16 bits-per-pixel. 13506SHOW is unable to change the color depth due to insufficient display buffer memory. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). ERROR: PCI bridge adapter not found. The Windows PCI driver did not find the PCI Bridge Adapter. ERROR: PCI driver not found. The Windows PCI driver is not loaded. ERROR: Program not configured for LCD/CRT/TV. Run 13506CFG and configure for LCD/CRT/TV. The program was configured by 13506CFG for a display device that is not available. This typically occurs if the wrong command line was entered for the current configuration. WARNING: CLKI frequency not in HAL table. Program assumes that external oscillator is used. WARNING: CLKI2 frequency not in HAL table. Program assumes that external oscillator is used. The correct frequency was not found in the HAL table used to program the clock synthesizer. An external oscillator may be in use. This warning message will not stop the program. WARNING: CRT/TV only available in LANDSCAPE mode. SwivelView™ is only available on LCD only configurations. ERROR: b= option cannot be used with /noinit. The command line options b= and /noinit are contradictory, since b= instructs the program to change the color depth and /noinit indicates that no register changes are to be made. ERROR: Continual screen read will not work with the /a switch. ERROR: Continual screen write will not work with the /a switch. The /a switch automatically cycles through the different color depths, whereas the continual screen read/write goes into an infinite loop to read/write memory. ERROR: Do not select 4 BPP LCD in SwivelView ™ 90 or SwivelView™ 270 degrees. SwivelView™ 90 and SwivelView™ 270 are available only in 8 and 16 bits-per-pixel modes. S1D13506 X25B-B-002-03 13506SHOW Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Document Number: X25B-B-003-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 13506PLAY 13506PLAY is a diagnostic utility which allows the user to read/write to all the S1D13506 Registers, Look-Up Tables and Display Buffer. 13506PLAY is similar to the DOS DEBUG program; commands are received from the standard input device, and output is sent to the standard output device (console for Intel, terminal for embedded platforms). This utility requires the target platform to support standard IO (stdio). 13506PLAY commands can be entered interactively by a user, or be executed from a script file. Scripting is a powerful feature which allows command sequences to be used repeatedly without re-entry. The 13506PLAY diagnostic utility must be configured and/or compiled to work with your hardware platform. The program 13506CFG.EXE can be used to configure 13506PLAY. Consult the 13506CFG users guide, document number X25B-B-001-xx, for more information on configuring S1D13506 utilities. This software is designed to work in both embedded and personal computer (PC) environments. For the embedded environment, it is assumed that the system has a means of downloading software from the PC to the target platform. Typically this is done by serial communications, where the PC uses a terminal program to send control commands and information to the target processor. Alternatively, the PC can program an EPROM, which is then placed in the target platform. Some target platforms can also communicate with the PC via a parallel port connection, or an Ethernet connection. S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms 13506PLAY supports the following S1D13506 evaluation platforms: • PC with an Intel 80x86 processor running Windows ‘95/’98/NT. • M68EC000IDP (Integrated Development Platform) board, revision 3.0, with a Motorola M68EC000 processor. • MC68030IDP (Integrated Development Platform) board, revision 3.0, with a Motorola MC68030 processor. • SH3-LCEVB board, revision B, with an Hitachi SH-3 HD6417780 processor. • MPC821ADS (Applications Development System) board, revision B, with a Motorola MPC821 processor. 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Installation PC platform Copy the file 13506play.exe to a directory in the path (e.g. PATH=C:\S1D13506). Embedded platform Download the program 13506play to the system. Usage PC platform At the prompt, type: 13506play [/?] Where: /? displays program version information. Embedded platform Execute 13506play and at the prompt, type the command line argument. Where: /? S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 displays program version information. 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Commands The following commands are designed to be used from within the 13506PLAY program. However, simple commands can also be executed from the command line. If a command with multiple arguments is executed from the command line, it must be enclosed in double quotes (e.g. 13506play “f 0 1FFFFF AB” q). CLKI [?] iFreq Selects a preset clock frequency (MHz) for CLKI. If the “?” option is used, the current CLKI frequency is displayed. Where: ? Displays a list of available frequencies for CLKI (MHz). iFreq Sets CLKI to a preset frequency (MHz) specified by iFreq. CLKI2 [?] iFreq Selects a preset clock frequency (MHz) for CLKI2. If the “?” option is used, the current CLKI2 frequency is displayed. Where: ? Displays a list of available frequencies for CLKI2 (MHz). iFreq Sets CLKI2 to a preset frequency (MHz) specified by iFreq. CW word Sends a 24-bit hexadecimal value to the programmable clock. Note that the programmable clock documentation uses the term “word” to describe the 24-bit value. The use of “word” does not imply a 16-bit value in this case. F addr addr data... Fills a specified address range with 8-bit data (bytes). Where: addr Address range to be filled (hex). data Data to be written (hex). Data can be a list of bytes that will be repeated for the duration of the fill. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal) FD addr addr data... Fills a specified address range with 32-bit data (dwords). Where: addr Address range to be filled (hex). data Data to be written (hex). Data can be a list of dwords that will be repeated for the duration of the fill. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal) 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center FW addr addr data... Fills a specified address range with 16-bit data (words). Where: addr Address range to be filled (hex). data Data to be written (hex). Data can be a list of words that will be repeated for the duration of the fill. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). H [lines] Sets the number of lines of data that will be displayed at a time. The display will be halted after the specified number of lines. Setting the number of lines to 0 will disable the halt function and allow the data to continue displaying until all data has been shown. Where: lines Number of lines that will be shown before halting the displayed data (decimal value). I [?] {LCD|CRT|TV} [d=iCrtTv] [COMP | SVIDEO] [FLICKER=ON | OFF] Initializes the S1D13506 registers for a given display type. Where: ? Displays a help message. LCD Initializes the LCD registers. CRT Initializes the CRT registers. TV Initializes the TV registers. d = iCrtTv Initializes the CRT/TV for a display configuration based on the following table. Table 1: iCrtTv Selection COMP SVIDEO FLICKER=ON FLICKER=OFF S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 iCrtTv Resolution Display Type 0 640x480 CRT 1 800x600 CRT 2 752x484 TV (NTSC) 3 696x436 TV (NTSC) 4 640x480 TV (NTSC) 5 920x572 TV (PAL) 6 856x518 TV (PAL) 7 800x572 TV (PAL) 8 640x480 TV (PAL) Initializes for Composite video output (TV only). Initializes for SVideo output (TV only). Initializes for Flicker Filter enabled (TV only). Initializes for Flicker Filter disabled (TV only). 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 IC {LCD|CRT|TV} Initializes the Hardware Cursor for a given display type. Where: LCD Initializes for the LCD display. CRT Initializes for the CRT display. TV Initializes for the TV display. II {LCD|CRT|TV} Initializes the Ink Layer for a given display type. Where: LCD Initializes for the LCD display. CRT Initializes for the CRT display. TV Initializes for the TV display. L {LCD|CRT|TV} index [red green blue] Writes red, green, and blue Look-Up Table (LUT) components for a given display type. If the red, green, and blue components are not specified, reads the components at the given index. Where: LCD LUT used by the LCD display. CRT LUT used by the CRT display. TV LUT used by the TV display. index Index into the LUT (hex). red Red component of the LUT (hex). green Green component of the LUT (hex). blue Blue component of the LUT (hex). Note Only bits 7-4 of each color are used in the LUT. For example, 10h is the first color intensity after 00h. Valid LUT colors follow the pattern 00h, 10h, 20h, 30h,...E0h, F0h. LA {LCD|CRT|TV} Reads all LUT values for a given display. Where: LCD Reads LUT values for LCD display. CRT Reads LUT values for CRT display. TV Reads LUT values for TV display. Note Only bits 7-4 of each color are used in the LUT. For example, 10h is the first color intensity after 00h. Valid LUT colors follow the pattern 00h, 10h, 20h, 30h,...E0h, F0h. 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center M [?] {LCD|CRT|TV} [bpp] Sets the color depth (bpp) for the specified display type. If no color depth is provided, information about the current setting on the specified display are listed. Where: ? Displays basic information on the current mode for a given display. LCD Sets the color depth of the LCD display. CRT Sets the color depth of the CRT display. TV Sets the color depth of the TV display. bpp Color depth to be set (4/8/16 bpp). MC [?] {LCD|CRT|TV} [bpp] Gets extended information and sets the color depth (bpp). Where: ? Displays further information on the current mode for a given display. LCD Sets the color depth of the LCD display. CRT Sets the color depth of the CRT display. TV Sets the color depth of the TV display. bpp Color depth to be set (4/8/16 bpp). Q Quits the program. R addr [count] Reads a certain number of bytes from the specified address. If no value is provided for count, it defaults to 10h. Where: addr Address from which byte(s) will be read (hex). count Number of bytes to be read (hex). RD addr [count] Reads a certain number of dwords from the specified address. If no value is provided for count, it defaults to 10h. Where: addr Address from which dword(s) will be read (hex). count Number of dwords to be read (hex). RW addr [count] Reads a certain number of words from the specified address. If no value is provided for count, it defaults to 10h. Where: addr Address from which word(s) will be read (hex). count Number of words to be read (hex). S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 S {CLKI | CLKI2 | BUSCLK} freq Sets PCLK source frequency (in kHz). Where: CLKI Sets PCLK source to CLKI. CLKI2 Sets PCLK source to CLKI2. BUSCLK Sets PCLK source to BUSCLK. freq Sets the frequency of the PCLK source (decimal value). V Calculates the current frame rate for all enabled display devices. The frame rate is calculated from the VNDP count. W addr data ... Writes byte(s) of data to specified memory address. Where: addr Address data is written to data Data to be written (hex). Data can be a list of bytes that will be repeated for the duration of the write. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). WD addr data ... Writes dword(s) of data to specified memory address. Where: addr Address data is written to data Data to be written (hex). Data can be a list of dwords that will be repeated for the duration of the write. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). WW addr data ... Writes word(s) of data to specified memory address. Where: addr Address data is written to data Data to be written (hex). Data can be a list of words that will be repeated for the duration of the write. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). X index [data] Writes byte data to the register at index. If no data is specified, reads the 8-bit (byte) data from the register at index. Where: index Index into the registers (hex). data Data to be written to/read from register (hex). Data can be a list of bytes that will be repeated for the duration of the write. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center XA Reads all the S1D13506 registers. XD index [data] Writes dword data to the register at index. If no data is specified, reads the 32-bit (dword) data from the register at index. Where: index Index into the registers (hex). data Data to be written to/read from register (hex). Data can be a list of dwords that will be repeated for the duration of the write. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). XW index [data] Writes word data to the register at index. If no data is specified, reads the 16-bit (word) data from the register at index. Where: index Index into the registers (hex). data Data to be written to/read from register (hex). Data can be a list of words that will be repeated for the duration of the write. To use decimal values, attach a “t” suffix to the value. (e.g. 100t is 100 decimal). ? Displays the help screen. S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 13506PLAY Example 1. Type 13506PLAY to start the program. 2. Type ? for help. 3. Type i LCD to initialize the registers. 4. Type xa to display the contents of the registers. 5. Type x 34 to read register 34h. 6. Type x 34 10 to write 10h to register 34h. 7. Type f 0 ffff aa to fill the first FFFFh bytes of the display buffer with AAh. 8. Type f 0 1fffff aa to fill 2M bytes of the display buffer with AAh. 9. Type r 0 100 to read the first 100h bytes of the display buffer. 10. Type q to exit the program. 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Scripting 13506PLAY can be driven by a script file. This is useful when: • there is no display output and a current register status is required. • various registers must be quickly changed to view results. A script file is an ASCII text file with one 13506PLAY command per line. All scripts must end with a “q” (quit) command. On a PC platform, a typical script command line might be: “13506PLAY < dumpregs.scr > results.” This causes the file “dumpregs.scr” to be interpreted as commands by 13506PLAY and the results to be sent to the file “results.” Example: Create an ASCII text file that contains the commands i, xa, and q. ; This file initializes the S1D13506 and reads the registers. ; Note: after a semicolon (;), all characters on a line are ignored. ; Note: all script files must end with the “q” command. i xa q Comments • All displayed numeric values are considered to be hexadecimal unless identified otherwise. For example, 10 = 10h = 16 decimal; 10t = 10 decimal; 010b = 2 decimal. • Redirecting commands from a script file (PC platform) allows those commands to be executed as though they were typed. S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 Program Messages ERROR: Could not map memory from evaluation board to host platform. This message should only be shown for DOS platforms. In this case the DOS extender could not be initialized, or was unable to get the linear address of the display memory. ERROR: Not enough display buffer memory. There was insufficient display buffer memory for the given configuration. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). ERROR: Not enough memory for LCD/CRT/TV in 4/8/16 bits-per-pixel. 13506BMP is unable to change the color depth due to insufficient display buffer memory. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). ERROR: PCI bridge adapter not found. The Windows PCI driver did not find the PCI Bridge Adapter. ERROR: PCI driver not found. The Windows PCI driver is not loaded. ERROR: Program not configured for LCD/CRT/TV. Run 13506CFG and configure for LCD/CRT/TV. The program was configured by 13506CFG for a display device that is not available. This typically occurs if the wrong command line was entered for the current configuration. WARNING: CLKI frequency not in HAL table. Program assumes that external oscillator is used. WARNING: CLKI2 frequency not in HAL table. Program assumes that external oscillator is used. The correct frequency was not found in the HAL table used to program the clock synthesizer. An external oscillator may be in use. This warning message will not stop the program. ERROR: At least one of the displays must be enabled. This message is shown when 13506PLAY received the V command, but no display is enabled. At least one display must be enabled for the V command to function (5 seconds of VNDP pulses are counted to calculate the frame rate). ERROR: Invalid iFreq value. The CLKI and/or CLKI2 commands were used with an invalid iFreq value. To display a list of iFreq values, type "CLKI ?" or "CLKI2 ?". 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center ERROR: Not enough display buffer memory for LCD/CRT/TV cursor/ink layer. There was insufficient display buffer memory for the given Hardware Cursor/Ink Layer configuration. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). WARNING: FEATCLK cannot be multiplexed to CLKI. Clock synthesizer programmed instead. In 13506PLAY, the CLKI command was used to select the FEATCLK frequency. Since the FEATCLK can only be multiplexed to CLKI2, the clock synthesizer is programmed instead. S1D13506 X25B-B-003-02 13506PLAY Diagnostic Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller 13506BMP Demonstration Program Document Number: X25B-B-004-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 13506BMP 13506BMP is a demonstration utility used to show the S1D13506 display capabilities by rendering bitmap images on the display device(s). The program will display any bitmap stored in Windows BMP file format and then exit. 13506BMP supports SviwelView™ (90°, 180°, and 270° hardware rotation of the display image). 13506BMP is designed to operate on a personal computer (PC) within a 32-bit environment only (Windows ‘95/’98/NT). Other embedded platforms are not supported due to the possible lack of system memory or structured file system. The 13506BMP demonstration utility must be configured and/or compiled to work with your hardware configuration. The program 13506CFG.EXE can be used to configure 13506BMP. Consult the 13506CFG users guide, document number X25B-B-001-xx, for more information on configuring S1D13506 utilities. S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms 13506BMP supports the following S1D13506 evaluation platforms: • PC with an Intel 80x86 processor running Windows ‘95/’98/NT. Note The 13506BMP source code may be modified by the OEM to support other evaluation platforms. Installation Copy the file 13506bmp.exe to a directory in the path (e.g. PATH=C:\S1D13506). 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Usage At the prompt, type: 13506bmp bmpfile [ds=n | ds=?] [/noinit] [/r90 | /r180 | /r270] [/v] [/?] Where: bmpfile specifies filename of a windows format bmp image ds=n selects display surfaces (see Section , “Display Surfaces” on page 5) ds=? shows available display surfaces (see Section , “Display Surfaces” on page 5) /noinit skips full register initialization. Only registers used for changing the color depth (bpp), selecting the memory/registers and programming the clock synthesizer are updated. Additionally, some registers are read to determine information such as display size and type (LCD, CRT, TV). /r90 SwivelView™ 90°, clockwise hardware rotation of LCD image by 90 degrees /r180 SwivelView™ 180°, clockwise hardware rotation of LCD image by 180 degrees /r270 SwivelView™ 270°, clockwise hardware rotation of LCD image by 270 degrees /v verbose mode (provides information about the displayed image) /? displays the help message Note 13506BMP will automatically finish execution and return to the prompt. S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Display Surfaces A surface is a block of memory assigned to one or more physical display devices. 13506BMP provides 7 display surfaces (0-6) which cover the possible combinations of display types. Table 1:, “Display Surfaces” lists the predefined display surfaces that may be selected. Table 1: Display Surfaces Display Surfaces (ds=) Display Display Device(s) using Device(s) using Memory Block 0 Memory Block 1 0 LCD 1 CRT 2 TV 3 LCD & CRT 4 LCD & TV 5 LCD CRT 6 LCD TV Display surfaces 0 through 2 each display data from a single memory block to an individual display device (LCD, CRT, or TV). Display surfaces 3 and 4 output to two seperate display devices, but generate the output from the same memory block. This may be useful when the same image is to be displayed on both display devices. It also reduces the total amount of display memory required. Display surfaces 5 and 6 output to two seperate devices from different memory blocks. This allows two completely different images to be displayed at the same time. When using display surfaces 5 or 6, some combinations of display modes with a high resolution and/or high color depth may not be supported within a 2MB display buffer. 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 13506BMP Examples To display a bmp image on an LCD, type the following: 13506bmp bmpfile.bmp ds=0 To display a bmp image on a CRT, type the following: 13506bmp bmpfile.bmp ds=1 To display a bmp image on an LCD with 90° SwivelView™ enabled, type the following: 13506bmp bmpfile.bmp ds=0 /r90 To display a bmp image on both the LCD and CRT, type the following: 13506bmp bmpfile.bmp ds=3 To display independent bmp images on the LCD and TV, type the following: 13506bmp bmpfile.bmp ds=6 Comments • 13506BMP displays only Windows BMP format images. • A 24-bit true color bitmap will be displayed at a color depth of 16 bit-per-pixel. • Only the green component of the image will be seen on a monochrome display. S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 Program Messages ERROR: Could not detect S1D13506. The ID register did not indicate the presence of the S1D13506. ERROR: Could not map memory from evaluation board to host platform. This message should only be shown for DOS platforms. In this case the DOS extender could not be initialized, or was unable to get the linear address of the display memory. ERROR: Failed to open BMP file:'filename' Could not open the BMP file. ERROR: 'filename' is not a valid bitmap file. The filename given on the command line is not a valid BMP file. ERROR: In the given display surface configuration, the user must select the same BPP for both LCD and CRT/TV. When two displays are using an image from the same display memory block, both displays must be configured for the same color depth (bpp). ERROR: Invalid display surface number. The "ds=" command line option included an invalid value. The parameter "ds=?" lists the valid numbers. ERROR: LCD and CRT resolutions must be identical. LCD: (width, height) CRT: (width, height) When the LCD and CRT are using an image from the same display memory block, both displays must be the same resolution. ERROR: LCD and TV resolutions must be identical. LCD: (width, height) TV: (width, height) When the LCD and TV are using an image from the same display memory block, both displays must be the same resolution. ERROR: LCD must be in landscape mode. The LCD panel must be configured for landscape mode if both the LCD display and CRT/TV are active. ERROR: Not enough display buffer memory. There was insufficient display buffer memory for the given configuration. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center ERROR: Not enough memory for LCD/CRT/TV in 4/8/15/16 bits-per-pixel. 13506BMP is unable to change the color depth due to insufficient display buffer memory. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). ERROR: Not enough memory for virtual display. A virtual display is required for SwivelView ™. This error message indicates there is insufficient memory for the given configuration. Memory requirements depend on: • the display resolution(s). • the bit-per-pixel depth(s). • whether a half-frame buffer is required. • the number of displays active (LCD or LCD and CRT/TV). ERROR: PCI bridge adapter not found. The Windows PCI driver did not find the PCI Bridge Adapter. ERROR: PCI driver not found. The Windows PCI driver is not loaded. ERROR: Program not configured for LCD/CRT/TV. Run 13506CFG and configure for LCD/CRT/TV. The program was configured by 13506CFG for a display device that is not available. This typically occurs if the wrong command line was entered for the current configuration. WARNING: CLKI frequency not in HAL table. Program assumes that external oscillator is used. WARNING: CLKI2 frequency not in HAL table. Program assumes that external oscillator is used. The correct frequency was not found in the HAL table used to program the clock synthesizer. An external oscillator may be in use. This warning message will not stop the program. WARNING: CRT/TV only available in LANDSCAPE mode. SwivelView™ is only available on LCD only configurations. S1D13506 X25B-B-004-02 13506BMP Demonstration Program Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller 13506FILT Test Utility Document Number: X25B-B-005-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-005-02 13506FILT Test Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 13506FILT 13506FILT is an interactive Windows® 9x/NT program that enables/disables the S1D13506 TV Filters. It demonstrates the effect each filter has on a pre-loaded TV image. 13506FILT is particularly useful in a test or demonstration environment where 13506FILT is run on one display and the effects of enabling/disabling each filter are seen on a TV. An OEM may find this useful in determining the appropriate filters for their application. Note The 13506FILT dialog box doesn’t appear on any display device controlled by the S1D13506. The 13506FILT dialog box appears on the Win 9x/NT desktop. 13506FILT is designed to operate on a personal computer (PC) within a 32-bit environment only (Windows 9x/NT). Other embedded platforms are not supported. S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms 13506FILT supports the following S1D13506 evaluation platforms: • PC with an Intel 80x86 processor running Windows 9x/NT. Installation Copy the file 13506filt.exe to a directory in the path. If desired, create a shortcut on the Windows 9x/NT desktop to the file 13506filt.exe. Usage In Windows ‘9x/NT, double-click the following icon: Or, at the Windows DOS Prompt, type 13506filt. 13506FILT Test Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-005-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Filter Dialog Box The filter dialog box controls which TV filters are enabled/disabled during NTSC or PAL output. The check box for each filter determines if the filter is enabled or disabled. When the box is checked the filter is enabled. When the box is unchecked the filter is disabled. In the example below: • the flicker filter is disabled. • the chrominance filter is enabled. • the luminance filter is enabled. Figure 1: Filter Dialog Box S1D13506 X25B-B-005-02 13506FILT Test Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Filter Descriptions When displaying computer images on a TV, several image distortions are likely to arise: • flickering. • cross-chrominance distortion. • cross-luminance distortion. These distortions are caused by the high-resolution nature of computer images which typically contain sharp chrominance (color) transitions, and sharp luminance (brightness) transitions. Three filters are available to reduce these distortions. Anti-flicker Filter The “flickering” effect seen on interlaced displays is caused by sharp vertical image transitions that occur over one line (1 vertical pixel). For example, flickering may occur where there are one pixel high lines, edges of window boxes, etc. Flickering occurs because these high resolution lines are effectively displayed at half the refresh frequency due to interlacing. To reduce flickering, the anti-flicker filter averages adjacent lines on the TV display. Chrominance Filter The chrominance filter adjusts the color of the TV by limiting the bandwidth of the chrominance signal (reducing cross-luminance distortion). This reduces the “ragged edges” seen at boundaries between sharp color transitions. This filter is intended for use with composite video output. Luminance Filter The luminance filter adjusts the brightness of the TV by limiting the bandwidth of the luminance signal (reducing cross-chrominance distortion). This reduces the “rainbow-like” colors at boundaries between sharp luminance transitions. This filter is intended for use with composite video output. 13506FILT Test Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-005-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Comments • The Flicker Filter can’t be enabled unless a TV is present and active. • 13506FILT is designed to show the effects of the filters on a pre-loaded TV image. 13506BMP may be used to display a static image on the TV (see the 13506BMP Users Manual, document number X25B-B-004-xx). • The chrominance and luminance filters are intended for use with composite output. • For information on manually enabling/disabling the TV filters, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification (document number X25B-A-001-xx) and the S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples (document number X25B-G-003-xx). S1D13506 X25B-B-005-02 13506FILT Test Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller 13506SWIVEL Demonstration Utility Document Number: X25B-B-006-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-B-006-02 13506SWIVEL Demonstration Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 13506SWIVEL 13506SWIVEL is a command line utility that demonstrates the SwivelView™ feature of the S1D13506. The SwivelView feature provides hardware rotation of a predefined image by 90°, 180°, and 270° in a clockwise direction. 13506SWIVEL cycles through each SwivelView mode, advancing to the next mode when a key is pressed. 13506SWIVEL is designed to operate on a personal computer (PC) within a 32-bit environment only (Windows 9x/NT). Other embedded platforms are not supported. The 13506SWIVEL utility must be configured and/or compiled to work with your hardware configuration. The program 13506CFG.EXE can be used to configure 13506SWIVEL. Consult the 13506CFG Users Manual, document number X25B-B-001xx, for more information on configuring S1D13506 utilities. S1D13506 Supported Evaluation Platforms 13506SWIVEL supports the following S1D13506 evaluation platforms: • PC with an Intel 80x86 processor running Windows 9x/NT. Installation Copy the file 13506swivel.exe to a directory in the path. If desired, create a shortcut on the Windows 9x/NT desktop to the file 13506swivel.exe. Usage At the Windows DOS Prompt, type: 13506swivel Note Pressing the ESC key exits the program. 13506SWIVEL Demonstration Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-B-006-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Example 1. Run the utility 13506SWIVEL. At the Windows DOS prompt type: 13506swivel Note A pattern of colored numbers appears in SwivelView 0° mode (normal landscape). 2. Press any key to enable SwivelView 90° mode. The displayed image is rotated by 90°. 3. Press any key to enable SwivelView 180° mode. The displayed image is rotated by 180°. 4. Press any key to enable SwivelView 270° mode. The displayed image is rotated by 270°. 5. Press any key to return to SwivelView 0° mode (normal landscape). 6. Press the ESC key to exit the program. Note 13506SWIVEL will continue to cycle through the SwivelView modes in the above order until the ESC key is pressed. Comments • 13506SWIVEL supports LCD panels only (no CRT or TV). • 13506SWIVEL only supports 8/15/16 bpp color depths. • 13506SWIVEL must be configured for LCD only using the utility 13506CFG. For further information on 13506CFG, refer to the 13506CFG Users Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx. • For further information on SwivelView™, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification (document number X25B-A-001-xx) and the S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples (document number X25B-G-003-xx). S1D13506 X25B-B-006-02 13506SWIVEL Demonstration Utility Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Windows® CE Display Drivers Document Number: X25A-E-001-05 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 WINDOWS® CE DISPLAY DRIVERS The Windows CE display drivers are designed to support the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller running under the Microsoft Windows CE operating system. Available drivers include: 4, 8 and 16 bit-per-pixel landscape modes (no rotation), and 8 and 16 bit-per-pixel SwivelView™ 90°, 180° and 270° modes. Note The Windows CE display drivers are provided as examples only. The source code contains functionality for all features of the S1D13506. Source code modification is necessary to provide a smaller, more efficent driver for mass production (i.e. TV support may be removed for products not requiring TV). This document and the source code for the Windows CE drivers is updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revisions before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Program Requirements Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Video Controller : S1D13506 Display Type : LCD or CRT Windows Version : CE Version 2.0 and 2.11 S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Example Driver Builds Build for CEPC (X86) on Windows CE 2.0 To build a Windows CE v2.0 display driver for the CEPC (X86) platform using a S5U13506B00C evaluation board, follow the instructions below: 1. Install Microsoft Windows NT v4.0. 2. Install Microsoft Visual C/C++ v5.0. 3. Install the Microsoft Windows CE Embedded Toolkit (ETK) by running SETUP.EXE from the ETK compact disc #1. 4. Create a new project by following the procedure documented in “Creating a New Project Directory” from the Windows CE ETK V2.0. Alternately, use the current “DEMO7” project included with the ETK v2.0. Follow the steps below to create a “X86 DEMO7” shortcut on the Windows NT v4.0 desktop which uses the current “DEMO7” project: a. Right click on the “Start” menu on the taskbar. b. Click on the item “Open All Users” and the “Start Menu” window will come up. c. Click on the icon “Programs”. d. Click on the icon “Windows CE Embedded Development Kit”. e. Drag the icon “X86 DEMO1” onto the desktop using the right mouse button. f. Click on “Copy Here”. g. Rename the icon “X86 DEMO1” on the desktop to “X86 DEMO7” by right clicking on the icon and choosing “rename”. h. Right click on the icon “X86 DEMO7” and click on “Properties” to bring up the “X86 DEMO7 Properties” window. i. Click on “Shortcut” and replace the string “DEMO1” under the entry “Target” with “DEMO7”. j. Click on “OK” to finish. Note You may need administrator privilege on your local developing machine to perform the above steps. If you only have a user privilege, you may refer to step 3 of the Section , “Build for CEPC (X86) on Windows CE Platform Builder 2.11” on page 6. 5. Create a sub-directory named S1D13506 under \wince\platform\cepc\drivers\display. 6. Copy the source code to the S1D13506 subdirectory. 7. Add an entry for the S1D13506 in the file \wince\platform\cepc\drivers\display\dirs. S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 8. Edit the file PLATFORM.BIB (located in X:\wince\platform\cepc\files) to set the default display driver to the file EPSON.DLL. (EPSON.DLL will be created during the build in step 12) You may replace the following lines in PLATFORM.BIB: IF CEPC_DDI_VGA2BPP ddi.dll $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\ddi_vga2.dll NK SH ENDIF IF CEPC_DDI_VGA8BPP ddi.dll $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\ddi_vga8.dll NK SH ENDIF IF CEPC_DDI_VGA2BPP ! IF CEPC_DDI_VGA8BPP ! ddi.dll $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\ddi_s364.dll NK SH $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\EPSON.dll NK SH ENDIF ENDIF with this line: ddi.dll 9. If the current MODE0.H is not appropriate for your project, generate a new MODE0.H file using the S1D13506 utility program 13506CFG.EXE. The file MODE0.H (located in X:\wince\platform\cepc\drivers\display\S1D13506) contains the register values required to set desired screen resolution, color depth (bpp), panel type, active display(LCD/CRT/TV), rotation, etc. 10. Edit the file PLATFORM.REG to match the screen resolution, color depth (bpp), active display(LCD/CRT/TV) and rotation information in MODE.H. PLATFORM.REG is located in X:\wince\platform\cepc\files. For example, the display driver section of PLATFORM.REG should be as follows when using a 640x480 LCD panel with a color depth of 8 bpp in SwivelView 0° (landscape) mode. ; Default for EPSON Display Driver ; 640x480 at 8bits/pixel, LCD display, no rotation ; Useful Hex Values ; 1024=0x400, 768=0x300 640=0x280 480=0x1E0 320=140 240=0xF0 [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Drivers\Display\S1D13506] “Width”=dword:280 “Height”=dword:1E0 “Bpp”=dword:8 “Flags”=dword:1 “Rotation”=dword:0 Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 11. Remove the X:\wince\release directory, and delete X:\wince\platform\cepc\*.bif 12. Generate the proper building environment by double-clicking on the sample project icon (i.e. X86 DEMO7). 13. Type BLDDEMO <ENTER> at the DOS prompt of the X86 DEMO7 window to generate a Windows CE image file (NK.BIN). Build for CEPC (X86) on Windows CE Platform Builder 2.11 1. Install Microsoft Windows NT v4.0. 2. Install Platform Builder 2.11 by running SETUP.EXE from compact disk #1. 3. Follow the steps below to create a “Build Epson for x86” shortcut which uses the current “Minshell” project icon/shortcut on the Windows NT 4.0 desktop. a. Right click on the “Start” menu on the taskbar. b. Click on the item “Explore”, and “Exploring -- Start Menu” window will come up. c. Under “\Winnt\Profiles\All Users\Start Menu\Programs\Microsoft Windows CE Platform Builder\x86 Tools, find the icon “Build Minshell for x86”. d. Drag the icon “Build Minshell for x86” onto the desktop using the right mouse button. e. Choose “Copy Here”. g. Rename the icon “Build Minshell for x86” to “Build Epson for x86” by right clicking on the icon and choosing “rename”. h. Right click on the icon “Build Epson for x86” and click on “Properties” to bring up the “Build Epson for x86 Properties” window. i. Click on “Shortcut” and replace the string “Minshelll” under the entry “Target” with “Epson”. j. Click on “OK” to finish. 4. Create an EPSON project. a. Make an Epson directory under \WINCE211\PUBLIC. b. Copy MAXALL and its sub-directories (\WINCE211\PUBLIC\MAXALL) to the Epson directory. xcopy /s /e \wince211\public\maxall\*.* \wince211\public\epson c. Rename \WINCE211\PUBLIC\EPSON\MAXALL.BAT to EPSON.BAT. d. Edit EPSON.BAT to add the following lines to the end of the file: @echo on set CEPC_DDI_S1D13506=1 @echo off S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 5. Make a S1D13506 directory under \WINCE211\PLATFORM\CEPC\DRIVERS\DISPLAY, and copy the S1D13506 driver source code into \WINCE211\PLATFORM\CEPC\DRIVERS\DISPLAY\S1D13506. 6. Add S1D13506 into the directory list in file -\WINCE211\PLATFORM\CEPC\DRIVERS\DISPLAY\dirs 7. Edit the file \WINCE211\PLATFORM\CEPC\FILES\platform.bib to add the following after the line “IF ODO_NODISPLAY!”: IF CEPC_DDI_S1D13506 ddi.dll $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\epson.dll NK SH ENDIF Replace the section: IF CEPC_DDI_S3VIRGE ! IF CEPC_DDI_CT655X ! IF CEPC_DDI_VGA8BPP ! ddi.dll $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\ddi_s364.dll NK SH ENDIF ENDIF ENDIF with the following: IF CEPC_DDI_S1D13506 ! IF CEPC_DDI_S3VIRGE ! IF CEPC_DDI_CT655X ! IF CEPC_DDI_VGA8BPP ! ddi.dll $(_FLATRELEASEDIR)\ddi_s364.dll NK SH ENDIF ENDIF ENDIF ENDIF 8. If the current MODE0.H is not appropriate for your project, generate a new MODE0.H using the S1D13506 utility program 13506CFG.EXE. The file MODE0.H (located in X:\wince\platform\cepc\drivers\display\S1D13506) contains the register values required to set desired screen resolution, color depth (bpp), panel type, active display(LCD/CRT/TV), rotation, etc. Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 9. Edit the file PLATFORM.REG match the screen resolution, color depth (bpp), active display(LCD/CRT/TV) and rotation information in MODE.H. PLATFORM.REG is located in X:\wince\platform\cepc\files. For example, the display driver section of PLATFORM.REG should be as follows when using a 640x480 LCD panel with a color depth of 8 bpp in SwivelView 0° (landscape) mode. ; Default for EPSON Display Driver ; 640x480 at 8bits/pixel, LCD display, no rotation ; Useful Hex Values ; 1024=0x400, 768=0x300 640=0x280 480=0x1E0 320=140 240=0xF0 [HKEY_LOCAL_MACHINE\Drivers\Display\S1D13506] “Width”=dword:280 “Height”=dword:1E0 “Bpp”=dword:8 “Flags”=dword:1 “Rotation”=dword:0 10. Remove the \wince211\release directory and delete \wince211\platform\cepc\*.bif 11. Generate the proper building environment by double-clicking on the Epson project icon -”Build Epson for x86”. 12. Type BLDDEMO <ENTER> at the DOS prompt of the “Build Epson for x86” window to generate a Windows CE image file (NK.BIN). S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 Installation for CEPC Environment Windows CE v2.0 can be loaded on a PC using a floppy drive or a hard drive. The two methods are described below: 1. To load CEPC from a floppy drive: a. Create a DOS bootable floppy disk. b. Edit CONFIG.SYS on the floppy disk to contain the following line only. device=a:\himem.sys c. Edit AUTOEXEC.BAT on the floppy disk to contain the following lines. mode com1:9600,n,8,1 loadcepc /B:9600 /C:1 c:\wince\release\nk.bin d. Copy LOADCEPC.EXE from c:\wince\public\common\oak\bin to the bootable floppy disk. e. Confirm that NK.BIN is located in c:\wince\release. f. Reboot the system from the bootable floppy disk. 2. To load CEPC from a hard drive: a. Copy LOADCEPC.EXE to the root directory of the hard drive. b. Edit CONFIG.SYS on the hard drive to contain the following line only. device=c:\himem.sys c. Edit AUTOEXEC.BAT on the hard drive to contain the following lines. mode com1:9600,n,8,1 loadcepc /B:9600 /C:1 c:\wince\release\nk.bin d. Confirm that NK.BIN is located in c:\wince\release. e. Reboot the system from the hard drive. Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Comments • The display driver is CPU independent allowing use of the driver for other Windows CE Platform Builder 2.11supported platforms. The file EPSON.CPP may require editing to return the correct value for PhysicalPortAddr, PhysicalVmemAddr, etc. • The sample code defaults to a 640x480 color dual passive 16-bit LCD panel at 8 bpp landscape mode. To support other settings, use 13506CFG.EXE to generate the proper MODE0.H file. For further information, refer to the 13506CFG user manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx. • As the time of printing, the drivers have been tested on the x86 CPUs and have been run with version 2.0 of the ETK and Platform Builder 2.11. The drivers are will be updated as appropriate. Before beginning any development, check the Epson Electronics America Website at www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document. S1D13506 X25A-E-001-05 Windows® CE Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Wind River WindML v2.0 Display Drivers Document Number: X25B-E-002-03 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-E-002-03 Wind River WindML v2.0 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/04/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Wind River WindML v2.0 DISPLAY DRIVERS The Wind River WindML v2.0 display drivers for the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller are intended as “reference” source code for OEMs developing for Wind River’s WindML v2.0. The driver package provides support for both 8 and 16 bit-per-pixel color depths. The source code is written for portability and contains functionality for most features of the S1D13506. Source code modification is required to provide a smaller, more efficient driver for mass production (e.g. TV support may be removed for products not requiring TV). The WindML display drivers are designed around a common configuration include file called mode0.h which is generated by the configuration utility 13506CFG. This design allows for easy customization of display type, clocks, decode addresses, rotation, etc. by OEMs. For further information on 13506CFG, see the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx. Note The WindML display drivers are provided as “reference” source code only. They are intended to provide a basis for OEMs to develop their own drivers for WindML v2.0. These drivers are not backwards compatible with UGL v1.2. For information on the UGL v1.2 display drivers, see Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers, document number X25B-E-003-xx. This document and the source code for the WindML display drivers is updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com or the Epson Research and Development website at http://www.erd.epson.com for the latest revisions before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Wind River WindML v2.0 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/04/06 S1D13506 X25B-E-002-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Building a WindML v2.0 Display Driver The following instructions produce a bootable disk that automatically starts the UGL demo program. These instructions assume that Wind River’s Tornado platform is already installed. Note For the example steps where the drive letter is given as “x:”. Substitute “x” with the drive letter that your development environment is on. 1. Create a working directory and unzip the WindML display driver into it. From a command prompt or GUI interface create a new directory (e.g. x:\13506). Unzip the file 13506windml.zip to the newly created working directory. The files will be unzipped to the directories “x:\13506\8bpp” and “x:\13506\16bpp”. 2. Configure for the target execution model. This example build creates a VxWorks image that fits onto and boots from a single floppy diskette. In order for the VxWorks image to fit on the disk certain modifications are required. Replace the file “x:\Tornado\target\config\pcPentium\config.h” with the file “x:\13506\8bpp\File\config.h” (or “x:\13506\16bpp\File\config.h”). The new config.h file removes networking components and configures the build image for booting from a floppy disk. Note Rather than simply replacing the original config.h file, rename it so the file can be kept for reference purposes. 3. Build a boot ROM image. From the Tornado tool bar, select Build -> Build Boot ROM. Select “pcPentium” as the BSP and “bootrom_uncmp” as the image. 4. Create a bootable disk (in drive A:). From a command prompt change to the directory “x:\Tornado\host\x86-win32\bin” and run the batch file torvars.bat. Next, change to the directory “x:\Tornado\target\config\pcPentium” and type: mkboot a: bootrom_uncmp 5. If necessary, generate a new mode0.h configuration file. The file mode0.h contains the register values required to set the screen resolution, color depth (bpp), display type, active display (LCD/CRT/TV), rotation, etc. The mode0.h file included with the drivers, may not contain applicable values and must be regenerated. The configuration program 13506CFG can be used to build a new mode0.h file. If building for 8 bpp, place the new mode0.h file in the directory “x:\13506\8bpp\File”. If building for 16 bpp, place the new mode0.h file in “x:\13506\16bpp\File”. S1D13506 X25B-E-002-03 Wind River WindML v2.0 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/04/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Note Mode0.h should be created using the configuration utility 13506CFG. For more information on 13506CFG, see the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx available at www.erd.epson.com. 6. Build the WindML v2.0 library. From a command prompt change to the directory “x:\Tornado\host\x86-win32\bin” and run the batch file torvars.bat. Next, change to the directory “x:\Tornado\target\src\ugl” and type the command: make CPU=PENTIUM ugl 7. Open the S1D13506 workspace. From the Tornado tool bar, select File->Open Workspace...->Existing->Browse... and select the file “x:\13506\8bpp\13506.wsp” (or “x:\13506\16bpp\13506.wsp”). 8. Add support for single line comments. The WindML v2.0 display driver source code uses single line comment notation, “//”, rather than the ANSI conventional comments, “/*...*/”. To add support for single line comments follow these steps: a. In the Tornado “Workspace Views” window, click on the “Builds” tab. b. Expand the “8bpp Builds” (or “16bpp Builds”) view by clicking on the “+” next to it. The expanded view will contain the item “default”. Right-click on “default” and select “Properties...”. A “Properties:” window will appear. c. Select the “C/C++ compiler” tab to display the command switches used in the build. Remove the “-ansi” switch from the line that contains “-g -mpentium -ansi -nostdinc -DRW_MULTI_THREAD”. (Refer to GNU ToolKit user's guide for details) 9. Compile the VxWorks image. Select the “Builds” tab in the Tornado “Workspace Views” window. Right-click on “8bpp files” (or “16bpp files”) and select “Dependencies...”. Click on “OK” to regenerate project file dependencies for “All Project files”. Right-click on “8bpp files” (or “16bpp files”) and select “ReBuild All(vxWorks)” to build VxWorks. 10. Copy the VxWorks file to the diskette. From a command prompt or through the Windows interface, copy the file “x:\13506\8bpp\default\vxWorks” (or “x:\13506\16bpp\default\vxWorks”) to the bootable disk created in step 4. 11. Start the VxWorks demo. Boot the target PC with the VxWorks bootable diskette to run the UGLDEMO automatically. Wind River WindML v2.0 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/04/06 S1D13506 X25B-E-002-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-E-002-03 Wind River WindML v2.0 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/04/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers Document Number: X25B-E-003-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-E-003-02 Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers The Wind River UGL v1.2 display drivers for the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller are intended as “reference” source code for OEMs developing for Wind River’s UGL v1.2. The drivers provide support for both 8 and 16 bit-per-pixel color depths. The source code is written for portability and contains functionality for most features of the S1D13506. Source code modification is required to provide a smaller, more efficient driver for mass production (e.g. TV support may be removed for products not requiring TV). The UGL display drivers are designed around a common configuration include file called mode0.h which is generated by the configuration utility 13506CFG. This design allows for easy customization of display type, clocks, addresses, rotation, etc. by OEMs. For further information on 13506CFG, see the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx. This document and the source code for the UGL display drivers are updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com or the Epson Research and Development website at http://www.erd.epson.com for the latest revisions before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via e-mail at [email protected]. Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-E-003-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Building a UGL v1.2 Display Driver The following instructions produce a bootable disk that automatically starts the UGL demo software. These instructions assume that the Wind River Tornado platform is correctly installed. Note For the example steps where the drive letter is given as “x:”. Substitute “x” with the drive letter that your development environment is on. 1. Create a working directory and unzip the UGL display driver into it Using a command prompt or GUI interface create a new directory (e.g. x:\13506). Unzip the file 13506ugl.zip to the newly created working directory. The files will be unzipped to the directories “x:\13506\8bpp” and “x:\13506\16bpp”. 2. Configure for the target execution model. This example build creates a VxWorks image that fits onto and boots from a single floppy diskette. In order for the VxWorks image to fit on the disk certain modifications are required. Replace the file “x:\Tornado\target\config\pcPentium\config.h” with the file “x:\13506\8bpp\File\config.h” (or “x:\13506\16bpp\File\config.h”). The new config.h file removes networking components and configures the build image for booting from a floppy disk. Note Rather than simply replacing the original config.h file, rename it so the file can be kept for reference purposes. 3. Build a boot ROM image. From the Tornado tool bar, select Build -> Build Boot ROM. Select “pcPentium” as the BSP and “bootrom_uncmp” as the image. 4. Create a bootable disk (in drive A:). From a command prompt in the directory “x:\Tornado\target\config\pcPentium” type mkboot a: bootrom_uncmp 5. If necessary, generate a new mode0.h configuration file. The file mode0.h contains the register values required to set the screen resolution, color depth (bpp), display type, active display (LCD/CRT/TV), rotation, etc. The mode0.h, included with the drivers, sets the display for 640x480 60 Hz output to a CRT display. If this setting is inappropriate then mode0.h must be regenerated. The configuration program 13506CFG can be used to build a new mode0.h file. If building for 8 bpp, place the new mode0.h file in “x:\13506\8bpp\File”. If building for 16 bpp, place the new mode0.h file in “x:\13506\16bpp\File”. S1D13506 X25B-E-003-02 Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Note Mode0.h should be created using the configuration utility 13506CFG. For more information on 13506CFG, see the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx available at www.erd.epson.com. 6. Open the S1D13506 workspace. From the Tornado tool bar, select File->Open Workspace...->Existing->Browse... and select the file “x:\13506\8bpp\13506.wsp” (or “x:\13506\16bpp\13506.wsp”). 7. Add support for single line comments. The UGL v1.2 display driver source code uses single line comment notation, “//”, rather than the ANSI conventional comments, “/* . . . */”. To add support for single line comments follow these steps: a. In the Tornado “Workspace” window, click on the “Builds” tab. b. Expand the “8bpp Builds” (or “16bpp Builds”) view by clicking on the “+” next to it. The expanded view will contain the item “default”. Right-click on “default” and select “Properties...”. A properties window will appear. c. Select the “C/C++ compiler” tab to display the command switches used in the build. Remove the “-ansi” switch from the line that contains “-g -mpentium -ansi -nostdinc -DRW_MULTI_THREAD”. (Refer to GNU ToolKit user's guide for details) 8. Compile the VxWorks image. Select the “Files” tab in the Tornado “Workspace” window. Right-click on “8bpp files” (or “16bpp files”) and select “Dependencies...”. Click on “OK” to regenerate project file dependencies for “All Project files”. Right-click on “8bpp files” (or “16bpp files”) and select “ReBuild All(vxWorks)” to build VxWorks. 9. Copy the VxWorks file to the diskette. From a command prompt or through the Windows interface, copy the file “x:\13506\8bpp\default\vxWorks” (or “x:\13506\16bpp\default\vxWorks”) to the bootable disk created in step 4. 10. Start the VxWorks demo. Boot the target PC with the VxWorks bootable diskette to run the UGLDEMO automatically. Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-E-003-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-E-003-02 Wind River UGL v1.2 Display Drivers Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT Controller Linux Console Driver Document Number: X23B-E-004-01 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X23B-E-004-01 Linux Console Driver Issue Date: 01/03/20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Linux Console Driver The Linux console driver for the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT Controller is intended as “reference” source code for OEMs developing for Linux. The console driver is a non-accelerated driver supporting 4, 8, and 16 bit-per-pixel color depths. A Graphical User Interface (GUI) such as Gnome can obtain the frame buffer address from this driver allowing the Linux GUI the ability to update the display. The console driver is designed around an include file called s1d13506.h which is generated by the configuration utility 13506CFG. Using 13506CFG the programmer can easily customize the operation of display type, clocks, addresses, rotation, etc. This document and the source code for the Linux console drivers are updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com or the Epson Research and Development website at http://www.erd.epson.com for the latest revisions or before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via e-mail at [email protected]. Linux Console Driver Issue Date: 01/03/20 S1D13506 X23B-E-004-01 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Building the S1D13506 Console Driver Follow the steps below to construct a copy of the Linux operating system using the S1D13506 as the console display device. These instructions assume that the GNU development environment is installed and the user is familiar with GNU and the Linux operating system. 1. Acquire the Linux kernel source code. You can obtain the Linux kernel source code from your Linux supplier or download the source from: ftp://ftp.kernel.org. The S1D13506 reference driver requires Linux kernel 2.2.0 or greater. For information on building the kernel refer to the readme file at: ftp://ftp.linuxberg.com/pub/linux/kernel/README Note The 13506 reference driver was built using Red Hat Linux 6.1, kernel version 2.2.17. Before continuing with modifications for the S1D13506, you should ensure that you can build and start the Linux operating system. 2. Unzip the console driver files. Using a zip file utility, unzip the S1D13506 archive to a temporary directory. (e.g. /tmp) When completed the files: s1d13xxxfb.c s1d13506.h Config.in fbmem.c fbcon-cfb4.c, and Makefile should be located in the temporary directory. 3. Copy the console driver files to the build directory. Copy the files /tmp/s1d13xxxfb.c and /tmp/s1d13506.h to the directory /usr/src/linux/drivers/video. Copy the remaining source files /tmp/Config.in /tmp/fbmem.c /tmp/fbcon-cfb4.c, and /tmp/Makefile into the directory /usr/src/linux/drivers/video replacing the files of the same name. S1D13506 X23B-E-004-01 Linux Console Driver Issue Date: 01/03/20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 If your kernel version is not 2.2.17 or you want to retain greater control of the build process then use a text editor and cut and paste the sections dealing with the Epson driver in the corresponding files of the same names. 4. Modify s1d13506.h The file s1d13506.h contains the register values required to set the screen resolution, color depth (bpp), display type, active display (LCD/CRT), display rotation, etc. Before building the console driver, refer to the descriptions in the file s1d13506.h for the default settings of the console driver. If the default does not match the configuration you are building for then s1d13506.h will have to be regenerated with the correct information. Use the program 13506CFG to generate the required header file. For information on how to use 13506CFG, refer to the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx, available at www.erd.epson.com After selecting the desired configuration, choose “File->Export” and select the “C Header File for S1D13506 Generic Drivers” option. Save the new configuration as s1d13506.h in the /usr/src/linux/drivers/video, replacing the original configuration file. 5. Configure the video options. From the command prompt in the directory /usr/src/linux run the command: make menuconfig This command will start a text based interface which allows the selection of build time parameters. From the text interface under “Console drivers” options, select: “Support for frame buffer devices” “Epson LCD/CRT controllers support” “S1D13506 support” “Advanced low level driver options” “xBpp packed pixels support” * * where x is the color depth being compiled for. If you are using the Epson PCI evaluation board then you must also select: “Epson PCI Bridge adapter support” Once you have configured the kernel options, save and exit the configuration utility. 6. Compile and install the kernel Build the kernel with the following sequence of commands: make dep make clean make bzImage /sbin/lilo (if running lilo) Linux Console Driver Issue Date: 01/03/20 S1D13506 X23B-E-004-01 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7. Boot to the Linux operating system If you are using lilo (Linux Loader), modify the lilo configuration file as discussed in the kernel build README file. If there were no errors during the build, from the command prompt run: lilo and reboot your system. Note In order to use the S1D13506 console driver with X server, you need to configure the X server to use the FBDEV device. A good place to look for the necessary files and instructions on this process is on the Internet at www.xfree86.org S1D13506 X23B-E-004-01 Linux Console Driver Issue Date: 01/03/20 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver Document Number: X25B-E-005-01 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-E-005-01 QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver Issue Date: 01/04/17 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver The Photon v2.0 display drivers for the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller are intended as “reference” source code for OEMs developing for QNX platforms. The driver package provides support for 8 and 16 bit-per-pixel color depths. The source code is written for portability and contains functionality for most features of the S1D13506. Source code modification is required to provide a smaller driver for mass production. The current revision of the driver is designed for use with either QNX RTP or QNX4 from the latest product CD (Dec. 99). The Photon v2.0 display driver is designed around a common configuration include file called S1D13506.h, which is generated by the configuration utility 13506CFG. This design allows for easy customization of display type, clocks, decode addresses, etc. by OEMs. For further information on 13506CFG, see the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx. Note The QNX display drivers are provided as “reference” source code only. They are intended to provide a basis for OEMs to develop their own drivers for QNX Photon v2.0. This document and the source code for the QNX display drivers are updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com or the Epson Research and Development website at http://www.erd.epson.com for the latest revisions before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via e-mail at [email protected]. QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver Issue Date: 01/04/17 S1D13506 X25B-E-005-01 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Building the Photon v2.0 Display Driver The following steps build the Photon v2.0 display driver and integrate it into the QNX operating system. These instructions assume the QNX developer environment is correctly installed and the developer is familiar with building for the QNX operating system. Unpack the Graphics Driver Development Kit Archive 1. Install the QNX ddk package using the Package Manager utility. For information about the Drivers Development Kit contact QNX directly. 2. Once the ddk package is installed, copy the directory tree /usr/scr/gddk_v1.0 into the Project directory. 3. Change directory to Project/gddk_1.0/devg. 4. Unpack the display driver files using the commands: #gunzip S1D13506.tar.gz #tar –xvf S1D13506.tar This unpacks the files into the directory Project/gddk_1.0/devg/S1D13506. Configure the Driver The files s1d13506_16.h and s1d13506_8.h contain register values required to set the screen resolution, color depth (bpp), display type, etc. The s1d13506.h file included with the drivers may not contain applicable values and must be regenerated. The configuration program 13506CFG can be used to build new s1d13506_16.h and s1d13506_8.h files. Note S1d13506.h should be created using the configuration utility 13506CFG. For more information on 13506CFG, see the 13506CFG Configuration Program User Manual, document number X25B-B-001-xx available at www.erd.epson.com. Build the Driver The first time the driver is built, the following command ensures that all drivers and required libraries are built. At the root of the Project source tree, type make. Note To build drivers for X86 NTO type ‘OSLIST=nto CPULIST=x86 make’. Further builds do not require all libraries to be re-built. To build only the S1D13506 display driver, change to the directory gddk_1.0/devg/S1D13506 and type make. S1D13506 X25B-E-005-01 QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver Issue Date: 01/04/17 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Installing the Driver The build step produces two library images: • lib/disputil/nto/x86/libdisputil.so • lib/disputil/nto/x86/libffb.so For the loader to locate them, the files need to be renamed and copied to the lib directory. 1. Rename libdisputil.so to libdisputil.so.1 and libffb.so to libffb.so.1. 2. Copy the files new files libdisputil.so.1 and libffb.so.1 to the directory /usr/lib. 3. Copy the file devg-S1D13506.so to the /lib/dll directory. Note To locate the file devg-S1D13506.so, watch the output of the ‘true’ command during the makefile build. 4. Modify the trap file crt.$NODE in the /etc/config/trap directory by inserting the following lines at the top of the file. io-graphics -g640x480x16 -dldevg-S1D13506.so -I0 -d0x0,0x0;#640,480,16 Epson io-graphics -g640x480x8 -dldevg-S1D13506.so -I0 -d0x0,0x0;#640,480,8 Epson Run the Driver Note For the remaining steps the S5U13506B00C evaluation board must be installed on the test platform. It is recommended that the driver be verified before starting QNX with the S1D13506 as the primary display. To verify the driver, type the following command at the root of the Project source tree (gddk_1.0 directory). util/bench/nto/x86/o/devg-bench -dldevg/S1D13506/nto/x86/dll/devg-S1D13506.so mW,H,C,F -d0x0,0x0 Where: W is the configured width of the display H is the configured height of the display C is the color depth in bpp (either 8 or 16) F is the configured frame rate This command starts the bench utility which will initialize the driver as the secondary display and exercise the drivers main functions. If the display appears satisfactory, restart QNX Photon and the restart will result in the S1D13506 display driver becoming the primary display device. QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver Issue Date: 01/04/17 S1D13506 X25B-E-005-01 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Comments • To restore the display driver to the default, comment out changes made to the trap file crt.$NODE. S1D13506 X25B-E-005-01 QNX Photon v2.0 Display Driver Issue Date: 01/04/17 S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Document No. X00A-E-003-04 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All Trademarks are the property of their respective owners Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK X00A-E-003-04 S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide This manual describes the installation of the Windows 9x/ME/NT 4.0/2000 device drivers for the S5U13xxxB00x series of Epson Evaluation Boards. The file S1D13XXX.VXD is required for using the Epson supplied Intel32 evaluation and test programs for the S1D13xxx family of LCD controllers with Windows 9x/ME. The file S1D13XXX.SYS is required for using the Epson supplied Intel32 evaluation and test programs for the S1D13xxx family of LCD controllers with Windows NT 4.0/2000. The file S1D13XXX.INF is the install script. For updated drivers, ask your Sales Representative or visit Epson Electronics America on the World Wide Web at www.eea.epson.com. Driver Requirements Video Controller : S1D13xxx Display Type : N/A BIOS : N/A DOS Program : No Dos Version : N/A Windows Program : Yes, Windows 9x/ME/NT Windows DOS Box : N/A Windows Full Screen : N/A OS/2 : N/A 4.0/2000 device driver Installation Windows NT Version 4.0 All evaluation boards require the driver to be installed as follows. 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Copy the files S1D13XXX.INF and S1D13XXX.SYS to a directory on a local hard drive. 3. Right click your mouse on the file S1D13XXX.INF and select INSTALL from the menu. 4. Windows will install the device driver and ask you to restart. S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 X00A-E-003-04 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Windows 2000 All PCI Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Windows will detect the new hardware as a new PCI Device and bring up the FOUND NEW HARDWARE dialog box. 3. Click NEXT. 4. The New Hardware Wizard will bring up the dialog box to search for a suitable driver. 5. Click NEXT. 6. When Windows does not find the driver it will allow you to specify the location of it. Type the driver location or select BROWSE to find it. 7. Click NEXT. 8. Windows 2000 will open the installation file and show the option EPSON PCI Bridge Card. Select this file and click OPEN. 9. Windows then shows the path to the file. Click OK. 10. Click NEXT. 11. Click FINISH. All ISA Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Go to the CONTROL PANEL and select ADD/REMOVE HARDWARE, click NEXT. 3. Select ADD/TROUBLESHOOT A DEVICE, and click NEXT. Windows 2000 will attempt to detect any new plug and play device and fail. 4. The CHOOSE HARDWARE DEVICE dialog box appears. Select ADD NEW HARDWARE and click NEXT. 5. Select NO I WANT TO SELECT FROM A LIST and click NEXT. 6. Select OTHER DEVICE from the list and click NEXT. 7. Click HAVE DISK. 8. Specify the location of the driver files, select the S1D13XXX INF file and click OPEN. 9. Click OK. X00A-E-003-04 S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Windows 98/ME All PCI Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Windows will detect the new hardware as a new PCI Device and bring up the ADD NEW HARDWARE dialog box. 3. Click NEXT. 4. Windows will look for the driver. When Windows does not find the driver it will allow you to specify the location of it. Type the driver location or select BROWSE to find it. 5. Click NEXT. 6. Windows will open the installation file and show the option EPSON PCI Bridge Card. 7. Click FINISH. All ISA Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Go to the CONTROL PANEL and double-click on ADD NEW HARDWARE to launch the ADD NEW HARDWARE WIZARD. Click NEXT. 3. Windows will attempt to detect any new plug and play device and fail. Click NEXT. 4. Windows will ask you to let it detect the hardware, or allow you to select from a list. Select NO, I WANT TO SELECT THE HARDWARE FROM A LIST and click NEXT. 5. From the list select OTHER DEVICES and click NEXT. 6. Click HAVE DISK and type the path to the driver files, or select browse to find the driver. 7. Click OK. 8. The driver will be identified as EPSON PCI Bridge Card. Click NEXT. 9. Click FINISH. S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 X00A-E-003-04 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Windows 95 OSR2 All PCI Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Windows will detect the card as a new PCI Device and launch the UPDATE DEVICE DRIVER wizard. If The Driver is on Floppy Disk 3. Place the disk into drive A: and click NEXT. 4. Windows will find the EPSON PCI Bridge Card. 5. Click FINISH to install the driver. 6. Windows will ask you to restart the system. If The Driver is not on Floppy Disk 3. Click NEXT, Windows will search the floppy drive and fail. 4. Windows will attempt to load the new hardware as a Standard VGA Card. 5. Click CANCEL. The Driver must be loaded from the CONTROL PANEL under ADD/NEW HARDWARE. 6. Select NO for Windows to DETECT NEW HARDWARE. 7. Click NEXT. 8. Select OTHER DEVICES from HARDWARE TYPE and Click NEXT. 9. Click HAVE DISK. 10. Specify the location of the driver and click OK. 11. Click OK. 12. EPSON PCI Bridge Card will appear in the list. 13. Click NEXT. 14. Windows will install the driver. 15. Click FINISH. 16. Windows will ask you to restart the system. 17. Windows will re-detect the card and ask you to restart the system. X00A-E-003-04 S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 All ISA Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Go to the CONTROL PANEL and select ADD NEW HARDWARE. 3. Click NEXT. 4. Select NO and click NEXT. 5. Select OTHER DEVICES and click NEXT. 6. Click Have Disk. 7. Specify the location of the driver files and click OK. 8. Click Next. 9. Click Finish. Previous Versions of Windows 95 All PCI Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Windows will detect the card. 3. Select DRIVER FROM DISK PROVIDED BY MANUFACTURER. 4. Click OK. 5. Specify a path to the location of the driver files. 6. Click OK. 7. Windows will find the S1D13XXX.INF file. 8. Click OK. 9. Click OK and Windows will install the driver. S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 X00A-E-003-04 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center All ISA Bus Evaluation Cards 1. Install the evaluation board in the computer and boot the computer. 2. Go to the CONTROL PANEL and select ADD NEW HARDWARE. 3. Click NEXT. 4. Select NO and click NEXT. 5. Select OTHER DEVICES from the HARDWARE TYPES list. 6. Click HAVE DISK. 7. Specify the location of the driver files and click OK. 8. Select the file S1D13XXX.INF and click OK. 9. Click OK. 10. The EPSON PCI Bridge Card should be selected in the list window. 11. Click NEXT. 12. Click NEXT. 13. Click Finish. X00A-E-003-04 S1D13XXX 32-Bit Windows Device Driver Installation Guide Issue Date: 01/04/17 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Document Number: X25B-G-004-06 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other Trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Features . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 3 Installation and Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.1 Configuration DIP Switches . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.2 Configuration Jumpers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 4 Technical Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1 PCI Bus Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.1 On-Board PCI Configuration Registers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.1.2 Utility Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 Non-PCI Host Interface Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2.1 CPU Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2.2 CPU Bus Connector Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 LCD Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.1 LCD Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.2 Buffered LCD Connector . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.3 16-bit Passive Color Panel Support with MediaPlug Enabled . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.4 Adjustable LCD Panel Positive Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3.5 Adjustable LCD Panel Negative Power Supply . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 CRT/TV Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.1 CRT/TV Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.2 CRT Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4.3 TV Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.5 MediaPlug Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6 Clock Synthesizer and Clock Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.6.1 Clock Programming . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 5 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 5.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 5.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 6 Parts List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24 7 Schematic Diagrams . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 8 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 8.1 EPSON LCD/CRTControllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 33 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 11 11 12 12 13 13 14 16 17 18 18 19 19 20 20 20 20 21 22 22 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: Table 3-2: Table 3-3: Table 4-1: Table 4-2: Table 4-3: Table 4-4: Table 4-5: Table 4-6: Table 4-7: Table 4-8: Table 4-9: Table 6-1: Configuration DIP Switch Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Host Bus Selection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Jumper Settings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . S1D13506 Memory Mapping onto 4M byte PCI Address Block PCI Configuration Register Read Values . . . . . . . . . . . . PCI Configuration Register Write Values . . . . . . . . . . . . CPU Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CPU/BUS Connector (H1) Pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CPU/BUS Connector (H2) Pinout . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . LCD Signal Connector (J1) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . CRT/TV Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . MediaPlug Connector (J5) Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . Parts List . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .9 10 10 11 12 12 13 14 15 17 20 21 24 List of Figures Figure 4-1: Figure 4-2: Figure 4-3: Figure 7-1: Figure 7-2: Figure 7-3: Figure 7-4: Figure 7-5: Figure 7-6: Figure 7-7: External Circuit for Color Single 16-Bit Panel with MediaPlug Enabled . . . . . . . . . 18 External Circuit for Color Dual 16-Bit Panel with MediaPlug Enabled . . . . . . . . . . 18 Symbolic Clock Synthesizer Connections . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (1 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (2 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (3 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (4 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (5 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 30 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (6 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31 S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (7 of 7) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This manual describes the setup and operation of the S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board. The S5U13506B00C is designed as an evaluation platform for the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller chip. This user manual will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Features The S5U13506B00C features the following: • S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV controller chip. • Headers for connecting to a 3.3V or 5V host bus interface. • 1Mx16 EDO DRAM. • Configuration options. • Adjustable positive LCD bias power supplies from +24V to +40V. • Adjustable negative LCD bias power supplies from -23V to -14V. • 4/8-bit 3.3V or 5V monochrome passive LCD panel support. • 4/8/16-bit 3.3V or 5V color passive LCD panel support. • 9/12/18-bit 3.3V or 5V TFT/D-TFD LCD panel support. • Embedded RAMDAC for CRT and TV support. • WINNOV VideumCam digital camera support at 320x240x256 colors at 30 frames per second. • Clock synthesizer for maximum clock flexibility. • Software initiated Power Save Mode. • Selectable clock source for BUSCLK and CLKI. S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 3 Installation and Configuration The S5U13506B00C is designed to support as many platforms as possible. The S5U13506B00C incorporates a DIP switch and several jumpers which allow both evaluation board and S1D13506 LCD controller settings to be configured for a specified evaluation platform. 3.1 Configuration DIP Switches The S1D13506 LCD controller has 16 configuration inputs (MD[15:0]) which are read on the rising edge of RESET#. Where appropriate, the S5U13506B00C hard-wires some of these configuration inputs, but in order to configure the S1D13506 for multiple host bus interfaces a ten-position DIP switch is required. The following DIP switch settings configure the S1D13506. Table 3-1: Configuration DIP Switch Settings value of this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure:(1/0) Switch Signal Closed/On=1 Open/Off=0 S1-1 MD1 S1-2 MD2 S1-3 MD3 S1-4 MD4 Little Endian Big Endian S1-5 MD5 WAIT# is active high WAIT# is active low S1-6 MD10 Reserved. This switch must be in the closed position. S1-7 MD11 See Table 3-2:, “Host Bus Selection” on page 10 S1-8 MD12 BUSCLK input divided by 2 BUSCLK input not divided MD13, MD13: FPDAT[15:8] is MediaPlug interface; external latches required for 16-bit STN panels. MD13: support 16-bit STN panels directly. S1-9 S1-10 MD14 See Table 3-2:, “Host Bus Selection” on page 10 MD14: MA11 is VMPEPWR. WAIT# is always driven. MD15 MD14: MA11 is GPIO2. WAIT# is tristated when S1D13506 is not selected. = Required configuration when used in a PCI environment with MediaPlug disabled Note MD13 and MD14 are configured using the same switch, for further information see Section 7, “Schematic Diagrams” on page 28. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The following table shows the Host Bus Interface options available. The Host Bus Interface chosen will depend on the evaluation platform to be used. Table 3-2: Host Bus Selection MD11 MD3 MD2 MD1 Host Bus Interface 0 0 0 0 SH-4/SH-3 0 0 0 1 MC68K Bus 1 0 0 1 0 MC68K Bus 2 0 0 1 1 Generic 0 1 0 0 Reserved 0 1 0 1 MIPS/ISA 0 1 1 0 PowerPC 0 1 1 1 PC Card 1 1 1 1 Philips PR31500/PR31700 / Toshiba TX3912 = Required configuration when used in a PCI environment 3.2 Configuration Jumpers The S5U13506B00C has seven jumper blocks which configure various board settings. The jumper positions for each function are shown below. Table 3-3: Jumper Settings Jumper Function Position 1-2 Position 2-3 Jumper Off JP1 S1D13506 VDD Selection 3.3V 5V n/a JP2 LCD panel signalling 5V 3.3V n/a MediaPlug interface (eight jumpers at 1-2, 3-4, 5-6, 7-8, 9-10, 11-12, 13-14 and 15-16) JP3 FPDAT[15:8] function JP4 BUSCLK Buffered 33MHz from PCI bus JP5 GPIO2 to VMPEPWR JP6 16-bit LCD panel MSBs (all jumpers disconnected) From header n/a MediaPlug interface used n/a MediaPlug interface not used CLKI From clock synthesizer From header n/a JP7 IREF for CRT/TV DAC 4.6mA for CRT 9.2mA for TV n/a JP8 FPDAT[15:8] output Always use this position Do not use this position n/a JP9 PCI bridge FPGA Disabled for non-PCI host n/a Enabled for PCI host = Default configuration S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 4 Technical Description The S5U13506B00C operates with both PCI and non-PCI evaluation platforms. It supports display types such as, passive LCD panels (4/8/16-bit), TFT/D-TFD panels (9/12/18-bit), CRT and TV (NTSC and PAL). Additionally, it supports a variety of clock options. 4.1 PCI Bus Support As a PCI device, the S5U13506B00C has the following characteristics. • 33MHz bus clock. • Target with no interrupts. • Non-cacheable memory read and write. • 3.3V or 5V PCI signalling. Note In a 3.3V PCI system, the S1D13506 must be powered at 3.3V by setting jumper JP1. In a 5V PCI system, the S1D13506 may be powered at either 3.3V or 5V. Although the S1D13506 does not support the PCI bus directly, the S5U13506B00C supports the PCI bus using a PCI Bridge Adapter FPGA. The FPGA translates PCI accesses into PC Card accesses which are then decoded by the S1D13506. A 4M byte PCI address range is allocated to the S5U13506B00C by the system BIOS. The S1D13506 uses this address range to map the internal registers and the 2M byte display buffer. The following table shows the memory mapping of the PCI address block. Table 4-1: S1D13506 Memory Mapping onto 4M byte PCI Address Block PCI Memory Offset Description S1D13506 M/R# S1D13506 AB[20:0] 00 0000h to 00 01FFh General registers (512 byte) 0 00 0000h to 00 01FFh 00 1000h to 00 1FFFh MediaPlug registers (4K byte) 0 00 1000h to 00 1FFFh 10 0000h to 1F FFFFh BitBlt data registers (1M byte) 0 10 0000h to 1F FFFFh 20 0000h to 3F FFFFh Display Buffer (2M byte) 1 00 0000h to 1F FFFFh S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.1.1 On-Board PCI Configuration Registers Read-Only Registers The PCI Bridge Adapter FPGA provides configuration registers which contain identification information required by the PCI interface. The following values are hard-wired into these registers. Table 4-2: PCI Configuration Register Read Values Name Address Register size Value Vendor ID 0h 16 bits 10F4h Device ID 2h 16 bits 1300h Status 6h 16 bits 400h Revision ID 8h 8 bits 1 Class Code 9h 24 bits FF 0000h Subsystem Vendor ID 2Ch 16 bits 10F4h Subsystem ID 2Dh 16 bits 8000h Header Type Eh 8 bits 0 n/a Fh-FFh 32 bits 0 Read/Write Registers The PCI Bridge Adapter FPGA provides two read/write registers which are used for access enabling and memory mapping as follows. Table 4-3: PCI Configuration Register Write Values Name Address Register size Valid bits Meaning Command 4h 16 bits Bit 1 only; other bits are zero. Access enabled if high Base Address 10h 32 bits Bits 31 to 22; other bits are zero. Position of 4M byte reserved window 4.1.2 Utility Software All utility software for the S5U13506B00C evaluation board is fully PCI compliant and handles the PCI configuration registers automatically. S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4.2 Non-PCI Host Interface Support The S5U13506B00C is specifically designed to support a standard PCI bus environment (using the PCI Bridge Adapter FPGA). However, the S5U13506B00C can directly support many other Host Bus Interfaces. When the FPGA is disabled (using jumper JP9), headers H1 and H2 provide the necessary IO pins to interface to the Host Bus Interfaces listed in Table 4-4:, “CPU Interface Pin Mapping”. The S1D13506 power supply must be set to 3.3V or 5V (using jumper JP1) according to the host CPU signalling voltage. 4.2.1 CPU Interface Pin Mapping The functions of the S1D13506 host interface pins are mapped to each host bus interface according to the following table. Table 4-4: CPU Interface Pin Mapping S1D1350 6 Pin Names Generic Hitachi SH-4/SH-3 MIPS/ISA Motorola MC68K Bus 1 Motorola MC68K Bus 2 AB20 A20 A20 LatchA20 A20 A20 A11 AB19 A19 A19 SA19 A19 A19 AB18 A18 A18 SA18 A18 AB17 A17 A17 SA17 AB[16:13] A[16:13] A[16:13] AB[12:1] A[12:1] A[12:1] AB0 A01 A01 SA0 LDS# DB[15:8] D[15:0] D[15:8] SD[15:0] DB[7:0] D[7:0] D[7:0] WE1# WE1# WE1# Philips PR31500 /PR31700 Toshiba TX3912 A20 ALE ALE A12 A19 /CARDREG CARDREG* A18 A13 A18 /CARDIORD CARDIORD* A17 A17 A14 A17 /CARDIOWR CARDIOWR* SA[16:13] A[16:13] A[16:13] A[15:18] A[16:13] SA[12:1] A[12:1] A[12:1] A[19:30] A[12:1] A[12:1] A[12:1] A0 A31 A01 A0 A0 D[15:8] D[31:24] D[0:7] D[15:0] D[23:16] D[23:16] SD[7:0] D[7:0] D[23:16] D[8:15] D[7:0] D[31:24] D[31:24] SBHE# UDS# DS# BI -CE2 /CARDxCSH CARDxCSH* Motorola PC Card PowerPC Connected to VDD M/R# External Decode Connected to VDD CS# External Decode Connected to VDD BUSCLK BCLK CKIO CLK BS# Connected to VDD BS# Connected to VDD CLKOUT CLK AS# TS Connected to VDD AS# RD/WR# RD1# RD/WR# Connected to VDD R/W# R/W# RD/WR -CE1 /CARDxCSL CARDxCSL* RD# RD0# RD# MEMR# Connected to VDD SIZ1 TSIZ0 -OE /RD RD* WE0# WE0# WE0# MEMW# Connected to VDD SIZ0 TSIZ1 -WE /WE WE* WAIT# WAIT# RDY# /WAIT# IOCHRDY TA -WAIT RESET# RESET# RESET# inverted RESET RESET# inverted RESET S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 CLK CLK DTACK# DSACK1# RESET# RESET# DCLKOUT DCLKOUT Connected to VDD /CARDxWAIT CARDxWAIT* RESET# PON* S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Note 1 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 A0 for these busses is not used internally by the S1D13506. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 4.2.2 CPU Bus Connector Pin Mapping The pinouts for Connector H1 are listed in the following table. Table 4-5: CPU/BUS Connector (H1) Pinout Pin No. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Function Connected to DB0 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB1 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB2 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB3 of the S1D13506 Ground Ground Connected to DB4 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB5 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB6 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB7 of the S1D13506 Ground Ground Connected to DB8 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB9 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB10 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB11 of the S1D13506 Ground Ground Connected to DB12 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB13 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB14 of the S1D13506 Connected to DB15 of the S1D13506 Connected to RESET# of the S1D13506 Ground Ground Ground +12 volt supply, required in non-PCI applications +12 volt supply, required in non-PCI applications Connected to WE0# of the S1D13506 Connected to WAIT# of the S1D13506 Connected to CS# of the S1D13506 Connected to MR# of the S1D13506 Connected to WE1# of the S1D13506 S1D13506 supply, provided by the S5U13506B00C S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The pinouts for Connector H2 are listed in the following table. Table 4-6: CPU/BUS Connector (H2) Pinout Pin No. S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Function 1 Connected to AB0 of the S1D13506 2 Connected to AB1 of the S1D13506 3 Connected to AB2 of the S1D13506 4 Connected to AB3 of the S1D13506 5 Connected to AB4 of the S1D13506 6 Connected to AB5 of the S1D13506 7 Connected to AB6 of the S1D13506 8 Connected to AB7 of the S1D13506 9 Ground 10 Ground 11 Connected to AB8 of the S1D13506 12 Connected to AB9 of the S1D13506 13 Connected to AB10 of the S1D13506 14 Connected to AB11 of the S1D13506 15 Connected to AB12 of the S1D13506 16 Connected to AB13 of the S1D13506 17 Ground 18 Ground 19 Connected to AB14 of the S1D13506 20 Connected to AB15 of the S1D13506 21 Connected to AB16 of the S1D13506 22 Connected to AB17 of the S1D13506 23 Connected to AB18 of the S1D13506 24 Connected to AB19 of the S1D13506 25 Ground 26 Ground 27 +5 volt supply, required in non-PCI applications 28 +5 volt supply, required in non-PCI applications 29 Connected to RD/WR# of the S1D13506 30 Connected to BS# of the S1D13506 31 Connected to S1D13506 BUSCLK if JP4 is in position 2-3 32 Connected to RD# of the S1D13506 33 Connected to AB20 of the S1D13506 34 Connected to S1D13506 CLKI if JP6 is in position 2-3 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 4.3 LCD Support The S1D13506 supports 4/8-bit dual and single passive monochrome panels, 4/8/16-bit dual and single passive color panels, and 9/12/18-bit active matrix color TFT/D-TFD panels. All necessary signals are provided on the 40-pin LCD connector (J1). The interface signals are alternated with grounds on the cable to reduce cross-talk and noise. When supporting an 18-bit TFT/D-TFD panel, the S1D13506 can display 64K of a possible 256K colors because only 16 of the18 bits of LCD data are available from the S1D13506. For details, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A001-xx. For S1D13506 FPDAT[15:0] pin mapping for various types of panel see Table 4-7:, “LCD Signal Connector (J1)” on page 18. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.3.1 LCD Interface Pin Mapping Table 4-7: LCD Signal Connector (J1) S1D13506 Pin Names Connector Pin No. FPDAT0 1 FPDAT1 FPDAT2 Monochrome Passive Panels Single Color Passive Panels Single Single Format 1 Format 2 Color TFT/D-TFD Panels Dual Single 8-bit 8-bit 4-bit 8-bit 8-bit 16-Bit 8-bit 16-bit 9-bit 12-bit 18-bit D0 LD0 D0 D0 D0 LD0 LD0 R2 R3 R5 3 D1 LD1 D1 D1 D1 LD1 LD1 R1 R2 R4 5 D2 LD2 D2 D2 D2 LD2 LD2 R0 R1 R3 4-bit Single Dual FPDAT3 7 D3 LD3 D3 D3 D3 LD3 LD3 G2 G3 G5 FPDAT4 9 D0 D4 UD0 D0 D4 D4 D4 UD0 UD0 G1 G2 G4 FPDAT5 11 D1 D5 UD1 D1 D5 D5 D5 UD1 UD1 G0 G1 G3 FPDAT6 13 D2 D6 UD2 D2 D6 D6 D6 UD2 UD2 B2 B3 B5 FPDAT7 15 D3 D7 UD3 D3 D7 D7 D7 UD3 UD3 B1 B2 B4 FPDAT8 17 D8 LD4 B0 B1 B3 FPDAT9 19 D9 LD5 FPDAT10 21 D10 LD6 FPDAT11 23 D11 LD7 R0 R2 R1 G0 G2 FPDAT12 25 D12 UD4 G1 FPDAT13 27 D13 UD5 G0 FPDAT14 29 D14 UD6 D15 UD7 FPDAT15 31 FPSHIFT 33 DRDY 35 and 38 B0 B2 B1 FPSHIFT MOD MOD FPSHIFT2 FPLINE 37 FPSHIFT FPFRAME 39 FPFRAME GND 2-26 (Even Pins) GND N/C 28 N/C VLCD 30 Adjustable -23 to -14V negative LCD bias LCDVCC 32 +5V or +3.3V according to JP2 +12V 34 +12V VDDH 36 Adjustable +24 to +40V positive LCD bias NC (pin 75)2 40 Panel Enable, active low (LCDPWR)2 DRDY = Driven low Note 1 For FPDATxx to LCD interface hardware connections refer to the Display Interface AC Timing section of the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. 2 The S5U13506B00C was designed using S1D13506 pin 75 (LCDPWR) to control the LCD bias power. This design is no longer supported. Applications should use one of the available GPIO pins to control the LCD bias power allowing for software control S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 of power sequencing delays. For further information on LCD power sequencing, see the S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, document number X25B-G-003xx. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.3.2 Buffered LCD Connector J1 provides the same LCD panel signals as those directly from S1D13506, but with voltage-adapting buffers which can be set to 3.3V or 5V. Pin 32 on this connector provides power for the LCD panel logic at the same voltage as the buffer power supply. 4.3.3 16-bit Passive Color Panel Support with MediaPlug Enabled When the MediaPlug option is enabled, (MD13 and MD14 set to “On”, see Table 3-1:, “Configuration DIP Switch Settings” on page 9) S1D13506 pins FPDAT[15:8] are used for the MediaPlug interface and are not available for panel connection. Instead, S1D13506 pins FPDAT[7:0] are multiplexed for 16-bit panel operation. If the MediaPlug option is selected and 16-bit panel operation is desired, demultiplexing circuitry must be built externally according to the schematic below. Refer to Table 4-7:, “LCD Signal Connector (J1)” on page 18 for connector pin mapping. Single color 16-bit passive panels can be used with the following modifications. D[7:0] To 16-bit panel FPDAT[7:0] D Q D[15:8] FROM S5U13506B00C FPSHIFT CK 74AHC374 Figure 4-1: External Circuit for Color Single 16-Bit Panel with MediaPlug Enabled Dual color 16-bit passive panels can be used with the following modifications. UD [3:0] LD [3:0] FROM S5U13506B00C FPDAT[7:4] FPDAT[3:0] FPSHIFT D Q UD [7:4] LD [7:4] To 16-bit panel CK 74AHC374 Figure 4-2: External Circuit for Color Dual 16-Bit Panel with MediaPlug Enabled S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 21 4.3.4 Adjustable LCD Panel Positive Power Supply For LCD panels which require a positive bias voltage between +24V and +40V (Iout=45mA), a power supply has been provided as an integral part of the S5U13506B00C design. The voltage on VDDH can be adjusted using R15 to provide an output voltage from +24V to +40V and can be enabled and disabled by LCDPWR (S1D13506 pin 75). The S5U13506B00C was designed using LCDPWR (pin 75) to control the LCD bias power. This design is no longer supported. Applications should use one of the available GPIO pins to control the LCD bias power allowing for software control of power sequencing delays. For further information on LCD power sequencing, see the S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, document number X25B-G-003-xx. Note Before connecting the panel, set the potentiometer according to the panel’s specific voltage requirements. 4.3.5 Adjustable LCD Panel Negative Power Supply For LCD panels which require a negative bias voltage between -23V and -14V (Iout=25mA), a power supply has been provided as an integral part of the S5U13506B00C design. The voltage on VLCD can be adjusted using R21 to provide an output voltage from -23V to -14V, and can be enabled and disabled by LCDPWR (S1D13506 pin 75). The S5U13506B00C was designed using LCDPWR (pin 75) to control the LCD bias power. This design is no longer supported. Applications should use one of the available GPIO pins to control the LCD bias power allowing for software control of power sequencing delays. For further information on LCD power sequencing, see the S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, document number X25B-G-003-xx. Note Before connecting the panel, set the potentiometer according to the panel’s specific voltage requirements. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 22 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.4 CRT/TV Support 4.4.1 CRT/TV Interface Pin Mapping CRT/TV signals are supplied on a standard CRT connector (J3), Composite Video connector (J2), and S-Video connector (J4): Table 4-8: CRT/TV Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name CRT Composite Video S-Video HRTC Horizontal retrace N/A N/A VRTC Vertical retrace N/A N/A RED Red N/A Luminance GREEN Green Composite N/A BLUE Blue N/A Chrominance 4.4.2 CRT Support CRT support is provided on connector J3 via the S1D13506 embedded RAMDAC. An external current reference is implemented to provide the necessary RAMDAC output gain. The reference current (IREF) should be set to 4.6mA using jumper JP7. Note When IREF is set to 4.6mA, the DAC Output Select bit (REG[05Bh] bit 3) must be set to 1. CRT output is not available when TV output is enabled. 4.4.3 TV Support The S1D13506 supports PAL or NTSC TV output. Composite Video is available on connector J2 and S-Video is available on connector J4. An external current reference is implemented to provide the necessary RAMDAC output gain. The reference current should be set to 9.2mA using jumper JP7. TV output is not available when CRT output is enabled. PAL and NTSC modes cannot be enabled at the same time. S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 23 4.5 MediaPlug Interface The S5U13506B00C supports the Winnov Videum®Cam digital camera through the S1D13506 built-in MediaPlug interface. The Winnov Videum®Cam digital camera inputs are TTL compatible and can be driven by the S1D13506 powered at 3.3V or 5V. Therefore, the power supply to the camera is 5V while the S1D13506 can powered at 3.3V or 5V. However, if the S1D13506 is powered at 5V, then 150nH inductors must be added at locations L8, L10, L11, L12 and L13. Jumper JP5 selects whether MA11/GPIO2 is used to enable the video camera power. For more information, see the note from Section 3.2, “Configuration Jumpers” on page 10. Eight jumpers identified globally as JP3 must be set for MediaPlug operation. The table below describes the S1D13506 pin mapping for the MediaPlug interface. Table 4-9: MediaPlug Connector (J5) Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names Connector Pin No. IO Type FPDAT8 1 O VMPLCTL FPDAT9 2 I VMPRCTL FPDAT10 3 IO VMPD0 FPDAT11 4 IO VMPD1 FPDAT12 6 IO VMPD2 FPDAT13 5 IO VMPD3 FPDAT14 8 O VMPCLK FPDAT15 7 O VMPCLKN MA11/GPIO2 9 O VMPEPWR GND Shield - Ground MediaPlug I/F Note When MediaPlug is enabled, 16-bit passive panels support requires an external circuit. See Section 4.3.3, “16-bit Passive Color Panel Support with MediaPlug Enabled” on page 20. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 24 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.6 Clock Synthesizer and Clock Options For maximum flexibility, the S5U13506B00C implements a Cypress ICD2061A Clock Generator. MCLKOUT from the clock chip is connected to CLKI of the S1D13506 and VCLKOUT from the clock chip is connected to CLKI2 of the S1D13506. A 14.31818MHz crystal (Y1) is connected to XTALIN of the clock chip and a 17.734475MHz oscillator (U14) is connected to the FEATCLK input of the clock chip. The diagram below shows a simplified representation of the clock synthesizer connections. ICD2061A Synthesizer reference 14.31818 MHz Feature clock for PAL TV 17.734475 MHz XTALIN MCLKOUT CLKI FEATCLK VCLKOUT CLKI2 Figure 4-3: Symbolic Clock Synthesizer Connections Upon power-up, CLKI (MCLKOUT) is 40MHz and CLKI2 (VCLKOUT) is configured to 25.175MHz. 4.6.1 Clock Programming The S1D13506 utilities automatically program the clock generator. If manual programming of the clock generator is required, refer to the source code for the S1D13506 utilities available on the internet at www.eea.epson.com. For further information on programming the clock generator, refer to the Cypress ICD2061A specification. Note When CLKI and CLKI2 are programmed to multiples of each other (e.g. CLKI = 20MHz, CLKI2 = 40MHz), the clock output signals from the Cypress clock generator may jitter. Refer to the Cypress ICD2061A specification for details. To avoid this problem, set CLKI and CLKI2 to different frequencies and configure both LCD PCLK and CRT/TV PCLK to use the same clock input (CLKI or CLKI2).Then use the S1D13506 internal clock divides (LCD PCLK Divide Select REG[014h] bits 5-4, CRT/TV PCLK Divide Select REG[018h] bits 5-4) to obtain the lower frequencies. S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 25 5 References 5.1 Documents • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. • Cypress Semiconductor Corporation, ICD2061A Data Sheet. 5.2 Document Sources • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. • Cypress Semiconductor Corporation Website: http://www.cypress.com. S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 26 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 Parts List Table 6-1: Parts List Item Quantity Reference Part Description 1 22 C1-C6,C10,C13-C16,C32-C34, C46-C49,C52,C54,C55,C57 0.1uF 1206 capacitor +/-20% 50V 2 4 C7,C8,C9,C38 0.01uF 1206 capacitor +/-20% 50V 3 6 C11,C12,C40,C45,C53,C56 10uF/16V Tantalum size C, 10uF 16V +/-10% 4 2 C17,C21 47uF/10V Tantalum size C, 47uF 10V +/-10% 5 3 C18,C19,C20 4.7uF/50V Tantalum size D, 4.7uF 50V +/-10% 6 1 C22 56uF/35V Low-ESR radial electrolytic capacitor 7 9 C23,C24,C25,C26,C27,C28,C29, C30,C31 0.22uF 1206 capacitor +/-20% 50V 8 6 C35,C36,C37,C39,C41,C42 33pF 1206 capacitor +/-20% 50V 9 2 C43,C44 220pF 1206 capacitor +/-20% 50V 10 2 C50,C51 not populated 1206 capacitor, not populated 11 4 D1,D2,D3,D5 BAV99L Diode BAV99L 12 1 D4 BAT54 Diode BAT54 13 2 H1,H2 Header 17X2 0.1" x 0.1" 2 rows by 17 header 14 2 JP5,JP9 Header 2 0.1" 1 row by 2 header 15 6 JP1,JP2,JP4,JP6,JP7,JP8 Header 3 0.1" 1 row by 3 header 16 1 JP3 Header 8X2 Not populated 17 1 J1 Header 20x2 2x20, .025" sq. shrouded connector, ctr-key, t/h 18 1 J2 C-Video Keystone 901 or equivalent 19 1 J3 CRT AMP 749264 or equivalent 20 1 J4 S-Video Assman A-HDF 15 A KG/T or equivalent 21 1 J5 MediaPlug Connector CUI Stack P/N:MD-90S or Digi-Key P/N:CP-2490-ND 22 8 L1,L2,L3,L5,L6,L7,L14,L15 Ferrite Philips BDS3/3/8.9-4S2 23 1 L4 1uH RCD MCI-1812 1uH MT or MSI-1812 1uH MT 24 1 L9 150nH Panasonic ELJNCR15JF or Delevan 1008-151K 25 3 Q1,Q5,Q6 MMBT2222A Transistor MMBT2222A 26 1 Q2 MMBT3906 Transistor MMBT3906 27 1 Q3 MMBT3904 Transistor MMBT3904 28 1 Q4 NDS9400A National Semi NDS9400A 29 16 R1-R11,R17,R26,R29,R61,R62 15K 1206 resistor +/-5% 30 1 R13 470K 1206 resistor +/-5% 31 6 R14,R16,R18,R19,R47,R50 10K 1206 resistor +/-5% 32 1 R15 200K potentiometer Spectrol 63S204T607 33 4 R20,R21,R23,R56 100K 1206 resistor +/-5% S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 27 Table 6-1: Parts List (Continued) Item Quantity Reference Part Description 34 1 R22 100K potentiometer Spectrol 63S104T607 35 3 R24,R25,R30 1K 1206 resistor +/-5% 36 3 R31,R32,R33 150 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 37 1 R34 6.04K 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 38 6 R35,R38,R41,R44,R48,R53 68 Ohms 1206 resistor +/-5% 39 1 R36 1.5K 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 40 3 R37,R43,R46 316 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 41 3 R39,R45,R49 357 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 42 2 R40,R42 137 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 43 2 R51,R54 22 Ohms 1206 resistor +/-5% 44 2 R52,R55 33 Ohms 1206 resistor +/-5% 45 1 R57 1.5K 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 46 1 R58 1K 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 47 1 R59 140 Ohms 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 48 1 R60 69.8 Ohms 1% 1206 resistor +/-1% 49 1 R63 4.7K 1206 resistor +/-5% 50 1 S1 SW DIP-10 10-position DIP switch 51 1 S2 SW DIP-4 Not populated 52 1 U1 S1D13506F00A Epson S1D13506F00A 53 1 U2 DRAM 1Mx16-SOJ Alliance AS4LC1M16E5-50JC or ISSI IS41LV16100K-50 or OKI MSM51V18165D50-JS 54 1 U3 RD-0412 Xentek RD-0412 55 1 U4 74AHC04 TI 74AHC04 or National 74VHC04 SO-14 package 56 1 U5 EPN001 Xentek EPN001 57 1 U6 EPF6016TC144-2 Altera EPF6016TC144-2 58 1 U7 EPC1441PC8 Altera EPC1441PC8 59 3 U8,U9,U10 74AHC244 TI 74AHC244 or National 74VHC244 SO-20 package 60 1 U11 LT1117CST-5 Linear Technology LT1117CST-5 or SGS-Thomson LD1117S50C 61 1 U12 ICD2061A Cypress ICD2061A 62 1 U13 LT1117CST-3.3 Linear Technology LT1117CST-3.3 or SGS-Thomson LD1117S33C 63 1 U15 LT1117CM-3.3 Linear Technology LT1117CM-3.3 or SGS-Thomson LD1117DT33C 64 1 U14 17.734475MHz 14-DIP oscillator DIP-14 oscillator 65 1 U16 74AHC374 TI 74AHC374 or National 74VHC374, SO-20 package 66 1 Y1 14.31818MHz crystal 14.31818MHz crystal HC-49 Fox FoxS/143-20 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 C1 0.1u ChipVdd WAIT# CLKI CLKI2 P2,4 P7 P7 +5V A C2 0.1u C3 0.1u ChipVdd ChipVdd RESET# P2,4 +3.3V CS# M/R# RD/WR# WE1# WE0# RD# BS# P2,4 P2,4 P2,4 P2,4 P2,4 P2,4 P2,4 DB[15:0] AB[20:0] BUSCLK P2,4 P2,4 P7 ChipVdd HEADER 3 JP1 A C4 0.1u ChipVdd DB[15:0] AB[20:0] C5 0.1u ChipVdd C6 0.1u ChipVdd B B ChipVdd ChipVdd ChipVdd ChipVdd ChipVdd ChipVdd 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 DB0 DB1 DB2 DB3 DB4 DB5 DB6 DB7 DB8 DB9 DB10 DB11 DB12 DB13 DB14 DB15 14 32 50 68 78 87 96 110 12 33 55 72 97 109 70 71 69 15 11 4 5 10 9 8 7 6 13 3 2 1 128 127 126 125 124 123 122 121 120 119 118 117 116 115 114 113 112 111 AB0 AB1 AB2 AB3 AB4 AB5 AB6 AB7 AB8 AB9 AB10 AB11 AB12 AB13 AB14 AB15 AB16 AB17 AB18 AB19 AB20 S1D13506F00A VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VSS VDD VDD VDD VDD VDD VDD TESTEN CLKI2 CLKI WAIT# RESET# CS# M/R# RD/WR# WE1# WE0# RD# BS# BUSCLK DB0 DB1 DB2 DB3 DB4 DB5 DB6 DB7 DB8 DB9 DB10 DB11 DB12 DB13 DB14 DB15 AB0 AB1 AB2 AB3 AB4 AB5 AB6 AB7 AB8 AB9 AB10 AB11 AB12 AB13 AB14 AB15 AB16 AB17 AB18 AB19 AB20 U1 C DACVSS DACVSS DACVDD DACVDD DACVDD IREF HRTC VRTC RED GREEN BLUE NC FPFRAME FPLINE FPSHIFT DRDY FPDAT0 FPDAT1 FPDAT2 FPDAT3 FPDAT4 FPDAT5 FPDAT6 FPDAT7 FPDAT8 FPDAT9 FPDAT10 FPDAT11 FPDAT12 FPDAT13 FPDAT14 FPDAT15 RAS# LCAS# UCAS# WE# MD0 MD1 MD2 MD3 MD4 MD5 MD6 MD7 MD8 MD9 MD10 MD11 MD12 MD13 MD14 MD15 MA0 MA1 MA2 MA3 MA4 MA5 MA6 MA7 MA8 MA9/GPIO3 MA10/GPIO1 MA11/GPIO2 C 98 106 99 102 104 101 107 108 100 103 105 75 73 74 77 76 79 80 81 82 83 84 85 86 88 89 90 91 92 93 94 95 AVDD AVDD AVDD FPDAT0 FPDAT1 FPDAT2 FPDAT3 FPDAT4 FPDAT5 FPDAT6 FPDAT7 FPDAT8 FPDAT9 FPDAT10 FPDAT11 FPDAT12 FPDAT13 FPDAT14 FPDAT15 MD0 MD1 MD2 MD3 MD4 MD5 MD6 MD7 MD8 MD9 MD10 MD11 MD12 MD13 MD14 MD15 35 37 39 41 43 45 47 49 48 46 44 42 40 38 36 34 54 51 52 53 MA0 MA1 MA2 MA3 MA4 MA5 MA6 MA7 MA8 MA9 61 63 65 67 66 64 62 60 58 56 59 57 AVDD C7 0.01u AVDD D C8 0.01u AVDD D C9 0.01u FPDAT[15:0] MD[15:0] MA[9:0] IREF HRTC VRTC RED GREEN BLUE LCDPWR FPFRAME FPLINE FPSHIFT DRDY FPDAT[15:0] RAS# LCAS# UCAS# WE# MD[15:0] GPIO1 GPIO2 MA[9:0] Date: Size B Title P7 P5 P5 P5 P5 P5 P3,5 P5 P5 P5 P5 P5,6 P3 P3 P3 P3 P3 P7 P7 P3 L1 Ferrite L2 Ferrite Thursday, April 01, 1999 Document Number {Doc} S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board +3.3V Sheet E E 1 C10 0.1u of AVDD 7 Rev 1 1 2 3 4 Page 28 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7 Schematic Diagrams Figure 7-1: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (1 of 7) S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 1 2 3 4 TRDY# STOP# PAR P4 P4 P4 C/BE0# FRAME# P4 P4 IDSEL RST# AD[31:0] P4 P4 P4 A A AD2 AD0 AD6 AD4 AD9 AD13 AD11 AD15 AD18 AD16 AD22 AD20 AD24 AD28 AD26 AD30 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 PCI-A C/BE0# +3.3V AD6 AD4 GND AD2 AD0 +VI/O REQ64# +5V +5V RESERVED RST# +VI/O GNT# GND RESERVED AD30 +3.3V AD28 AD26 GND AD24 IDSEL +3.3V AD22 AD20 GND AD18 AD16 +3.3V FRAME# GND TRDY# GND STOP# +3.3V SDONE SBO# GND PAR AD15 +3.3V AD13 AD11 GND AD9 TRST# +12V TMS TDI +5V INTA# INTC# +5V RESERVED +VI/O RESERVED PCIA1 + C11 10uF/16V +5V +5V +12V AD[31:0] B B PCI-B AD8 AD7 +3.3V AD5 AD3 GND AD1 +VI/O ACK64# +5V +5V RESERVED GND CLK GND REQ# +VI/O AD31 AD29 GND AD27 AD25 +3.3V C/BE3# AD23 GND AD21 AD19 +3.3V AD17 C/BE2# GND IRDY# +3.3V DEVSEL# GND LOCK# PERR# +3.3V SERR# 3.3V C/BE1# AD14 GND AD12 AD10 GND -12V TCK GND TDO +5V +5V INTB# INTD# PRSNT#1 RESERVED PRSNT#2 PCIB1 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 + C12 10uF/16V +5V +5V AD1 AD5 AD3 AD8 AD7 AD12 AD10 AD14 AD17 AD21 AD19 AD23 AD27 AD25 AD31 AD29 C P1,4 P4 P4 SERR# C/BE1# P4 P4 P4 P4 P4 P4 P1,4 PERR# DEVSEL# IRDY# C/BE2# C/BE3# CLK C AB[20:0] DB[15:0] P1,4 P7 P1,4 P1,4 P1,4 P1,4 RD/WR# EXTBCLK WE0# CS# WE1# RESET# D AB[20:0] AB20 AB14 AB16 AB18 AB8 AB10 AB12 AB0 AB2 AB4 AB6 DB12 DB14 DB8 DB10 DB4 DB6 DB0 DB2 DB[15:0] D +5V +12V Date: Size B Title 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 +5V +12V Thursday, April 01, 1999 Document Number {Doc} WAIT# M/R# P1,4 P1,4 Sheet E BS# RD# EXTCLKI AB15 AB17 AB19 AB9 AB11 AB13 AB1 AB3 AB5 AB7 2 P1,4 P1,4 P7 of (Provided by the S5U13506B00C) ChipVdd DB13 DB15 DB9 DB11 DB5 DB7 DB1 DB3 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board HEADER 17X2 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 H2 HEADER 17X2 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 H1 E 7 Rev 1 1 2 3 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 29 Figure 7-2: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (2 of 7) S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 1 2 3 P1,5 A LCDPWR ChipVdd 1 Ferrite L3 WE# P1 +5V RAS# UCAS# LCAS# P1 P1 P1 2 74AHC04 U4A C16 0.1u U5 EPN001 1 47uF/10V R22 100K Pot. + C21 R16 10K R14 10K B 2 3 4 5 7 8 9 10 33 34 35 36 38 39 40 41 U3 RD-0412 VCC 1 VCC 6 VCC 21 VSS 22 VSS 37 VSS 42 DQ0 DQ1 DQ2 DQ3 DQ4 DQ5 DQ6 DQ7 DQ8 DQ9 DQ10 DQ11 DQ12 DQ13 DQ14 DQ15 47uF/10V + C17 3 Q1 2MMBT2222A +5V DRAM 1Mx16-SOJ 11 NC 12 NC 32 NC 29 /OE 14 /RAS 30 /UCAS 31 /LCAS 13 /W A0 A1 A2 A3 A4 A5 A6 A7 A8R/A8 A9R/A9 A10/NC A11/NC U2 VOUT_ADJ 6 4 17 18 19 20 23 24 25 26 27 28 16 15 GND GND 5 4 MA0 MA1 MA2 MA3 MA4 MA5 MA6 MA7 MA8 MA9 NC NC NC NC 9 8 7 3 MA[9:0] DC_OUT 2 P1 MD0 MD1 MD2 MD3 MD4 MD5 MD6 MD7 MD8 MD9 MD10 MD11 MD12 MD13 MD14 MD15 C13 0.1u 1 2 C22 56uF/35V Low ESR 100K R20 10K R18 Q3 MMBT3904 3 R19 10K Q2 3 MMBT3906 2 +5V DC_IN 2 1 MA[9:0] REMOTE 3 DC_OUT MD[15:0] GND GND GND GND GND GND GND MD[15:0] NC 4 5 6 7 8 10 11 1 B VOUT_ADJ 9 P1 11 DC_IN 10 DC_IN DC_OUT 12 1 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 + A C +5V R17 15K MD1 MD2 MD3 MD4 MD5 MD10 MD11 MD12 MD13 MD15 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 VLCD 4.7uF/50V 1uH L4 SW DIP-10 S1 + C19 MD6 MD14 4.7uF/50V + C18 ChipVdd C15 0.1u R21 100K R15 200K Pot. R13 470K C14 0.1u C D P5 R11 15K R12 n/p R2 15K Date: Size B Title ChipVdd R3 15K 4.7uF/50V + C20 R1 15K D MD14 MD13 R5 15K R6 15K R63 4.7K R7 15K R8 15K Monday, June 14, 1999 Document Number {Doc} E Sheet S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board Rework R4 15K E 3 VDDH R9 15K of R10 15K 7 P5 Rev 1 ChipVdd 1 2 3 4 Page 30 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 7-3: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (3 of 7) S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 1 2 3 AD[31:0] C/BE3# IDSEL C/BE2# FRAME# IRDY# TRDY# DEVSEL# STOP# PERR# SERR# PAR C/BE1# C/BE0# P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 P2 RST# P2 P2 CLK P2 A AD28 AD27 AD26 AD31 AD30 AD29 AB20 AB17 AB18 AB19 AD[31:0] 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 IO1 IO2 IO3 nCE GND Vccint Vccio IO8 IO9 IO10 IO11 IO12 IO13 IO14 IO15 IO16 I17 GND Vccio I20 IO21 IO22 IO23 IO24 IO25 IO26 IO27 IO28 IO29 GND Vccint Vccio MSEL IO34 IO35 IO36 AD25 AD24 AB14 AB15 AB16 AB13 AB12 AB11 AB10 AB9 AB8 AB7 AB6 AB5 AB4 AB3 AB2 AB1 AB0 AD23 AD22 AD21 AD20 AD19 AD18 AD17 AD16 U6 DATA B nSTATUS +5V ChipVdd DCLK B DB11 DB10 DB13 DB12 DB15 DB14 144 143 142 141 140 139 138 137 136 135 134 133 132 131 130 129 128 127 126 125 124 123 122 121 120 119 118 117 116 115 114 113 112 111 110 109 DB[15:0] AB[20:0] C IO108 IO107 IO106 CONF_DONE Vccio Vccint GND IO101 IO100 IO99 IO98 IO97 IO96 IO95 IO94 IO93 I92 Vccio GND I89 IO88 IO87 IO86 IO85 IO84 IO83 IO82 IO81 IO80 IO79 Vccio Vccint GND IO75 IO74 IO73 C nCONFIG 108 DB9 107 DB8 106 DB7 105 CONF_DONE 104 103 102 101 DB6 100 DB5 99 DB4 98 DB3 97 96 DB2 95 DB1 94 93 DB0 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 AD0 83 AD1 82 AD2 81 AD3 80 AD4 79 78 77 76 AD5 75 AD6 74 AD7 73 EPF6016TC144-2 IO144 IO143 IO142 IO141 IO140 IO139 IO138 IO137 IO136 IO135 IO134 IO133 IO132 IO131 IO130 IO129 DCLK Vccio GND DATA IO124 IO123 IO122 IO121 IO120 IO119 IO118 IO117 IO116 IO115 IO114 IO113 IO112 IO111 IO110 IO109 IO37 IO38 IO39 IO40 IO41 IO42 IO43 IO44 IO45 IO46 IO47 IO48 IO49 IO50 IO51 IO52 nCONFIG GND Vccio nSTATUS IO57 IO58 IO59 IO60 IO61 IO62 IO63 IO64 IO65 IO66 IO67 IO68 IO69 IO70 IO71 IO72 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56 57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64 65 66 67 68 69 70 71 72 AD15 AD14 AD13 AD12 AD11 AD10 AD9 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 AD8 4 A R30 1K HEADER 2 1 2 JP9 R27 15K Place jumper to disable FPGA +5V R26 15K R23 100K R28 15K P1,2 P1,2 P7 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 P1,2 D 1 2 3 4 +5V R25 1K 1 2 3 4 U7 +5V C24 0.22u +5V +5V +5V +5V Date: Size B Title C28 0.22u C25 0.22u C30 0.22u ChipVdd C26 0.22u 8 7 6 5 Thursday, April 01, 1999 Document Number {Doc} E Sheet E C31 0.22u ChipVdd C27 0.22u +5V +5V +5V S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board C29 0.22u ChipVdd +5V +5V EPC1441PC8 VCC DATA DCLK VCC OE nCASC nCS GND FPGA configuration EPROM R24 1K ChipVdd 8 7 6 5 +5V SW DIP-4 S2 DATA DCLK nSTATUS CONF_DONE R29 15K DB[15:0] AB[20:0] BCLK RD# BS# RD/WR# WE1# M/R# CS# WAIT# WE0# RESET# D +5V 4 C23 0.22u of 7 Rev 1 1 2 3 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 31 Figure 7-4: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (4 of 7) S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 P1 P1 P1 P1 P1,3 FPSHIFT DRDY FPLINE FPFRAME LCDPWR HEADER 3 JP8 P1,6 FPDAT[15:0] A MUXED DIRECT VRTC P1 P1 HRTC GREEN BLUE P1 P1 RED R61 15K P1 ChipVdd FPDAT8 FPDAT9 FPDAT10 FPDAT11 FPDAT12 FPDAT13 FPDAT14 FPDAT15 FPDAT0 FPDAT1 FPDAT2 FPDAT3 FPDAT4 FPDAT5 FPDAT6 FPDAT7 1 11 3 4 7 8 13 14 17 18 1 19 2 4 6 8 11 13 15 17 VCC GND Q0 Q1 Q2 Q3 Q4 Q5 Q6 Q7 20 10 2 5 6 9 12 15 16 19 VCC GND 1Y1 1Y2 1Y3 1Y4 2Y1 2Y2 2Y3 2Y4 R31 150 1% FPSHIFT DRDY FPLINE FPFRAME LCDPWR 74AHC374 OC CLK D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 U16 74AHC244 1G 2G 1A1 1A2 1A3 1A4 2A1 2A2 2A3 2A4 U8 B R32 150 1% C57 0.1u LCDVCC R33 150 1% 1 19 Ferrite Ferrite L7 Ferrite L6 L5 VCC GND 1Y1 1Y2 1Y3 1Y4 2Y1 2Y2 2Y3 2Y4 FPDAT8 FPDAT9 FPDAT10 FPDAT11 FPDAT12 FPDAT13 FPDAT14 FPDAT15 74AHC244 1G 2G 1A1 1A2 1A3 1A4 2A1 2A2 2A3 2A4 U10 R62 15K 2 4 6 8 11 13 15 17 ChipVdd DIRECT C32 0.1u LCDVCC BFPDAT0 BFPDAT1 BFPDAT2 BFPDAT3 BFPDAT4 BFPDAT5 BFPDAT6 BFPDAT7 BFPDAT8 BFPDAT9 BFPDAT10 BFPDAT11 BFPDAT12 BFPDAT13 BFPDAT14 BFPDAT15 20 10 18 16 14 12 9 7 5 3 20 10 18 16 14 12 9 7 5 3 1 19 2 4 6 8 11 13 15 17 VCC GND 1Y1 1Y2 1Y3 1Y4 2Y1 2Y2 2Y3 2Y4 C AVDD D1 BAV99L 3 20 10 18 16 14 12 9 7 5 3 C C34 0.1u D2 BAV99L 3 C33 0.1u LCDVCC BFPDAT8 BFPDAT9 BFPDAT10 BFPDAT11 BFPDAT12 BFPDAT13 BFPDAT14 BFPDAT15 AVDD LCDVCC BFPSHIFT BDRDY BFPLINE BFPFRAME BLCDPWR 74AHC244 1G 2G 1A1 1A2 1A3 1A4 2A1 2A2 2A3 2A4 U9 2 1 B 2 1 A AVDD 2 1 D3 BAV99L 3 BFPDAT0 BFPDAT1 BFPDAT2 BFPDAT3 BFPDAT4 BFPDAT5 BFPDAT6 BFPDAT7 BFPDAT8 BFPDAT9 BFPDAT10 BFPDAT11 BFPDAT12 BFPDAT13 BFPDAT14 BFPDAT15 BFPSHIFT BDRDY BFPLINE BFPFRAME 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 24 26 28 30 32 34 36 38 40 D Header 20x2 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25 27 29 31 33 35 37 39 J1 D 6 1 11 7 2 12 8 3 13 9 4 14 10 5 15 CRT J3 Date: Size B Title J4 G S-VIDEO G C Y J2 1 3 C-VIDEO LCDVCC Thursday, April 01, 1999 Document Number {Doc} S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board 2 4 P3 +12V VDDH 1 P3 VLCD 2 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 FPDAT[15:0] Sheet E +3.3V +5V E 5 of 7 HEADER 3 1 2 3 JP2 Rev 1 1 2 3 4 Page 32 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 7-5: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (5 of 7) S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 1 2 3 4 P1,5 FPDAT[15:0] A FPDAT[15:0] A FPDAT9 FPDAT8 FPDAT10 FPDAT11 FPDAT13 FPDAT12 FPDAT15 FPDAT14 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 HEADER 8X2 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 JP3 B ChipVdd B VMPCLK R42 137 1% R40 137 1% C41 33pF ChipVdd VMPCLKN VMPD2 R45 357 1% VMPD3 R43 316 1% VMPD1 VMPD0 VMPLCTL VMPRCTL 2 3 ChipVdd 2 1 3 22 R54 22 R51 BAV99L D5 BAT54 D4 ChipVdd R49 357 1% C43 220pF C C44 220pF 33 R55 33 R52 C42 33pF R53 68 n/p 68 L13 R48 n/p 68 L12 R44 n/p L11 68 1 0.01u C37 33pF C35 33pF 68 R35 n/p L8 R41 C39 33pF R39 357 1% R37 316 1% R36 1.5K 1% R34 6.04K 1% C38 R46 316 1% ChipVdd ChipVdd C R38 n/p L10 68 D D 150nH L9 Date: Size B Title P7 3 ChipVdd 4 4 Wednesday, June 16, 1999 Document Number {Doc} Sheet E 10K R50 + C40 10uF/16V 74AHC04 U4B Q4 NDS9400A 8 7 6 5 3 2 1 MPLCTL MPRCTL MPD0 MPD1 MPD3 MPD2 MPCLKN MPCLK MPPWR S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board VMPEPWR +5V C36 33pF E 6 1 R47 10K 7 Rev 1 3 Q5 2MMBT2222A of +5V MediaPlug Conn. 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 J5 1 2 3 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 33 Figure 7-6: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (6 of 7) S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 1 2 3 4 P1 P1 GPIO2 GPIO1 +5V + C45 10uF/16V A 13 ChipVdd 11 ChipVdd C54 0.1u C50 n/p C46 0.1u JP5 74AHC04 U4F 74AHC04 U4E 7 14 C47 0.1u OUT NC 12 10 8 1 2 11 15 6 7 16 4 12 14 1 2 VMPEPWR B ICD2061A FEATCLK INTCLK XTALIN XTALOUT PWRDWN# OE INIT0 INIT1 S0/CLK S1/DATA U12 P6 +5V C48 0.1u OSCVDD L15 Ferrite 8 P4 2 BCLK C ChipVdd 5 JP4 C55 0.1u ERROUT# VCLKOUT MCLKOUT 3 C49 0.1u VIN U15 LT1117CM-3.3 10 9 VOUT C + C56 10uF/16V +5V ChipVdd 8 6 C52 0.1u 74AHC04 U4D +3.3V 9 74AHC04 U4C HEADER 3 VOUT 3 ADJ OSCVDD VIN C51 n/p 17.734475MHz GND VCC U14 3 R56 100K HEADER 2 14.31818MHz Y1 Ferrite 1 2 L14 B 13 VDD GND 5 AVDD 1 U11 LT1117CST-5 3 VIN U13 LT1117CST-3.3 BUSCLK EXTBCLK ADJ 1 +12V A VOUT P1 P2 2 D D + C53 10uF/16V HEADER 3 JP6 Date: Size B Title 1 2 3 1 2 3 ADJ P1 CLKI2 1 Thursday, April 01, 1999 Document Number {Doc} S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board R58 1K 1% HEADER 3 JP7 IREF 3 Q6 2 MMBT2222A P1 CLKI R57 1.5K 1% P2 EXTCLKI E P1 Sheet E R59 140 1% 1 2 3 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 1 7 of R60 69.8 1% 7 Rev 1 1 2 3 4 Page 34 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 7-7: S5U13506B00C Schematic Diagram (7 of 7) S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 35 8 Technical Support 8.1 EPSON LCD/CRTControllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 Page 36 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-004-06 S5U13506B00C Evaluation Board User Manual Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Document Number: X25B-G-005-03 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus 2.1 The PC Card System Bus . . 2.1.1 PC Card Overview . . 2.1.2 Memory Access Cycles 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 3.1 PC Card Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 3.2 PC Card Host Bus Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 4 PC Card to S1D13506 Interface . . 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration 4.3 Performance . . . . . . . . . 4.4 Register/Memory Mapping . . . 5 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 6 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 6.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 6.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 7 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 7.1 Epson LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 7.2 PC Card Standard . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 . . . .8 . . . . .8 . . . . .8 . . . . . . . . . . . 13 . 13 . 15 . 15 . 16 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: PC Card Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Table 4-2: Register/Memory Mapping for Typical Implementation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 List of Figures Figure 2-1: PC Card Read Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Figure 2-2: PC Card Write Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of PC Card to S1D13506 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment required to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the PC Card (PCMCIA) bus. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus 2.1 The PC Card System Bus PC Card technology has gained wide acceptance in the mobile computing field as well as in other markets due to its portability and ruggedness. This section is an overview of the operation of the 16-bit PC Card interface conforming to the PCMCIA 2.0/JEIDA 4.1 Standard (or later). 2.1.1 PC Card Overview The 16-bit PC Card provides a 26-bit address bus and additional control lines which allow access to three 64M byte address ranges. These ranges are used for common memory space, IO space, and attribute memory space. Common memory may be accessed by a host system for memory read and write operations. Attribute memory is used for defining card specific information such as configuration registers, card capabilities, and card use. IO space maintains software and hardware compatibility with hosts such as the Intel x86 architecture, which address peripherals independently from memory space. Bit notation follows the convention used by most micro-processors, the high bit being the most significant. Therefore, signals A25 and D15 are the most significant bits for the address and data busses respectively. Support is provided for on-chip DMA controllers. To find further information on these topics, refer to Section 6, “References” on page 18. PC Card bus signals are asynchronous to the host CPU bus signals. Bus cycles are started with the assertion of the CE1# and/or the CE2# card enable signals. The cycle ends once these signals are de-asserted. Bus cycles can be lengthened using the WAIT# signal. Note The PCMCIA 2.0/JEIDA 4.1 (and later) PC Card Standard support the two signals WAIT# and RESET which are not supported in earlier versions of the standard. The WAIT# signal allows for asynchronous data transfers for memory, attribute, and IO access cycles. The RESET signal allows resetting of the card configuration by the reset line of the host CPU. 2.1.2 Memory Access Cycles A data transfer is initiated when a memory address is placed on the PC Card bus and one, or both, of the card enable signals (CE1# and CE2#) are driven low. REG# must be inactive. If only CE1# is driven low, 8-bit data transfers are enabled and A0 specifies whether the even or odd data byte appears on data bus lines D[7:0]. If both CE1# and CE2# are driven low, a 16-bit word transfer takes place. If only CE2# is driven low, an odd byte transfer occurs on data lines D[15:8]. S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 During a read cycle, OE# (output enable) is driven low. A write cycle is specified by driving OE# high and driving the write enable signal (WE#) low. The cycle can be lengthened by driving WAIT# low for the time needed to complete the cycle. Figure 2-1: illustrates a typical memory access read cycle on the PC Card bus. A[25:0] REG# ADDRESS VALID CE1# CE2# OE# WAIT# D[15:0] Hi-Z DATA VALID Transfer Start Hi-Z Transfer Complete Figure 2-1: PC Card Read Cycle Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 2-2: illustrates a typical memory access write cycle on the PC Card bus. A[25:0] REG# ADDRESS VALID CE1# CE2# OE# WE# WAIT# D[15:0] Hi-Z Hi-Z DATA VALID Transfer Start Transfer Complete Figure 2-2: PC Card Write Cycle S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit PC Card (PCMCIA) Host Bus Interface which is used to interface to the PC Card bus. The PC Card Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Hardware Configuration” on page 15. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 PC Card Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the functions of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: PC Card Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name AB[20:1] DB[15:0] WE1# M/R# CS# BUSCLK BS# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# RESET# PC Card (PCMCIA) A[20:1]1 D[15:0] CE2# External Decode External Decode n/a2 VDD CE1# OE# WE# WAIT# Inverted RESET Note 1 The bus signal A0 is not used by the S1D13506 internally. 2Although a clock is not directly supplied by the PC Card interface, one is required by the S1D13506 PC Card Host Bus Interface. For an example of how this can be accomplished see the discussion on BUSCLK in Section 3.2, “PC Card Host Bus Interface Signals” on page 12. Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3.2 PC Card Host Bus Interface Signals The S1D13506 PC Card Host Bus Interface is designed to support processors which interface the S1D13506 through the PC Card bus. The S1D13506 PC Card Host Bus Interface requires the following signals from the PC Card bus. • BUSCLK is a clock input which is required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is separate from the input clock (CLKI) and is typically driven by the host CPU system clock. Since PC Card signalling is independent of any clock, BUSCLK can come from any oscillator already implemented. For example, the source for the CLKI input of the S1D13506 may be used. • The address inputs AB[20:1], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the PC Card address (A[20:1]) and data bus (D[15:0]), respectively. MD4 must be set to select little endian mode upon reset. • M/R# (memory/register) selects between memory or register access. It may be connected to an address line, allowing system address A21 to be connected to the M/R# line. • Chip Select (CS#) must be driven low whenever the S1D13506 is accessed by the PC Card bus. • WE1# and RD/WR# connect to CE2# and CE1# (the byte enables for the high-order and low-order bytes). They are driven low when the PC Card bus is accessing the S1D13506. • RD# connects to OE# (the read enable signal from the PC Card bus). • WE0# connects to WE# (the write enable signal from the PC Card bus). • WAIT# is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the PC Card bus must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since PC Card bus accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. For PC Card applications, this signal should be set active low using the MD5 configuration input. • The Bus Start (BS#) signal is not used for the PC Card Host Bus Interface and should be tied high (connected to VDD). • The RESET# (active low) input of the S1D13506 may be connected to the PC Card RESET (active high) using an inverter. S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4 PC Card to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description The S1D13506 is designed to directly support a variety of CPUs, providing an interface to each processor’s unique “local bus”. However, in order to provide support for processors not having an appropriate local bus, the S1D13506 supports a specific PC Card interface. The S1D13506 provides a “glueless” interface to the PC Card bus except for the following. • The RESET# signal on the S1D13506 is active low and must be inverted to support the active high RESET provided by the PC Card interface. • Although the S1D13506 supports an asynchronous bus interface, a clock source is required on the BUSCLK input pin. In this implementation, the address inputs (AB[20:1]) and data bus (DB[15:0]) connect directly to the CPU address (A[20:1]) and data bus (D[15:0]). M/R# is treated as an address line so that it can be controlled using system address A21. The PC Card interface does not provide a bus clock, so one must be supplied for the S1D13506. Since the bus clock frequency is not critical, nor does it have to be synchronous to the bus signals, it may be the same as CLKI. BS# (bus start) is not used and should be tied high (connected to VDD). Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The following shows a typical implementation of the PC Card to S1D13506 interface. PC Card socket S1D13506 OE# RD# WE0# WE# CE1# RD/WR# WE1# CE2# RESET VDD A21 RESET# BS# CS# M/R# AB[20:1] A[20:1] D[15:0] DB[15:0] 15K WAIT# WAIT# BUSCLK Oscillator CLKI Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of PC Card to S1D13506 Interface S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows only those configuration settings important to the PC Card Host Bus Interface. Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure:(1/0) 1 0 111 = PC Card Host Bus Interface selected Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD11 MD12 Alternate Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input divided by two Primary Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input not divided by two MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected S1D13506 Pin Name = configuration for PC Card Host Bus Interface 4.3 Performance The S1D13506 PC Card Interface specification supports a BCLK up to 50MHz, and therefore can provide a high performance display solution. Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.4 Register/Memory Mapping The S1D13506 is a memory mapped device. The internal registers require 47 bytes and are mapped in the lower PC Card memory address space starting at zero.The display buffer requires 2M bytes and is mapped in the third and fourth megabytes of the PC Card address space (ranging from 200000h to 3FFFFFh). A typical implementation as shown in Figure 4-1: “Typical Implementation of PC Card to S1D13506 Interface,” on page 14 has Chip Select (CS#) connected to ground (always enabled) and the Memory/Register select pin (M/R#) connected to address bit A21. This provides the following decoding: Table 4-2: Register/Memory Mapping for Typical Implementation CS# M/R# (A21) Address Range Function 0 0 0 - 1F FFFFh Internal Register Set decoded 0 1 20 0000h - 3F FFFFh Display Buffer decode The PC Card socket provides 64M byte of address space. Without further resolution on the decoding logic (M/R# connected to A21), the entire register set is aliased for every 64 byte boundary within the specified address range above. Since address bits A[25:22] are ignored, the S1D13506 registers and display buffer are aliased 16 times. Note If aliasing is not desirable, the upper addresses must be fully decoded. S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 5 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 References 6.1 Documents • PC Card (PCMCIA) Standard, March 1997 • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. 6.2 Document Sources • PC Card Website: http://www.pc-card.com. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 7 Technical Support 7.1 Epson LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 7.2 PC Card Standard PCMCIA (Personal Computer Memory Card International Association) 2635 North First Street, Suite 209 San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 433-2273 Fax: (408) 433-9558 http://www.pc-card.com Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-005-03 Interfacing to the PC Card Bus Issue Date: 01/02/06 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Power Consumption Document Number: X25B-G-006-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-006-02 Power Consumption Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 1 S1D13506 Power Consumption S1D13506 power consumption is affected by many system design variables. • Input clock frequency (CLKI/CLKI2): the CLKI/CLKI2 frequency determines the LCD/CRT frame-rate, CPU performance to memory, and other functions – the higher the input clock frequency, the higher the frame-rate, performance and power consumption. • CPU interface: the S1D13506 current consumption depends on the BUSCLK frequency, data width, number of toggling pins, and other factors – the higher the BUSCLK, the higher the CPU performance and power consumption. • VDD voltage level: the voltage level affects power consumption – the higher the voltage, the higher the consumption. • Display mode: the resolution and color depth affect power consumption – the higher the resolution/color depth, the higher the consumption. • Internal CLK divide: internal registers allow the input clock to be divided before going to the internal logic blocks – the higher the divide, the lower the power consumption. There is a power save mode in the S1D13506. The power consumption is affected by various system design variables. • DRAM refresh mode (CBR or self-refresh): self-refresh capable DRAM allows the S1D13506 to disable the internal memory clock thereby saving power. • Clock states during the power save mode: disabling the clocks during power save mode has substantial power savings. Power Consumption Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-006-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 1.1 Conditions Table 1-1: “S1D13506 Power Consumption” gives an example of a specific environment and its effects on power consumption. Table 1-1: S1D13506 Power Consumption Test Condition VDD = 3.3V, BUSCLK = 8MHz 1 CLKI = 6MHz LCD Panel = 60Hz 320x240 4-bit Single Monochrome 2 CLKI = 6 MHz LCD Panel = 60Hz 320x240 8-bit Single Color 3 CLKI = 25MHz LCD Panel = 60Hz 640x480 8-bit Dual Monochrome 4 CLKI = 25MHz LCD Panel = 60Hz 640x480 16-bit Dual Color 5 6 7 CLKI = 33.333MHz, CLKI2 = 25.175MHz CRT = 60Hz 640x480 Color CLKI = 33.333MHz, CLKI2 = 14.31818MHz NTSC TV = 640x480 Color, S-Video output, no filter CLKI = 33.333MHz, CLKI2 = 17.734475MHz PAL TV = 640x480 Color, S-Video output, no filter Color Depth S1D13506 Active (mW) 4 bpp 21.22 4 bpp 23.30 8 bpp 24.98 16 bpp 26.73 4 bpp 70.75 4 bpp 91.74 8 bpp 96.89 16 bpp 99.03 4 bpp 224.86 8 bpp 233.44 16 bpp 242.68 4 bpp 359.83 8 bpp 365.11 16 bpp 372.04 4 bpp 364.78 8 bpp 369.07 16 bpp 374.02 Power Save Mode Clocks Active (mW) 1 Clocks Removed (mW) 2 3.14 .13 3.14 .13 10.36 .13 10.40 .13 11.72 .13 10.00 .13 10.53 .13 Note 1. Conditions for software suspend with Clocks active: • CPU interface inactive • CLKI, CLKI2, BUSCLK active • Self-Refresh DRAM 2. Conditions for software suspend with Clocks inactive: • CPU interface inactive • CLKI, CLKI2, BUSCLK stopped • Self-Refresh DRAM S1D13506 X25B-G-006-02 Power Consumption Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 Summary The system design variables in Section 1, “S1D13506 Power Consumption” and in Table 1-1: “S1D13506 Power Consumption” show that S1D13506 power consumption depends on the specific implementation. Active Mode power consumption depends on the desired CPU performance and LCD/CRT frame-rate, whereas power save mode consumption depends on the CPU Interface and Input Clock state. In a typical design environment, the S1D13506 can be configured to be an extremely power-efficient LCD/CRT/TV Controller with high performance and flexibility. Power Consumption Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-006-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-006-02 Power Consumption Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Document Number: X25B-G-007-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the VR4102/VR4111 . . . . . 2.1 The NEC VR4102/VR4111 System Bus . 2.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1.2 LCD Memory Access Cycles . . . . 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 4 VR4102/VR4111 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration . . 4.3 NEC VR4102/VR4111 Configuration . 5 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 6 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 6.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 6.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 7 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 7.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 7.2 NEC Electronics Inc. (VR4102/VR4111). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 . . .8 . . . .8 . . . .9 . . . . . . . . 12 12 13 13 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 List of Figures Figure 2-1: NEC VR4102/VR4111 Read/Write Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Figure 4-1: NEC VR4102/VR4111 to S1D13506 Configuration Schematic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment necessary to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the NEC VR4102TM (µPD30102) or VR4111TM (µPD30111) Microprocessors. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the VR4102/VR4111 2.1 The NEC VR4102/VR4111 System Bus The VR-Series family of microprocessors features a high-speed synchronous system bus typical of modern microprocessors. Designed with external LCD controller support and Windows CE based embedded consumer applications in mind, the VR4102/VR4111 offers a highly integrated solution for portable systems. This section provides an overview of the operation of the CPU bus in order to establish interface requirements. 2.1.1 Overview The NEC VR4102/VR4111 is designed around the RISC architecture developed by MIPS. This microprocessor is based on the 66MHz VR4100 CPU core which supports 64-bit processing. The CPU communicates with the Bus Control Unit (BCU) using its internal SysAD bus. The BCU in turn communicates with external devices using its ADD and DAT buses which can be dynamically sized for 16 or 32-bit operation. The NEC VR4102/VR4111 has direct support for an external LCD controller. Specific control signals are assigned for an external LCD controller providing an easy interface to the CPU. A 16M byte block of memory is assigned for the LCD controller and its own chip select and ready signals are available. Word or byte accesses are controlled by the system high byte signal (SHB#). S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 2.1.2 LCD Memory Access Cycles Once an address in the LCD block of memory is placed on the external address bus (ADD[25:0]), the LCD chip select (LCDCS#) is driven low. The read or write enable signals (RD# or WR#) are driven low for the appropriate cycle and LCDRDY is driven low to insert wait states into the cycle. The high byte enable (SHB#) in conjunction with address bit 0 allows for byte steering. The following figure illustrates typical NEC VR4102/VR4111 memory read and write cycles to the LCD controller interface. TCLK ADD[25:0] VALID SHB# LCDCS# WR#,RD# D[15:0] (write) D[15:0] (read) VALID Hi-Z VALID Hi-Z LCDRDY Figure 2-1: NEC VR4102/VR4111 Read/Write Cycles Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 directly supports multiple processors. The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface which is most suitable for direct connection to the VR4102/VR4111 microprocessor. The MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Hardware Configuration” on page 13. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the functions of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name AB20 AB[19:0] DB[15:0] WE1# M/R# CS# BUSCLK BS# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# RESET# S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 NEC VR4102/VR4111 Pin Name ADD20 ADD[19:0] DAT[15:0] SHB# ADD21 LCDCS# BUSCLK VDD VDD RD# WR# LCDRDY connected to system reset Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions The S1D13506 MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface requires the following signals. • BUSCLK is a clock input which is required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is separate from the input clock (CLKI) and is typically driven by the host CPU system clock. • The address inputs AB[20:0], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the VR4102/VR4111 address (ADD[20:0]) and data bus (DAT[15:0]), respectively. MD4 must be set to select the proper endian mode upon reset. • M/R# (memory/register) selects between memory or register access. It may be connected to an address line, allowing system address ADD21 to be connected to the M/R# line. • Chip Select (CS#) must be driven low by LCDCS# whenever the S1D13506 is accessed by the VR4102/VR4111. • WE1# connects to SHB# (the high byte enable signal from the VR4102/VR4111) which in conjunction with address bit 0 allows byte steering of read and write operations. • WE0# connects to WR# (the write enable signal from the VR4102/VR4111) and must be driven low when the VR4102/VR4111 is writing data to the S1D13506. • RD# connects to RD# (the read enable signal from the VR4102/VR4111) and must be driven low when the VR4102/VR4111 is reading data from the S1D13506. • WAIT# connects to LCDRDY and is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the VR4102/VR4111 must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since VR4102/VR4111 accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. • The BS# and RD/WR# signals are not used for the MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface and should be tied high (connected to VDD). Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4 VR4102/VR4111 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description The NEC VR4102/VR4111 Microprocessors are specifically designed to support an external LCD controller. They provide the necessary internal address decoding and control signals. The diagram below shows a typical implementation utilizing the S1D13506. NEC VR4102/VR4111 S1D13506 WR# WE0# SHB# WE1# RD# RD# LCDCS# CS# Pull-up LCDRDY WAIT# System RESET RESET# ADD21 M/R# ADD[25:0] AB[20:0] DAT[15:0] DB[15:0] BUSCLK BUSCLK VDD VDD BS# RD/WR# Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: NEC VR4102/VR4111 to S1D13506 Configuration Schematic Note For pin mapping see Table 3-1:, “Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 10. S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows those configuration settings important to the NEC VR4102/VR4111 CPU interface. Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure:(1/0) 1 0 101 = MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD11 Alternate Host Bus Interface Selected Primary Host Bus Interface Selected MD12 BUSCLK input divided by two BUSCLK input not divided MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected S1D13506 Pin Name = configuration for NEC VR4102/VR4111 microprocessor 4.3 NEC VR4102/VR4111 Configuration NEC VR4102/VR4111The NEC VR4102/VR4111 provides the internal address decoding necessary to map an external LCD controller. Physical address 0A00 0000h to 0AFF FFFFh (16M bytes) is reserved for an external LCD controller. The S1D13506 supports up to 2M bytes of display buffer. The NEC VR4102/VR4111 address line A21 is used to select between the S1D13506 display buffer (A21=1) and internal registers (A21=0). The NEC VR4102/VR4111 has a 16-bit internal register named BCUCNTREG2 located at address 0B00 0002h. It must be set to the value of 0001h to indicate that LCD controller accesses using a non-inverting data bus. Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE v2.0 display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE v2.0 display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE v2.0 display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 6 References 6.1 Documents • NEC Electronics Inc., VR4102 Preliminary Users Manual, Document Number U12739EJ2V0UM00. • NEC Electronics Inc., VR4111 Preliminary Users Manual, Document Number U13137EJ2V0UM00. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. 6.2 Document Sources • NEC Electronics Website: http://www.necel.com. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7 Technical Support 7.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 7.2 NEC Electronics Inc. (VR4102/VR4111). NEC Electronics Inc. (U.S.A.) Corporate Headquarters 2880 Scott Blvd. Santa Clara, CA 95050-8062, USA Tel: (800) 366-9782 Fax: (800) 729-9288 http://www.nec.com S1D13506 X25B-G-007-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4102/VR4111™ Microprocessors Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Document Number: X25B-G-008-03 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the MPC821 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.1 The MPC8xx System Bus . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2 MPC821 Bus Overview . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.2.1 Normal (Non-Burst) Bus Transactions . . . . . . . 2.2.2 Burst Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3 Memory Controller Module . . . . . . . . . . . . 2.3.1 General-Purpose Chip Select Module (GPCM) . . . 2.3.2 User-Programmable Machine (UPM) . . . . . . . . 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 3.1 PowerPC Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 3.2 PowerPC Host Bus Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 4 MPC821 to S1D13506 Interface . . 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . 4.2 Hardware Connections . . . . . 4.3 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration 4.4 Register/Memory Mapping . . . 4.5 MPC821 Chip Select Configuration 4.6 Test Software . . . . . . . . 5 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21 6 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 6.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 6.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22 7 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 7.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 7.2 Motorola MPC821 Processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 . . .8 . . .8 . . . .9 . . . 10 . . 11 . . . 11 . . . 12 . . . . . . . . 15 . 15 . 16 . 18 . 18 . 19 . 20 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: PowerPC Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Table 4-1: List of Connections from MPC821ADS to S1D13506 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 Table 4-2: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 List of Figures Figure 2-1: Power PC Memory Read Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Figure 2-2: Power PC Memory Write Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of MPC821 to S1D13506 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment required to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the Motorola MPC821 processor. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the MPC821 2.1 The MPC8xx System Bus The MPC8xx family of processors feature a high-speed synchronous system bus typical of modern RISC microprocessors. This section provides an overview of the operation of the CPU bus in order to establish interface requirements. 2.2 MPC821 Bus Overview The MPC8xx microprocessor family uses a synchronous address and data bus. All IO is synchronous to a square-wave reference clock called MCLK (Master Clock). This clock runs at the machine cycle speed of the CPU core (typically 25 to 50 MHz). Most outputs from the processor change state on the rising edge of this clock. Similarly, most inputs to the processor are sampled on the rising edge. Note The external bus can run at one-half the CPU core speed using the clock control register. This is typically used when the CPU core is operated above 50 MHz. The MPC821 can generate up to eight independent chip select outputs, each of which may be controlled by one of two types of timing generators: the General Purpose Chip Select Module (GPCM) or the User-Programmable Machine (UPM). Examples are given using the GPCM. It should be noted that all Power PC microprocessors, including the MPC8xx family, use bit notation opposite from the convention used by most other microprocessor systems. Bit numbering for the MPC8xx always starts with zero as the most significant bit, and increments in value to the least-significant bit. For example, the most significant bits of the address bus and data bus are A0 and D0, while the least significant bits are A31 and D31. The MPC8xx uses both a 32-bit address and data bus. A parity bit is supported for each of the four byte lanes on the data bus. Parity checking is done when data is read from external memory or peripherals, and generated by the MPC8xx bus controller on write cycles. All IO accesses are memory-mapped meaning there is no separate IO space in the Power PC architecture. Support is provided for both on-chip (DMA controllers) and off-chip (other processors and peripheral controllers) bus masters. For further information on this topic, refer to Section 6, “References” on page 22. The bus can support both normal and burst cycles. Burst memory cycles are used to fill on-chip cache memory, and for certain on-chip DMA operations. Normal cycles are used for all other data transfers. S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 2.2.1 Normal (Non-Burst) Bus Transactions A data transfer is initiated by the bus master by placing the memory address on address lines A0 through A31 and driving TS (Transfer Start) low for one clock cycle. Several control signals are also provided with the memory address: • TSIZ[0:1] (Transfer Size) -- indicates whether the bus cycle is 8, 16, or 32-bit. • RD/WR -- set high for read cycles and low for write cycles. • AT[0:3] (Address Type Signals) -- provides more detail on the type of transfer being attempted. When the peripheral device being accessed has completed the bus transfer, it asserts TA (Transfer Acknowledge) for one clock cycle to complete the bus transaction. Once TA has been asserted, the MPC821 will not start another bus cycle until TA has been de-asserted. The minimum length of a bus transaction is two bus clocks. Figure 2-1: “Power PC Memory Read Cycle” on page 9 illustrates a typical memory read cycle on the Power PC system bus. SYSCLK TS TA A[0:31] RD/WR TSIZ[0:1], AT[0:3] Sampled when TA low D[0:31] Transfer Start Wait States Transfer Complete Next Transfer Starts Figure 2-1: Power PC Memory Read Cycle Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 2-2: “Power PC Memory Write Cycle” on page 10 illustrates a typical memory write cycle on the Power PC system bus. SYSCLK TS TA A[0:31] RD/WR TSIZ[0:1], AT[0:3] D[0:31] Transfer Start Valid Wait States Transfer Complete Next Transfer Starts Figure 2-2: Power PC Memory Write Cycle If an error occurs, TEA (Transfer Error Acknowledge) is asserted and the bus cycle is aborted. For example, a peripheral device may assert TEA if a parity error is detected, or the MPC821 bus controller may assert TEA if no peripheral device responds at the addressed memory location within a bus time-out period. For 32-bit transfers, all data lines (D[0:31]) are used and the two low-order address lines A30 and A31 are ignored. For 16-bit transfers, data lines D[0:15] are used and address line A31 is ignored. For 8-bit transfers, data lines D[0:7] are used and all address lines (A[0:31]) are used. Note This assumes that the Power PC core is operating in big endian mode (typically the case for embedded systems). 2.2.2 Burst Cycles Burst memory cycles are used to fill on-chip cache memory and to carry out certain on-chip DMA operations. They are very similar to normal bus cycles with the following exceptions: • Always 32-bit. • Always attempt to transfer four 32-bit words sequentially. • Always address longword-aligned memory (i.e. A30 and A31 are always 0:0). • Do not increment address bits A28 and A29 between successive transfers; the addressed device must increment these address bits internally. S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 If a peripheral is not capable of supporting burst cycles, it can assert Burst Inhibit (BI) simultaneously with TA, and the processor will revert to normal bus cycles for the remaining data transfers. Burst cycles are mainly intended to facilitate cache line fills from program or data memory. They are normally not used for transfers to/from IO peripheral devices such as the S1D13506, therefore the interfaces described in this document do not attempt to support burst cycles. However, the example interfaces include circuitry to detect the assertion of BDIP and respond with BI if caching is accidently enabled for the S1D13506 address space. 2.3 Memory Controller Module 2.3.1 General-Purpose Chip Select Module (GPCM) The General-Purpose Chip Select Module (GPCM) is used to control memory and peripheral devices which do not require special timing or address multiplexing. In addition to the chip select output, it can generate active-low Output Enable (OE) and Write Enable (WE) signals compatible with most memory and x86-style peripherals. The MPC821 bus controller also provides a Read/Write (RD/WR) signal which is compatible with most 68K peripherals. The GPCM is controlled by the values programmed into the Base Register (BR) and Option Register (OR) of the respective chip select. The Option Register sets the base address, the block size of the chip select, and controls the following timing parameters: • The ACS bit field allows the chip select assertion to be delayed by 0, ¼, or ½ clock cycle with respect to the address bus valid. • The CSNT bit causes chip select and WE to be negated ½ clock cycle earlier than normal. • The TRLX (relaxed timing) bit will insert an additional one clock delay between assertion of the address bus and chip select. This accommodates memory and peripherals with long setup times. • The EHTR (Extended hold time) bit will insert an additional 1 clock delay on the first access to a chip select. • Up to 15 wait states may be inserted, or the peripheral can terminate the bus cycle itself by asserting TA (Transfer Acknowledge). • Any chip select may be programmed to assert BI (Burst Inhibit) automatically when its memory space is addressed by the processor core. Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2.3.2 User-Programmable Machine (UPM) The UPM is typically used to control memory types, such as Dynamic RAMs, which have complex control or address multiplexing requirements. The UPM is a general purpose RAM-based pattern generator which can control address multiplexing, wait state generation, and five general-purpose output lines on the MPC821. Up to 64 pattern locations are available, each 32 bits wide. Separate patterns may be programmed for normal accesses, burst accesses, refresh (timer) events, and exception conditions. This flexibility allows almost any type of memory or peripheral device to be accommodated by the MPC821. In this application note, the GPCM is used instead of the UPM, since the GPCM has enough flexibility to accommodate the S1D13506 and it is desirable to leave the UPM free to handle other interfacing duties, such as EDO DRAM. S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit native PowerPC host bus interface which is used to interface to the MPC821 microprocessor. The PowerPC host bus interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.3, “S1D13506 Hardware Configuration” on page 18. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 PowerPC Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the functions of each host bus interface signal. Table 3-1: PowerPC Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names PowerPC AB[20:0] A[11:31] DB[15:0] D[0:15] WE1# BI M/R# External Decode CS# External Decode BUSCLK CLKOUT BS# TS RD/WR# RD/WR RD# TSIZ0 WE0# TSIZ1 WAIT# TA RESET# RESET# Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3.2 PowerPC Host Bus Interface Signals The S1D13506 PowerPC host bus interface is designed to support processors which interface the S1D13506 through the PowerPC bus. The S1D13506 PowerPC host bus interface requires the following signals: • BUSCLK is a clock input which is required by the S1D13506 host bus interface. It is separate from the input clock (CLKI) and is typically driven by the host CPU system clock. • The address inputs AB[20:0], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the PowerPC bus address (A[11:31]) and data bus (D[0:15]), respectively. MD4 must be set to select the proper endian mode upon reset. • M/R# (memory/register) selects between memory or register access. It may be connected to an address line, allowing system address A10 to be connected to the M/R# line. • Chip Select (CS#) must be driven low whenever the S1D13506 is accessed by the PowerPC bus. • RD/WR# connects to RD/WR which indicates whether a read or a write access is being performed on the S1D13506. • WE1# connects to BI (burst inhibit signal). WE1# is output by the S1D13506 to indicate whether the S1D13506 is able to perform burst accesses. • WE0# and RD# connect to TSIZ1 and TSIZ0 (high and low byte enable signals). These signals must be driven by the PowerPC bus to indicate the size of the transfer taking place on the bus. • WAIT# connects to TA and is output from the S1D13506 to indicate the PowerPC bus must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since PowerPC bus accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur while accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until resource arbitration is complete. • The Bus Start (BS#) signal connects to TS (the transfer start signal). S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 4 MPC821 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description The S1D13506 provides native Power PC bus support, making it very simple to interface the two devices. This application note describes the environment necessary to connect the S1D13506 to the MPC821 native system bus and the connections between the S5U13506B00B Evaluation Board and the Motorola MPC821 Application Development System (ADS). The S1D13506, by implementing a dedicated display buffer, can reduce system power consumption, improve image quality, and increase system performance as compared to the MPC821’s on-chip LCD controller. The S1D13506, through the use of the MPC821 chip selects, can share the system bus with all other MPC821 peripherals. The following figure demonstrates a typical implementation of the S1D13506 to MPC821 interface. S1D13506 MPC821 M/R# A10 A[11:31] AB[20:0] D[0:15] DB[15:0] CS4 CS# TS BS# TA WAIT# RD/WR RD/WR# TSIZ0 RD# TSIZ1 WE0# BI WE1# BUSCLK SYSCLK System RESET Note: RESET# When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of MPC821 to S1D13506 Interface Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Table 4-1:,“List of Connections from MPC821ADS to S1D13506” on page 16 shows the connections between the pins and signals of the MPC821 and the S1D13506. Note The interface was designed using a Motorola MPC821 Application Development System (ADS). The ADS board has 5 volt logic connected to the data bus, so the interface included two 74F245 octal buffers on D[0:15] between the ADS and the S1D13506. In a true 3 volt system, no buffering is necessary. 4.2 Hardware Connections The following table details the connections between the pins and signals of the MPC821 and the S1D13506. Table 4-1: List of Connections from MPC821ADS to S1D13506 MPC821 Signal Name Vcc A10 A11 A12 A13 A14 A15 A16 A17 A18 A19 A20 A21 A22 A23 A24 A25 A26 A27 A28 A29 A30 A31 D0 D1 D2 D3 D4 D5 D6 D7 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 MPC821ADS Connector and Pin Name P6-A1, P6-B1 P6-C23 P6-A22 P6-B22 P6-C21 P6-C20 P6-D20 P6-B24 P6-C24 P6-D23 P6-D22 P6-D19 P6-A19 P6-D28 P6-A28 P6-C27 P6-A26 P6-C26 P6-A25 P6-D26 P6-B25 P6-B19 P6-D17 P12-A9 P12-C9 P12-D9 P12-A8 P12-B8 P12-D8 P12-B7 P12-C7 S1D13506 Signal Name Vcc M/R# AB20 AB19 AB18 AB17 AB16 AB15 AB14 AB13 AB12 AB11 AB10 AB9 AB8 AB7 AB6 AB5 AB4 AB3 AB2 AB1 AB0 DB15 DB14 DB13 DB12 DB11 DB10 DB9 DB8 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 Table 4-1: List of Connections from MPC821ADS to S1D13506 (Continued) MPC821 Signal Name D8 D9 D10 D11 D12 D13 D14 D15 SRESET SYSCLK CS4 TS TA R/W TSIZ0 TSIZ1 BI Gnd MPC821ADS Connector and Pin Name P12-A15 P12-C15 P12-D15 P12-A14 P12-B14 P12-D14 P12-B13 P12-C13 P9-D15 P9-C2 P6-D13 P6-B7 P6-B6 P6-D8 P6-B18 P6-C18 P6-B9 P12-A1, P12-B1, P12-A2, P12-B2, P12-A3, P12-B3, P12-A4, P12-B4, P12-A5, P12-B5, P12-A6, P12-B6, P12-A7 S1D13506 Signal Name DB7 DB6 DB5 DB4 DB3 DB2 DB1 DB0 RESET# BUSCLK CS# BS# WAIT# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WE1# Vss Note Note that the bit numbering of the Power PC bus signals is reversed. e.g. the most significant address bit is A0, the next is A1, A2, etc. Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.3 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The following table shows those configuration settings important to the MPC821 host bus interface. Table 4-2: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options S1D13506 Pin Name MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure: (1/0) 1 0 110 = PowerPC host bus interface selected Little Endian Big Endian Wait# signal is active high Wait# signal is active low MD9 Reserved Configure SUSPEND# pin as Hardware Suspend Enable MD11 MD12 Alternate Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input divided by two Primary Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input not divided MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected = required settings for MPC821 support. 4.4 Register/Memory Mapping The DRAM on the MPC821 ADS board extends from address 0 through 3F FFFFh, so the S1D13506 is addressed starting at 40 0000h. A total of 4M bytes of address space is used, where the lower 2M bytes is reserved for the S1D13506 on-chip registers and the upper 2M bytes is used to access the S1D13506 display buffer. S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 4.5 MPC821 Chip Select Configuration Chip select 4 is used to control the S1D13506. The following options are selected in the base address register (BR4): • BA[0:16] = 0000 0000 0100 0000 0 – set starting address of S1D13506 to 40 0000h. • AT[0:2] = 0 – ignore address type bits. • PS[0:1] = 1:0 – memory port size is 16-bit. • PARE = 0 – disable parity checking. • WP = 0 – disable write protect. • MS[0:1] = 0:0 – select General Purpose Chip Select module to control this chip select. • V = 1 – set valid bit to enable chip select. The following options were selected in the option register (OR4): • AM[0:16] = 1111 1111 1100 0000 0 – mask all but upper 10 address bits; S1D13506 consumes 4M byte of address space. • ATM[0:2] = 0 – ignore address type bits. • CSNT = 0 – normal CS/WE negation. • ACS[0:1] = 1:1 – delay CS assertion by ½ clock cycle from address lines. • BI = 0 – do not assert Burst Inhibit. • SCY[0:3] = 0 – wait state selection; this field is ignored since external transfer acknowledge is used; see SETA below. • SETA = 1 – the S1D13506 generates an external transfer acknowledge using the WAIT# line. • TRLX = 0 – normal timing. • EHTR = 0 – normal timing. Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.6 Test Software The test software is very simple. It configures chip select 4 (CS4) on the MPC821 to map the S1D13506 to an unused 4M byte block of address space. Next, it loads the appropriate values into the option register for CS4 and writes the value 0 to the S1D13506 register REG[001h] to enable full S1D13506 memory/register decoding. Lastly, the software runs a tight loop that reads the S1D13506 Revision Code Register REG[000h]. This allows monitoring of the bus timing on a logic analyzer. The following source code was entered into the memory of the MPC821ADS using the line-by-line assembler in MPC8BUG (the debugger provided with the ADS board). Once the program was executed on the ADS, a logic analyzer was used to verify operation of the interface hardware. It is important to note that when the MPC821 comes out of reset, the on-chip caches and MMU are disabled. If the data cache is enabled, then the MMU must be set so that the S1D13506 memory block is tagged as non-cacheable. This ensures the MPC821 does not attempt to cache any data read from, or written to, the S1D13506 or its display buffer. BR4 OR4 MemStart DisableReg RevCodeReg equ equ equ equ equ $120 $124 $40 $1 $0 Start mfspr andis. andis. oris ori stw andis. oris ori r1,IMMR r1,r1,$ffff r2,r0,0 r2,r2,MemStart r2,r2,$0801 r2,BR4(r1) r2,r0,0 r2,r2,$ffc0 r2,r2,$0608 Loop stw andis. oris stb lbz b ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; ; r2,OR4(r1) ; r1,r0,0 ; r1,r1,MemStart ; r1,DisableReg(r1) ; r0,RevCodeReg(r1) ; Loop ; CS4 base register CS4 option register upper word of S1D13506 start address address of S1D13506 Disable Register address of Revision Code Register get base address of internal registers clear lower 16 bits to 0 clear r2 write base address port size 16 bits; select GPCM; enable write value to base register clear r2 address mask – use upper 10 bits normal CS negation; delay CS ½ clock; no burst inhibit (13506 does this) write to option register clear r1 point r1 to start of S1D13506 mem space write 0 to disable register read revision code into r1 branch forever end Note MPC8BUG does not support comments or symbolic equates; these have been added for clarity. S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 21 5 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 22 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 References 6.1 Documents • Motorola Inc., Power PC MPC821 Portable Systems Microprocessor User’s Manual; Motorola Publication no. MPC821UM/AD. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00B Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. 6.2 Document Sources • Motorola Literature Distribution Center: (800) 441-2447. • Epson Electronics America Website: www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 23 7 Technical Support 7.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 7.2 Motorola MPC821 Processor • Motorola Design Line, (800) 521-6274. • Local Motorola sales office or authorized distributor. Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Page 24 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-008-03 Interfacing to the Motorola MPC821 Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Document Number: X25B-G-009-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the PR31500/PR31700 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.1 PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.2 PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 4 Direct Connection to the Philips PR31500/PR31700 . 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.3 Memory Mapping and Aliasing . . . . . . . . . 5 System Design Using the IT8368E PC Card Buffer 5.1 Hardware Description . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 IT8368E Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 S1D13506 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 7 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 8 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) 8.2 Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor . 8.3 ITE IT8368E . . . . . . . . . . . . . Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 11 12 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 14 15 15 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 . 18 . 18 . 18 S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Table 4-1: S1D13506 Configuration for Direct Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Table 4-2: PR31500/PR31700 to PC Card Slots Address Remapping for Direct Connection . . . . 13 List of Figures Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of Direct Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Figure 5-1: IT8368E Implementation Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment necessary to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT Controller and the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the PR31500/PR31700 The Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 processor supports up to two PC Card (PCMCIA) slots. It is through this Host Bus Interface that the S1D13506 connects to the PR31500/PR31700 processor. The S1D13506 can be successfully interfaced using one of the following configurations: • Direct connection to the PR31500/PR31700 (see Section 4, “Direct Connection to the Philips PR31500/PR31700” on page 11). • System design using the ITE IT8368E PC Card/GPIO buffer chip (see Section 5, “System Design Using the IT8368E PC Card Buffer” on page 14). S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit Host Bus Interface specifically for interfacing to the PR31500/PR31700 microprocessor. The PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset, the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 12. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the function of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name AB20 AB19 AB18 AB17 AB[16:13] AB[12:0] DB[15:8] DB[7:0] WE1# M/R# CS# BUSCLK BS# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# RESET# Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Philips PR31500/PR31700 ALE /CARDREG /CARDIORD /CARDIOWR VDD A[12:0] D[23:16] D[31:24] /CARDxCSH VDD VDD DCLKOUT VDD /CARDxCSL /RD /WE /CARDxWAIT RESET# S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3.2 PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface Signals When the S1D13506 is configured to operate with the PR31500/PR31700, the Host Bus Interface requires the following signals: • BUSCLK is a clock input required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is separate from the input clock (CLKI) and should be driven by the PR31500/PR31700 bus clock output DCLKOUT. • Address input AB20 corresponds to the PR31500/PR31700 signal ALE (address latch enable) whose falling edge indicates that the most significant bits of the address are present on the multiplexed address bus (AB[12:0]). • Address input AB19 should be connected to the PR31500/PR31700 signal /CARDREG. This signal is active when either IO or configuration space of the PR31500/PR31700 PC Card slot is being accessed. • Address input AB18 should be connected to the PR31500/PR31700 signal /CARDIORD. Either AB18 or the RD# input must be asserted for a read operation to take place. • Address input AB17 should be connected to the PR31500/PR31700 signal /CARDIOWR. Either AB17 or the WE0# input must be asserted for a write operation to take place. • Address inputs AB[16:13] and control inputs M/R#, CS# and BS# must be tied to VDD as they are not used in this interface mode. • Address inputs AB[12:0], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the PR31500/PR31700 address and data bus, respectively. MD4 must be set to select the proper endian mode on reset (see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 12). Because of the PR31500/PR31700 data bus naming convention and endian mode, S1D13506 DB[15:8] must be connected to PR31500/PR31700 D[23:16], and S1D13506 DB[7:0] must be connected to PR31500/PR31700 D[31:24]. • Control inputs WE1# and RD/WR# should be connected to the PR31500/PR31700 signals /CARDxCSH and /CARDxCSL respectively for byte steering. • Input RD# should be connected to the PR31500/PR31700 signal /RD. Either RD# or the AB18 input (/CARDIORD) must be asserted for a read operation to take place. • Input WE0# should be connected to the PR31500/PR31700 signal /WR. Either WE0# or the AB17 input (/CARDIOWR) must be asserted for a write operation to take place. • WAIT# is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the host CPU must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since the host CPU accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 4 Direct Connection to the Philips PR31500/PR31700 The S1D13506 was specifically designed to support the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 processor. When configured, the S1D13506 will utilize one of the PC Card slots supported by the processor. 4.1 Hardware Description In this example implementation, the S1D13506 occupies one PC Card slot and resides in the Attribute and IO address range. The processor provides address bits A[12:0], with A[23:13] being multiplexed and available on the falling edge of ALE. Peripherals requiring more than 8K bytes of address space would require an external latch for these multiplexed bits. However, the S1D13506 has an internal latch specifically designed for this processor making additional logic unnecessary. To further reduce the need for external components, the S1D13506 has an optional BUSCLK divide-by-2 feature, allowing the high speed DCLKOUT from the processor to be directly connected to the BUSCLK input of the S1D13506. An optional external oscillator may be used for BUSCLK since the S1D13506 will accept host bus control signals asynchronously with respect to BUSCLK. The following diagram shows a typical implementation of the interface. VDD (+3.3V) PR31500/PR31700 S1D13506 M/R# CS# BS# AB[16:13] AB[12:0] DB[15:8] DB[7:0] A[12:0] D[23:16] D[31:24] ALE /CARDREG AB20 /CARDIORD AB18 /CARDIOWR AB17 /CARDxCSH WE1# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# /CARDxCSL /RD /WE /CARDxWAIT AB19 VDD pull-up System RESET RESET# ENDIAN DCLKOUT ...or... Oscillator See text BUSCLK CLKI Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of Direct Connection Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The host interface control signals of the S1D13506 are asynchronous with respect to the S1D13506 bus clock. This gives the system designer full flexibility to choose the appropriate source (or sources) for CLKI and BUSCLK. The choice of whether both clocks should be the same, whether to use DCLKOUT as clock source, and whether an external or internal clock divider is needed, should be based on the desired: • pixel and frame rates. • power budget. • part count. • maximum S1D13506 clock frequencies. The S1D13506 also has internal CLKI dividers providing additional flexibility. 4.2 S1D13506 Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows those configuration settings relevant to the Philips PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface. Table 4-1: S1D13506 Configuration for Direct Connection S1D13506 Pin Name MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 Value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure: 1 (VDD) 0 (VSS) 111 = Philips PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface when MD11 = 1 Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD11 MD12 Alternate Host Bus Interface selected BUSCLK input divided by two: use with DCLKOUT Primary Host Bus Interface selected BUSCLK input not divided: use with external oscillator MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected = configuration for Philips PR31500/PR31700 Host Bus Interface S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4.3 Memory Mapping and Aliasing The PR31500/PR31700 uses a portion of the PC Card Attribute and IO space to access the S1D13506. The S1D13506 responds to both PC Card Attribute and IO bus accesses, thus freeing the programmer from having to set the PR31500/PR31700 Memory Configuration Register 3 bit CARD1IOEN (or CARD2IOEN if slot 2 is used). As a result, the PR31500/PR31700 sees the S1D13506 on its PC Card slot as described in the table below. Table 4-2: PR31500/PR31700 to PC Card Slots Address Remapping for Direct Connection S1D13506 Uses PC Card Slot # 1 2 Philips Address Size Function 0800 0000h 16M byte Card 1 IO or Attribute 0900 0000h 8M byte 0980 0000h 8M byte S1D13506 registers, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals S1D13506 display buffer, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals 0A00 0000h 32M byte Card 1 IO or Attribute 6400 0000h 64M byte Card 1 Memory 0C00 0000h 16M byte Card 2 IO or Attribute 0D00 0000h 8M byte 0D80 0000h 8M byte 0E00 0000h 32M byte Card 2 IO or Attribute 6800 0000h 64M byte Card 2 Memory Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 registers, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals S1D13506 display buffer, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5 System Design Using the IT8368E PC Card Buffer In a system design using one or two ITE IT8368E PC Card and multiple-function IO buffers, the S1D13506 can be interfaced so as to share one of the PC Card slots. 5.1 Hardware Description The IT8368E can be programmed to allocate the same portion of the PC Card Attribute and IO space to the S1D13506 as in the direct connection implementation described in Section 4, “Direct Connection to the Philips PR31500/PR31700” on page 11. Following is a block diagram showing an implementation using the IT8368E PC Card buffer. PR31500/ PR31700 S1D13506 IT8368E PC Card Device IT8368E PC Card Device Figure 5-1: IT8368E Implementation Block Diagram S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 5.2 IT8368E Configuration The ITE IT8368E has been specifically designed to support EPSON LCD/CRT controllers. Older EPSON Controllers not supporting a direct interface to the Philips processor can utilize the IT8368E MFIO pins to provide the necessary control signals, however when using the S1D13506 this is not necessary as the Direct Connection described in Section 4, “Direct Connection to the Philips PR31500/PR31700” on page 11 can be used. The IT8368E must have both “Fix Attribute/IO” and “VGA” modes enabled. When both these modes are enabled a 16M byte portion of the system PC Card attribute and IO space is allocated to address the S1D13506. When the IT8368E senses that the S1D13506 is being accessed, it does not propagate the PC Card signals to its PC Card device. This makes S1D13506 accesses transparent to any PC Card device connected to the same slot. For mapping details, refer to Section 4.3, “Memory Mapping and Aliasing” on page 13. For further information on configuring the IT8368E, refer to the IT8368E PC Card/GPIO Buffer Chip Specification. 5.3 S1D13506 Configuration For S1D13506 configuration, refer to Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 12. Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE v2.0 display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE v2.0 display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE v2.0 display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 7 References 7.1 Documents • Philips Electronics, PR31500/PR31700 Preliminary Specifications. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. 7.2 Document Sources • Philips Electronics Website: http://www-us2.semiconductors.philips.com. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8 Technical Support 8.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 8.2 Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Philips Semiconductors Handheld Computing Group 4811 E. Arques Avenue M/S 42, P.O. Box 3409 Sunnyvale, CA 94088-3409 Tel: (408) 991-2313 http://www.philips.com 8.3 ITE IT8368E Integrated Technology Express, Inc. Sales & Marketing Division 2710 Walsh Avenue Santa Clara, CA 95051, USA Tel: (408) 980-8168 Fax: (408) 980-9232 http://www.iteusa.com S1D13506 X25B-G-009-02 Interfacing to the Philips MIPS PR31500/PR31700 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Document Number: X25B-G-010-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the TX3912 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.1 TX3912 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 3.2 TX3912 Host Bus Interface Signals . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 4 Direct Connection to the Toshiba TX3912 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Configuration . . . . . . . 4.3 Memory Mapping and Aliasing . . . . 5 System Design Using the IT8368E PC Card Buffer 5.1 Hardware Description . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.2 IT8368E Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . . 5.3 S1D13506 Configuration . . . . . . . . . . . 6 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 7 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 8 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) 8.2 Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor . . . . . 8.3 ITE IT8368E . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 . 11 . 12 . 13 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 14 15 15 . 18 . 18 . 18 . 18 S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: TX3912 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Table 4-1: S1D13506 Configuration for Direct Connection. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Table 4-2: TX3912 to PC Card Slots Address Remapping for Direct Connection . . . . . . . . . . 13 List of Figures Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of Direct Connection . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 Figure 5-1: IT8368E Implementation Block Diagram . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment necessary to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the TX3912 The Toshiba MIPS TX3912 processor supports up to two PC Card (PCMCIA) slots. It is through this Host Bus Interface that the S1D13506 connects to the TX3912 processor. The S1D13506 can be successfully interfaced using one of the following configurations: • Direct connection to the TX3912 (see Section 4, “Direct Connection to the Toshiba TX3912” on page 11). • System design using the ITE IT8368E PC Card/GPIO buffer chip (see Section 5, “System Design Using the IT8368E PC Card Buffer” on page 14). S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit Host Bus Interface specifically for interfacing to the TX3912 microprocessor. The TX3912 Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset, the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 12. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 TX3912 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the function of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: TX3912 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Names AB20 AB19 AB18 AB17 AB[16:13] AB[12:0] DB[15:8] DB[7:0] WE1# M/R# CS# BUSCLK BS# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# RESET# Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Toshiba TX3912 ALE CARDREG* CARDIORD* CARDIOWR* VDD A[12:0] D[23:16] D[31:24] CARDxCSH* VDD VDD DCLKOUT VDD CARDxCSL* RD* WE* CARDxWAIT* PON* S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3.2 TX3912 Host Bus Interface Signals When the S1D13506 is configured to operate with the TX3912, the Host Bus Interface requires the following signals: • BUSCLK is a clock input required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is separate from the input clock (CLKI) and should be driven by the TX3912 bus clock output DCLKOUT. • Address input AB20 corresponds to the TX3912 signal ALE (address latch enable) whose falling edge indicates that the most significant bits of the address are present on the multiplexed address bus (AB[12:0]). • Address input AB19 should be connected to the TX3912 signal CARDREG*. This signal is active when either IO or configuration space of the TX3912 PC Card slot is being accessed. • Address input AB18 should be connected to the TX3912 signal CARDIORD*. Either AB18 or the RD# input must be asserted for a read operation to take place. • Address input AB17 should be connected to the TX3912 signal CARDIOWR*. Either AB17 or the WE0# input must be asserted for a write operation to take place. • Address inputs AB[16:13] and control inputs M/R#, CS# and BS# must be tied to VDD as they are not used in this interface mode. • Address inputs AB[12:0], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the TX3912 address and data bus, respectively. MD4 must be set to select the proper endian mode on reset (see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 12). Because of the TX3912 data bus naming convention and endian mode, S1D13506 DB[15:8] must be connected to TX3912 D[23:16], and S1D13506 DB[7:0] must be connected to TX3912 D[31:24]. • Control inputs WE1# and RD/WR# should be connected to the TX3912 signals CARDxCSH* and CARDxCSL* respectively for byte steering. • Input RD# should be connected to the TX3912 signal RD*. Either RD# or the AB18 input (CARDIORD*) must be asserted for a read operation to take place. • Input WE0# should be connected to the TX3912 signal WR*. Either WE0# or the AB17 input (CARDIOWR*) must be asserted for a write operation to take place. • WAIT# is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the TX3912 must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since the TX3912 accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 4 Direct Connection to the Toshiba TX3912 The S1D13506 was specifically designed to support the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 processor. When configured, the S1D13506 will utilize one of the PC Card slots supported by the processor. 4.1 Hardware Description In this example implementation, the S1D13506 occupies one PC Card slot and resides in the Attribute and IO address range. The processor provides address bits A[12:0], with A[23:13] being multiplexed and available on the falling edge of ALE. Peripherals requiring more than 8K bytes of address space would require an external latch for these multiplexed bits. However, the S1D13506 has an internal latch specifically designed for this processor making additional logic unnecessary. To further reduce the need for external components, the S1D13506 has an optional BUSCLK divide-by-2 feature, allowing the high speed DCLKOUT from the processor to be directly connected to the BUSCLK input of the S1D13506. An optional external oscillator may be used for BUSCLK since the S1D13506 will accept host bus control signals asynchronously with respect to BUSCLK. The following diagram shows a typical implementation of the interface. VDD (+3.3V) TX3912 S1D13506 M/R# CS# BS# AB[16:13] AB[12:0] DB[15:8] DB[7:0] A[12:0] D[23:16] D[31:24] ALE CARDREG* AB20 CARDIORD* AB18 CARDIOWR* AB17 CARDxCSH* WE1# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# CARDxCSL* RD* WE* CARDxWAIT* AB19 VDD pull-up System RESET RESET# ENDIAN DCLKOUT ...or... Oscillator See text BUSCLK CLKI Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of Direct Connection Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center The host interface control signals of the S1D13506 are asynchronous with respect to the S1D13506 bus clock. This gives the system designer full flexibility to choose the appropriate source (or sources) for CLKI and BUSCLK. The choice of whether both clocks should be the same, whether to use DCLKOUT as clock source, and whether an external or internal clock divider is needed, should be based on the desired: • pixel and frame rates. • power budget. • part count. • maximum S1D13506 clock frequencies. The S1D13506 also has internal CLKI dividers providing additional flexibility. 4.2 S1D13506 Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows those configuration settings relevant to the Toshiba TX3912 Host Bus Interface. Table 4-1: S1D13506 Configuration for Direct Connection S1D13506 Pin Name MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 Value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure: 1 (VDD) 0 (VSS) 111 = Toshiba TX3912 Host Bus Interface if MD11 = 1 Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD11 MD12 Alternate Host Bus Interface selected BUSCLK input divided by two: use with DCLKOUT Primary Host Bus Interface selected BUSCLK input not divided: use with external oscillator MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected = configuration for Toshiba TX3912 Host Bus Interface S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4.3 Memory Mapping and Aliasing The TX3912 uses a portion of the PC Card Attribute and IO space to access the S1D13506. The S1D13506 responds to both PC Card Attribute and IO bus accesses, thus freeing the programmer from having to set the TX3912 Memory Configuration Register 3 bit CARD1IOEN (or CARD2IOEN if slot 2 is used). As a result, the TX3912 sees the S1D13506 on its PC Card slot as described in the table below. Table 4-2: TX3912 to PC Card Slots Address Remapping for Direct Connection S1D13506 Uses PC Card Slot # 1 2 Toshiba Address Size Function 0800 0000h 16M byte Card 1 IO or Attribute 0900 0000h 8M byte 0980 0000h 8M byte S1D13506 registers, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals S1D13506 display buffer, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals 0A00 0000h 32M byte Card 1 IO or Attribute 6400 0000h 64M byte Card 1 Memory 0C00 0000h 16M byte Card 2 IO or Attribute 0D00 0000h 8M byte 0D80 0000h 8M byte 0E00 0000h 32M byte Card 2 IO or Attribute 6800 0000h 64M byte Card 2 Memory Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 registers, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals S1D13506 display buffer, aliased 4 times at 2M byte intervals S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5 System Design Using the IT8368E PC Card Buffer In a system design using one or two ITE IT8368E PC Card and multiple-function IO buffers, the S1D13506 can be interfaced so as to share one of the PC Card slots. 5.1 Hardware Description The IT8368E can be programmed to allocate the same portion of the PC Card Attribute and IO space to the S1D13506 as in the direct connection implementation described in Section 4, “Direct Connection to the Toshiba TX3912” on page 11. Following is a block diagram showing an implementation using the IT8368E PC Card buffer. TX3912 S1D13506 IT8368E PC Card Device IT8368E PC Card Device Figure 5-1: IT8368E Implementation Block Diagram S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 5.2 IT8368E Configuration The ITE IT8368E has been specifically designed to support EPSON LCD/CRT controllers. Older EPSON Controllers not supporting a direct interface to the Toshiba processor can utilize the IT8368E MFIO pins to provide the necessary control signals, however when using the S1D13506 this is not necessary as the Direct Connection described in Section 4, “Direct Connection to the Toshiba TX3912” on page 11 can be used. The IT8368E must have both “Fix Attribute/IO” and “VGA” modes enabled. When both these modes are enabled a 16M byte portion of the system PC Card attribute and IO space is allocated to address the S1D13506. When the IT8368E senses that the S1D13506 is being accessed, it does not propagate the PC Card signals to its PC Card device. This makes S1D13506 accesses transparent to any PC Card device connected to the same slot. For mapping details, refer to Section 4.3, “Memory Mapping and Aliasing” on page 13. For further information on configuring the IT8368E, refer to the IT8368E PC Card/GPIO Buffer Chip Specification. 5.3 S1D13506 Configuration For S1D13506 configuration, refer to Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 12. Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE v2.0 display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE v2.0 display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE v2.0 display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 7 References 7.1 Documents • Toshiba America Electrical Components, Inc., TX3905/12 Specification. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. 7.2 Document Sources • Toshiba America Electrical Components Website: http://www.toshiba.com/taec. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 8 Technical Support 8.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 8.2 Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor http://www.toshiba.com/taec/nonflash/indexproducts.html 8.3 ITE IT8368E Integrated Technology Express, Inc. Sales & Marketing Division 2710 Walsh Avenue Santa Clara, CA 95051, USA Tel: (408) 980-8168 Fax: (408) 980-9232 http://www.iteusa.com S1D13506 X25B-G-010-02 Interfacing to the Toshiba MIPS TX3912 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Document Number: X25B-G-011-02 Copyright © 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121 . . 2.1 The NEC VR4121 System Bus . . 2.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . 2.1.2 LCD Memory Access Cycles 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 4 VR4121 to S1D13506 Interface . . 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Configuration . . . 4.3 NEC VR4121 Configuration . . 4.4 Memory Mapping and Aliasing 5 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15 6 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 6.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 6.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 7 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7.1 Epson LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7.2 NEC Electronics Inc. (VR4121). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 . . .8 . . . .8 . . . .9 . . . . . . 12 . 12 . 13 . 13 . 14 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 List of Figures Figure 2-1: NEC VR4121 Read/Write Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Figure 4-1: NEC VR4121 to S1D13506 Configuration Schematic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment necessary to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the NEC VR4121TM (µPD30121) microprocessor. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note will be updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the NEC V R 4121 2.1 The NEC VR4121 System Bus The VR-Series family of microprocessors features a high-speed synchronous system bus typical of modern microprocessors. Designed with external LCD controller support and Windows CE based embedded consumer applications in mind, the VR4121 offers a highly integrated solution for portable systems. This section provides an overview of the operation of the CPU bus in order to establish interface requirements. 2.1.1 Overview The NEC VR4121 is designed around the RISC architecture developed by MIPS. This microprocessor is based on the 166MHz VR4120 CPU core which supports 64-bit processing. The CPU communicates with the Bus Control Unit (BCU) using its internal SysAD bus. The BCU in turn communicates with external devices using its ADD and DATA buses which can be dynamically sized to 16 or 32-bit operation. The NEC VR4121 has direct support for an external LCD controller. Specific control signals are assigned for an external LCD controller providing an easy interface to the CPU. A 16M byte block of memory is assigned for the LCD controller and its own chip select and ready signals are available. Word or byte accesses are controlled by the system high byte signal (SHB#). S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 2.1.2 LCD Memory Access Cycles Once an address in the LCD block of memory is placed on the external address bus (ADD[25:0]), the LCD chip select (LCDCS#) is driven low. The read or write enable signals (RD# or WR#) are driven low for the appropriate cycle and LCDRDY is driven low to insert wait states into the cycle. The high byte enable (SHB#) in conjunction with address bit 0 allows for byte steering. The following figure illustrates typical NEC VR4121 memory read and write cycles to the LCD controller interface. TCLK ADD[25:0] VALID SHB# LCDCS# WR#,RD# D[15:0] (write) VALID Hi-Z D[15:0] (read) VALID Hi-Z LCDRDY Figure 2-1: NEC VR4121 Read/Write Cycles Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 directly supports multiple processors. The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface which is most suitable for direct connection to the VR4121 microprocessor. The MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Configuration” on page 13. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the functions of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name AB20 AB[19:0] DB[15:0] WE1# M/R# CS# BUSCLK BS# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# RESET# S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 NEC VR4121 Pin Name ADD20 ADD[19:0] DAT[15:0] SHB# ADD21 LCDCS# BUSCLK VDD VDD RD# WR# LCDRDY connected to system reset Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions The S1D13506 MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface requires the following signals. • BUSCLK is a clock input which is required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is separate from the input clock (CLKI) and is typically driven by the host CPU system clock. • The address inputs AB[20:0], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the VR4121 address (ADD[20:0]) and data bus (DAT[15:0]), respectively. MD4 must be set to select the proper endian mode upon reset. • M/R# (memory/register) selects between memory or register access. It may be connected to an address line, allowing system address ADD21 to be connected to the M/R# line. • Chip Select (CS#) must be driven low by LCDCS# whenever the S1D13506 is accessed by the VR4121. • WE1# connects to SHB# (the high byte enable signal from the VR4121) which in conjunction with address bit 0 allows byte steering of read and write operations. • WE0# connects to WR# (the write enable signal from the VR4121) and must be driven low when the VR4121 bus is writing data to the S1D13506. • RD# connects to RD# (the read enable signal from the VR4121) and must be driven low when the VR4121 bus is reading data from the S1D13506. • WAIT# connects to LCDRDY and is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the VR4121 bus must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since VR4121 bus accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. • The BS# and RD/WR# signals are not used for the MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface and should be tied high (connected to VDD). Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4 V R 4121 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description The NEC VR4121 microprocessor is specifically designed to support an external LCD controller. It provides all the necessary internal address decoding and control signals required by the S1D13506. The diagram below shows a typical implementation utilizing the S1D13506. NEC VR4121 S1D13506 WR# WE0# SHB# WE1# RD# RD# LCDCS# CS# Pull-up LCDRDY WAIT# System RESET RESET# M/R# ADD21 ADD[25:0] AB[20:0] DAT[15:0] DB[15:0] BUSCLK BUSCLK VDD(+3.3V) BS# VDD3 VDD2 +3.3V RD/WR# +2.5V VDD Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: NEC VR4121 to S1D13506 Configuration Schematic Note For pin mapping see Table 3-1:, “Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 10. S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4.2 S1D13506 Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows those configuration settings relevant to the MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface used by the NEC VR4121 microprocessor. Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options S1D13506 Pin Name MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure:(1/0) 1 0 101 = MIPS/ISA Host Bus Interface Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD11 Alternate Host Bus Interface Selected Primary Host Bus Interface Selected MD12 BUSCLK input divided by 2 BUSCLK input not divided MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected = configuration for NEC VR4121 microprocessor 4.3 NEC VR4121 Configuration The NEC VR4121 register BCUCNTREG1 bit ISAM/LCD must be set to 0. A 0 indicates that the reserved address space is for the LCD controller, and not for the high-speed ISA memory. The register BCUCNTREG2 bit GMODE must be set to 1 to indicate that a non-inverting data bus is used for LCD controller accesses. The LCD interface must be set to operate using a 16-bit data bus. This is accomplished by setting the NEC VR4121 register BCUCNTREG3 bit LCD32/ISA32 to 0. Note Setting the register BCUCNTREG3 bit LCD32/ISA32 to 0 affects both the LCD controller and high-speed ISA memory access. The frequency of BUSCLK output is programmed from the state of pins TxD/CLKSEL2, RTS#/CLKSEL1 and DTR#/CLKSEL0 during reset, and from the PMU (Power Management Unit) configuration registers of the NEC VR4121. The S1D13506 works at any of the frequencies provided by the NEC VR4121. Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.4 Memory Mapping and Aliasing The NEC VR4121 provides the internal address decoding required by an external LCD controller. The physical address range from 0A00 0000h to 0AFF FFFFh (16M bytes) is reserved for use by an external LCD controller (e.g. S1D13506). The S1D13506 supports up to 2M bytes of display buffer. The NEC VR4121 address line ADD21 (connected to M/R#) is used to select between the S1D13506 display buffer (ADD21=1) and the S1D13506 internal registers (ADD21=0). NEC VR4121 address lines ADD[23:22] are ignored, thus the S1D13506 is aliased four times at 4M byte intervals over the LCD controller address range. Address lines ADD[25:24] are set at 10b and never change while the LCD controller is being addressed. S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 5 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE v2.0 display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE v2.0 display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE v2.0 display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 References 6.1 Documents • NEC Electronics Inc., VR4121 Preliminary Users Manual, Document Number U13569EJ1V0UM00. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. 6.2 Document Sources • NEC Electronics Website: http://www.necel.com. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 7 Technical Support 7.1 Epson LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 7.2 NEC Electronics Inc. (VR4121). NEC Electronics Inc. (U.S.A.) Corporate Headquarters 2880 Scott Blvd. Santa Clara, CA 95050-8062, USA Tel: (800) 366-9782 Fax: (800) 729-9288 http://www.nec.com http://www.vrseries.com Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-011-02 Interfacing to the NEC VR4121™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Document Number: X25B-G-012-03 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Microsoft and Windows are registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the NEC V832 . . . . 2.1 The NEC V832 System Bus . . . 2.1.1 Overview . . . . . . . . . . 2.1.2 Access Cycles . . . . . . . . 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 4 V832 to S1D13506 Interface . . . . 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration 4.3 NEC V832 Configuration . . . . 4.4 Memory Mapping and Aliasing . 5 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16 6 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 6.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 6.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 7 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 7.1 Epson LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 7.2 NEC Electronics Inc. (V832). . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 . . .8 . . . .8 . . . .9 . . . . . . 12 . 12 . 13 . 14 . 15 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: Table 4-1: Table 4-2: Table 4-3: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . NEC V832 Wait States vs. Bus Clock Frequency . NEC V832 IO Address Range For Each CSn Line . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 13 14 15 List of Figures Figure 2-1: NEC V832 Read/Write Cycles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Figure 4-1: NEC V832 to S1D13506 Configuration Schematic . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment required to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the NEC V832TM microprocessor (µPD705102). The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note is updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America Website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the NEC V832 2.1 The NEC V832 System Bus This section provides an overview of the operation of the CPU bus in order to establish interface requirements. 2.1.1 Overview The NEC V832 is designed around the RISC architecture developed by MIPS. This microprocessor is based on the 32-bit V830 CPU core. The CPU communicates with external devices via the Bus Control Unit (BCU). The BCU in turn communicates using its ADD and DATA buses which can be dynamically sized to 16 or 32-bit operation. The NEC V832 features dedicated chip select pins which allow memory-mapped IO operations. A 16M byte block of addressing space can be assigned for the LCD controller and its own chip select and ready signals are available. Word or byte accesses are controlled by system byte enable signals (LLBEN and LUBEN). S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 2.1.2 Access Cycles Once an address in the appropriate range is placed on the external address bus (A[23:1]), the corresponding chip select (CSn) is driven low. The read or write enable signals (IORD or IOWR) are driven low and READY is driven low by the S1D13506 to insert wait states into the cycle. The byte enable signals (LLBEN and LUBEN) allow byte steering. The following figure illustrates typical NEC V832 memory-mapped IO access cycles. SDCLKOUT A[23:1] VALID LLBEN, LUBEN CSn IORD, IOWR D[15:0] (write) VALID Hi-Z D[15:0] (read) VALID Hi-Z READY Figure 2-1: NEC V832 Read/Write Cycles Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 directly supports multiple processors. The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit PC Card (PCMCIA) Host Bus Interface which is most suitable for direct connection to the V832 microprocessor. The PC Card Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Hardware Configuration” on page 13. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the functions of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name NEC V832 Pin Name AB[20:1] A[20:1] A0 GND1 DB[15:0] D[15:0] WE1# LUBEN M/R# A21 CS# CS3, CS4, CS5 or CS6 BUSCLK SDCLKOUT BS# VDD (+3.3V) RD/WR# LLBEN RD# IORD WE0# IOWR WAIT# READY RESET# connected to system reset Note 1 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 The bus signal A0 is not used by the S1D13506 internally. Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions The S1D13506 PC Card Host Bus Interface requires the following signals. • BUSCLK is a clock input which is required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is driven by the V832 signal SDCLKOUT. • The address inputs AB[20:1], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the V832 address (A[20:1]) and data bus (D[15:0]), respectively. MD4 must be set to select little endian mode upon reset. • M/R# (memory/register) selects between memory or register access. It may be connected to an address line, allowing system address A21 to be connected to the M/R# line. • Chip Select (CS#) must be driven low by CSx (where x is the V832 chip select used) whenever the S1D13506 is accessed by the V832. • WE1# and RD/WR# connect to LUBEN and LLBEN (the byte enables for the highorder and low-order bytes). They are driven low when the V832 is accessing the S1D13506. • RD# connects to IORD (the read enable signal from the V832). • WE0# connects to IOWR (the write enable signal from the V832). • WAIT# is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the V832 must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since V832 accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. For V832 applications, this signal should be set active low using the MD5 configuration input. • The Bus Start (BS#) signal is not used for the PC Card Host Bus Interface and should be tied high (connected to V DD). • The RESET# (active low) input of the S1D13506 may be connected to the system RESET. Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4 V832 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description The NEC V832 microprocessor features configurable chip select lines which can easily be used for an external LCD controller. It provides all the necessary internal address decoding and control signals required by the S1D13506. The diagram below shows a typical implementation utilizing the S1D13506. S1D13506 NEC V832 LLBEN RD/WR# LUBEN WE1# IORD IOWR RD# WE0# CS# CSn Pull-up READY WAIT# System RESET RESET# A21 M/R# A[20:1] AB[20:1] D[15:0] DB[15:0] SDCLKOUT BUSCLK VDD(+3.3V) BS# VDD_O VDD_I +3.3V VDD +2.5V AB0 Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: NEC V832 to S1D13506 Configuration Schematic Note For pin mapping see Table 3-1:, “Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping,” on page 10. S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows those configuration settings relevant to the PC Card Host Bus Interface used by the NEC V832 microprocessor. Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options S1D13506 Pin Name MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 MD11 Value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure: (1/0) 1 0 111 = PC Card Host Bus Interface Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD12 Alternate Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input divided by two Primary Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input not divided by two MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is floating if S1D13506 is not selected = configuration for NEC V832 microprocessor Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.3 NEC V832 Configuration The NEC V832 should access the S1D13506 in non-burst mode only. This is ensured by using any one of the CS3 to CS6 lines to control the S1D13506 and setting that line to respond to IO operations using the NEC V832 BCTC register. For example, if line CS5 is used then bit 5 (CT5) of the BCTC register should be set to 1 (IO cycle). The NEC V832 data bus should be programmed to use 16 bits as the maximum width for S1D13506 bus transactions. This does not affect the width of other NEC V832 data bus transactions. Data bus width is set in the NEC V832 DBC register. For example, if line CS4 is used then bit 4 (BW4) of the DBC register should be set to 1 (16-bit bus width). Depending on bus clock frequencies, a different number of wait states may be required. These need to be programmed into the NEC V832 PWC0 and PWC1 registers in the bit field corresponding to the CSn line chosen for the S1D13506. For example, if CS3 is used and one wait state is required, then bits 14-12 of the NEC V832 PWC0 register (WS3) must be set to 001b (one wait state). If CS6 is used and no wait state is needed, then bits 11-8 of the NEC V832 PWC1 register (WS6) must be set to 0000b (zero wait state). The table below shows the recommended wait states depending on the bus clock frequency. Table 4-2: NEC V832 Wait States vs. Bus Clock Frequency Wait States Maximum Frequency (SDCLKOUT) 0 10.8MHz 1 32.6MHz 2 No limit No idle state needs to be added. The NEC V832 PIC0 and PIC1 register bit field corresponding to the CSn line chosen for the S1D13506 must be set to zero. For example, if CS3 is used then bits 14-12 of the NEC V832 PIC0 register (IS3) must be set to 000b (no idle state). S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 4.4 Memory Mapping and Aliasing The CSn line selected determines the address range to be reserved for the S1D13506. The table below summarizes the S1D13506 address mapping. Table 4-3: NEC V832 IO Address Range For Each CSn Line CSn Line CS3 CS4 CS5 CS6 NEC V832 IO Address S1D13506 Function 0300 0000h to 03FF FFFFh 0300 0000h Registers 0320 0000h Display buffer (2M bytes) 0400 0000h to 04FF FFFFh 0400 0000h Registers 0420 0000h Display buffer (2M bytes) 0500 0000h to 05FF FFFFh 0500 0000h Registers 0520 0000h Display buffer (2M bytes) 0600 0000h to 06FF FFFFh 0600 0000h Registers 0620 0000h Display buffer (2M bytes) Each address range is 16M bytes, therefore, the S1D13506 is aliased four times over the address range. Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 5 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE display drivers are available from your sales support contact or www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 6 References 6.1 Documents • NEC Electronics Inc., V832 Preliminary Users Manual, Document Number U13577EJ1V0UM00. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. 6.2 Document Sources • NEC Electronics Website: http://www.necel.com. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 7 Technical Support 7.1 Epson LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 7.2 NEC Electronics Inc. (V832). NEC Electronics Inc. (U.S.A.) Corporate Headquarters 2880 Scott Blvd. Santa Clara, CA 95050-8062, USA Tel: (800) 366-9782 Fax: (800) 729-9288 http://www.necel.com S1D13506 X25B-G-012-03 Interfacing to the NEC V832™ Microprocessor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Document Number: X25B-G-013-03 Copyright © 1999, 2001 Epson Research and Development, Inc. All Rights Reserved. Information in this document is subject to change without notice.You may download and use this document, but only for your own use in evaluating Seiko Epson/EPSON products. You may not modify the document. Epson Research and Development, Inc. disclaims any representation that the contents of this document are accurate or current. The Programs/Technologies described in this document may contain material protected under U.S. and/or International Patent laws. EPSON is a registered trademark of Seiko Epson Corporation. All other trademarks are the property of their respective owners. Page 2 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 3 Table of Contents 1 Introduction . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 7 2 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Bus 2.1 The StrongARM SA-1110 System Bus . . 2.1.1 StrongARM SA-1110 Overview . . . 2.1.2 Variable-Latency IO Access Overview 2.1.3 Variable-Latency IO Access Cycles . 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12 4 StrongARM SA-1110 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description . . . . . . . . . 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration . . . . 4.3 Performance . . . . . . . . . . . . . 4.4 Register/Memory Mapping . . . . . . . 4.5 StrongARM SA-1110 Register Configuration 5 Software . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17 6 References . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 6.1 Documents . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 6.2 Document Sources . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18 7 Technical Support . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 7.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 7.2 Intel StrongARM SA-1110 Micro-processor . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8 . . . .8 . . . . .8 . . . . .8 . . . . .9 . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 13 14 14 15 16 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 4 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 5 List of Tables Table 3-1: Table 4-1: Table 4-2: Table 4-3: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Summary of Power-On/Reset Options . . . . . . . . . . . Register/Memory Mapping for Typical Implementation . RDFx Parameter Value versus CPU Maximum Frequency . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11 14 15 16 List of Figures Figure 2-1: SA-1110 Variable-Latency IO Read Cycle. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9 Figure 2-2: SA-1110 Variable-Latency IO Write Cycle . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10 Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of SA-1110 to S1D13506 Interface . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 6 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 7 1 Introduction This application note describes the hardware and software environment required to provide an interface between the S1D13506 Color LCD/CRT/TV Controller and the Intel StrongARM SA-1110. The designs described in this document are presented only as examples of how such interfaces might be implemented. This application note is updated as appropriate. Please check the Epson Electronics America website at http://www.eea.epson.com for the latest revision of this document before beginning any development. We appreciate your comments on our documentation. Please contact us via email at [email protected]. Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 8 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 2 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Bus 2.1 The StrongARM SA-1110 System Bus The StrongARM SA-1110 microprocessor is a highly integrated communications microcontroller that incorporates a 32-bit StrongARM RISC processor core. The SA-1110 is ideally suited to interface to the S1D13506 LCD controller and provides a high performance, power efficient solution for embedded systems. 2.1.1 StrongARM SA-1110 Overview The SA-1110 system bus can access both variable-latency IO and memory devices. The SA-1110 uses a 26-bit address bus and a 32-bit data bus which can be used to access 16-bit devices. A chip select module with six chip select signals (each accessing 64M bytes of memory) allows selection of external devices. Only chip selects 3 through 5 (nCS[5:3]) may be used to select variable-latency devices which use RDY to extend access cycles. These chip selects are individually programmed in the SA-1110 memory configuration registers and can be configured for either a 16 or 32-bit data bus. Byte steering is implemented using the four signals nCAS[3:0]. Each signal selects a byte on the 32-bit data bus. For example, nCAS0 selects bits D[7:0] and nCAS3 selects bits D[31:24]. For a 16-bit data bus, only nCAS[1:0] are used with nCAS0 selecting the low byte and nCAS1 selecting the high byte. The SA-1110 can be configured to support little or big endian mode. 2.1.2 Variable-Latency IO Access Overview A data transfer is initiated when a memory address is placed on the SA-1110 system bus and a chip select signal (nCS[5:3]) is driven low. If all byte enable signals (nCAS[3:0]) are driven low, then a 32-bit transfer takes place. If only nCAS[1:0] are driven low, then a word transfer takes place over a 16-bit bus interface. If only one byte enable is driven low, then a byte transfer takes place on the respective data lines. During a read cycle, the output enable signal (nOE) is driven low. A write cycle is specified by driving nOE high and driving the write enable signal (nWE) low. The cycle can be lengthened by driving RDY high for the time needed to complete the cycle. S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 9 2.1.3 Variable-Latency IO Access Cycles The first nOE assertion occurs two memory cycles after the assertion of chip select (nCS3, nCS4, or nCS5). Two memory cycles prior to the end of minimum nOE or nWE assertion (RDF+1 memory cycles), the SA-1110 starts sampling the data ready input (RDY). Samples are taken every half memory cycle until three consecutive samples (at the rising edge, falling edge, and following rising edge of the memory clock) indicate that the IO device is ready for data transfer. Read data is latched one-half memory cycle after the third successful sample (on falling edge). Then nOE or nWE is deasserted on the next rising edge and the address may change on the subsequent falling edge. Prior to a subsequent data cycle, nOE or nWE will remain deasserted for RDN+1 memory cycles. The chip select and byte selects (nCAS/DQM[1:0] for 16-bit data transfers), remain asserted for one memory cycle after the final nOE or nWE deassertion of the burst. The SA-1110 is capable of burst cycles during which the chip select remains low while the read or write command is asserted, precharged and reasserted repeatedly. Figure 2-1: illustrates a typical variable-latency IO access read cycle on the SA-1110 bus. A[25:0] ADDRESS VALID nCS4 nOE nWE RDY D[31:0] DATA VALID nCAS[3:0] Figure 2-1: SA-1110 Variable-Latency IO Read Cycle Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 10 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Figure 2-2: illustrates a typical variable-latency IO access write cycle on the SA-1110 bus. A[25:0] ADDRESS VALID nCS4 nWE nOE RDY D[31:0] DATA VALID nCAS[3:0] Figure 2-2: SA-1110 Variable-Latency IO Write Cycle S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 11 3 S1D13506 Host Bus Interface The S1D13506 directly supports multiple processors. The S1D13506 implements a 16-bit PC Card (PCMCIA) Host Bus Interface which is most suitable for direct connection to the SA-1110. The PC Card Host Bus Interface is selected by the S1D13506 on the rising edge of RESET#. After releasing reset the bus interface signals assume their selected configuration. For details on S1D13506 configuration, see Section 4.2, “S1D13506 Hardware Configuration” on page 14. Note At reset, the Register/Memory Select bit in the Miscellaneous Register (REG[001h] bit 7) is set to 1. This means that only REG[000h] (read-only) and REG[001h] are accessible until a write to REG[001h] sets bit 7 to 0 making all registers accessible. When debugging a new hardware design, this can sometimes give the appearance that the interface is not working, so it is important to remember to clear this bit before proceeding with debugging. 3.1 Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping The following table shows the functions of each Host Bus Interface signal. Table 3-1: Host Bus Interface Pin Mapping S1D13506 Pin Name AB[20:1]1 DB[15:0] WE1# M/R# CS# BUSCLK BS# RD/WR# RD# WE0# WAIT# RESET# SA-1110 A[20:1]1 D[15:0] nCAS1 A21 nCS4 SDCLK2 VDD nCAS0 nOE nWE RDY system RESET Note 1 The bus signal A0 is not used by the S1D13506 internally. Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 12 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 3.2 Host Bus Interface Signal Descriptions The S1D13506 PC Card Host Bus Interface requires the following signals. • BUSCLK is a clock input which is required by the S1D13506 Host Bus Interface. It is driven by one of the SA-1110 signals SDCLK1 or SDCLK2 (the example implementation in this document uses SDCLK2). For further information, see Section 4.3, “Performance” on page 14. • The address inputs AB[20:1], and the data bus DB[15:0], connect directly to the SA-1110 address (A[20:1]) and data bus (D[15:0]), respectively. MD4 must be set to select little endian mode upon reset. • M/R# (memory/register) selects between memory or register access. It may be connected to an address line, allowing system address A21 to be connected to the M/R# line. • Chip Select (CS#) must be driven low by nCSx (where x is the SA-1110 chip select used) whenever the S1D13506 is accessed by the SA-1110. • WE1# and RD/WR# connect to nCAS1 and nCAS0 (the byte enables for the high-order and low-order bytes). They are driven low when the SA-1110 is accessing the S1D13506. • RD# connects to nOE (the read enable signal from the SA-1110). • WE0# connects to nWE (the write enable signal from the SA-1110). • WAIT# is a signal output from the S1D13506 that indicates the SA-1110 must wait until data is ready (read cycle) or accepted (write cycle) on the host bus. Since SA-1110 accesses to the S1D13506 may occur asynchronously to the display update, it is possible that contention may occur in accessing the S1D13506 internal registers and/or display buffer. The WAIT# line resolves these contentions by forcing the host to wait until the resource arbitration is complete. For the SA-1110, this signal should be set active low using the MD5 configuration input. • The Bus Start (BS#) signal is not used for this Host Bus Interface and should be tied high (connected to VDD). • The RESET# (active low) input of the S1D13506 may be connected to the system RESET. S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 13 4 StrongARM SA-1110 to S1D13506 Interface 4.1 Hardware Description The S1D13506 is designed to directly support a variety of CPUs, providing an interface to each processor’s unique “local bus”. Using the S1D13506’s PC Card Host Bus Interface provides a “glueless” interface to the SA-1110. In this implementation, the address inputs (AB[20:1]) and data bus (DB[15:0]) connect directly to the CPU address (A[20:1]) and data bus (D[15:0]). M/R# is treated as an address line so that it can be controlled using system address A21. BS# (Bus Start) is not used and should be tied high (connected to VDD). The following diagram shows a typical implementation of the SA-1110 to S1D13506 interface. S1D13506 SA-1110 VDDX nOE nWE +3.3V +3.3V VDD RD# WE0# nCAS0 nCAS1 RD/WR# WE1# System RESET +3.3V nCS4 A21 RESET# BS# CS# M/R# A[20:1] AB[20:1] D[15:0] DB[15:0] WAIT# RDY SDCLK2 BUSCLK Oscillator CLKI Note: When connecting the S1D13506 RESET# pin, the system designer should be aware of all conditions that may reset the S1D13506 (e.g. CPU reset can be asserted during wake-up from power-down modes, or during debug states). Figure 4-1: Typical Implementation of SA-1110 to S1D13506 Interface Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 14 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.2 S1D13506 Hardware Configuration The S1D13506 latches MD15 through MD0 to allow selection of the bus mode and other configuration data on the rising edge of RESET#. For details on configuration, refer to the S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, document number X25B-A-001-xx. The table below shows only those configuration settings important to the PC Card Host Bus Interface. Table 4-1: Summary of Power-On/Reset Options MD[3:1] MD4 MD5 value on this pin at rising edge of RESET# is used to configure:(1/0) 1 0 111 = PC Card Host Bus Interface selected Little Endian Big Endian WAIT# is active high (1 = insert wait state) WAIT# is active low (0 = insert wait state) MD11 MD12 Alternate Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input divided by two Primary Host Bus Interface Selected BUSCLK input not divided by two MD15 WAIT# is always driven WAIT# is tristated when the chip is not accessed by the host S1D13506 Pin Name = configuration for PC Card Host Bus Interface 4.3 Performance The S1D13506 PC Card Interface specification supports a BUSCLK up to 50MHz, and therefore provides a high performance display solution. The BUSCLK signal input to the S1D13506 (from one of the SDCLK[2:1] pins) is a derivative of the SA-1110 internal processor speed. Since the PC Card Host Bus Interface on the S1D13506 has a maximum BUSCLK of 50MHz, the output clock from the SA-1110 must be a divided down from the processor clock. The DRAM Refresh Control Register (MDREFR) determines the output of this signal. • If SDCLK2 is used, bit 26 should be set to 1 to divide the CPU clock by 4. • If SDCLK1 is used, bit 22 should be set to 1 to divide the CPU clock by 4. S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 15 4.4 Register/Memory Mapping The S1D13506 is a memory mapped device. The SA-1110 will use the memory assigned to a chip select (nCS4 in this example) to map the S1D13506 internal registers and display buffer. The internal registers require 2M bytes of memory and are mapped to the lower memory address space starting at zero. The display buffer also requires 2M bytes and is mapped in the third and fourth megabytes (ranging from 200000h to 3FFFFFh). This implementation decodes as shown in the following table. Table 4-2: Register/Memory Mapping for Typical Implementation M/R# (A21) Address Range Function 0 0 - 1F FFFFh Internal Registers 1 20 0000h - 3F FFFFh Display Buffer Each chip select on the SA-1110 provides 64M bytes of address space. Without further resolution of the decoding logic (M/R# connected to A21), the entire register set and display buffer are aliased for every 4M byte boundary within the specified address range of the chip select. Since address bits A[25:22] are ignored, the S1D13506 registers and display buffer are aliased 16 times. Note If aliasing is not desirable, the upper addresses must be fully decoded. Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 16 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 4.5 StrongARM SA-1110 Register Configuration The SA-1110 requires configuration of several of its internal registers to interface to the S1D13506 PC Card Host Bus Interface. • The Static Memory Control Registers (MSC[2:0]) are read/write registers containing control bits for configuring static memory or variable-latency IO devices. These registers correspond to chip select pairs nCS[5:4], nCS[3:2], and nCS[1:0] respectively. Each of the three registers contains two identical CNFG fields, one for each chip select within the pair. Since only nCS[5:3] controls variable-latency IO devices, MSC2 and MSC1 should be programmed based on the chip select used. Parameter RTx<1:0> should be set to 01b (selects variable-latency IO mode). Parameter RBWx should be set to 1 (selects 16-bit bus width). Parameter RDFx<4:0> should be set according to the maximum desired CPU frequency as indicated in the table below. Table 4-3: RDFx Parameter Value versus CPU Maximum Frequency CPU Frequency 147.5MHz 206.4MHz Up to SA-1110 maximum RDFx 2 3 4 Parameter RDNx<4:0> should be set to 0 (minimum command precharge time). Parameter RRRx<2:0> should be set to 0 (minimum nCSx precharge time). • The S1D13506 endian mode is set to little endian. To program the SA-1110 for little endian as well use the control register (register 1). • Bit 7 must be set to 0. • The BUSCLK signal input to the S1D13506 (from one of the SDCLK[2:1] pins) is a derivative of the SA-1110 internal processor speed. Since the PC Card Host Bus Interface on the S1D13506 has a maximum BUSCLK of 50MHz, the output clock from the SA-1110 must be a divided down from the processor clock. The DRAM Refresh Control Register (MDREFR) determines the output of this signal. • If SDCLK2 is used, bit 26 should be set to 1 to divide the CPU clock by 4. • If SDCLK1 is used, bit 22 should be set to 1 to divide the CPU clock by 4. S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 17 5 Software Test utilities and Windows® CE display drivers are available for the S1D13506. Full source code is available for both the test utilities and the drivers. The test utilities are configurable for different panel types using a program called 13506CFG, or by directly modifying the source. The Windows CE display drivers can be customized by the OEM for different panel types, resolutions and color depths only by modifying the source. The S1D13506 test utilities and Windows CE display drivers are available from your sales support contact or on the internet at http://www.eea.epson.com. Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 18 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center 6 References 6.1 Documents • Intel Corporation, StrongARM® SA-1110 Microprocessor Advanced Developer’s Manual, Order Number 278240-001. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Hardware Functional Specification, Document Number X25B-A-001-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S1D13506 Programming Notes and Examples, Document Number X25B-G-003-xx. • Epson Research and Development, Inc., S5U13506B00C Rev. 1.0 ISA Bus Evaluation Board User Manual, Document Number X25B-G-004-xx. 6.2 Document Sources • Intel Developers Website: http://developer.intel.com. • Intel Literature contact: 1(800) 548-4725. • Epson Electronics America Website: http://www.eea.epson.com. S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center Page 19 7 Technical Support 7.1 EPSON LCD/CRT Controllers (S1D13506) Japan Seiko Epson Corporation Electronic Devices Marketing Division 421-8, Hino, Hino-shi Tokyo 191-8501, Japan Tel: 042-587-5812 Fax: 042-587-5564 http://www.epson.co.jp North America Epson Electronics America, Inc. 150 River Oaks Parkway San Jose, CA 95134, USA Tel: (408) 922-0200 Fax: (408) 922-0238 http://www.eea.epson.com Taiwan, R.O.C. Epson Taiwan Technology & Trading Ltd. 10F, No. 287 Nanking East Road Sec. 3, Taipei, Taiwan, R.O.C. Tel: 02-2717-7360 Fax: 02-2712-9164 Hong Kong Epson Hong Kong Ltd. 20/F., Harbour Centre 25 Harbour Road Wanchai, Hong Kong Tel: 2585-4600 Fax: 2827-4346 Europe Epson Europe Electronics GmbH Riesstrasse 15 80992 Munich, Germany Tel: 089-14005-0 Fax: 089-14005-110 Singapore Epson Singapore Pte., Ltd. No. 1 Temasek Avenue #36-00 Millenia Tower Singapore, 039192 Tel: 337-7911 Fax: 334-2716 7.2 Intel StrongARM SA-1110 Micro-processor INTEL Intel Customer Support (ICS) for StrongARM: (800) 628-8686 Website for StrongARM Processor http://developer.intel.com/design/strong/ Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08 S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Page 20 Epson Research and Development Vancouver Design Center THIS PAGE LEFT BLANK S1D13506 X25B-G-013-03 Interfacing to the StrongARM SA-1110 Processor Issue Date: 01/02/08